3 \# Source code to NASM documentation
5 \M{category}{Programming}
6 \M{title}{NASM - The Netwide Assembler}
8 \M{author}{The NASM Development Team}
9 \M{license}{All rights reserved. This document is redistributable under the licence given in the file "COPYING" distributed in the NASM archive.}
10 \M{summary}{This file documents NASM, the Netwide Assembler: an assembler targetting the Intel x86 series of processors, with portable source.}
13 \M{infotitle}{The Netwide Assembler for x86}
14 \M{epslogo}{nasmlogo.eps}
20 \IR{-On} \c{-On} option
36 \IR{!=} \c{!=} operator
37 \IR{$, here} \c{$}, Here token
38 \IR{$, prefix} \c{$}, prefix
41 \IR{%%} \c{%%} operator
42 \IR{%+1} \c{%+1} and \c{%-1} syntax
44 \IR{%0} \c{%0} parameter count
46 \IR{&&} \c{&&} operator
48 \IR{..@} \c{..@} symbol prefix
50 \IR{//} \c{//} operator
52 \IR{<<} \c{<<} operator
53 \IR{<=} \c{<=} operator
54 \IR{<>} \c{<>} operator
56 \IR{==} \c{==} operator
58 \IR{>=} \c{>=} operator
59 \IR{>>} \c{>>} operator
60 \IR{?} \c{?} MASM syntax
62 \IR{^^} \c{^^} operator
64 \IR{||} \c{||} operator
66 \IR{%$} \c{%$} and \c{%$$} prefixes
68 \IR{+ opaddition} \c{+} operator, binary
69 \IR{+ opunary} \c{+} operator, unary
70 \IR{+ modifier} \c{+} modifier
71 \IR{- opsubtraction} \c{-} operator, binary
72 \IR{- opunary} \c{-} operator, unary
73 \IR{alignment, in bin sections} alignment, in \c{bin} sections
74 \IR{alignment, in elf sections} alignment, in \c{elf} sections
75 \IR{alignment, in win32 sections} alignment, in \c{win32} sections
76 \IR{alignment, of elf common variables} alignment, of \c{elf} common
78 \IR{alignment, in obj sections} alignment, in \c{obj} sections
79 \IR{a.out, bsd version} \c{a.out}, BSD version
80 \IR{a.out, linux version} \c{a.out}, Linux version
81 \IR{autoconf} Autoconf
83 \IR{bitwise and} bitwise AND
84 \IR{bitwise or} bitwise OR
85 \IR{bitwise xor} bitwise XOR
86 \IR{block ifs} block IFs
87 \IR{borland pascal} Borland, Pascal
88 \IR{borland's win32 compilers} Borland, Win32 compilers
89 \IR{braces, after % sign} braces, after \c{%} sign
91 \IR{c calling convention} C calling convention
92 \IR{c symbol names} C symbol names
93 \IA{critical expressions}{critical expression}
94 \IA{command line}{command-line}
95 \IA{case sensitivity}{case sensitive}
96 \IA{case-sensitive}{case sensitive}
97 \IA{case-insensitive}{case sensitive}
98 \IA{character constants}{character constant}
99 \IR{common object file format} Common Object File Format
100 \IR{common variables, alignment in elf} common variables, alignment
102 \IR{common, elf extensions to} \c{COMMON}, \c{elf} extensions to
103 \IR{common, obj extensions to} \c{COMMON}, \c{obj} extensions to
104 \IR{declaring structure} declaring structures
105 \IR{default-wrt mechanism} default-\c{WRT} mechanism
108 \IR{dll symbols, exporting} DLL symbols, exporting
109 \IR{dll symbols, importing} DLL symbols, importing
111 \IR{dos archive} DOS archive
112 \IR{dos source archive} DOS source archive
113 \IA{effective address}{effective addresses}
114 \IA{effective-address}{effective addresses}
116 \IR{elf, 16-bit code and} ELF, 16-bit code and
117 \IR{elf shared libraries} ELF, shared libraries
118 \IR{executable and linkable format} Executable and Linkable Format
119 \IR{extern, obj extensions to} \c{EXTERN}, \c{obj} extensions to
121 \IR{freelink} FreeLink
122 \IR{functions, c calling convention} functions, C calling convention
123 \IR{functions, pascal calling convention} functions, Pascal calling
125 \IR{global, aoutb extensions to} \c{GLOBAL}, \c{aoutb} extensions to
126 \IR{global, elf extensions to} \c{GLOBAL}, \c{elf} extensions to
127 \IR{global, rdf extensions to} \c{GLOBAL}, \c{rdf} extensions to
129 \IR{got relocations} \c{GOT} relocations
130 \IR{gotoff relocation} \c{GOTOFF} relocations
131 \IR{gotpc relocation} \c{GOTPC} relocations
132 \IR{intel number formats} Intel number formats
133 \IR{linux, elf} Linux, ELF
134 \IR{linux, a.out} Linux, \c{a.out}
135 \IR{linux, as86} Linux, \c{as86}
136 \IR{logical and} logical AND
137 \IR{logical or} logical OR
138 \IR{logical xor} logical XOR
140 \IA{memory reference}{memory references}
142 \IA{misc directory}{misc subdirectory}
143 \IR{misc subdirectory} \c{misc} subdirectory
144 \IR{microsoft omf} Microsoft OMF
145 \IR{mmx registers} MMX registers
146 \IA{modr/m}{modr/m byte}
147 \IR{modr/m byte} ModR/M byte
149 \IR{ms-dos device drivers} MS-DOS device drivers
150 \IR{multipush} \c{multipush} macro
151 \IR{nasm version} NASM version
155 \IR{operating system} operating system
157 \IR{pascal calling convention}Pascal calling convention
158 \IR{passes} passes, assembly
163 \IR{plt} \c{PLT} relocations
164 \IA{pre-defining macros}{pre-define}
165 \IA{preprocessor expressions}{preprocessor, expressions}
166 \IA{preprocessor loops}{preprocessor, loops}
167 \IA{preprocessor variables}{preprocessor, variables}
168 \IA{rdoff subdirectory}{rdoff}
169 \IR{rdoff} \c{rdoff} subdirectory
170 \IR{relocatable dynamic object file format} Relocatable Dynamic
172 \IR{relocations, pic-specific} relocations, PIC-specific
173 \IA{repeating}{repeating code}
174 \IR{section alignment, in elf} section alignment, in \c{elf}
175 \IR{section alignment, in bin} section alignment, in \c{bin}
176 \IR{section alignment, in obj} section alignment, in \c{obj}
177 \IR{section alignment, in win32} section alignment, in \c{win32}
178 \IR{section, elf extensions to} \c{SECTION}, \c{elf} extensions to
179 \IR{section, win32 extensions to} \c{SECTION}, \c{win32} extensions to
180 \IR{segment alignment, in bin} segment alignment, in \c{bin}
181 \IR{segment alignment, in obj} segment alignment, in \c{obj}
182 \IR{segment, obj extensions to} \c{SEGMENT}, \c{elf} extensions to
183 \IR{segment names, borland pascal} segment names, Borland Pascal
184 \IR{shift command} \c{shift} command
186 \IR{sib byte} SIB byte
187 \IR{solaris x86} Solaris x86
188 \IA{standard section names}{standardised section names}
189 \IR{symbols, exporting from dlls} symbols, exporting from DLLs
190 \IR{symbols, importing from dlls} symbols, importing from DLLs
191 \IR{test subdirectory} \c{test} subdirectory
193 \IR{underscore, in c symbols} underscore, in C symbols
195 \IA{sco unix}{unix, sco}
196 \IR{unix, sco} Unix, SCO
197 \IA{unix source archive}{unix, source archive}
198 \IR{unix, source archive} Unix, source archive
199 \IA{unix system v}{unix, system v}
200 \IR{unix, system v} Unix, System V
201 \IR{unixware} UnixWare
203 \IR{version number of nasm} version number of NASM
204 \IR{visual c++} Visual C++
205 \IR{www page} WWW page
208 \IR{windows 95} Windows 95
209 \IR{windows nt} Windows NT
210 \# \IC{program entry point}{entry point, program}
211 \# \IC{program entry point}{start point, program}
212 \# \IC{MS-DOS device drivers}{device drivers, MS-DOS}
213 \# \IC{16-bit mode, versus 32-bit mode}{32-bit mode, versus 16-bit mode}
214 \# \IC{c symbol names}{symbol names, in C}
217 \C{intro} Introduction
219 \H{whatsnasm} What Is NASM?
221 The Netwide Assembler, NASM, is an 80x86 assembler designed for
222 portability and modularity. It supports a range of object file
223 formats, including Linux and \c{NetBSD/FreeBSD} \c{a.out}, \c{ELF},
224 \c{COFF}, Microsoft 16-bit \c{OBJ} and \c{Win32}. It will also output
225 plain binary files. Its syntax is designed to be simple and easy to
226 understand, similar to Intel's but less complex. It supports \c{Pentium},
227 \c{P6}, \c{MMX}, \c{3DNow!}, \c{SSE} and \c{SSE2} opcodes, and has
231 \S{yaasm} Why Yet Another Assembler?
233 The Netwide Assembler grew out of an idea on \i\c{comp.lang.asm.x86}
234 (or possibly \i\c{alt.lang.asm} - I forget which), which was
235 essentially that there didn't seem to be a good \e{free} x86-series
236 assembler around, and that maybe someone ought to write one.
238 \b \i\c{a86} is good, but not free, and in particular you don't get any
239 32-bit capability until you pay. It's DOS only, too.
241 \b \i\c{gas} is free, and ports over DOS and Unix, but it's not
242 very good, since it's designed to be a back end to \i\c{gcc}, which
243 always feeds it correct code. So its error checking is minimal. Also,
244 its syntax is horrible, from the point of view of anyone trying to
245 actually \e{write} anything in it. Plus you can't write 16-bit code in
248 \b \i\c{as86} is Minix- and Linux-specific, and (my version at least)
249 doesn't seem to have much (or any) documentation.
251 \b \i\c{MASM} isn't very good, and it's expensive, and it runs only under
254 \b \i\c{TASM} is better, but still strives for MASM compatibility,
255 which means millions of directives and tons of red tape. And its syntax
256 is essentially MASM's, with the contradictions and quirks that
257 entails (although it sorts out some of those by means of Ideal mode).
258 It's expensive too. And it's DOS-only.
260 So here, for your coding pleasure, is NASM. At present it's
261 still in prototype stage - we don't promise that it can outperform
262 any of these assemblers. But please, \e{please} send us bug reports,
263 fixes, helpful information, and anything else you can get your hands
264 on (and thanks to the many people who've done this already! You all
265 know who you are), and we'll improve it out of all recognition.
269 \S{legal} Licence Conditions
271 Please see the file \c{Licence}, supplied as part of any NASM
272 distribution archive, for the \i{licence} conditions under which you
276 \H{contact} Contact Information
278 The current version of NASM (since about 0.98.08) are maintained by a
279 team of developers, accessible through the \c{nasm-devel} mailing list
280 (see below for the link).
281 If you want to report a bug, please read \k{bugs} first.
283 NASM has a \i{WWW page} at
284 \W{http://www.web-sites.co.uk/nasm}\c{http://www.web-sites.co.uk/nasm},
285 and another, with additional information, at
286 \W{http://nasm.2y.net/}\c{http://nasm.2y.net/}
288 The original authors are \i{e\-mail}able as
289 \W{mailto:jules@dsf.org.uk}\c{jules@dsf.org.uk} and
290 \W{mailto:anakin@pobox.com}\c{anakin@pobox.com}.
291 The latter is no longer involved in the development team.
293 \i{New releases} of NASM are uploaded to the official sites
294 \W{http://www.web-sites.co.uk/nasm}\c{http://www.web-sites.co.uk/nasm}
296 \W{ftp://ftp.kernel.org/pub/software/devel/nasm/}\i\c{ftp.kernel.org}
298 \W{ftp://ibiblio.org/pub/Linux/devel/lang/assemblers/}\i\c{ibiblio.org}.
300 Announcements are posted to
301 \W{news:comp.lang.asm.x86}\i\c{comp.lang.asm.x86},
302 \W{news:alt.lang.asm}\i\c{alt.lang.asm} and
303 \W{news:comp.os.linux.announce}\i\c{comp.os.linux.announce}
305 If you want information about NASM beta releases, and the current
306 development status, please subscribe to the \i\c{nasm-devel} email list
308 \W{http://groups.yahoo.com/group/nasm-devel}\c{http://groups.yahoo.com/group/nasm-devel},
309 \W{http://www.pairlist.net/mailman/listinfo/nasm-devel}\c{http://www.pairlist.net/mailman/listinfo/nasm-devel}
311 \W{http://sourceforge.net/projects/nasm}\c{http://sourceforge.net/projects/nasm}.
313 The preferred list is the list at Sourceforge, which is also the home to
314 the latest nasm source code and releases. The other lists are open, but
315 may not continue to be supported in the long term.
318 \H{install} Installation
320 \S{instdos} \i{Installing} NASM under MS-\i{DOS} or Windows
322 Once you've obtained the \i{DOS archive} for NASM, \i\c{nasmXXX.zip}
323 (where \c{XXX} denotes the version number of NASM contained in the
324 archive), unpack it into its own directory (for example \c{c:\\nasm}).
326 The archive will contain four executable files: the NASM executable
327 files \i\c{nasm.exe} and \i\c{nasmw.exe}, and the NDISASM executable
328 files \i\c{ndisasm.exe} and \i\c{ndisasmw.exe}. In each case, the
329 file whose name ends in \c{w} is a \I{Win32}\c{Win32} executable,
330 designed to run under \I{Windows 95}\c{Windows 95} or \I{Windows NT}
331 \c{Windows NT} Intel, and the other one is a 16-bit \I{DOS}\c{DOS}
334 The only file NASM needs to run is its own executable, so copy
335 (at least) one of \c{nasm.exe} and \c{nasmw.exe} to a directory on
336 your PATH, or alternatively edit \i\c{autoexec.bat} to add the
337 \c{nasm} directory to your \i\c{PATH}. (If you're only installing the
338 \c{Win32} version, you may wish to rename it to \c{nasm.exe}.)
340 That's it - NASM is installed. You don't need the nasm directory
341 to be present to run NASM (unless you've added it to your \c{PATH}),
342 so you can delete it if you need to save space; however, you may
343 want to keep the documentation or test programs.
345 If you've downloaded the \i{DOS source archive}, \i\c{nasmXXXs.zip},
346 the \c{nasm} directory will also contain the full NASM \i{source
347 code}, and a selection of \i{Makefiles} you can (hopefully) use to
348 rebuild your copy of NASM from scratch.
350 Note that the source files \c{insnsa.c}, \c{insnsd.c}, \c{insnsi.h}
351 and \c{insnsn.c} are automatically generated from the master
352 instruction table \c{insns.dat} by a Perl script; the file
353 \c{macros.c} is generated from \c{standard.mac} by another Perl
354 script. Although the NASM 0.98 distribution includes these generated
355 files, you will need to rebuild them (and hence, will need a Perl
356 interpreter) if you change insns.dat, standard.mac or the
357 documentation. It is possible future source distributions may not
358 include these files at all. Ports of \i{Perl} for a variety of
359 platforms, including DOS and Windows, are available from
360 \W{http://www.cpan.org/ports/}\i{www.cpan.org}.
363 \S{instdos} Installing NASM under \i{Unix}
365 Once you've obtained the \i{Unix source archive} for NASM,
366 \i\c{nasm-X.XX.tar.gz} (where \c{X.XX} denotes the version number of
367 NASM contained in the archive), unpack it into a directory such
368 as \c{/usr/local/src}. The archive, when unpacked, will create its
369 own subdirectory \c{nasm-X.XX}.
371 NASM is an \I{Autoconf}\I\c{configure}auto-configuring package: once
372 you've unpacked it, \c{cd} to the directory it's been unpacked into
373 and type \c{./configure}. This shell script will find the best C
374 compiler to use for building NASM and set up \i{Makefiles}
377 Once NASM has auto-configured, you can type \i\c{make} to build the
378 \c{nasm} and \c{ndisasm} binaries, and then \c{make install} to
379 install them in \c{/usr/local/bin} and install the \i{man pages}
380 \i\c{nasm.1} and \i\c{ndisasm.1} in \c{/usr/local/man/man1}.
381 Alternatively, you can give options such as \c{--prefix} to the
382 configure script (see the file \i\c{INSTALL} for more details), or
383 install the programs yourself.
385 NASM also comes with a set of utilities for handling the \c{RDOFF}
386 custom object-file format, which are in the \i\c{rdoff} subdirectory
387 of the NASM archive. You can build these with \c{make rdf} and
388 install them with \c{make rdf_install}, if you want them.
390 If NASM fails to auto-configure, you may still be able to make it
391 compile by using the fall-back Unix makefile \i\c{Makefile.unx}.
392 Copy or rename that file to \c{Makefile} and try typing \c{make}.
393 There is also a Makefile.unx file in the \c{rdoff} subdirectory.
396 \C{running} Running NASM
398 \H{syntax} NASM \i{Command-Line} Syntax
400 To assemble a file, you issue a command of the form
402 \c nasm -f <format> <filename> [-o <output>]
406 \c nasm -f elf myfile.asm
408 will assemble \c{myfile.asm} into an \c{ELF} object file \c{myfile.o}. And
410 \c nasm -f bin myfile.asm -o myfile.com
412 will assemble \c{myfile.asm} into a raw binary file \c{myfile.com}.
414 To produce a listing file, with the hex codes output from NASM
415 displayed on the left of the original sources, use the \c{-l} option
416 to give a listing file name, for example:
418 \c nasm -f coff myfile.asm -l myfile.lst
420 To get further usage instructions from NASM, try typing
424 This will also list the available output file formats, and what they
427 If you use Linux but aren't sure whether your system is \c{a.out}
432 (in the directory in which you put the NASM binary when you
433 installed it). If it says something like
435 \c nasm: ELF 32-bit LSB executable i386 (386 and up) Version 1
437 then your system is \c{ELF}, and you should use the option \c{-f elf}
438 when you want NASM to produce Linux object files. If it says
440 \c nasm: Linux/i386 demand-paged executable (QMAGIC)
442 or something similar, your system is \c{a.out}, and you should use
443 \c{-f aout} instead (Linux \c{a.out} systems have long been obsolete,
444 and are rare these days.)
446 Like Unix compilers and assemblers, NASM is silent unless it
447 goes wrong: you won't see any output at all, unless it gives error
451 \S{opt-o} The \i\c{-o} Option: Specifying the Output File Name
453 NASM will normally choose the name of your output file for you;
454 precisely how it does this is dependent on the object file format.
455 For Microsoft object file formats (\i\c{obj} and \i\c{win32}), it
456 will remove the \c{.asm} \i{extension} (or whatever extension you
457 like to use - NASM doesn't care) from your source file name and
458 substitute \c{.obj}. For Unix object file formats (\i\c{aout},
459 \i\c{coff}, \i\c{elf} and \i\c{as86}) it will substitute \c{.o}. For
460 \i\c{rdf}, it will use \c{.rdf}, and for the \i\c{bin} format it
461 will simply remove the extension, so that \c{myfile.asm} produces
462 the output file \c{myfile}.
464 If the output file already exists, NASM will overwrite it, unless it
465 has the same name as the input file, in which case it will give a
466 warning and use \i\c{nasm.out} as the output file name instead.
468 For situations in which this behaviour is unacceptable, NASM
469 provides the \c{-o} command-line option, which allows you to specify
470 your desired output file name. You invoke \c{-o} by following it
471 with the name you wish for the output file, either with or without
472 an intervening space. For example:
474 \c nasm -f bin program.asm -o program.com
475 \c nasm -f bin driver.asm -odriver.sys
477 Note that this is a small o, and is different from a capital O , which
478 is used to specify the number of optimisation passes required. See \k{opt-On}.
481 \S{opt-f} The \i\c{-f} Option: Specifying the \i{Output File Format}
483 If you do not supply the \c{-f} option to NASM, it will choose an
484 output file format for you itself. In the distribution versions of
485 NASM, the default is always \i\c{bin}; if you've compiled your own
486 copy of NASM, you can redefine \i\c{OF_DEFAULT} at compile time and
487 choose what you want the default to be.
489 Like \c{-o}, the intervening space between \c{-f} and the output
490 file format is optional; so \c{-f elf} and \c{-felf} are both valid.
492 A complete list of the available output file formats can be given by
493 issuing the command \i\c{nasm -hf}.
496 \S{opt-l} The \i\c{-l} Option: Generating a \i{Listing File}
498 If you supply the \c{-l} option to NASM, followed (with the usual
499 optional space) by a file name, NASM will generate a
500 \i{source-listing file} for you, in which addresses and generated
501 code are listed on the left, and the actual source code, with
502 expansions of multi-line macros (except those which specifically
503 request no expansion in source listings: see \k{nolist}) on the
506 \c nasm -f elf myfile.asm -l myfile.lst
509 \S{opt-M} The \i\c{-M} Option: Generate \i{Makefile Dependencies}.
511 This option can be used to generate makefile dependencies on stdout.
512 This can be redirected to a file for further processing. For example:
514 \c NASM -M myfile.asm > myfile.dep
517 \S{opt-F} The \i\c{-F} Option: Selecting a \i{Debugging Format}
519 This option can be used to select a debugging format for the output file.
520 The syntax is the same as for the -f option, except that it produces
521 output in a debugging format.
523 A complete list of the available debug file formats for an output format
524 can be seen by issuing the command \i\c{nasm -f <format> -y}.
526 This option is not built into NASM by default. For information on how
527 to enable it when building from the sources, see \k{dbgfmt}
530 \S{opt-g} The \i\c{-g} Option: Enabling \i{Debug Information}.
532 This option can be used to generate debugging information in the specified
535 See \k{opt-F} for more information.
538 \S{opt-X} The \i\c{-X} Option: Selecting an \i{Error Reporting Format}
540 This option can be used to select an error reporting format for any
541 error messages that might be produced by NASM.
543 Currently, two error reporting formats may be selected. They are
544 the \c{-Xvc} option and the \c{-Xgnu} option. The GNU format is
545 the default and looks like this:
547 \c filename.asm:65: error: specific error message
549 where \c{filename.asm} is the name of the source file in which the
550 error was detected, \c{65} is the source file line number on which
551 the error was detected, \c{error} is the severity of the error (this
552 could be \c{warning}), and \c{specific error message} is a more
553 detailed text message which should help pinpoint the exact problem.
555 The other format, specified by \c{-Xvc} is the style used by Microsoft
556 Visual C++ and some other programs. It looks like this:
558 \c filename.asm(65) : error: specific error message
560 where the only difference is that the line number is in parentheses
561 instead of being delimited by colons.
563 See also the \c{Visual C++} output format, \k{win32fmt}.
565 \S{opt-E} The \i\c{-E} Option: Send Errors to a File
567 Under \I{DOS}\c{MS-DOS} it can be difficult (though there are ways) to
568 redirect the standard-error output of a program to a file. Since
569 NASM usually produces its warning and \i{error messages} on
570 \i\c{stderr}, this can make it hard to capture the errors if (for
571 example) you want to load them into an editor.
573 NASM therefore provides the \c{-E} option, taking a filename argument
574 which causes errors to be sent to the specified files rather than
575 standard error. Therefore you can \I{redirecting errors}redirect
576 the errors into a file by typing
578 \c nasm -E myfile.err -f obj myfile.asm
581 \S{opt-s} The \i\c{-s} Option: Send Errors to \i\c{stdout}
583 The \c{-s} option redirects \i{error messages} to \c{stdout} rather
584 than \c{stderr}, so it can be redirected under \I{DOS}\c{MS-DOS}. To
585 assemble the file \c{myfile.asm} and pipe its output to the \c{more}
586 program, you can type:
588 \c nasm -s -f obj myfile.asm | more
590 See also the \c{-E} option, \k{opt-E}.
593 \S{opt-i} The \i\c{-i}\I\c{-I} Option: Include File Search Directories
595 When NASM sees the \i\c{%include} directive in a source file (see
596 \k{include}), it will search for the given file not only in the
597 current directory, but also in any directories specified on the
598 command line by the use of the \c{-i} option. Therefore you can
599 include files from a \i{macro library}, for example, by typing
601 \c nasm -ic:\macrolib\ -f obj myfile.asm
603 (As usual, a space between \c{-i} and the path name is allowed, and
606 NASM, in the interests of complete source-code portability, does not
607 understand the file naming conventions of the OS it is running on;
608 the string you provide as an argument to the \c{-i} option will be
609 prepended exactly as written to the name of the include file.
610 Therefore the trailing backslash in the above example is necessary.
611 Under Unix, a trailing forward slash is similarly necessary.
613 (You can use this to your advantage, if you're really \i{perverse},
614 by noting that the option \c{-ifoo} will cause \c{%include "bar.i"}
615 to search for the file \c{foobar.i}...)
617 If you want to define a \e{standard} \i{include search path},
618 similar to \c{/usr/include} on Unix systems, you should place one or
619 more \c{-i} directives in the \c{NASMENV} environment variable (see
622 For Makefile compatibility with many C compilers, this option can also
623 be specified as \c{-I}.
626 \S{opt-p} The \i\c{-p}\I\c{-P} Option: \I{pre-including files}Pre-Include a File
628 \I\c{%include}NASM allows you to specify files to be
629 \e{pre-included} into your source file, by the use of the \c{-p}
632 \c nasm myfile.asm -p myinc.inc
634 is equivalent to running \c{nasm myfile.asm} and placing the
635 directive \c{%include "myinc.inc"} at the start of the file.
637 For consistency with the \c{-I}, \c{-D} and \c{-U} options, this
638 option can also be specified as \c{-P}.
641 \S{opt-d} The \i\c{-d}\I\c{-D} Option: \I{pre-defining macros}Pre-Define a Macro
643 \I\c{%define}Just as the \c{-p} option gives an alternative to placing
644 \c{%include} directives at the start of a source file, the \c{-d}
645 option gives an alternative to placing a \c{%define} directive. You
648 \c nasm myfile.asm -dFOO=100
650 as an alternative to placing the directive
654 at the start of the file. You can miss off the macro value, as well:
655 the option \c{-dFOO} is equivalent to coding \c{%define FOO}. This
656 form of the directive may be useful for selecting \i{assembly-time
657 options} which are then tested using \c{%ifdef}, for example
660 For Makefile compatibility with many C compilers, this option can also
661 be specified as \c{-D}.
664 \S{opt-u} The \i\c{-u}\I\c{-U} Option: \I{Undefining macros}Undefine a Macro
666 \I\c{%undef}The \c{-u} option undefines a macro that would otherwise
667 have been pre-defined, either automatically or by a \c{-p} or \c{-d}
668 option specified earlier on the command lines.
670 For example, the following command line:
672 \c nasm myfile.asm -dFOO=100 -uFOO
674 would result in \c{FOO} \e{not} being a predefined macro in the
675 program. This is useful to override options specified at a different
678 For Makefile compatibility with many C compilers, this option can also
679 be specified as \c{-U}.
682 \S{opt-e} The \i\c{-e} Option: Preprocess Only
684 NASM allows the \i{preprocessor} to be run on its own, up to a
685 point. Using the \c{-e} option (which requires no arguments) will
686 cause NASM to preprocess its input file, expand all the macro
687 references, remove all the comments and preprocessor directives, and
688 print the resulting file on standard output (or save it to a file,
689 if the \c{-o} option is also used).
691 This option cannot be applied to programs which require the
692 preprocessor to evaluate \I{preprocessor expressions}\i{expressions}
693 which depend on the values of symbols: so code such as
695 \c %assign tablesize ($-tablestart)
697 will cause an error in \i{preprocess-only mode}.
700 \S{opt-a} The \i\c{-a} Option: Don't Preprocess At All
702 If NASM is being used as the back end to a compiler, it might be
703 desirable to \I{suppressing preprocessing}suppress preprocessing
704 completely and assume the compiler has already done it, to save time
705 and increase compilation speeds. The \c{-a} option, requiring no
706 argument, instructs NASM to replace its powerful \i{preprocessor}
707 with a \i{stub preprocessor} which does nothing.
710 \S{opt-On} The \i\c{-On} Option: Specifying \i{Multipass Optimization}.
712 NASM defaults to being a two pass assembler. This means that if you
713 have a complex source file which needs more than 2 passes to assemble
714 correctly, you have to tell it.
716 Using the \c{-O} option, you can tell NASM to carry out multiple passes.
719 \b \c{-O0} strict two-pass assembly, JMP and Jcc are handled more
720 like v0.98, except that backward JMPs are short, if possible.
721 Immediate operands take their long forms if a short form is
724 \b \c{-O1} strict two-pass assembly, but forward branches are assembled
725 with code guaranteed to reach; may produce larger code than
726 -O0, but will produce successful assembly more often if
727 branch offset sizes are not specified.
728 Additionally, immediate operands which will fit in a signed byte
729 are optimised, unless the long form is specified.
731 \b \c{-On} multi-pass optimization, minimize branch offsets; also will
732 minimize signed immediate bytes, overriding size specification
733 when the \c{strict} keyword hasn't been used (see \k{strict}).
734 If 2 <= n <= 3, then there are 5 * n passes, otherwise there
738 Note that this is a capital O, and is different from a small o, which
739 is used to specify the output format. See \k{opt-o}.
742 \S{opt-t} The \i\c{-t} option: Enable TASM Compatibility Mode
744 NASM includes a limited form of compatibility with Borland's \i\c{TASM}.
745 When NASM's \c{-t} option is used, the following changes are made:
747 \b local labels may be prefixed with \c{@@} instead of \c{.}
749 \b TASM-style response files beginning with \c{@} may be specified on
750 the command line. This is different from the \c{-@resp} style that NASM
753 \b size override is supported within brackets. In TASM compatible mode,
754 a size override inside square brackets changes the size of the operand,
755 and not the address type of the operand as it does in NASM syntax. E.g.
756 \c{mov eax,[DWORD val]} is valid syntax in TASM compatibility mode.
757 Note that you lose the ability to override the default address type for
760 \b \c{%arg} preprocessor directive is supported which is similar to
761 TASM's \c{ARG} directive.
763 \b \c{%local} preprocessor directive
765 \b \c{%stacksize} preprocessor directive
767 \b unprefixed forms of some directives supported (\c{arg}, \c{elif},
768 \c{else}, \c{endif}, \c{if}, \c{ifdef}, \c{ifdifi}, \c{ifndef},
769 \c{include}, \c{local})
773 For more information on the directives, see the section on TASM
774 Compatiblity preprocessor directives in \k{tasmcompat}.
777 \S{opt-w} The \i\c{-w} Option: Enable or Disable Assembly \i{Warnings}
779 NASM can observe many conditions during the course of assembly which
780 are worth mentioning to the user, but not a sufficiently severe
781 error to justify NASM refusing to generate an output file. These
782 conditions are reported like errors, but come up with the word
783 `warning' before the message. Warnings do not prevent NASM from
784 generating an output file and returning a success status to the
787 Some conditions are even less severe than that: they are only
788 sometimes worth mentioning to the user. Therefore NASM supports the
789 \c{-w} command-line option, which enables or disables certain
790 classes of assembly warning. Such warning classes are described by a
791 name, for example \c{orphan-labels}; you can enable warnings of
792 this class by the command-line option \c{-w+orphan-labels} and
793 disable it by \c{-w-orphan-labels}.
795 The \i{suppressible warning} classes are:
797 \b \i\c{macro-params} covers warnings about \i{multi-line macros}
798 being invoked with the wrong number of parameters. This warning
799 class is enabled by default; see \k{mlmacover} for an example of why
800 you might want to disable it.
802 \b \i\c{orphan-labels} covers warnings about source lines which
803 contain no instruction but define a label without a trailing colon.
804 NASM does not warn about this somewhat obscure condition by default;
805 see \k{syntax} for an example of why you might want it to.
807 \b \i\c{number-overflow} covers warnings about numeric constants which
808 don't fit in 32 bits (for example, it's easy to type one too many Fs
809 and produce \c{0x7ffffffff} by mistake). This warning class is
813 \S{opt-v} The \i\c{-v} Option: Display \i{Version} Info
815 Typing \c{NASM -v} will display the version of NASM which you are using,
816 and the date on which it was compiled.
818 You will need the version number if you report a bug.
821 \S{nasmenv} The \c{NASMENV} \i{Environment} Variable
823 If you define an environment variable called \c{NASMENV}, the program
824 will interpret it as a list of extra command-line options, which are
825 processed before the real command line. You can use this to define
826 standard search directories for include files, by putting \c{-i}
827 options in the \c{NASMENV} variable.
829 The value of the variable is split up at white space, so that the
830 value \c{-s -ic:\\nasmlib} will be treated as two separate options.
831 However, that means that the value \c{-dNAME="my name"} won't do
832 what you might want, because it will be split at the space and the
833 NASM command-line processing will get confused by the two
834 nonsensical words \c{-dNAME="my} and \c{name"}.
836 To get round this, NASM provides a feature whereby, if you begin the
837 \c{NASMENV} environment variable with some character that isn't a minus
838 sign, then NASM will treat this character as the \i{separator
839 character} for options. So setting the \c{NASMENV} variable to the
840 value \c{!-s!-ic:\\nasmlib} is equivalent to setting it to \c{-s
841 -ic:\\nasmlib}, but \c{!-dNAME="my name"} will work.
843 This environment variable was previously called \c{NASM}. This was
844 changed with version 0.98.31.
847 \H{qstart} \i{Quick Start} for \i{MASM} Users
849 If you're used to writing programs with MASM, or with \i{TASM} in
850 MASM-compatible (non-Ideal) mode, or with \i\c{a86}, this section
851 attempts to outline the major differences between MASM's syntax and
852 NASM's. If you're not already used to MASM, it's probably worth
853 skipping this section.
856 \S{qscs} NASM Is \I{case sensitivity}Case-Sensitive
858 One simple difference is that NASM is case-sensitive. It makes a
859 difference whether you call your label \c{foo}, \c{Foo} or \c{FOO}.
860 If you're assembling to \c{DOS} or \c{OS/2} \c{.OBJ} files, you can
861 invoke the \i\c{UPPERCASE} directive (documented in \k{objfmt}) to
862 ensure that all symbols exported to other code modules are forced
863 to be upper case; but even then, \e{within} a single module, NASM
864 will distinguish between labels differing only in case.
867 \S{qsbrackets} NASM Requires \i{Square Brackets} For \i{Memory References}
869 NASM was designed with simplicity of syntax in mind. One of the
870 \i{design goals} of NASM is that it should be possible, as far as is
871 practical, for the user to look at a single line of NASM code
872 and tell what opcode is generated by it. You can't do this in MASM:
873 if you declare, for example,
878 then the two lines of code
883 generate completely different opcodes, despite having
884 identical-looking syntaxes.
886 NASM avoids this undesirable situation by having a much simpler
887 syntax for memory references. The rule is simply that any access to
888 the \e{contents} of a memory location requires square brackets
889 around the address, and any access to the \e{address} of a variable
890 doesn't. So an instruction of the form \c{mov ax,foo} will
891 \e{always} refer to a compile-time constant, whether it's an \c{EQU}
892 or the address of a variable; and to access the \e{contents} of the
893 variable \c{bar}, you must code \c{mov ax,[bar]}.
895 This also means that NASM has no need for MASM's \i\c{OFFSET}
896 keyword, since the MASM code \c{mov ax,offset bar} means exactly the
897 same thing as NASM's \c{mov ax,bar}. If you're trying to get
898 large amounts of MASM code to assemble sensibly under NASM, you
899 can always code \c{%idefine offset} to make the preprocessor treat
900 the \c{OFFSET} keyword as a no-op.
902 This issue is even more confusing in \i\c{a86}, where declaring a
903 label with a trailing colon defines it to be a `label' as opposed to
904 a `variable' and causes \c{a86} to adopt NASM-style semantics; so in
905 \c{a86}, \c{mov ax,var} has different behaviour depending on whether
906 \c{var} was declared as \c{var: dw 0} (a label) or \c{var dw 0} (a
907 word-size variable). NASM is very simple by comparison:
908 \e{everything} is a label.
910 NASM, in the interests of simplicity, also does not support the
911 \i{hybrid syntaxes} supported by MASM and its clones, such as
912 \c{mov ax,table[bx]}, where a memory reference is denoted by one
913 portion outside square brackets and another portion inside. The
914 correct syntax for the above is \c{mov ax,[table+bx]}. Likewise,
915 \c{mov ax,es:[di]} is wrong and \c{mov ax,[es:di]} is right.
918 \S{qstypes} NASM Doesn't Store \i{Variable Types}
920 NASM, by design, chooses not to remember the types of variables you
921 declare. Whereas MASM will remember, on seeing \c{var dw 0}, that
922 you declared \c{var} as a word-size variable, and will then be able
923 to fill in the \i{ambiguity} in the size of the instruction \c{mov
924 var,2}, NASM will deliberately remember nothing about the symbol
925 \c{var} except where it begins, and so you must explicitly code
926 \c{mov word [var],2}.
928 For this reason, NASM doesn't support the \c{LODS}, \c{MOVS},
929 \c{STOS}, \c{SCAS}, \c{CMPS}, \c{INS}, or \c{OUTS} instructions,
930 but only supports the forms such as \c{LODSB}, \c{MOVSW}, and
931 \c{SCASD}, which explicitly specify the size of the components of
932 the strings being manipulated.
935 \S{qsassume} NASM Doesn't \i\c{ASSUME}
937 As part of NASM's drive for simplicity, it also does not support the
938 \c{ASSUME} directive. NASM will not keep track of what values you
939 choose to put in your segment registers, and will never
940 \e{automatically} generate a \i{segment override} prefix.
943 \S{qsmodel} NASM Doesn't Support \i{Memory Models}
945 NASM also does not have any directives to support different 16-bit
946 memory models. The programmer has to keep track of which functions
947 are supposed to be called with a \i{far call} and which with a
948 \i{near call}, and is responsible for putting the correct form of
949 \c{RET} instruction (\c{RETN} or \c{RETF}; NASM accepts \c{RET}
950 itself as an alternate form for \c{RETN}); in addition, the
951 programmer is responsible for coding CALL FAR instructions where
952 necessary when calling \e{external} functions, and must also keep
953 track of which external variable definitions are far and which are
957 \S{qsfpu} \i{Floating-Point} Differences
959 NASM uses different names to refer to floating-point registers from
960 MASM: where MASM would call them \c{ST(0)}, \c{ST(1)} and so on, and
961 \i\c{a86} would call them simply \c{0}, \c{1} and so on, NASM
962 chooses to call them \c{st0}, \c{st1} etc.
964 As of version 0.96, NASM now treats the instructions with
965 \i{`nowait'} forms in the same way as MASM-compatible assemblers.
966 The idiosyncratic treatment employed by 0.95 and earlier was based
967 on a misunderstanding by the authors.
970 \S{qsother} Other Differences
972 For historical reasons, NASM uses the keyword \i\c{TWORD} where MASM
973 and compatible assemblers use \i\c{TBYTE}.
975 NASM does not declare \i{uninitialised storage} in the same way as
976 MASM: where a MASM programmer might use \c{stack db 64 dup (?)},
977 NASM requires \c{stack resb 64}, intended to be read as `reserve 64
978 bytes'. For a limited amount of compatibility, since NASM treats
979 \c{?} as a valid character in symbol names, you can code \c{? equ 0}
980 and then writing \c{dw ?} will at least do something vaguely useful.
981 \I\c{RESB}\i\c{DUP} is still not a supported syntax, however.
983 In addition to all of this, macros and directives work completely
984 differently to MASM. See \k{preproc} and \k{directive} for further
988 \C{lang} The NASM Language
990 \H{syntax} Layout of a NASM Source Line
992 Like most assemblers, each NASM source line contains (unless it
993 is a macro, a preprocessor directive or an assembler directive: see
994 \k{preproc} and \k{directive}) some combination of the four fields
996 \c label: instruction operands ; comment
998 As usual, most of these fields are optional; the presence or absence
999 of any combination of a label, an instruction and a comment is allowed.
1000 Of course, the operand field is either required or forbidden by the
1001 presence and nature of the instruction field.
1003 NASM uses backslash (\\) as the line continuation character; if a line
1004 ends with backslash, the next line is considered to be a part of the
1005 backslash-ended line.
1007 NASM places no restrictions on white space within a line: labels may
1008 have white space before them, or instructions may have no space
1009 before them, or anything. The \i{colon} after a label is also
1010 optional. (Note that this means that if you intend to code \c{lodsb}
1011 alone on a line, and type \c{lodab} by accident, then that's still a
1012 valid source line which does nothing but define a label. Running
1013 NASM with the command-line option
1014 \I{orphan-labels}\c{-w+orphan-labels} will cause it to warn you if
1015 you define a label alone on a line without a \i{trailing colon}.)
1017 \i{Valid characters} in labels are letters, numbers, \c{_}, \c{$},
1018 \c{#}, \c{@}, \c{~}, \c{.}, and \c{?}. The only characters which may
1019 be used as the \e{first} character of an identifier are letters,
1020 \c{.} (with special meaning: see \k{locallab}), \c{_} and \c{?}.
1021 An identifier may also be prefixed with a \I{$, prefix}\c{$} to
1022 indicate that it is intended to be read as an identifier and not a
1023 reserved word; thus, if some other module you are linking with
1024 defines a symbol called \c{eax}, you can refer to \c{$eax} in NASM
1025 code to distinguish the symbol from the register.
1027 The instruction field may contain any machine instruction: Pentium
1028 and P6 instructions, FPU instructions, MMX instructions and even
1029 undocumented instructions are all supported. The instruction may be
1030 prefixed by \c{LOCK}, \c{REP}, \c{REPE}/\c{REPZ} or
1031 \c{REPNE}/\c{REPNZ}, in the usual way. Explicit \I{address-size
1032 prefixes}address-size and \i{operand-size prefixes} \c{A16},
1033 \c{A32}, \c{O16} and \c{O32} are provided - one example of their use
1034 is given in \k{mixsize}. You can also use the name of a \I{segment
1035 override}segment register as an instruction prefix: coding
1036 \c{es mov [bx],ax} is equivalent to coding \c{mov [es:bx],ax}. We
1037 recommend the latter syntax, since it is consistent with other
1038 syntactic features of the language, but for instructions such as
1039 \c{LODSB}, which has no operands and yet can require a segment
1040 override, there is no clean syntactic way to proceed apart from
1043 An instruction is not required to use a prefix: prefixes such as
1044 \c{CS}, \c{A32}, \c{LOCK} or \c{REPE} can appear on a line by
1045 themselves, and NASM will just generate the prefix bytes.
1047 In addition to actual machine instructions, NASM also supports a
1048 number of pseudo-instructions, described in \k{pseudop}.
1050 Instruction \i{operands} may take a number of forms: they can be
1051 registers, described simply by the register name (e.g. \c{ax},
1052 \c{bp}, \c{ebx}, \c{cr0}: NASM does not use the \c{gas}-style
1053 syntax in which register names must be prefixed by a \c{%} sign), or
1054 they can be \i{effective addresses} (see \k{effaddr}), constants
1055 (\k{const}) or expressions (\k{expr}).
1057 For \i{floating-point} instructions, NASM accepts a wide range of
1058 syntaxes: you can use two-operand forms like MASM supports, or you
1059 can use NASM's native single-operand forms in most cases. Details of
1060 all forms of each supported instruction are given in
1061 \k{iref}. For example, you can code:
1063 \c fadd st1 ; this sets st0 := st0 + st1
1064 \c fadd st0,st1 ; so does this
1066 \c fadd st1,st0 ; this sets st1 := st1 + st0
1067 \c fadd to st1 ; so does this
1069 Almost any floating-point instruction that references memory must
1070 use one of the prefixes \i\c{DWORD}, \i\c{QWORD} or \i\c{TWORD} to
1071 indicate what size of \i{memory operand} it refers to.
1074 \H{pseudop} \i{Pseudo-Instructions}
1076 Pseudo-instructions are things which, though not real x86 machine
1077 instructions, are used in the instruction field anyway because
1078 that's the most convenient place to put them. The current
1079 pseudo-instructions are \i\c{DB}, \i\c{DW}, \i\c{DD}, \i\c{DQ} and
1080 \i\c{DT}, their \i{uninitialised} counterparts \i\c{RESB},
1081 \i\c{RESW}, \i\c{RESD}, \i\c{RESQ} and \i\c{REST}, the \i\c{INCBIN}
1082 command, the \i\c{EQU} command, and the \i\c{TIMES} prefix.
1085 \S{db} \c{DB} and friends: Declaring Initialised Data
1087 \i\c{DB}, \i\c{DW}, \i\c{DD}, \i\c{DQ} and \i\c{DT} are used, much
1088 as in MASM, to declare initialised data in the output file. They can
1089 be invoked in a wide range of ways:
1090 \I{floating-point}\I{character constant}\I{string constant}
1092 \c db 0x55 ; just the byte 0x55
1093 \c db 0x55,0x56,0x57 ; three bytes in succession
1094 \c db 'a',0x55 ; character constants are OK
1095 \c db 'hello',13,10,'$' ; so are string constants
1096 \c dw 0x1234 ; 0x34 0x12
1097 \c dw 'a' ; 0x41 0x00 (it's just a number)
1098 \c dw 'ab' ; 0x41 0x42 (character constant)
1099 \c dw 'abc' ; 0x41 0x42 0x43 0x00 (string)
1100 \c dd 0x12345678 ; 0x78 0x56 0x34 0x12
1101 \c dd 1.234567e20 ; floating-point constant
1102 \c dq 1.234567e20 ; double-precision float
1103 \c dt 1.234567e20 ; extended-precision float
1105 \c{DQ} and \c{DT} do not accept \i{numeric constants} or string
1106 constants as operands.
1109 \S{resb} \c{RESB} and friends: Declaring \i{Uninitialised} Data
1111 \i\c{RESB}, \i\c{RESW}, \i\c{RESD}, \i\c{RESQ} and \i\c{REST} are
1112 designed to be used in the BSS section of a module: they declare
1113 \e{uninitialised} storage space. Each takes a single operand, which
1114 is the number of bytes, words, doublewords or whatever to reserve.
1115 As stated in \k{qsother}, NASM does not support the MASM/TASM syntax
1116 of reserving uninitialised space by writing \I\c{?}\c{DW ?} or
1117 similar things: this is what it does instead. The operand to a
1118 \c{RESB}-type pseudo-instruction is a \i\e{critical expression}: see
1123 \c buffer: resb 64 ; reserve 64 bytes
1124 \c wordvar: resw 1 ; reserve a word
1125 \c realarray resq 10 ; array of ten reals
1128 \S{incbin} \i\c{INCBIN}: Including External \i{Binary Files}
1130 \c{INCBIN} is borrowed from the old Amiga assembler \i{DevPac}: it
1131 includes a binary file verbatim into the output file. This can be
1132 handy for (for example) including \i{graphics} and \i{sound} data
1133 directly into a game executable file. It can be called in one of
1136 \c incbin "file.dat" ; include the whole file
1137 \c incbin "file.dat",1024 ; skip the first 1024 bytes
1138 \c incbin "file.dat",1024,512 ; skip the first 1024, and
1139 \c ; actually include at most 512
1142 \S{equ} \i\c{EQU}: Defining Constants
1144 \c{EQU} defines a symbol to a given constant value: when \c{EQU} is
1145 used, the source line must contain a label. The action of \c{EQU} is
1146 to define the given label name to the value of its (only) operand.
1147 This definition is absolute, and cannot change later. So, for
1150 \c message db 'hello, world'
1151 \c msglen equ $-message
1153 defines \c{msglen} to be the constant 12. \c{msglen} may not then be
1154 redefined later. This is not a \i{preprocessor} definition either:
1155 the value of \c{msglen} is evaluated \e{once}, using the value of
1156 \c{$} (see \k{expr} for an explanation of \c{$}) at the point of
1157 definition, rather than being evaluated wherever it is referenced
1158 and using the value of \c{$} at the point of reference. Note that
1159 the operand to an \c{EQU} is also a \i{critical expression}
1163 \S{times} \i\c{TIMES}: \i{Repeating} Instructions or Data
1165 The \c{TIMES} prefix causes the instruction to be assembled multiple
1166 times. This is partly present as NASM's equivalent of the \i\c{DUP}
1167 syntax supported by \i{MASM}-compatible assemblers, in that you can
1170 \c zerobuf: times 64 db 0
1172 or similar things; but \c{TIMES} is more versatile than that. The
1173 argument to \c{TIMES} is not just a numeric constant, but a numeric
1174 \e{expression}, so you can do things like
1176 \c buffer: db 'hello, world'
1177 \c times 64-$+buffer db ' '
1179 which will store exactly enough spaces to make the total length of
1180 \c{buffer} up to 64. Finally, \c{TIMES} can be applied to ordinary
1181 instructions, so you can code trivial \i{unrolled loops} in it:
1185 Note that there is no effective difference between \c{times 100 resb
1186 1} and \c{resb 100}, except that the latter will be assembled about
1187 100 times faster due to the internal structure of the assembler.
1189 The operand to \c{TIMES}, like that of \c{EQU} and those of \c{RESB}
1190 and friends, is a critical expression (\k{crit}).
1192 Note also that \c{TIMES} can't be applied to \i{macros}: the reason
1193 for this is that \c{TIMES} is processed after the macro phase, which
1194 allows the argument to \c{TIMES} to contain expressions such as
1195 \c{64-$+buffer} as above. To repeat more than one line of code, or a
1196 complex macro, use the preprocessor \i\c{%rep} directive.
1199 \H{effaddr} Effective Addresses
1201 An \i{effective address} is any operand to an instruction which
1202 \I{memory reference}references memory. Effective addresses, in NASM,
1203 have a very simple syntax: they consist of an expression evaluating
1204 to the desired address, enclosed in \i{square brackets}. For
1209 \c mov ax,[wordvar+1]
1210 \c mov ax,[es:wordvar+bx]
1212 Anything not conforming to this simple system is not a valid memory
1213 reference in NASM, for example \c{es:wordvar[bx]}.
1215 More complicated effective addresses, such as those involving more
1216 than one register, work in exactly the same way:
1218 \c mov eax,[ebx*2+ecx+offset]
1221 NASM is capable of doing \i{algebra} on these effective addresses,
1222 so that things which don't necessarily \e{look} legal are perfectly
1225 \c mov eax,[ebx*5] ; assembles as [ebx*4+ebx]
1226 \c mov eax,[label1*2-label2] ; ie [label1+(label1-label2)]
1228 Some forms of effective address have more than one assembled form;
1229 in most such cases NASM will generate the smallest form it can. For
1230 example, there are distinct assembled forms for the 32-bit effective
1231 addresses \c{[eax*2+0]} and \c{[eax+eax]}, and NASM will generally
1232 generate the latter on the grounds that the former requires four
1233 bytes to store a zero offset.
1235 NASM has a hinting mechanism which will cause \c{[eax+ebx]} and
1236 \c{[ebx+eax]} to generate different opcodes; this is occasionally
1237 useful because \c{[esi+ebp]} and \c{[ebp+esi]} have different
1238 default segment registers.
1240 However, you can force NASM to generate an effective address in a
1241 particular form by the use of the keywords \c{BYTE}, \c{WORD},
1242 \c{DWORD} and \c{NOSPLIT}. If you need \c{[eax+3]} to be assembled
1243 using a double-word offset field instead of the one byte NASM will
1244 normally generate, you can code \c{[dword eax+3]}. Similarly, you
1245 can force NASM to use a byte offset for a small value which it
1246 hasn't seen on the first pass (see \k{crit} for an example of such a
1247 code fragment) by using \c{[byte eax+offset]}. As special cases,
1248 \c{[byte eax]} will code \c{[eax+0]} with a byte offset of zero, and
1249 \c{[dword eax]} will code it with a double-word offset of zero. The
1250 normal form, \c{[eax]}, will be coded with no offset field.
1252 The form described in the previous paragraph is also useful if you
1253 are trying to access data in a 32-bit segment from within 16 bit code.
1254 For more information on this see the section on mixed-size addressing
1255 (\k{mixaddr}). In particular, if you need to access data with a known
1256 offset that is larger than will fit in a 16-bit value, if you don't
1257 specify that it is a dword offset, nasm will cause the high word of
1258 the offset to be lost.
1260 Similarly, NASM will split \c{[eax*2]} into \c{[eax+eax]} because
1261 that allows the offset field to be absent and space to be saved; in
1262 fact, it will also split \c{[eax*2+offset]} into
1263 \c{[eax+eax+offset]}. You can combat this behaviour by the use of
1264 the \c{NOSPLIT} keyword: \c{[nosplit eax*2]} will force
1265 \c{[eax*2+0]} to be generated literally.
1268 \H{const} \i{Constants}
1270 NASM understands four different types of constant: numeric,
1271 character, string and floating-point.
1274 \S{numconst} \i{Numeric Constants}
1276 A numeric constant is simply a number. NASM allows you to specify
1277 numbers in a variety of number bases, in a variety of ways: you can
1278 suffix \c{H}, \c{Q} and \c{B} for \i{hex}, \i{octal} and \i{binary},
1279 or you can prefix \c{0x} for hex in the style of C, or you can
1280 prefix \c{$} for hex in the style of Borland Pascal. Note, though,
1281 that the \I{$, prefix}\c{$} prefix does double duty as a prefix on
1282 identifiers (see \k{syntax}), so a hex number prefixed with a \c{$}
1283 sign must have a digit after the \c{$} rather than a letter.
1287 \c mov ax,100 ; decimal
1288 \c mov ax,0a2h ; hex
1289 \c mov ax,$0a2 ; hex again: the 0 is required
1290 \c mov ax,0xa2 ; hex yet again
1291 \c mov ax,777q ; octal
1292 \c mov ax,10010011b ; binary
1295 \S{chrconst} \i{Character Constants}
1297 A character constant consists of up to four characters enclosed in
1298 either single or double quotes. The type of quote makes no
1299 difference to NASM, except of course that surrounding the constant
1300 with single quotes allows double quotes to appear within it and vice
1303 A character constant with more than one character will be arranged
1304 with \i{little-endian} order in mind: if you code
1308 then the constant generated is not \c{0x61626364}, but
1309 \c{0x64636261}, so that if you were then to store the value into
1310 memory, it would read \c{abcd} rather than \c{dcba}. This is also
1311 the sense of character constants understood by the Pentium's
1312 \i\c{CPUID} instruction (see \k{insCPUID}).
1315 \S{strconst} String Constants
1317 String constants are only acceptable to some pseudo-instructions,
1318 namely the \I\c{DW}\I\c{DD}\I\c{DQ}\I\c{DT}\i\c{DB} family and
1321 A string constant looks like a character constant, only longer. It
1322 is treated as a concatenation of maximum-size character constants
1323 for the conditions. So the following are equivalent:
1325 \c db 'hello' ; string constant
1326 \c db 'h','e','l','l','o' ; equivalent character constants
1328 And the following are also equivalent:
1330 \c dd 'ninechars' ; doubleword string constant
1331 \c dd 'nine','char','s' ; becomes three doublewords
1332 \c db 'ninechars',0,0,0 ; and really looks like this
1334 Note that when used as an operand to \c{db}, a constant like
1335 \c{'ab'} is treated as a string constant despite being short enough
1336 to be a character constant, because otherwise \c{db 'ab'} would have
1337 the same effect as \c{db 'a'}, which would be silly. Similarly,
1338 three-character or four-character constants are treated as strings
1339 when they are operands to \c{dw}.
1342 \S{fltconst} \I{floating-point, constants}Floating-Point Constants
1344 \i{Floating-point} constants are acceptable only as arguments to
1345 \i\c{DD}, \i\c{DQ} and \i\c{DT}. They are expressed in the
1346 traditional form: digits, then a period, then optionally more
1347 digits, then optionally an \c{E} followed by an exponent. The period
1348 is mandatory, so that NASM can distinguish between \c{dd 1}, which
1349 declares an integer constant, and \c{dd 1.0} which declares a
1350 floating-point constant.
1354 \c dd 1.2 ; an easy one
1355 \c dq 1.e10 ; 10,000,000,000
1356 \c dq 1.e+10 ; synonymous with 1.e10
1357 \c dq 1.e-10 ; 0.000 000 000 1
1358 \c dt 3.141592653589793238462 ; pi
1360 NASM cannot do compile-time arithmetic on floating-point constants.
1361 This is because NASM is designed to be portable - although it always
1362 generates code to run on x86 processors, the assembler itself can
1363 run on any system with an ANSI C compiler. Therefore, the assembler
1364 cannot guarantee the presence of a floating-point unit capable of
1365 handling the \i{Intel number formats}, and so for NASM to be able to
1366 do floating arithmetic it would have to include its own complete set
1367 of floating-point routines, which would significantly increase the
1368 size of the assembler for very little benefit.
1371 \H{expr} \i{Expressions}
1373 Expressions in NASM are similar in syntax to those in C.
1375 NASM does not guarantee the size of the integers used to evaluate
1376 expressions at compile time: since NASM can compile and run on
1377 64-bit systems quite happily, don't assume that expressions are
1378 evaluated in 32-bit registers and so try to make deliberate use of
1379 \i{integer overflow}. It might not always work. The only thing NASM
1380 will guarantee is what's guaranteed by ANSI C: you always have \e{at
1381 least} 32 bits to work in.
1383 NASM supports two special tokens in expressions, allowing
1384 calculations to involve the current assembly position: the
1385 \I{$, here}\c{$} and \i\c{$$} tokens. \c{$} evaluates to the assembly
1386 position at the beginning of the line containing the expression; so
1387 you can code an \i{infinite loop} using \c{JMP $}. \c{$$} evaluates
1388 to the beginning of the current section; so you can tell how far
1389 into the section you are by using \c{($-$$)}.
1391 The arithmetic \i{operators} provided by NASM are listed here, in
1392 increasing order of \i{precedence}.
1395 \S{expor} \i\c{|}: \i{Bitwise OR} Operator
1397 The \c{|} operator gives a bitwise OR, exactly as performed by the
1398 \c{OR} machine instruction. Bitwise OR is the lowest-priority
1399 arithmetic operator supported by NASM.
1402 \S{expxor} \i\c{^}: \i{Bitwise XOR} Operator
1404 \c{^} provides the bitwise XOR operation.
1407 \S{expand} \i\c{&}: \i{Bitwise AND} Operator
1409 \c{&} provides the bitwise AND operation.
1412 \S{expshift} \i\c{<<} and \i\c{>>}: \i{Bit Shift} Operators
1414 \c{<<} gives a bit-shift to the left, just as it does in C. So \c{5<<3}
1415 evaluates to 5 times 8, or 40. \c{>>} gives a bit-shift to the
1416 right; in NASM, such a shift is \e{always} unsigned, so that
1417 the bits shifted in from the left-hand end are filled with zero
1418 rather than a sign-extension of the previous highest bit.
1421 \S{expplmi} \I{+ opaddition}\c{+} and \I{- opsubtraction}\c{-}:
1422 \i{Addition} and \i{Subtraction} Operators
1424 The \c{+} and \c{-} operators do perfectly ordinary addition and
1428 \S{expmul} \i\c{*}, \i\c{/}, \i\c{//}, \i\c{%} and \i\c{%%}:
1429 \i{Multiplication} and \i{Division}
1431 \c{*} is the multiplication operator. \c{/} and \c{//} are both
1432 division operators: \c{/} is \i{unsigned division} and \c{//} is
1433 \i{signed division}. Similarly, \c{%} and \c{%%} provide \I{unsigned
1434 modulo}\I{modulo operators}unsigned and
1435 \i{signed modulo} operators respectively.
1437 NASM, like ANSI C, provides no guarantees about the sensible
1438 operation of the signed modulo operator.
1440 Since the \c{%} character is used extensively by the macro
1441 \i{preprocessor}, you should ensure that both the signed and unsigned
1442 modulo operators are followed by white space wherever they appear.
1445 \S{expmul} \i{Unary Operators}: \I{+ opunary}\c{+}, \I{- opunary}\c{-},
1446 \i\c{~} and \i\c{SEG}
1448 The highest-priority operators in NASM's expression grammar are
1449 those which only apply to one argument. \c{-} negates its operand,
1450 \c{+} does nothing (it's provided for symmetry with \c{-}), \c{~}
1451 computes the \i{one's complement} of its operand, and \c{SEG}
1452 provides the \i{segment address} of its operand (explained in more
1453 detail in \k{segwrt}).
1456 \H{segwrt} \i\c{SEG} and \i\c{WRT}
1458 When writing large 16-bit programs, which must be split into
1459 multiple \i{segments}, it is often necessary to be able to refer to
1460 the \I{segment address}segment part of the address of a symbol. NASM
1461 supports the \c{SEG} operator to perform this function.
1463 The \c{SEG} operator returns the \i\e{preferred} segment base of a
1464 symbol, defined as the segment base relative to which the offset of
1465 the symbol makes sense. So the code
1467 \c mov ax,seg symbol
1471 will load \c{ES:BX} with a valid pointer to the symbol \c{symbol}.
1473 Things can be more complex than this: since 16-bit segments and
1474 \i{groups} may \I{overlapping segments}overlap, you might occasionally
1475 want to refer to some symbol using a different segment base from the
1476 preferred one. NASM lets you do this, by the use of the \c{WRT}
1477 (With Reference To) keyword. So you can do things like
1479 \c mov ax,weird_seg ; weird_seg is a segment base
1481 \c mov bx,symbol wrt weird_seg
1483 to load \c{ES:BX} with a different, but functionally equivalent,
1484 pointer to the symbol \c{symbol}.
1486 NASM supports far (inter-segment) calls and jumps by means of the
1487 syntax \c{call segment:offset}, where \c{segment} and \c{offset}
1488 both represent immediate values. So to call a far procedure, you
1489 could code either of
1491 \c call (seg procedure):procedure
1492 \c call weird_seg:(procedure wrt weird_seg)
1494 (The parentheses are included for clarity, to show the intended
1495 parsing of the above instructions. They are not necessary in
1498 NASM supports the syntax \I\c{CALL FAR}\c{call far procedure} as a
1499 synonym for the first of the above usages. \c{JMP} works identically
1500 to \c{CALL} in these examples.
1502 To declare a \i{far pointer} to a data item in a data segment, you
1505 \c dw symbol, seg symbol
1507 NASM supports no convenient synonym for this, though you can always
1508 invent one using the macro processor.
1511 \H{strict} \i\c{STRICT}: Inhibiting Optimization
1513 When assembling with the optimizer set to level 2 or higher (see
1514 \k{opt-On}), NASM will usee size specifiers (\c{BYTE}, \c{WORD},
1515 \c{DWORD}, \c{QWORD}, or \c{TWORD}), but will give them the smallest
1516 possible size. The keyword \c{STRICT} can be used to inhibit
1517 optimization and force a particular operand to be emitted in the
1518 specified size. For example, with the optimizer on, and in
1523 is encoded in three bytes \c{66 6A 21}, whereas
1525 \c push strict dword 33
1527 is encoded in six bytes, with a full dword immediate operand \c{66 68
1530 With the optimizer off, the same code (six bytes) is generated whether
1531 the \c{STRICT} keyword was used or not.
1534 \H{crit} \i{Critical Expressions}
1536 A limitation of NASM is that it is a \i{two-pass assembler}; unlike
1537 TASM and others, it will always do exactly two \I{passes}\i{assembly
1538 passes}. Therefore it is unable to cope with source files that are
1539 complex enough to require three or more passes.
1541 The first pass is used to determine the size of all the assembled
1542 code and data, so that the second pass, when generating all the
1543 code, knows all the symbol addresses the code refers to. So one
1544 thing NASM can't handle is code whose size depends on the value of a
1545 symbol declared after the code in question. For example,
1547 \c times (label-$) db 0
1548 \c label: db 'Where am I?'
1550 The argument to \i\c{TIMES} in this case could equally legally
1551 evaluate to anything at all; NASM will reject this example because
1552 it cannot tell the size of the \c{TIMES} line when it first sees it.
1553 It will just as firmly reject the slightly \I{paradox}paradoxical
1556 \c times (label-$+1) db 0
1557 \c label: db 'NOW where am I?'
1559 in which \e{any} value for the \c{TIMES} argument is by definition
1562 NASM rejects these examples by means of a concept called a
1563 \e{critical expression}, which is defined to be an expression whose
1564 value is required to be computable in the first pass, and which must
1565 therefore depend only on symbols defined before it. The argument to
1566 the \c{TIMES} prefix is a critical expression; for the same reason,
1567 the arguments to the \i\c{RESB} family of pseudo-instructions are
1568 also critical expressions.
1570 Critical expressions can crop up in other contexts as well: consider
1574 \c symbol1 equ symbol2
1577 On the first pass, NASM cannot determine the value of \c{symbol1},
1578 because \c{symbol1} is defined to be equal to \c{symbol2} which NASM
1579 hasn't seen yet. On the second pass, therefore, when it encounters
1580 the line \c{mov ax,symbol1}, it is unable to generate the code for
1581 it because it still doesn't know the value of \c{symbol1}. On the
1582 next line, it would see the \i\c{EQU} again and be able to determine
1583 the value of \c{symbol1}, but by then it would be too late.
1585 NASM avoids this problem by defining the right-hand side of an
1586 \c{EQU} statement to be a critical expression, so the definition of
1587 \c{symbol1} would be rejected in the first pass.
1589 There is a related issue involving \i{forward references}: consider
1592 \c mov eax,[ebx+offset]
1595 NASM, on pass one, must calculate the size of the instruction \c{mov
1596 eax,[ebx+offset]} without knowing the value of \c{offset}. It has no
1597 way of knowing that \c{offset} is small enough to fit into a
1598 one-byte offset field and that it could therefore get away with
1599 generating a shorter form of the \i{effective-address} encoding; for
1600 all it knows, in pass one, \c{offset} could be a symbol in the code
1601 segment, and it might need the full four-byte form. So it is forced
1602 to compute the size of the instruction to accommodate a four-byte
1603 address part. In pass two, having made this decision, it is now
1604 forced to honour it and keep the instruction large, so the code
1605 generated in this case is not as small as it could have been. This
1606 problem can be solved by defining \c{offset} before using it, or by
1607 forcing byte size in the effective address by coding \c{[byte
1611 \H{locallab} \i{Local Labels}
1613 NASM gives special treatment to symbols beginning with a \i{period}.
1614 A label beginning with a single period is treated as a \e{local}
1615 label, which means that it is associated with the previous non-local
1616 label. So, for example:
1618 \c label1 ; some code
1626 \c label2 ; some code
1634 In the above code fragment, each \c{JNE} instruction jumps to the
1635 line immediately before it, because the two definitions of \c{.loop}
1636 are kept separate by virtue of each being associated with the
1637 previous non-local label.
1639 This form of local label handling is borrowed from the old Amiga
1640 assembler \i{DevPac}; however, NASM goes one step further, in
1641 allowing access to local labels from other parts of the code. This
1642 is achieved by means of \e{defining} a local label in terms of the
1643 previous non-local label: the first definition of \c{.loop} above is
1644 really defining a symbol called \c{label1.loop}, and the second
1645 defines a symbol called \c{label2.loop}. So, if you really needed
1648 \c label3 ; some more code
1653 Sometimes it is useful - in a macro, for instance - to be able to
1654 define a label which can be referenced from anywhere but which
1655 doesn't interfere with the normal local-label mechanism. Such a
1656 label can't be non-local because it would interfere with subsequent
1657 definitions of, and references to, local labels; and it can't be
1658 local because the macro that defined it wouldn't know the label's
1659 full name. NASM therefore introduces a third type of label, which is
1660 probably only useful in macro definitions: if a label begins with
1661 the \I{label prefix}special prefix \i\c{..@}, then it does nothing
1662 to the local label mechanism. So you could code
1664 \c label1: ; a non-local label
1665 \c .local: ; this is really label1.local
1666 \c ..@foo: ; this is a special symbol
1667 \c label2: ; another non-local label
1668 \c .local: ; this is really label2.local
1670 \c jmp ..@foo ; this will jump three lines up
1672 NASM has the capacity to define other special symbols beginning with
1673 a double period: for example, \c{..start} is used to specify the
1674 entry point in the \c{obj} output format (see \k{dotdotstart}).
1677 \C{preproc} The NASM \i{Preprocessor}
1679 NASM contains a powerful \i{macro processor}, which supports
1680 conditional assembly, multi-level file inclusion, two forms of macro
1681 (single-line and multi-line), and a `context stack' mechanism for
1682 extra macro power. Preprocessor directives all begin with a \c{%}
1685 The preprocessor collapses all lines which end with a backslash (\\)
1686 character into a single line. Thus:
1688 \c %define THIS_VERY_LONG_MACRO_NAME_IS_DEFINED_TO \\
1691 will work like a single-line macro without the backslash-newline
1694 \H{slmacro} \i{Single-Line Macros}
1696 \S{define} The Normal Way: \I\c{%idefine}\i\c{%define}
1698 Single-line macros are defined using the \c{%define} preprocessor
1699 directive. The definitions work in a similar way to C; so you can do
1702 \c %define ctrl 0x1F &
1703 \c %define param(a,b) ((a)+(a)*(b))
1705 \c mov byte [param(2,ebx)], ctrl 'D'
1707 which will expand to
1709 \c mov byte [(2)+(2)*(ebx)], 0x1F & 'D'
1711 When the expansion of a single-line macro contains tokens which
1712 invoke another macro, the expansion is performed at invocation time,
1713 not at definition time. Thus the code
1715 \c %define a(x) 1+b(x)
1720 will evaluate in the expected way to \c{mov ax,1+2*8}, even though
1721 the macro \c{b} wasn't defined at the time of definition of \c{a}.
1723 Macros defined with \c{%define} are \i{case sensitive}: after
1724 \c{%define foo bar}, only \c{foo} will expand to \c{bar}: \c{Foo} or
1725 \c{FOO} will not. By using \c{%idefine} instead of \c{%define} (the
1726 `i' stands for `insensitive') you can define all the case variants
1727 of a macro at once, so that \c{%idefine foo bar} would cause
1728 \c{foo}, \c{Foo}, \c{FOO}, \c{fOO} and so on all to expand to
1731 There is a mechanism which detects when a macro call has occurred as
1732 a result of a previous expansion of the same macro, to guard against
1733 \i{circular references} and infinite loops. If this happens, the
1734 preprocessor will only expand the first occurrence of the macro.
1737 \c %define a(x) 1+a(x)
1741 the macro \c{a(3)} will expand once, becoming \c{1+a(3)}, and will
1742 then expand no further. This behaviour can be useful: see \k{32c}
1743 for an example of its use.
1745 You can \I{overloading, single-line macros}overload single-line
1746 macros: if you write
1748 \c %define foo(x) 1+x
1749 \c %define foo(x,y) 1+x*y
1751 the preprocessor will be able to handle both types of macro call,
1752 by counting the parameters you pass; so \c{foo(3)} will become
1753 \c{1+3} whereas \c{foo(ebx,2)} will become \c{1+ebx*2}. However, if
1758 then no other definition of \c{foo} will be accepted: a macro with
1759 no parameters prohibits the definition of the same name as a macro
1760 \e{with} parameters, and vice versa.
1762 This doesn't prevent single-line macros being \e{redefined}: you can
1763 perfectly well define a macro with
1767 and then re-define it later in the same source file with
1771 Then everywhere the macro \c{foo} is invoked, it will be expanded
1772 according to the most recent definition. This is particularly useful
1773 when defining single-line macros with \c{%assign} (see \k{assign}).
1775 You can \i{pre-define} single-line macros using the `-d' option on
1776 the NASM command line: see \k{opt-d}.
1779 \S{xdefine} Enhancing %define: \I\c{%xidefine}\i\c{%xdefine}
1781 To have a reference to an embedded single-line macro resolved at the
1782 time that it is embedded, as opposed to when the calling macro is
1783 expanded, you need a different mechanism to the one offered by
1784 \c{%define}. The solution is to use \c{%xdefine}, or it's
1785 \I{case sensitive}case-insensitive counterpart \c{%xidefine}.
1787 Suppose you have the following code:
1790 \c %define isFalse isTrue
1799 In this case, \c{val1} is equal to 0, and \c{val2} is equal to 1.
1800 This is because, when a single-line macro is defined using
1801 \c{%define}, it is expanded only when it is called. As \c{isFalse}
1802 expands to \c{isTrue}, the expansion will be the current value of
1803 \c{isTrue}. The first time it is called that is 0, and the second
1806 If you wanted \c{isFalse} to expand to the value assigned to the
1807 embedded macro \c{isTrue} at the time that \c{isFalse} was defined,
1808 you need to change the above code to use \c{%xdefine}.
1810 \c %xdefine isTrue 1
1811 \c %xdefine isFalse isTrue
1812 \c %xdefine isTrue 0
1816 \c %xdefine isTrue 1
1820 Now, each time that \c{isFalse} is called, it expands to 1,
1821 as that is what the embedded macro \c{isTrue} expanded to at
1822 the time that \c{isFalse} was defined.
1825 \S{concat%+} Concatenating Single Line Macro Tokens: \i\c{%+}
1827 Individual tokens in single line macros can be concatenated, to produce
1828 longer tokens for later processing. This can be useful if there are
1829 several similar macros that perform similar functions.
1831 As an example, consider the following:
1833 \c %define BDASTART 400h ; Start of BIOS data area
1835 \c struc tBIOSDA ; its structure
1841 Now, if we need to access the elements of tBIOSDA in different places,
1844 \c mov ax,BDASTART + tBIOSDA.COM1addr
1845 \c mov bx,BDASTART + tBIOSDA.COM2addr
1847 This will become pretty ugly (and tedious) if used in many places, and
1848 can be reduced in size significantly by using the following macro:
1850 \c ; Macro to access BIOS variables by their names (from tBDA):
1852 \c %define BDA(x) BDASTART + tBIOSDA. %+ x
1854 Now the above code can be written as:
1856 \c mov ax,BDA(COM1addr)
1857 \c mov bx,BDA(COM2addr)
1859 Using this feature, we can simplify references to a lot of macros (and,
1860 in turn, reduce typing errors).
1863 \S{undef} Undefining macros: \i\c{%undef}
1865 Single-line macros can be removed with the \c{%undef} command. For
1866 example, the following sequence:
1873 will expand to the instruction \c{mov eax, foo}, since after
1874 \c{%undef} the macro \c{foo} is no longer defined.
1876 Macros that would otherwise be pre-defined can be undefined on the
1877 command-line using the `-u' option on the NASM command line: see
1881 \S{assign} \i{Preprocessor Variables}: \i\c{%assign}
1883 An alternative way to define single-line macros is by means of the
1884 \c{%assign} command (and its \I{case sensitive}case-insensitive
1885 counterpart \i\c{%iassign}, which differs from \c{%assign} in
1886 exactly the same way that \c{%idefine} differs from \c{%define}).
1888 \c{%assign} is used to define single-line macros which take no
1889 parameters and have a numeric value. This value can be specified in
1890 the form of an expression, and it will be evaluated once, when the
1891 \c{%assign} directive is processed.
1893 Like \c{%define}, macros defined using \c{%assign} can be re-defined
1894 later, so you can do things like
1898 to increment the numeric value of a macro.
1900 \c{%assign} is useful for controlling the termination of \c{%rep}
1901 preprocessor loops: see \k{rep} for an example of this. Another
1902 use for \c{%assign} is given in \k{16c} and \k{32c}.
1904 The expression passed to \c{%assign} is a \i{critical expression}
1905 (see \k{crit}), and must also evaluate to a pure number (rather than
1906 a relocatable reference such as a code or data address, or anything
1907 involving a register).
1910 \H{strlen} \i{String Handling in Macros}: \i\c{%strlen} and \i\c{%substr}
1912 It's often useful to be able to handle strings in macros. NASM
1913 supports two simple string handling macro operators from which
1914 more complex operations can be constructed.
1917 \S{strlen} \i{String Length}: \i\c{%strlen}
1919 The \c{%strlen} macro is like \c{%assign} macro in that it creates
1920 (or redefines) a numeric value to a macro. The difference is that
1921 with \c{%strlen}, the numeric value is the length of a string. An
1922 example of the use of this would be:
1924 \c %strlen charcnt 'my string'
1926 In this example, \c{charcnt} would receive the value 8, just as
1927 if an \c{%assign} had been used. In this example, \c{'my string'}
1928 was a literal string but it could also have been a single-line
1929 macro that expands to a string, as in the following example:
1931 \c %define sometext 'my string'
1932 \c %strlen charcnt sometext
1934 As in the first case, this would result in \c{charcnt} being
1935 assigned the value of 8.
1938 \S{substr} \i{Sub-strings}: \i\c{%substr}
1940 Individual letters in strings can be extracted using \c{%substr}.
1941 An example of its use is probably more useful than the description:
1943 \c %substr mychar 'xyz' 1 ; equivalent to %define mychar 'x'
1944 \c %substr mychar 'xyz' 2 ; equivalent to %define mychar 'y'
1945 \c %substr mychar 'xyz' 3 ; equivalent to %define mychar 'z'
1947 In this example, mychar gets the value of 'y'. As with \c{%strlen}
1948 (see \k{strlen}), the first parameter is the single-line macro to
1949 be created and the second is the string. The third parameter
1950 specifies which character is to be selected. Note that the first
1951 index is 1, not 0 and the last index is equal to the value that
1952 \c{%strlen} would assign given the same string. Index values out
1953 of range result in an empty string.
1956 \H{mlmacro} \i{Multi-Line Macros}: \I\c{%imacro}\i\c{%macro}
1958 Multi-line macros are much more like the type of macro seen in MASM
1959 and TASM: a multi-line macro definition in NASM looks something like
1962 \c %macro prologue 1
1970 This defines a C-like function prologue as a macro: so you would
1971 invoke the macro with a call such as
1973 \c myfunc: prologue 12
1975 which would expand to the three lines of code
1981 The number \c{1} after the macro name in the \c{%macro} line defines
1982 the number of parameters the macro \c{prologue} expects to receive.
1983 The use of \c{%1} inside the macro definition refers to the first
1984 parameter to the macro call. With a macro taking more than one
1985 parameter, subsequent parameters would be referred to as \c{%2},
1988 Multi-line macros, like single-line macros, are \i{case-sensitive},
1989 unless you define them using the alternative directive \c{%imacro}.
1991 If you need to pass a comma as \e{part} of a parameter to a
1992 multi-line macro, you can do that by enclosing the entire parameter
1993 in \I{braces, around macro parameters}braces. So you could code
2002 \c silly 'a', letter_a ; letter_a: db 'a'
2003 \c silly 'ab', string_ab ; string_ab: db 'ab'
2004 \c silly {13,10}, crlf ; crlf: db 13,10
2007 \S{mlmacover} Overloading Multi-Line Macros\I{overloading, multi-line macros}
2009 As with single-line macros, multi-line macros can be overloaded by
2010 defining the same macro name several times with different numbers of
2011 parameters. This time, no exception is made for macros with no
2012 parameters at all. So you could define
2014 \c %macro prologue 0
2021 to define an alternative form of the function prologue which
2022 allocates no local stack space.
2024 Sometimes, however, you might want to `overload' a machine
2025 instruction; for example, you might want to define
2034 so that you could code
2036 \c push ebx ; this line is not a macro call
2037 \c push eax,ecx ; but this one is
2039 Ordinarily, NASM will give a warning for the first of the above two
2040 lines, since \c{push} is now defined to be a macro, and is being
2041 invoked with a number of parameters for which no definition has been
2042 given. The correct code will still be generated, but the assembler
2043 will give a warning. This warning can be disabled by the use of the
2044 \c{-w-macro-params} command-line option (see \k{opt-w}).
2047 \S{maclocal} \i{Macro-Local Labels}
2049 NASM allows you to define labels within a multi-line macro
2050 definition in such a way as to make them local to the macro call: so
2051 calling the same macro multiple times will use a different label
2052 each time. You do this by prefixing \i\c{%%} to the label name. So
2053 you can invent an instruction which executes a \c{RET} if the \c{Z}
2054 flag is set by doing this:
2064 You can call this macro as many times as you want, and every time
2065 you call it NASM will make up a different `real' name to substitute
2066 for the label \c{%%skip}. The names NASM invents are of the form
2067 \c{..@2345.skip}, where the number 2345 changes with every macro
2068 call. The \i\c{..@} prefix prevents macro-local labels from
2069 interfering with the local label mechanism, as described in
2070 \k{locallab}. You should avoid defining your own labels in this form
2071 (the \c{..@} prefix, then a number, then another period) in case
2072 they interfere with macro-local labels.
2075 \S{mlmacgre} \i{Greedy Macro Parameters}
2077 Occasionally it is useful to define a macro which lumps its entire
2078 command line into one parameter definition, possibly after
2079 extracting one or two smaller parameters from the front. An example
2080 might be a macro to write a text string to a file in MS-DOS, where
2081 you might want to be able to write
2083 \c writefile [filehandle],"hello, world",13,10
2085 NASM allows you to define the last parameter of a macro to be
2086 \e{greedy}, meaning that if you invoke the macro with more
2087 parameters than it expects, all the spare parameters get lumped into
2088 the last defined one along with the separating commas. So if you
2091 \c %macro writefile 2+
2097 \c mov cx,%%endstr-%%str
2104 then the example call to \c{writefile} above will work as expected:
2105 the text before the first comma, \c{[filehandle]}, is used as the
2106 first macro parameter and expanded when \c{%1} is referred to, and
2107 all the subsequent text is lumped into \c{%2} and placed after the
2110 The greedy nature of the macro is indicated to NASM by the use of
2111 the \I{+ modifier}\c{+} sign after the parameter count on the
2114 If you define a greedy macro, you are effectively telling NASM how
2115 it should expand the macro given \e{any} number of parameters from
2116 the actual number specified up to infinity; in this case, for
2117 example, NASM now knows what to do when it sees a call to
2118 \c{writefile} with 2, 3, 4 or more parameters. NASM will take this
2119 into account when overloading macros, and will not allow you to
2120 define another form of \c{writefile} taking 4 parameters (for
2123 Of course, the above macro could have been implemented as a
2124 non-greedy macro, in which case the call to it would have had to
2127 \c writefile [filehandle], {"hello, world",13,10}
2129 NASM provides both mechanisms for putting \i{commas in macro
2130 parameters}, and you choose which one you prefer for each macro
2133 See \k{sectmac} for a better way to write the above macro.
2136 \S{mlmacdef} \i{Default Macro Parameters}
2138 NASM also allows you to define a multi-line macro with a \e{range}
2139 of allowable parameter counts. If you do this, you can specify
2140 defaults for \i{omitted parameters}. So, for example:
2142 \c %macro die 0-1 "Painful program death has occurred."
2150 This macro (which makes use of the \c{writefile} macro defined in
2151 \k{mlmacgre}) can be called with an explicit error message, which it
2152 will display on the error output stream before exiting, or it can be
2153 called with no parameters, in which case it will use the default
2154 error message supplied in the macro definition.
2156 In general, you supply a minimum and maximum number of parameters
2157 for a macro of this type; the minimum number of parameters are then
2158 required in the macro call, and then you provide defaults for the
2159 optional ones. So if a macro definition began with the line
2161 \c %macro foobar 1-3 eax,[ebx+2]
2163 then it could be called with between one and three parameters, and
2164 \c{%1} would always be taken from the macro call. \c{%2}, if not
2165 specified by the macro call, would default to \c{eax}, and \c{%3} if
2166 not specified would default to \c{[ebx+2]}.
2168 You may omit parameter defaults from the macro definition, in which
2169 case the parameter default is taken to be blank. This can be useful
2170 for macros which can take a variable number of parameters, since the
2171 \i\c{%0} token (see \k{percent0}) allows you to determine how many
2172 parameters were really passed to the macro call.
2174 This defaulting mechanism can be combined with the greedy-parameter
2175 mechanism; so the \c{die} macro above could be made more powerful,
2176 and more useful, by changing the first line of the definition to
2178 \c %macro die 0-1+ "Painful program death has occurred.",13,10
2180 The maximum parameter count can be infinite, denoted by \c{*}. In
2181 this case, of course, it is impossible to provide a \e{full} set of
2182 default parameters. Examples of this usage are shown in \k{rotate}.
2185 \S{percent0} \i\c{%0}: \I{counting macro parameters}Macro Parameter Counter
2187 For a macro which can take a variable number of parameters, the
2188 parameter reference \c{%0} will return a numeric constant giving the
2189 number of parameters passed to the macro. This can be used as an
2190 argument to \c{%rep} (see \k{rep}) in order to iterate through all
2191 the parameters of a macro. Examples are given in \k{rotate}.
2194 \S{rotate} \i\c{%rotate}: \i{Rotating Macro Parameters}
2196 Unix shell programmers will be familiar with the \I{shift
2197 command}\c{shift} shell command, which allows the arguments passed
2198 to a shell script (referenced as \c{$1}, \c{$2} and so on) to be
2199 moved left by one place, so that the argument previously referenced
2200 as \c{$2} becomes available as \c{$1}, and the argument previously
2201 referenced as \c{$1} is no longer available at all.
2203 NASM provides a similar mechanism, in the form of \c{%rotate}. As
2204 its name suggests, it differs from the Unix \c{shift} in that no
2205 parameters are lost: parameters rotated off the left end of the
2206 argument list reappear on the right, and vice versa.
2208 \c{%rotate} is invoked with a single numeric argument (which may be
2209 an expression). The macro parameters are rotated to the left by that
2210 many places. If the argument to \c{%rotate} is negative, the macro
2211 parameters are rotated to the right.
2213 \I{iterating over macro parameters}So a pair of macros to save and
2214 restore a set of registers might work as follows:
2216 \c %macro multipush 1-*
2225 This macro invokes the \c{PUSH} instruction on each of its arguments
2226 in turn, from left to right. It begins by pushing its first
2227 argument, \c{%1}, then invokes \c{%rotate} to move all the arguments
2228 one place to the left, so that the original second argument is now
2229 available as \c{%1}. Repeating this procedure as many times as there
2230 were arguments (achieved by supplying \c{%0} as the argument to
2231 \c{%rep}) causes each argument in turn to be pushed.
2233 Note also the use of \c{*} as the maximum parameter count,
2234 indicating that there is no upper limit on the number of parameters
2235 you may supply to the \i\c{multipush} macro.
2237 It would be convenient, when using this macro, to have a \c{POP}
2238 equivalent, which \e{didn't} require the arguments to be given in
2239 reverse order. Ideally, you would write the \c{multipush} macro
2240 call, then cut-and-paste the line to where the pop needed to be
2241 done, and change the name of the called macro to \c{multipop}, and
2242 the macro would take care of popping the registers in the opposite
2243 order from the one in which they were pushed.
2245 This can be done by the following definition:
2247 \c %macro multipop 1-*
2256 This macro begins by rotating its arguments one place to the
2257 \e{right}, so that the original \e{last} argument appears as \c{%1}.
2258 This is then popped, and the arguments are rotated right again, so
2259 the second-to-last argument becomes \c{%1}. Thus the arguments are
2260 iterated through in reverse order.
2263 \S{concat} \i{Concatenating Macro Parameters}
2265 NASM can concatenate macro parameters on to other text surrounding
2266 them. This allows you to declare a family of symbols, for example,
2267 in a macro definition. If, for example, you wanted to generate a
2268 table of key codes along with offsets into the table, you could code
2271 \c %macro keytab_entry 2
2273 \c keypos%1 equ $-keytab
2279 \c keytab_entry F1,128+1
2280 \c keytab_entry F2,128+2
2281 \c keytab_entry Return,13
2283 which would expand to
2286 \c keyposF1 equ $-keytab
2288 \c keyposF2 equ $-keytab
2290 \c keyposReturn equ $-keytab
2293 You can just as easily concatenate text on to the other end of a
2294 macro parameter, by writing \c{%1foo}.
2296 If you need to append a \e{digit} to a macro parameter, for example
2297 defining labels \c{foo1} and \c{foo2} when passed the parameter
2298 \c{foo}, you can't code \c{%11} because that would be taken as the
2299 eleventh macro parameter. Instead, you must code
2300 \I{braces, after % sign}\c{%\{1\}1}, which will separate the first
2301 \c{1} (giving the number of the macro parameter) from the second
2302 (literal text to be concatenated to the parameter).
2304 This concatenation can also be applied to other preprocessor in-line
2305 objects, such as macro-local labels (\k{maclocal}) and context-local
2306 labels (\k{ctxlocal}). In all cases, ambiguities in syntax can be
2307 resolved by enclosing everything after the \c{%} sign and before the
2308 literal text in braces: so \c{%\{%foo\}bar} concatenates the text
2309 \c{bar} to the end of the real name of the macro-local label
2310 \c{%%foo}. (This is unnecessary, since the form NASM uses for the
2311 real names of macro-local labels means that the two usages
2312 \c{%\{%foo\}bar} and \c{%%foobar} would both expand to the same
2313 thing anyway; nevertheless, the capability is there.)
2316 \S{mlmaccc} \i{Condition Codes as Macro Parameters}
2318 NASM can give special treatment to a macro parameter which contains
2319 a condition code. For a start, you can refer to the macro parameter
2320 \c{%1} by means of the alternative syntax \i\c{%+1}, which informs
2321 NASM that this macro parameter is supposed to contain a condition
2322 code, and will cause the preprocessor to report an error message if
2323 the macro is called with a parameter which is \e{not} a valid
2326 Far more usefully, though, you can refer to the macro parameter by
2327 means of \i\c{%-1}, which NASM will expand as the \e{inverse}
2328 condition code. So the \c{retz} macro defined in \k{maclocal} can be
2329 replaced by a general \i{conditional-return macro} like this:
2339 This macro can now be invoked using calls like \c{retc ne}, which
2340 will cause the conditional-jump instruction in the macro expansion
2341 to come out as \c{JE}, or \c{retc po} which will make the jump a
2344 The \c{%+1} macro-parameter reference is quite happy to interpret
2345 the arguments \c{CXZ} and \c{ECXZ} as valid condition codes;
2346 however, \c{%-1} will report an error if passed either of these,
2347 because no inverse condition code exists.
2350 \S{nolist} \i{Disabling Listing Expansion}\I\c{.nolist}
2352 When NASM is generating a listing file from your program, it will
2353 generally expand multi-line macros by means of writing the macro
2354 call and then listing each line of the expansion. This allows you to
2355 see which instructions in the macro expansion are generating what
2356 code; however, for some macros this clutters the listing up
2359 NASM therefore provides the \c{.nolist} qualifier, which you can
2360 include in a macro definition to inhibit the expansion of the macro
2361 in the listing file. The \c{.nolist} qualifier comes directly after
2362 the number of parameters, like this:
2364 \c %macro foo 1.nolist
2368 \c %macro bar 1-5+.nolist a,b,c,d,e,f,g,h
2370 \H{condasm} \i{Conditional Assembly}\I\c{%if}
2372 Similarly to the C preprocessor, NASM allows sections of a source
2373 file to be assembled only if certain conditions are met. The general
2374 syntax of this feature looks like this:
2377 \c ; some code which only appears if <condition> is met
2378 \c %elif<condition2>
2379 \c ; only appears if <condition> is not met but <condition2> is
2381 \c ; this appears if neither <condition> nor <condition2> was met
2384 The \i\c{%else} clause is optional, as is the \i\c{%elif} clause.
2385 You can have more than one \c{%elif} clause as well.
2388 \S{ifdef} \i\c{%ifdef}: Testing Single-Line Macro Existence\I{testing,
2389 single-line macro existence}
2391 Beginning a conditional-assembly block with the line \c{%ifdef
2392 MACRO} will assemble the subsequent code if, and only if, a
2393 single-line macro called \c{MACRO} is defined. If not, then the
2394 \c{%elif} and \c{%else} blocks (if any) will be processed instead.
2396 For example, when debugging a program, you might want to write code
2399 \c ; perform some function
2401 \c writefile 2,"Function performed successfully",13,10
2403 \c ; go and do something else
2405 Then you could use the command-line option \c{-dDEBUG} to create a
2406 version of the program which produced debugging messages, and remove
2407 the option to generate the final release version of the program.
2409 You can test for a macro \e{not} being defined by using
2410 \i\c{%ifndef} instead of \c{%ifdef}. You can also test for macro
2411 definitions in \c{%elif} blocks by using \i\c{%elifdef} and
2415 \S{ifmacro} \i\c{ifmacro}: Testing Multi-Line Macro
2416 Existence\I{testing, multi-line macro existence}
2418 The \c{%ifmacro} directive operates in the same way as the \c{%ifdef}
2419 directive, except that it checks for the existence of a multi-line macro.
2421 For example, you may be working with a large project and not have control
2422 over the macros in a library. You may want to create a macro with one
2423 name if it doesn't already exist, and another name if one with that name
2426 The \c{%ifmacro} is considered true if defining a macro with the given name
2427 and number of arguments would cause a definitions conflict. For example:
2429 \c %ifmacro MyMacro 1-3
2431 \c %error "MyMacro 1-3" causes a conflict with an existing macro.
2435 \c %macro MyMacro 1-3
2437 \c ; insert code to define the macro
2443 This will create the macro "MyMacro 1-3" if no macro already exists which
2444 would conflict with it, and emits a warning if there would be a definition
2447 You can test for the macro not existing by using the \i\c{%ifnmacro} instead
2448 of \c{%ifmacro}. Additional tests can be performed in \c{%elif} blocks by using
2449 \i\c{%elifmacro} and \i\c{%elifnmacro}.
2452 \S{ifctx} \i\c{%ifctx}: Testing the Context Stack\I{testing, context
2455 The conditional-assembly construct \c{%ifctx ctxname} will cause the
2456 subsequent code to be assembled if and only if the top context on
2457 the preprocessor's context stack has the name \c{ctxname}. As with
2458 \c{%ifdef}, the inverse and \c{%elif} forms \i\c{%ifnctx},
2459 \i\c{%elifctx} and \i\c{%elifnctx} are also supported.
2461 For more details of the context stack, see \k{ctxstack}. For a
2462 sample use of \c{%ifctx}, see \k{blockif}.
2465 \S{if} \i\c{%if}: Testing Arbitrary Numeric Expressions\I{testing,
2466 arbitrary numeric expressions}
2468 The conditional-assembly construct \c{%if expr} will cause the
2469 subsequent code to be assembled if and only if the value of the
2470 numeric expression \c{expr} is non-zero. An example of the use of
2471 this feature is in deciding when to break out of a \c{%rep}
2472 preprocessor loop: see \k{rep} for a detailed example.
2474 The expression given to \c{%if}, and its counterpart \i\c{%elif}, is
2475 a critical expression (see \k{crit}).
2477 \c{%if} extends the normal NASM expression syntax, by providing a
2478 set of \i{relational operators} which are not normally available in
2479 expressions. The operators \i\c{=}, \i\c{<}, \i\c{>}, \i\c{<=},
2480 \i\c{>=} and \i\c{<>} test equality, less-than, greater-than,
2481 less-or-equal, greater-or-equal and not-equal respectively. The
2482 C-like forms \i\c{==} and \i\c{!=} are supported as alternative
2483 forms of \c{=} and \c{<>}. In addition, low-priority logical
2484 operators \i\c{&&}, \i\c{^^} and \i\c{||} are provided, supplying
2485 \i{logical AND}, \i{logical XOR} and \i{logical OR}. These work like
2486 the C logical operators (although C has no logical XOR), in that
2487 they always return either 0 or 1, and treat any non-zero input as 1
2488 (so that \c{^^}, for example, returns 1 if exactly one of its inputs
2489 is zero, and 0 otherwise). The relational operators also return 1
2490 for true and 0 for false.
2493 \S{ifidn} \i\c{%ifidn} and \i\c{%ifidni}: Testing Exact Text
2494 Identity\I{testing, exact text identity}
2496 The construct \c{%ifidn text1,text2} will cause the subsequent code
2497 to be assembled if and only if \c{text1} and \c{text2}, after
2498 expanding single-line macros, are identical pieces of text.
2499 Differences in white space are not counted.
2501 \c{%ifidni} is similar to \c{%ifidn}, but is \i{case-insensitive}.
2503 For example, the following macro pushes a register or number on the
2504 stack, and allows you to treat \c{IP} as a real register:
2506 \c %macro pushparam 1
2517 Like most other \c{%if} constructs, \c{%ifidn} has a counterpart
2518 \i\c{%elifidn}, and negative forms \i\c{%ifnidn} and \i\c{%elifnidn}.
2519 Similarly, \c{%ifidni} has counterparts \i\c{%elifidni},
2520 \i\c{%ifnidni} and \i\c{%elifnidni}.
2523 \S{iftyp} \i\c{%ifid}, \i\c{%ifnum}, \i\c{%ifstr}: Testing Token
2524 Types\I{testing, token types}
2526 Some macros will want to perform different tasks depending on
2527 whether they are passed a number, a string, or an identifier. For
2528 example, a string output macro might want to be able to cope with
2529 being passed either a string constant or a pointer to an existing
2532 The conditional assembly construct \c{%ifid}, taking one parameter
2533 (which may be blank), assembles the subsequent code if and only if
2534 the first token in the parameter exists and is an identifier.
2535 \c{%ifnum} works similarly, but tests for the token being a numeric
2536 constant; \c{%ifstr} tests for it being a string.
2538 For example, the \c{writefile} macro defined in \k{mlmacgre} can be
2539 extended to take advantage of \c{%ifstr} in the following fashion:
2541 \c %macro writefile 2-3+
2550 \c %%endstr: mov dx,%%str
2551 \c mov cx,%%endstr-%%str
2562 Then the \c{writefile} macro can cope with being called in either of
2563 the following two ways:
2565 \c writefile [file], strpointer, length
2566 \c writefile [file], "hello", 13, 10
2568 In the first, \c{strpointer} is used as the address of an
2569 already-declared string, and \c{length} is used as its length; in
2570 the second, a string is given to the macro, which therefore declares
2571 it itself and works out the address and length for itself.
2573 Note the use of \c{%if} inside the \c{%ifstr}: this is to detect
2574 whether the macro was passed two arguments (so the string would be a
2575 single string constant, and \c{db %2} would be adequate) or more (in
2576 which case, all but the first two would be lumped together into
2577 \c{%3}, and \c{db %2,%3} would be required).
2579 \I\c{%ifnid}\I\c{%elifid}\I\c{%elifnid}\I\c{%ifnnum}\I\c{%elifnum}
2580 \I\c{%elifnnum}\I\c{%ifnstr}\I\c{%elifstr}\I\c{%elifnstr}
2581 The usual \c{%elifXXX}, \c{%ifnXXX} and \c{%elifnXXX} versions exist
2582 for each of \c{%ifid}, \c{%ifnum} and \c{%ifstr}.
2585 \S{pperror} \i\c{%error}: Reporting \i{User-Defined Errors}
2587 The preprocessor directive \c{%error} will cause NASM to report an
2588 error if it occurs in assembled code. So if other users are going to
2589 try to assemble your source files, you can ensure that they define
2590 the right macros by means of code like this:
2592 \c %ifdef SOME_MACRO
2594 \c %elifdef SOME_OTHER_MACRO
2595 \c ; do some different setup
2597 \c %error Neither SOME_MACRO nor SOME_OTHER_MACRO was defined.
2600 Then any user who fails to understand the way your code is supposed
2601 to be assembled will be quickly warned of their mistake, rather than
2602 having to wait until the program crashes on being run and then not
2603 knowing what went wrong.
2606 \H{rep} \i{Preprocessor Loops}\I{repeating code}: \i\c{%rep}
2608 NASM's \c{TIMES} prefix, though useful, cannot be used to invoke a
2609 multi-line macro multiple times, because it is processed by NASM
2610 after macros have already been expanded. Therefore NASM provides
2611 another form of loop, this time at the preprocessor level: \c{%rep}.
2613 The directives \c{%rep} and \i\c{%endrep} (\c{%rep} takes a numeric
2614 argument, which can be an expression; \c{%endrep} takes no
2615 arguments) can be used to enclose a chunk of code, which is then
2616 replicated as many times as specified by the preprocessor:
2620 \c inc word [table+2*i]
2624 This will generate a sequence of 64 \c{INC} instructions,
2625 incrementing every word of memory from \c{[table]} to
2628 For more complex termination conditions, or to break out of a repeat
2629 loop part way along, you can use the \i\c{%exitrep} directive to
2630 terminate the loop, like this:
2645 \c fib_number equ ($-fibonacci)/2
2647 This produces a list of all the Fibonacci numbers that will fit in
2648 16 bits. Note that a maximum repeat count must still be given to
2649 \c{%rep}. This is to prevent the possibility of NASM getting into an
2650 infinite loop in the preprocessor, which (on multitasking or
2651 multi-user systems) would typically cause all the system memory to
2652 be gradually used up and other applications to start crashing.
2655 \H{include} \i{Including Other Files}
2657 Using, once again, a very similar syntax to the C preprocessor,
2658 NASM's preprocessor lets you include other source files into your
2659 code. This is done by the use of the \i\c{%include} directive:
2661 \c %include "macros.mac"
2663 will include the contents of the file \c{macros.mac} into the source
2664 file containing the \c{%include} directive.
2666 Include files are \I{searching for include files}searched for in the
2667 current directory (the directory you're in when you run NASM, as
2668 opposed to the location of the NASM executable or the location of
2669 the source file), plus any directories specified on the NASM command
2670 line using the \c{-i} option.
2672 The standard C idiom for preventing a file being included more than
2673 once is just as applicable in NASM: if the file \c{macros.mac} has
2676 \c %ifndef MACROS_MAC
2677 \c %define MACROS_MAC
2678 \c ; now define some macros
2681 then including the file more than once will not cause errors,
2682 because the second time the file is included nothing will happen
2683 because the macro \c{MACROS_MAC} will already be defined.
2685 You can force a file to be included even if there is no \c{%include}
2686 directive that explicitly includes it, by using the \i\c{-p} option
2687 on the NASM command line (see \k{opt-p}).
2690 \H{ctxstack} The \i{Context Stack}
2692 Having labels that are local to a macro definition is sometimes not
2693 quite powerful enough: sometimes you want to be able to share labels
2694 between several macro calls. An example might be a \c{REPEAT} ...
2695 \c{UNTIL} loop, in which the expansion of the \c{REPEAT} macro
2696 would need to be able to refer to a label which the \c{UNTIL} macro
2697 had defined. However, for such a macro you would also want to be
2698 able to nest these loops.
2700 NASM provides this level of power by means of a \e{context stack}.
2701 The preprocessor maintains a stack of \e{contexts}, each of which is
2702 characterised by a name. You add a new context to the stack using
2703 the \i\c{%push} directive, and remove one using \i\c{%pop}. You can
2704 define labels that are local to a particular context on the stack.
2707 \S{pushpop} \i\c{%push} and \i\c{%pop}: \I{creating
2708 contexts}\I{removing contexts}Creating and Removing Contexts
2710 The \c{%push} directive is used to create a new context and place it
2711 on the top of the context stack. \c{%push} requires one argument,
2712 which is the name of the context. For example:
2716 This pushes a new context called \c{foobar} on the stack. You can
2717 have several contexts on the stack with the same name: they can
2718 still be distinguished.
2720 The directive \c{%pop}, requiring no arguments, removes the top
2721 context from the context stack and destroys it, along with any
2722 labels associated with it.
2725 \S{ctxlocal} \i{Context-Local Labels}
2727 Just as the usage \c{%%foo} defines a label which is local to the
2728 particular macro call in which it is used, the usage \I{%$}\c{%$foo}
2729 is used to define a label which is local to the context on the top
2730 of the context stack. So the \c{REPEAT} and \c{UNTIL} example given
2731 above could be implemented by means of:
2747 and invoked by means of, for example,
2755 which would scan every fourth byte of a string in search of the byte
2758 If you need to define, or access, labels local to the context
2759 \e{below} the top one on the stack, you can use \I{%$$}\c{%$$foo}, or
2760 \c{%$$$foo} for the context below that, and so on.
2763 \S{ctxdefine} \i{Context-Local Single-Line Macros}
2765 NASM also allows you to define single-line macros which are local to
2766 a particular context, in just the same way:
2768 \c %define %$localmac 3
2770 will define the single-line macro \c{%$localmac} to be local to the
2771 top context on the stack. Of course, after a subsequent \c{%push},
2772 it can then still be accessed by the name \c{%$$localmac}.
2775 \S{ctxrepl} \i\c{%repl}: \I{renaming contexts}Renaming a Context
2777 If you need to change the name of the top context on the stack (in
2778 order, for example, to have it respond differently to \c{%ifctx}),
2779 you can execute a \c{%pop} followed by a \c{%push}; but this will
2780 have the side effect of destroying all context-local labels and
2781 macros associated with the context that was just popped.
2783 NASM provides the directive \c{%repl}, which \e{replaces} a context
2784 with a different name, without touching the associated macros and
2785 labels. So you could replace the destructive code
2790 with the non-destructive version \c{%repl newname}.
2793 \S{blockif} Example Use of the \i{Context Stack}: \i{Block IFs}
2795 This example makes use of almost all the context-stack features,
2796 including the conditional-assembly construct \i\c{%ifctx}, to
2797 implement a block IF statement as a set of macros.
2813 \c %error "expected `if' before `else'"
2827 \c %error "expected `if' or `else' before `endif'"
2832 This code is more robust than the \c{REPEAT} and \c{UNTIL} macros
2833 given in \k{ctxlocal}, because it uses conditional assembly to check
2834 that the macros are issued in the right order (for example, not
2835 calling \c{endif} before \c{if}) and issues a \c{%error} if they're
2838 In addition, the \c{endif} macro has to be able to cope with the two
2839 distinct cases of either directly following an \c{if}, or following
2840 an \c{else}. It achieves this, again, by using conditional assembly
2841 to do different things depending on whether the context on top of
2842 the stack is \c{if} or \c{else}.
2844 The \c{else} macro has to preserve the context on the stack, in
2845 order to have the \c{%$ifnot} referred to by the \c{if} macro be the
2846 same as the one defined by the \c{endif} macro, but has to change
2847 the context's name so that \c{endif} will know there was an
2848 intervening \c{else}. It does this by the use of \c{%repl}.
2850 A sample usage of these macros might look like:
2872 The block-\c{IF} macros handle nesting quite happily, by means of
2873 pushing another context, describing the inner \c{if}, on top of the
2874 one describing the outer \c{if}; thus \c{else} and \c{endif} always
2875 refer to the last unmatched \c{if} or \c{else}.
2878 \H{stdmac} \i{Standard Macros}
2880 NASM defines a set of standard macros, which are already defined
2881 when it starts to process any source file. If you really need a
2882 program to be assembled with no pre-defined macros, you can use the
2883 \i\c{%clear} directive to empty the preprocessor of everything.
2885 Most \i{user-level assembler directives} (see \k{directive}) are
2886 implemented as macros which invoke primitive directives; these are
2887 described in \k{directive}. The rest of the standard macro set is
2891 \S{stdmacver} \i\c{__NASM_MAJOR__}, \i\c{__NASM_MINOR__},
2892 \i\c{__NASM_SUBMINOR__} and \i\c{___NASM_PATCHLEVEL__}: \i{NASM Version}
2894 The single-line macros \c{__NASM_MAJOR__}, \c{__NASM_MINOR__},
2895 \c{__NASM_SUBMINOR__} and \c{___NASM_PATCHLEVEL__} expand to the
2896 major, minor, subminor and patch level parts of the \i{version
2897 number of NASM} being used. So, under NASM 0.98.32p1 for
2898 example, \c{__NASM_MAJOR__} would be defined to be 0, \c{__NASM_MINOR__}
2899 would be defined as 98, \c{__NASM_SUBMINOR__} would be defined to 32,
2900 and \c{___NASM_PATCHLEVEL__} would be defined as 1.
2903 \S{stdmacverid} \i\c{__NASM_VERSION_ID__}: \i{NASM Version ID}
2905 The single-line macro \c{__NASM_VERSION_ID__} expands to a dword integer
2906 representing the full version number of the version of nasm being used.
2907 The value is the equivalent to \c{__NASM_MAJOR__}, \c{__NASM_MINOR__},
2908 \c{__NASM_SUBMINOR__} and \c{___NASM_PATCHLEVEL__} concatenated to
2909 produce a single doubleword. Hence, for 0.98.32p1, the returned number
2910 would be equivalent to:
2918 Note that the above lines are generate exactly the same code, the second
2919 line is used just to give an indication of the order that the separate
2920 values will be present in memory.
2923 \S{stdmacverstr} \i\c{__NASM_VER__}: \i{NASM Version string}
2925 The single-line macro \c{__NASM_VER__} expands to a string which defines
2926 the version number of nasm being used. So, under NASM 0.98.32 for example,
2935 \S{fileline} \i\c{__FILE__} and \i\c{__LINE__}: File Name and Line Number
2937 Like the C preprocessor, NASM allows the user to find out the file
2938 name and line number containing the current instruction. The macro
2939 \c{__FILE__} expands to a string constant giving the name of the
2940 current input file (which may change through the course of assembly
2941 if \c{%include} directives are used), and \c{__LINE__} expands to a
2942 numeric constant giving the current line number in the input file.
2944 These macros could be used, for example, to communicate debugging
2945 information to a macro, since invoking \c{__LINE__} inside a macro
2946 definition (either single-line or multi-line) will return the line
2947 number of the macro \e{call}, rather than \e{definition}. So to
2948 determine where in a piece of code a crash is occurring, for
2949 example, one could write a routine \c{stillhere}, which is passed a
2950 line number in \c{EAX} and outputs something like `line 155: still
2951 here'. You could then write a macro
2953 \c %macro notdeadyet 0
2962 and then pepper your code with calls to \c{notdeadyet} until you
2963 find the crash point.
2966 \S{struc} \i\c{STRUC} and \i\c{ENDSTRUC}: \i{Declaring Structure} Data Types
2968 The core of NASM contains no intrinsic means of defining data
2969 structures; instead, the preprocessor is sufficiently powerful that
2970 data structures can be implemented as a set of macros. The macros
2971 \c{STRUC} and \c{ENDSTRUC} are used to define a structure data type.
2973 \c{STRUC} takes one parameter, which is the name of the data type.
2974 This name is defined as a symbol with the value zero, and also has
2975 the suffix \c{_size} appended to it and is then defined as an
2976 \c{EQU} giving the size of the structure. Once \c{STRUC} has been
2977 issued, you are defining the structure, and should define fields
2978 using the \c{RESB} family of pseudo-instructions, and then invoke
2979 \c{ENDSTRUC} to finish the definition.
2981 For example, to define a structure called \c{mytype} containing a
2982 longword, a word, a byte and a string of bytes, you might code
2993 The above code defines six symbols: \c{mt_long} as 0 (the offset
2994 from the beginning of a \c{mytype} structure to the longword field),
2995 \c{mt_word} as 4, \c{mt_byte} as 6, \c{mt_str} as 7, \c{mytype_size}
2996 as 39, and \c{mytype} itself as zero.
2998 The reason why the structure type name is defined at zero is a side
2999 effect of allowing structures to work with the local label
3000 mechanism: if your structure members tend to have the same names in
3001 more than one structure, you can define the above structure like this:
3012 This defines the offsets to the structure fields as \c{mytype.long},
3013 \c{mytype.word}, \c{mytype.byte} and \c{mytype.str}.
3015 NASM, since it has no \e{intrinsic} structure support, does not
3016 support any form of period notation to refer to the elements of a
3017 structure once you have one (except the above local-label notation),
3018 so code such as \c{mov ax,[mystruc.mt_word]} is not valid.
3019 \c{mt_word} is a constant just like any other constant, so the
3020 correct syntax is \c{mov ax,[mystruc+mt_word]} or \c{mov
3021 ax,[mystruc+mytype.word]}.
3024 \S{istruc} \i\c{ISTRUC}, \i\c{AT} and \i\c{IEND}: Declaring
3025 \i{Instances of Structures}
3027 Having defined a structure type, the next thing you typically want
3028 to do is to declare instances of that structure in your data
3029 segment. NASM provides an easy way to do this in the \c{ISTRUC}
3030 mechanism. To declare a structure of type \c{mytype} in a program,
3031 you code something like this:
3036 \c at mt_long, dd 123456
3037 \c at mt_word, dw 1024
3038 \c at mt_byte, db 'x'
3039 \c at mt_str, db 'hello, world', 13, 10, 0
3043 The function of the \c{AT} macro is to make use of the \c{TIMES}
3044 prefix to advance the assembly position to the correct point for the
3045 specified structure field, and then to declare the specified data.
3046 Therefore the structure fields must be declared in the same order as
3047 they were specified in the structure definition.
3049 If the data to go in a structure field requires more than one source
3050 line to specify, the remaining source lines can easily come after
3051 the \c{AT} line. For example:
3053 \c at mt_str, db 123,134,145,156,167,178,189
3056 Depending on personal taste, you can also omit the code part of the
3057 \c{AT} line completely, and start the structure field on the next
3061 \c db 'hello, world'
3065 \S{align} \i\c{ALIGN} and \i\c{ALIGNB}: Data Alignment
3067 The \c{ALIGN} and \c{ALIGNB} macros provides a convenient way to
3068 align code or data on a word, longword, paragraph or other boundary.
3069 (Some assemblers call this directive \i\c{EVEN}.) The syntax of the
3070 \c{ALIGN} and \c{ALIGNB} macros is
3072 \c align 4 ; align on 4-byte boundary
3073 \c align 16 ; align on 16-byte boundary
3074 \c align 8,db 0 ; pad with 0s rather than NOPs
3075 \c align 4,resb 1 ; align to 4 in the BSS
3076 \c alignb 4 ; equivalent to previous line
3078 Both macros require their first argument to be a power of two; they
3079 both compute the number of additional bytes required to bring the
3080 length of the current section up to a multiple of that power of two,
3081 and then apply the \c{TIMES} prefix to their second argument to
3082 perform the alignment.
3084 If the second argument is not specified, the default for \c{ALIGN}
3085 is \c{NOP}, and the default for \c{ALIGNB} is \c{RESB 1}. So if the
3086 second argument is specified, the two macros are equivalent.
3087 Normally, you can just use \c{ALIGN} in code and data sections and
3088 \c{ALIGNB} in BSS sections, and never need the second argument
3089 except for special purposes.
3091 \c{ALIGN} and \c{ALIGNB}, being simple macros, perform no error
3092 checking: they cannot warn you if their first argument fails to be a
3093 power of two, or if their second argument generates more than one
3094 byte of code. In each of these cases they will silently do the wrong
3097 \c{ALIGNB} (or \c{ALIGN} with a second argument of \c{RESB 1}) can
3098 be used within structure definitions:
3115 This will ensure that the structure members are sensibly aligned
3116 relative to the base of the structure.
3118 A final caveat: \c{ALIGN} and \c{ALIGNB} work relative to the
3119 beginning of the \e{section}, not the beginning of the address space
3120 in the final executable. Aligning to a 16-byte boundary when the
3121 section you're in is only guaranteed to be aligned to a 4-byte
3122 boundary, for example, is a waste of effort. Again, NASM does not
3123 check that the section's alignment characteristics are sensible for
3124 the use of \c{ALIGN} or \c{ALIGNB}.
3127 \H{tasmcompat} \i{TASM Compatible Preprocessor Directives}
3129 The following preprocessor directives may only be used when TASM
3130 compatibility is turned on using the \c{-t} command line switch
3131 (This switch is described in \k{opt-t}.)
3133 \b\c{%arg} (see \k{arg})
3135 \b\c{%stacksize} (see \k{stacksize})
3137 \b\c{%local} (see \k{local})
3140 \S{arg} \i\c{%arg} Directive
3142 The \c{%arg} directive is used to simplify the handling of
3143 parameters passed on the stack. Stack based parameter passing
3144 is used by many high level languages, including C, C++ and Pascal.
3146 While NASM comes with macros which attempt to duplicate this
3147 functionality (see \k{16cmacro}), the syntax is not particularly
3148 convenient to use and is not TASM compatible. Here is an example
3149 which shows the use of \c{%arg} without any external macros:
3153 \c %push mycontext ; save the current context
3154 \c %stacksize large ; tell NASM to use bp
3155 \c %arg i:word, j_ptr:word
3162 \c %pop ; restore original context
3164 This is similar to the procedure defined in \k{16cmacro} and adds
3165 the value in i to the value pointed to by j_ptr and returns the
3166 sum in the ax register. See \k{pushpop} for an explanation of
3167 \c{push} and \c{pop} and the use of context stacks.
3170 \S{stacksize} \i\c{%stacksize} Directive
3172 The \c{%stacksize} directive is used in conjunction with the
3173 \c{%arg} (see \k{arg}) and the \c{%local} (see \k{local}) directives.
3174 It tells NASM the default size to use for subsequent \c{%arg} and
3175 \c{%local} directives. The \c{%stacksize} directive takes one
3176 required argument which is one of \c{flat}, \c{large} or \c{small}.
3180 This form causes NASM to use stack-based parameter addressing
3181 relative to \c{ebp} and it assumes that a near form of call was used
3182 to get to this label (i.e. that \c{eip} is on the stack).
3186 This form uses \c{bp} to do stack-based parameter addressing and
3187 assumes that a far form of call was used to get to this address
3188 (i.e. that \c{ip} and \c{cs} are on the stack).
3192 This form also uses \c{bp} to address stack parameters, but it is
3193 different from \c{large} because it also assumes that the old value
3194 of bp is pushed onto the stack (i.e. it expects an \c{ENTER}
3195 instruction). In other words, it expects that \c{bp}, \c{ip} and
3196 \c{cs} are on the top of the stack, underneath any local space which
3197 may have been allocated by \c{ENTER}. This form is probably most
3198 useful when used in combination with the \c{%local} directive
3202 \S{local} \i\c{%local} Directive
3204 The \c{%local} directive is used to simplify the use of local
3205 temporary stack variables allocated in a stack frame. Automatic
3206 local variables in C are an example of this kind of variable. The
3207 \c{%local} directive is most useful when used with the \c{%stacksize}
3208 (see \k{stacksize} and is also compatible with the \c{%arg} directive
3209 (see \k{arg}). It allows simplified reference to variables on the
3210 stack which have been allocated typically by using the \c{ENTER}
3211 instruction (see \k{insENTER} for a description of that instruction).
3212 An example of its use is the following:
3216 \c %push mycontext ; save the current context
3217 \c %stacksize small ; tell NASM to use bp
3218 \c %assign %$localsize 0 ; see text for explanation
3219 \c %local old_ax:word, old_dx:word
3221 \c enter %$localsize,0 ; see text for explanation
3222 \c mov [old_ax],ax ; swap ax & bx
3223 \c mov [old_dx],dx ; and swap dx & cx
3228 \c leave ; restore old bp
3231 \c %pop ; restore original context
3233 The \c{%$localsize} variable is used internally by the
3234 \c{%local} directive and \e{must} be defined within the
3235 current context before the \c{%local} directive may be used.
3236 Failure to do so will result in one expression syntax error for
3237 each \c{%local} variable declared. It then may be used in
3238 the construction of an appropriately sized ENTER instruction
3239 as shown in the example.
3241 \H{otherpreproc} \i{Other Preprocessor Directives}
3243 NASM also has preprocessor directives which allow access to
3244 information from external sources. Currently they include:
3246 The following preprocessor directive is supported to allow NASM to
3247 correctly handle output of the cpp C language preprocessor.
3249 \b\c{%line} enables NAsM to correctly handle the output of the cpp
3250 C language preprocessor (see \k{line}).
3252 \b\c{%!} enables NASM to read in the value of an environment variable,
3253 which can then be used in your program (see \k{getenv}).
3255 \S{line} \i\c{%line} Directive
3257 The \c{%line} directive is used to notify NASM that the input line
3258 corresponds to a specific line number in another file. Typically
3259 this other file would be an original source file, with the current
3260 NASM input being the output of a pre-processor. The \c{%line}
3261 directive allows NASM to output messages which indicate the line
3262 number of the original source file, instead of the file that is being
3265 This preprocessor directive is not generally of use to programmers,
3266 by may be of interest to preprocessor authors. The usage of the
3267 \c{%line} preprocessor directive is as follows:
3269 \c %line nnn[+mmm] [filename]
3271 In this directive, \c{nnn} indentifies the line of the original source
3272 file which this line corresponds to. \c{mmm} is an optional parameter
3273 which specifies a line increment value; each line of the input file
3274 read in is considered to correspond to \c{mmm} lines of the original
3275 source file. Finally, \c{filename} is an optional parameter which
3276 specifies the file name of the original source file.
3278 After reading a \c{%line} preprocessor directive, NASM will report
3279 all file name and line numbers relative to the values specified
3283 \S{getenv} \i\c{%!}\c{<env>}: Read an environment variable.
3285 The \c{%!<env>} directive makes it possible to read the value of an
3286 environment variable at assembly time. This could, for example, be used
3287 to store the contents of an environment variable into a string, which
3288 could be used at some other point in your code.
3290 For example, suppose that you have an environment variable \c{FOO}, and
3291 you want the contents of \c{FOO} to be embedded in your program. You
3292 could do that as follows:
3294 \c %define FOO %!FOO
3297 \c tmpstr db quote FOO quote
3299 At the time of writing, this will generate an "unterminated string"
3300 warning at the time of defining "quote", and it will add a space
3301 before and after the string that is read in. I was unable to find
3302 a simple workaround (although a workaround can be created using a
3303 multi-line macro), so I believe that you will need to either learn how
3304 to create more complex macros, or allow for the extra spaces if you
3305 make use of this feature in that way.
3308 \C{directive} \i{Assembler Directives}
3310 NASM, though it attempts to avoid the bureaucracy of assemblers like
3311 MASM and TASM, is nevertheless forced to support a \e{few}
3312 directives. These are described in this chapter.
3314 NASM's directives come in two types: \I{user-level
3315 directives}\e{user-level} directives and \I{primitive
3316 directives}\e{primitive} directives. Typically, each directive has a
3317 user-level form and a primitive form. In almost all cases, we
3318 recommend that users use the user-level forms of the directives,
3319 which are implemented as macros which call the primitive forms.
3321 Primitive directives are enclosed in square brackets; user-level
3324 In addition to the universal directives described in this chapter,
3325 each object file format can optionally supply extra directives in
3326 order to control particular features of that file format. These
3327 \I{format-specific directives}\e{format-specific} directives are
3328 documented along with the formats that implement them, in \k{outfmt}.
3331 \H{bits} \i\c{BITS}: Specifying Target \i{Processor Mode}
3333 The \c{BITS} directive specifies whether NASM should generate code
3334 \I{16-bit mode, versus 32-bit mode}designed to run on a processor
3335 operating in 16-bit mode, or code designed to run on a processor
3336 operating in 32-bit mode. The syntax is \c{BITS 16} or \c{BITS 32}.
3338 In most cases, you should not need to use \c{BITS} explicitly. The
3339 \c{aout}, \c{coff}, \c{elf} and \c{win32} object formats, which are
3340 designed for use in 32-bit operating systems, all cause NASM to
3341 select 32-bit mode by default. The \c{obj} object format allows you
3342 to specify each segment you define as either \c{USE16} or \c{USE32},
3343 and NASM will set its operating mode accordingly, so the use of the
3344 \c{BITS} directive is once again unnecessary.
3346 The most likely reason for using the \c{BITS} directive is to write
3347 32-bit code in a flat binary file; this is because the \c{bin}
3348 output format defaults to 16-bit mode in anticipation of it being
3349 used most frequently to write DOS \c{.COM} programs, DOS \c{.SYS}
3350 device drivers and boot loader software.
3352 You do \e{not} need to specify \c{BITS 32} merely in order to use
3353 32-bit instructions in a 16-bit DOS program; if you do, the
3354 assembler will generate incorrect code because it will be writing
3355 code targeted at a 32-bit platform, to be run on a 16-bit one.
3357 When NASM is in \c{BITS 16} state, instructions which use 32-bit
3358 data are prefixed with an 0x66 byte, and those referring to 32-bit
3359 addresses have an 0x67 prefix. In \c{BITS 32} state, the reverse is
3360 true: 32-bit instructions require no prefixes, whereas instructions
3361 using 16-bit data need an 0x66 and those working on 16-bit addresses
3364 The \c{BITS} directive has an exactly equivalent primitive form,
3365 \c{[BITS 16]} and \c{[BITS 32]}. The user-level form is a macro
3366 which has no function other than to call the primitive form.
3369 \S{USE16 & USE32} \i\c{USE16} & \i\c{USE32}: Aliases for BITS
3371 The `\c{USE16}' and `\c{USE32}' directives can be used in place of
3372 `\c{BITS 16}' and `\c{BITS 32}', for compatibility with other assemblers.
3375 \H{section} \i\c{SECTION} or \i\c{SEGMENT}: Changing and \i{Defining
3378 \I{changing sections}\I{switching between sections}The \c{SECTION}
3379 directive (\c{SEGMENT} is an exactly equivalent synonym) changes
3380 which section of the output file the code you write will be
3381 assembled into. In some object file formats, the number and names of
3382 sections are fixed; in others, the user may make up as many as they
3383 wish. Hence \c{SECTION} may sometimes give an error message, or may
3384 define a new section, if you try to switch to a section that does
3387 The Unix object formats, and the \c{bin} object format, all support
3388 the \i{standardised section names} \c{.text}, \c{.data} and \c{.bss}
3389 for the code, data and uninitialised-data sections. The \c{obj}
3390 format, by contrast, does not recognise these section names as being
3391 special, and indeed will strip off the leading period of any section
3395 \S{sectmac} The \i\c{__SECT__} Macro
3397 The \c{SECTION} directive is unusual in that its user-level form
3398 functions differently from its primitive form. The primitive form,
3399 \c{[SECTION xyz]}, simply switches the current target section to the
3400 one given. The user-level form, \c{SECTION xyz}, however, first
3401 defines the single-line macro \c{__SECT__} to be the primitive
3402 \c{[SECTION]} directive which it is about to issue, and then issues
3403 it. So the user-level directive
3407 expands to the two lines
3409 \c %define __SECT__ [SECTION .text]
3412 Users may find it useful to make use of this in their own macros.
3413 For example, the \c{writefile} macro defined in \k{mlmacgre} can be
3414 usefully rewritten in the following more sophisticated form:
3416 \c %macro writefile 2+
3426 \c mov cx,%%endstr-%%str
3433 This form of the macro, once passed a string to output, first
3434 switches temporarily to the data section of the file, using the
3435 primitive form of the \c{SECTION} directive so as not to modify
3436 \c{__SECT__}. It then declares its string in the data section, and
3437 then invokes \c{__SECT__} to switch back to \e{whichever} section
3438 the user was previously working in. It thus avoids the need, in the
3439 previous version of the macro, to include a \c{JMP} instruction to
3440 jump over the data, and also does not fail if, in a complicated
3441 \c{OBJ} format module, the user could potentially be assembling the
3442 code in any of several separate code sections.
3445 \H{absolute} \i\c{ABSOLUTE}: Defining Absolute Labels
3447 The \c{ABSOLUTE} directive can be thought of as an alternative form
3448 of \c{SECTION}: it causes the subsequent code to be directed at no
3449 physical section, but at the hypothetical section starting at the
3450 given absolute address. The only instructions you can use in this
3451 mode are the \c{RESB} family.
3453 \c{ABSOLUTE} is used as follows:
3461 This example describes a section of the PC BIOS data area, at
3462 segment address 0x40: the above code defines \c{kbuf_chr} to be
3463 0x1A, \c{kbuf_free} to be 0x1C, and \c{kbuf} to be 0x1E.
3465 The user-level form of \c{ABSOLUTE}, like that of \c{SECTION},
3466 redefines the \i\c{__SECT__} macro when it is invoked.
3468 \i\c{STRUC} and \i\c{ENDSTRUC} are defined as macros which use
3469 \c{ABSOLUTE} (and also \c{__SECT__}).
3471 \c{ABSOLUTE} doesn't have to take an absolute constant as an
3472 argument: it can take an expression (actually, a \i{critical
3473 expression}: see \k{crit}) and it can be a value in a segment. For
3474 example, a TSR can re-use its setup code as run-time BSS like this:
3476 \c org 100h ; it's a .COM program
3478 \c jmp setup ; setup code comes last
3480 \c ; the resident part of the TSR goes here
3482 \c ; now write the code that installs the TSR here
3486 \c runtimevar1 resw 1
3487 \c runtimevar2 resd 20
3491 This defines some variables `on top of' the setup code, so that
3492 after the setup has finished running, the space it took up can be
3493 re-used as data storage for the running TSR. The symbol `tsr_end'
3494 can be used to calculate the total size of the part of the TSR that
3495 needs to be made resident.
3498 \H{extern} \i\c{EXTERN}: \i{Importing Symbols} from Other Modules
3500 \c{EXTERN} is similar to the MASM directive \c{EXTRN} and the C
3501 keyword \c{extern}: it is used to declare a symbol which is not
3502 defined anywhere in the module being assembled, but is assumed to be
3503 defined in some other module and needs to be referred to by this
3504 one. Not every object-file format can support external variables:
3505 the \c{bin} format cannot.
3507 The \c{EXTERN} directive takes as many arguments as you like. Each
3508 argument is the name of a symbol:
3511 \c extern _sscanf,_fscanf
3513 Some object-file formats provide extra features to the \c{EXTERN}
3514 directive. In all cases, the extra features are used by suffixing a
3515 colon to the symbol name followed by object-format specific text.
3516 For example, the \c{obj} format allows you to declare that the
3517 default segment base of an external should be the group \c{dgroup}
3518 by means of the directive
3520 \c extern _variable:wrt dgroup
3522 The primitive form of \c{EXTERN} differs from the user-level form
3523 only in that it can take only one argument at a time: the support
3524 for multiple arguments is implemented at the preprocessor level.
3526 You can declare the same variable as \c{EXTERN} more than once: NASM
3527 will quietly ignore the second and later redeclarations. You can't
3528 declare a variable as \c{EXTERN} as well as something else, though.
3531 \H{global} \i\c{GLOBAL}: \i{Exporting Symbols} to Other Modules
3533 \c{GLOBAL} is the other end of \c{EXTERN}: if one module declares a
3534 symbol as \c{EXTERN} and refers to it, then in order to prevent
3535 linker errors, some other module must actually \e{define} the
3536 symbol and declare it as \c{GLOBAL}. Some assemblers use the name
3537 \i\c{PUBLIC} for this purpose.
3539 The \c{GLOBAL} directive applying to a symbol must appear \e{before}
3540 the definition of the symbol.
3542 \c{GLOBAL} uses the same syntax as \c{EXTERN}, except that it must
3543 refer to symbols which \e{are} defined in the same module as the
3544 \c{GLOBAL} directive. For example:
3550 \c{GLOBAL}, like \c{EXTERN}, allows object formats to define private
3551 extensions by means of a colon. The \c{elf} object format, for
3552 example, lets you specify whether global data items are functions or
3555 \c global hashlookup:function, hashtable:data
3557 Like \c{EXTERN}, the primitive form of \c{GLOBAL} differs from the
3558 user-level form only in that it can take only one argument at a
3562 \H{common} \i\c{COMMON}: Defining Common Data Areas
3564 The \c{COMMON} directive is used to declare \i\e{common variables}.
3565 A common variable is much like a global variable declared in the
3566 uninitialised data section, so that
3570 is similar in function to
3577 The difference is that if more than one module defines the same
3578 common variable, then at link time those variables will be
3579 \e{merged}, and references to \c{intvar} in all modules will point
3580 at the same piece of memory.
3582 Like \c{GLOBAL} and \c{EXTERN}, \c{COMMON} supports object-format
3583 specific extensions. For example, the \c{obj} format allows common
3584 variables to be NEAR or FAR, and the \c{elf} format allows you to
3585 specify the alignment requirements of a common variable:
3587 \c common commvar 4:near ; works in OBJ
3588 \c common intarray 100:4 ; works in ELF: 4 byte aligned
3590 Once again, like \c{EXTERN} and \c{GLOBAL}, the primitive form of
3591 \c{COMMON} differs from the user-level form only in that it can take
3592 only one argument at a time.
3595 \H{CPU} \i\c{CPU}: Defining CPU Dependencies
3597 The \i\c{CPU} directive restricts assembly to those instructions which
3598 are available on the specified CPU.
3602 \b\c{CPU 8086} Assemble only 8086 instruction set
3604 \b\c{CPU 186} Assemble instructions up to the 80186 instruction set
3606 \b\c{CPU 286} Assemble instructions up to the 286 instruction set
3608 \b\c{CPU 386} Assemble instructions up to the 386 instruction set
3610 \b\c{CPU 486} 486 instruction set
3612 \b\c{CPU 586} Pentium instruction set
3614 \b\c{CPU PENTIUM} Same as 586
3616 \b\c{CPU 686} P6 instruction set
3618 \b\c{CPU PPRO} Same as 686
3620 \b\c{CPU P2} Same as 686
3622 \b\c{CPU P3} Pentium III and Katmai instruction sets
3624 \b\c{CPU KATMAI} Same as P3
3626 \b\c{CPU P4} Pentium 4 (Willamette) instruction set
3628 \b\c{CPU WILLAMETTE} Same as P4
3630 \b\c{CPU IA64} IA64 CPU (in x86 mode) instruction set
3632 All options are case insensitive. All instructions will be selected
3633 only if they apply to the selected CPU or lower. By default, all
3634 instructions are available.
3637 \C{outfmt} \i{Output Formats}
3639 NASM is a portable assembler, designed to be able to compile on any
3640 ANSI C-supporting platform and produce output to run on a variety of
3641 Intel x86 operating systems. For this reason, it has a large number
3642 of available output formats, selected using the \i\c{-f} option on
3643 the NASM \i{command line}. Each of these formats, along with its
3644 extensions to the base NASM syntax, is detailed in this chapter.
3646 As stated in \k{opt-o}, NASM chooses a \i{default name} for your
3647 output file based on the input file name and the chosen output
3648 format. This will be generated by removing the \i{extension}
3649 (\c{.asm}, \c{.s}, or whatever you like to use) from the input file
3650 name, and substituting an extension defined by the output format.
3651 The extensions are given with each format below.
3654 \H{binfmt} \i\c{bin}: \i{Flat-Form Binary}\I{pure binary} Output
3656 The \c{bin} format does not produce object files: it generates
3657 nothing in the output file except the code you wrote. Such `pure
3658 binary' files are used by \i{MS-DOS}: \i\c{.COM} executables and
3659 \i\c{.SYS} device drivers are pure binary files. Pure binary output
3660 is also useful for \i{operating system} and \i{boot loader}
3663 The \c{bin} format supports \i{multiple section names}. For details of
3664 how nasm handles sections in the \c{bin} format, see \k{multisec}.
3666 Using the \c{bin} format puts NASM by default into 16-bit mode (see
3667 \k{bits}). In order to use \c{bin} to write 32-bit code such as an
3668 OS kernel, you need to explicitly issue the \I\c{BITS}\c{BITS 32}
3671 \c{bin} has no default output file name extension: instead, it
3672 leaves your file name as it is once the original extension has been
3673 removed. Thus, the default is for NASM to assemble \c{binprog.asm}
3674 into a binary file called \c{binprog}.
3677 \S{org} \i\c{ORG}: Binary File \i{Program Origin}
3679 The \c{bin} format provides an additional directive to the list
3680 given in \k{directive}: \c{ORG}. The function of the \c{ORG}
3681 directive is to specify the origin address which NASM will assume
3682 the program begins at when it is loaded into memory.
3684 For example, the following code will generate the longword
3691 Unlike the \c{ORG} directive provided by MASM-compatible assemblers,
3692 which allows you to jump around in the object file and overwrite
3693 code you have already generated, NASM's \c{ORG} does exactly what
3694 the directive says: \e{origin}. Its sole function is to specify one
3695 offset which is added to all internal address references within the
3696 section; it does not permit any of the trickery that MASM's version
3697 does. See \k{proborg} for further comments.
3700 \S{binseg} \c{bin} Extensions to the \c{SECTION}
3701 Directive\I{SECTION, bin extensions to}
3703 The \c{bin} output format extends the \c{SECTION} (or \c{SEGMENT})
3704 directive to allow you to specify the alignment requirements of
3705 segments. This is done by appending the \i\c{ALIGN} qualifier to the
3706 end of the section-definition line. For example,
3708 \c section .data align=16
3710 switches to the section \c{.data} and also specifies that it must be
3711 aligned on a 16-byte boundary.
3713 The parameter to \c{ALIGN} specifies how many low bits of the
3714 section start address must be forced to zero. The alignment value
3715 given may be any power of two.\I{section alignment, in
3716 bin}\I{segment alignment, in bin}\I{alignment, in bin sections}
3719 \S{multisec} \c{Multisection}\I{bin, multisection} support for the BIN format.
3721 The \c{bin} format allows the use of multiple sections, which are
3722 ordered according to a few basic rules.
3724 \b Any code which comes before an explicit \c{SECTION} directive
3725 is directed by default into the \c{.text} section.
3727 \b If a \c{.text} section is not given an \c{ORG} statement, it is
3728 allocated \c{ORG 0} by default.
3730 \b Sections which have an \c{ORG} statement, explicit or implicit,
3731 are placed in the order of the \c{ORG} statement. The code is padded
3732 with 0s to give the correct offsets within the output file.
3734 \b If a section has multiple \c{ORG} statements, the last \c{ORG} statement
3735 is applied to the entire section, without affecting the order in
3736 which the separate parts of the section are put together at assembly
3739 \b Sections without an \c{ORG} statement will be placed after those which
3740 do have one, and they will be placed in the order that they are first
3743 \b The \c{.data} section does not follow any special rules, unlike the
3744 \c{.text} and \c{.bss} sections.
3746 \b The \c{.bss} section will be placed after all other sections.
3748 \b All sections are aligned on dword boundaries, unless a higher level
3749 of alignment has been specified.
3751 \b Sections cannot overlap.
3754 \H{objfmt} \i\c{obj}: \i{Microsoft OMF}\I{OMF} Object Files
3756 The \c{obj} file format (NASM calls it \c{obj} rather than \c{omf}
3757 for historical reasons) is the one produced by \i{MASM} and
3758 \i{TASM}, which is typically fed to 16-bit DOS linkers to produce
3759 \i\c{.EXE} files. It is also the format used by \i{OS/2}.
3761 \c{obj} provides a default output file-name extension of \c{.obj}.
3763 \c{obj} is not exclusively a 16-bit format, though: NASM has full
3764 support for the 32-bit extensions to the format. In particular,
3765 32-bit \c{obj} format files are used by \i{Borland's Win32
3766 compilers}, instead of using Microsoft's newer \i\c{win32} object
3769 The \c{obj} format does not define any special segment names: you
3770 can call your segments anything you like. Typical names for segments
3771 in \c{obj} format files are \c{CODE}, \c{DATA} and \c{BSS}.
3773 If your source file contains code before specifying an explicit
3774 \c{SEGMENT} directive, then NASM will invent its own segment called
3775 \i\c{__NASMDEFSEG} for you.
3777 When you define a segment in an \c{obj} file, NASM defines the
3778 segment name as a symbol as well, so that you can access the segment
3779 address of the segment. So, for example:
3788 \c mov ax,data ; get segment address of data
3789 \c mov ds,ax ; and move it into DS
3790 \c inc word [dvar] ; now this reference will work
3793 The \c{obj} format also enables the use of the \i\c{SEG} and
3794 \i\c{WRT} operators, so that you can write code which does things
3799 \c mov ax,seg foo ; get preferred segment of foo
3801 \c mov ax,data ; a different segment
3803 \c mov ax,[ds:foo] ; this accesses `foo'
3804 \c mov [es:foo wrt data],bx ; so does this
3807 \S{objseg} \c{obj} Extensions to the \c{SEGMENT}
3808 Directive\I{SEGMENT, obj extensions to}
3810 The \c{obj} output format extends the \c{SEGMENT} (or \c{SECTION})
3811 directive to allow you to specify various properties of the segment
3812 you are defining. This is done by appending extra qualifiers to the
3813 end of the segment-definition line. For example,
3815 \c segment code private align=16
3817 defines the segment \c{code}, but also declares it to be a private
3818 segment, and requires that the portion of it described in this code
3819 module must be aligned on a 16-byte boundary.
3821 The available qualifiers are:
3823 \b \i\c{PRIVATE}, \i\c{PUBLIC}, \i\c{COMMON} and \i\c{STACK} specify
3824 the combination characteristics of the segment. \c{PRIVATE} segments
3825 do not get combined with any others by the linker; \c{PUBLIC} and
3826 \c{STACK} segments get concatenated together at link time; and
3827 \c{COMMON} segments all get overlaid on top of each other rather
3828 than stuck end-to-end.
3830 \b \i\c{ALIGN} is used, as shown above, to specify how many low bits
3831 of the segment start address must be forced to zero. The alignment
3832 value given may be any power of two from 1 to 4096; in reality, the
3833 only values supported are 1, 2, 4, 16, 256 and 4096, so if 8 is
3834 specified it will be rounded up to 16, and 32, 64 and 128 will all
3835 be rounded up to 256, and so on. Note that alignment to 4096-byte
3836 boundaries is a \i{PharLap} extension to the format and may not be
3837 supported by all linkers.\I{section alignment, in OBJ}\I{segment
3838 alignment, in OBJ}\I{alignment, in OBJ sections}
3840 \b \i\c{CLASS} can be used to specify the segment class; this feature
3841 indicates to the linker that segments of the same class should be
3842 placed near each other in the output file. The class name can be any
3843 word, e.g. \c{CLASS=CODE}.
3845 \b \i\c{OVERLAY}, like \c{CLASS}, is specified with an arbitrary word
3846 as an argument, and provides overlay information to an
3847 overlay-capable linker.
3849 \b Segments can be declared as \i\c{USE16} or \i\c{USE32}, which has
3850 the effect of recording the choice in the object file and also
3851 ensuring that NASM's default assembly mode when assembling in that
3852 segment is 16-bit or 32-bit respectively.
3854 \b When writing \i{OS/2} object files, you should declare 32-bit
3855 segments as \i\c{FLAT}, which causes the default segment base for
3856 anything in the segment to be the special group \c{FLAT}, and also
3857 defines the group if it is not already defined.
3859 \b The \c{obj} file format also allows segments to be declared as
3860 having a pre-defined absolute segment address, although no linkers
3861 are currently known to make sensible use of this feature;
3862 nevertheless, NASM allows you to declare a segment such as
3863 \c{SEGMENT SCREEN ABSOLUTE=0xB800} if you need to. The \i\c{ABSOLUTE}
3864 and \c{ALIGN} keywords are mutually exclusive.
3866 NASM's default segment attributes are \c{PUBLIC}, \c{ALIGN=1}, no
3867 class, no overlay, and \c{USE16}.
3870 \S{group} \i\c{GROUP}: Defining Groups of Segments\I{segments, groups of}
3872 The \c{obj} format also allows segments to be grouped, so that a
3873 single segment register can be used to refer to all the segments in
3874 a group. NASM therefore supplies the \c{GROUP} directive, whereby
3883 \c ; some uninitialised data
3885 \c group dgroup data bss
3887 which will define a group called \c{dgroup} to contain the segments
3888 \c{data} and \c{bss}. Like \c{SEGMENT}, \c{GROUP} causes the group
3889 name to be defined as a symbol, so that you can refer to a variable
3890 \c{var} in the \c{data} segment as \c{var wrt data} or as \c{var wrt
3891 dgroup}, depending on which segment value is currently in your
3894 If you just refer to \c{var}, however, and \c{var} is declared in a
3895 segment which is part of a group, then NASM will default to giving
3896 you the offset of \c{var} from the beginning of the \e{group}, not
3897 the \e{segment}. Therefore \c{SEG var}, also, will return the group
3898 base rather than the segment base.
3900 NASM will allow a segment to be part of more than one group, but
3901 will generate a warning if you do this. Variables declared in a
3902 segment which is part of more than one group will default to being
3903 relative to the first group that was defined to contain the segment.
3905 A group does not have to contain any segments; you can still make
3906 \c{WRT} references to a group which does not contain the variable
3907 you are referring to. OS/2, for example, defines the special group
3908 \c{FLAT} with no segments in it.
3911 \S{uppercase} \i\c{UPPERCASE}: Disabling Case Sensitivity in Output
3913 Although NASM itself is \i{case sensitive}, some OMF linkers are
3914 not; therefore it can be useful for NASM to output single-case
3915 object files. The \c{UPPERCASE} format-specific directive causes all
3916 segment, group and symbol names that are written to the object file
3917 to be forced to upper case just before being written. Within a
3918 source file, NASM is still case-sensitive; but the object file can
3919 be written entirely in upper case if desired.
3921 \c{UPPERCASE} is used alone on a line; it requires no parameters.
3924 \S{import} \i\c{IMPORT}: Importing DLL Symbols\I{DLL symbols,
3925 importing}\I{symbols, importing from DLLs}
3927 The \c{IMPORT} format-specific directive defines a symbol to be
3928 imported from a DLL, for use if you are writing a DLL's \i{import
3929 library} in NASM. You still need to declare the symbol as \c{EXTERN}
3930 as well as using the \c{IMPORT} directive.
3932 The \c{IMPORT} directive takes two required parameters, separated by
3933 white space, which are (respectively) the name of the symbol you
3934 wish to import and the name of the library you wish to import it
3937 \c import WSAStartup wsock32.dll
3939 A third optional parameter gives the name by which the symbol is
3940 known in the library you are importing it from, in case this is not
3941 the same as the name you wish the symbol to be known by to your code
3942 once you have imported it. For example:
3944 \c import asyncsel wsock32.dll WSAAsyncSelect
3947 \S{export} \i\c{EXPORT}: Exporting DLL Symbols\I{DLL symbols,
3948 exporting}\I{symbols, exporting from DLLs}
3950 The \c{EXPORT} format-specific directive defines a global symbol to
3951 be exported as a DLL symbol, for use if you are writing a DLL in
3952 NASM. You still need to declare the symbol as \c{GLOBAL} as well as
3953 using the \c{EXPORT} directive.
3955 \c{EXPORT} takes one required parameter, which is the name of the
3956 symbol you wish to export, as it was defined in your source file. An
3957 optional second parameter (separated by white space from the first)
3958 gives the \e{external} name of the symbol: the name by which you
3959 wish the symbol to be known to programs using the DLL. If this name
3960 is the same as the internal name, you may leave the second parameter
3963 Further parameters can be given to define attributes of the exported
3964 symbol. These parameters, like the second, are separated by white
3965 space. If further parameters are given, the external name must also
3966 be specified, even if it is the same as the internal name. The
3967 available attributes are:
3969 \b \c{resident} indicates that the exported name is to be kept
3970 resident by the system loader. This is an optimisation for
3971 frequently used symbols imported by name.
3973 \b \c{nodata} indicates that the exported symbol is a function which
3974 does not make use of any initialised data.
3976 \b \c{parm=NNN}, where \c{NNN} is an integer, sets the number of
3977 parameter words for the case in which the symbol is a call gate
3978 between 32-bit and 16-bit segments.
3980 \b An attribute which is just a number indicates that the symbol
3981 should be exported with an identifying number (ordinal), and gives
3987 \c export myfunc TheRealMoreFormalLookingFunctionName
3988 \c export myfunc myfunc 1234 ; export by ordinal
3989 \c export myfunc myfunc resident parm=23 nodata
3992 \S{dotdotstart} \i\c{..start}: Defining the \i{Program Entry
3995 \c{OMF} linkers require exactly one of the object files being linked to
3996 define the program entry point, where execution will begin when the
3997 program is run. If the object file that defines the entry point is
3998 assembled using NASM, you specify the entry point by declaring the
3999 special symbol \c{..start} at the point where you wish execution to
4003 \S{objextern} \c{obj} Extensions to the \c{EXTERN}
4004 Directive\I{EXTERN, obj extensions to}
4006 If you declare an external symbol with the directive
4010 then references such as \c{mov ax,foo} will give you the offset of
4011 \c{foo} from its preferred segment base (as specified in whichever
4012 module \c{foo} is actually defined in). So to access the contents of
4013 \c{foo} you will usually need to do something like
4015 \c mov ax,seg foo ; get preferred segment base
4016 \c mov es,ax ; move it into ES
4017 \c mov ax,[es:foo] ; and use offset `foo' from it
4019 This is a little unwieldy, particularly if you know that an external
4020 is going to be accessible from a given segment or group, say
4021 \c{dgroup}. So if \c{DS} already contained \c{dgroup}, you could
4024 \c mov ax,[foo wrt dgroup]
4026 However, having to type this every time you want to access \c{foo}
4027 can be a pain; so NASM allows you to declare \c{foo} in the
4030 \c extern foo:wrt dgroup
4032 This form causes NASM to pretend that the preferred segment base of
4033 \c{foo} is in fact \c{dgroup}; so the expression \c{seg foo} will
4034 now return \c{dgroup}, and the expression \c{foo} is equivalent to
4037 This \I{default-WRT mechanism}default-\c{WRT} mechanism can be used
4038 to make externals appear to be relative to any group or segment in
4039 your program. It can also be applied to common variables: see
4043 \S{objcommon} \c{obj} Extensions to the \c{COMMON}
4044 Directive\I{COMMON, obj extensions to}
4046 The \c{obj} format allows common variables to be either near\I{near
4047 common variables} or far\I{far common variables}; NASM allows you to
4048 specify which your variables should be by the use of the syntax
4050 \c common nearvar 2:near ; `nearvar' is a near common
4051 \c common farvar 10:far ; and `farvar' is far
4053 Far common variables may be greater in size than 64Kb, and so the
4054 OMF specification says that they are declared as a number of
4055 \e{elements} of a given size. So a 10-byte far common variable could
4056 be declared as ten one-byte elements, five two-byte elements, two
4057 five-byte elements or one ten-byte element.
4059 Some \c{OMF} linkers require the \I{element size, in common
4060 variables}\I{common variables, element size}element size, as well as
4061 the variable size, to match when resolving common variables declared
4062 in more than one module. Therefore NASM must allow you to specify
4063 the element size on your far common variables. This is done by the
4066 \c common c_5by2 10:far 5 ; two five-byte elements
4067 \c common c_2by5 10:far 2 ; five two-byte elements
4069 If no element size is specified, the default is 1. Also, the \c{FAR}
4070 keyword is not required when an element size is specified, since
4071 only far commons may have element sizes at all. So the above
4072 declarations could equivalently be
4074 \c common c_5by2 10:5 ; two five-byte elements
4075 \c common c_2by5 10:2 ; five two-byte elements
4077 In addition to these extensions, the \c{COMMON} directive in \c{obj}
4078 also supports default-\c{WRT} specification like \c{EXTERN} does
4079 (explained in \k{objextern}). So you can also declare things like
4081 \c common foo 10:wrt dgroup
4082 \c common bar 16:far 2:wrt data
4083 \c common baz 24:wrt data:6
4086 \H{win32fmt} \i\c{win32}: Microsoft Win32 Object Files
4088 The \c{win32} output format generates Microsoft Win32 object files,
4089 suitable for passing to Microsoft linkers such as \i{Visual C++}.
4090 Note that Borland Win32 compilers do not use this format, but use
4091 \c{obj} instead (see \k{objfmt}).
4093 \c{win32} provides a default output file-name extension of \c{.obj}.
4095 Note that although Microsoft say that Win32 object files follow the
4096 \c{COFF} (Common Object File Format) standard, the object files produced
4097 by Microsoft Win32 compilers are not compatible with COFF linkers
4098 such as DJGPP's, and vice versa. This is due to a difference of
4099 opinion over the precise semantics of PC-relative relocations. To
4100 produce COFF files suitable for DJGPP, use NASM's \c{coff} output
4101 format; conversely, the \c{coff} format does not produce object
4102 files that Win32 linkers can generate correct output from.
4105 \S{win32sect} \c{win32} Extensions to the \c{SECTION}
4106 Directive\I{SECTION, win32 extensions to}
4108 Like the \c{obj} format, \c{win32} allows you to specify additional
4109 information on the \c{SECTION} directive line, to control the type
4110 and properties of sections you declare. Section types and properties
4111 are generated automatically by NASM for the \i{standard section names}
4112 \c{.text}, \c{.data} and \c{.bss}, but may still be overridden by
4115 The available qualifiers are:
4117 \b \c{code}, or equivalently \c{text}, defines the section to be a
4118 code section. This marks the section as readable and executable, but
4119 not writable, and also indicates to the linker that the type of the
4122 \b \c{data} and \c{bss} define the section to be a data section,
4123 analogously to \c{code}. Data sections are marked as readable and
4124 writable, but not executable. \c{data} declares an initialised data
4125 section, whereas \c{bss} declares an uninitialised data section.
4127 \b \c{rdata} declares an initialised data section that is readable
4128 but not writable. Microsoft compilers use this section to place
4131 \b \c{info} defines the section to be an \i{informational section},
4132 which is not included in the executable file by the linker, but may
4133 (for example) pass information \e{to} the linker. For example,
4134 declaring an \c{info}-type section called \i\c{.drectve} causes the
4135 linker to interpret the contents of the section as command-line
4138 \b \c{align=}, used with a trailing number as in \c{obj}, gives the
4139 \I{section alignment, in win32}\I{alignment, in win32
4140 sections}alignment requirements of the section. The maximum you may
4141 specify is 64: the Win32 object file format contains no means to
4142 request a greater section alignment than this. If alignment is not
4143 explicitly specified, the defaults are 16-byte alignment for code
4144 sections, 8-byte alignment for rdata sections and 4-byte alignment
4145 for data (and BSS) sections.
4146 Informational sections get a default alignment of 1 byte (no
4147 alignment), though the value does not matter.
4149 The defaults assumed by NASM if you do not specify the above
4152 \c section .text code align=16
4153 \c section .data data align=4
4154 \c section .rdata rdata align=8
4155 \c section .bss bss align=4
4157 Any other section name is treated by default like \c{.text}.
4160 \H{cofffmt} \i\c{coff}: \i{Common Object File Format}
4162 The \c{coff} output type produces \c{COFF} object files suitable for
4163 linking with the \i{DJGPP} linker.
4165 \c{coff} provides a default output file-name extension of \c{.o}.
4167 The \c{coff} format supports the same extensions to the \c{SECTION}
4168 directive as \c{win32} does, except that the \c{align} qualifier and
4169 the \c{info} section type are not supported.
4172 \H{elffmt} \i\c{elf}: \I{ELF}\I{linux, elf}\i{Executable and Linkable
4173 Format} Object Files
4175 The \c{elf} output format generates \c{ELF32} (Executable and Linkable
4176 Format) object files, as used by Linux as well as \i{Unix System V},
4177 including \i{Solaris x86}, \i{UnixWare} and \i{SCO Unix}. \c{elf}
4178 provides a default output file-name extension of \c{.o}.
4181 \S{elfsect} \c{elf} Extensions to the \c{SECTION}
4182 Directive\I{SECTION, elf extensions to}
4184 Like the \c{obj} format, \c{elf} allows you to specify additional
4185 information on the \c{SECTION} directive line, to control the type
4186 and properties of sections you declare. Section types and properties
4187 are generated automatically by NASM for the \i{standard section
4188 names} \i\c{.text}, \i\c{.data} and \i\c{.bss}, but may still be
4189 overridden by these qualifiers.
4191 The available qualifiers are:
4193 \b \i\c{alloc} defines the section to be one which is loaded into
4194 memory when the program is run. \i\c{noalloc} defines it to be one
4195 which is not, such as an informational or comment section.
4197 \b \i\c{exec} defines the section to be one which should have execute
4198 permission when the program is run. \i\c{noexec} defines it as one
4201 \b \i\c{write} defines the section to be one which should be writable
4202 when the program is run. \i\c{nowrite} defines it as one which should
4205 \b \i\c{progbits} defines the section to be one with explicit contents
4206 stored in the object file: an ordinary code or data section, for
4207 example, \i\c{nobits} defines the section to be one with no explicit
4208 contents given, such as a BSS section.
4210 \b \c{align=}, used with a trailing number as in \c{obj}, gives the
4211 \I{section alignment, in elf}\I{alignment, in elf sections}alignment
4212 requirements of the section.
4214 The defaults assumed by NASM if you do not specify the above
4217 \c section .text progbits alloc exec nowrite align=16
4218 \c section .rodata progbits alloc noexec nowrite align=4
4219 \c section .data progbits alloc noexec write align=4
4220 \c section .bss nobits alloc noexec write align=4
4221 \c section other progbits alloc noexec nowrite align=1
4223 (Any section name other than \c{.text}, \c{.rodata}, \c{.data} and
4224 \c{.bss} is treated by default like \c{other} in the above code.)
4227 \S{elfwrt} \i{Position-Independent Code}\I{PIC}: \c{elf} Special
4228 Symbols and \i\c{WRT}
4230 The \c{ELF} specification contains enough features to allow
4231 position-independent code (PIC) to be written, which makes \i{ELF
4232 shared libraries} very flexible. However, it also means NASM has to
4233 be able to generate a variety of strange relocation types in ELF
4234 object files, if it is to be an assembler which can write PIC.
4236 Since \c{ELF} does not support segment-base references, the \c{WRT}
4237 operator is not used for its normal purpose; therefore NASM's
4238 \c{elf} output format makes use of \c{WRT} for a different purpose,
4239 namely the PIC-specific \I{relocations, PIC-specific}relocation
4242 \c{elf} defines five special symbols which you can use as the
4243 right-hand side of the \c{WRT} operator to obtain PIC relocation
4244 types. They are \i\c{..gotpc}, \i\c{..gotoff}, \i\c{..got},
4245 \i\c{..plt} and \i\c{..sym}. Their functions are summarised here:
4247 \b Referring to the symbol marking the global offset table base
4248 using \c{wrt ..gotpc} will end up giving the distance from the
4249 beginning of the current section to the global offset table.
4250 (\i\c{_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_} is the standard symbol name used to
4251 refer to the \i{GOT}.) So you would then need to add \i\c{$$} to the
4252 result to get the real address of the GOT.
4254 \b Referring to a location in one of your own sections using \c{wrt
4255 ..gotoff} will give the distance from the beginning of the GOT to
4256 the specified location, so that adding on the address of the GOT
4257 would give the real address of the location you wanted.
4259 \b Referring to an external or global symbol using \c{wrt ..got}
4260 causes the linker to build an entry \e{in} the GOT containing the
4261 address of the symbol, and the reference gives the distance from the
4262 beginning of the GOT to the entry; so you can add on the address of
4263 the GOT, load from the resulting address, and end up with the
4264 address of the symbol.
4266 \b Referring to a procedure name using \c{wrt ..plt} causes the
4267 linker to build a \i{procedure linkage table} entry for the symbol,
4268 and the reference gives the address of the \i{PLT} entry. You can
4269 only use this in contexts which would generate a PC-relative
4270 relocation normally (i.e. as the destination for \c{CALL} or
4271 \c{JMP}), since ELF contains no relocation type to refer to PLT
4274 \b Referring to a symbol name using \c{wrt ..sym} causes NASM to
4275 write an ordinary relocation, but instead of making the relocation
4276 relative to the start of the section and then adding on the offset
4277 to the symbol, it will write a relocation record aimed directly at
4278 the symbol in question. The distinction is a necessary one due to a
4279 peculiarity of the dynamic linker.
4281 A fuller explanation of how to use these relocation types to write
4282 shared libraries entirely in NASM is given in \k{picdll}.
4285 \S{elfglob} \c{elf} Extensions to the \c{GLOBAL} Directive\I{GLOBAL,
4286 elf extensions to}\I{GLOBAL, aoutb extensions to}
4288 \c{ELF} object files can contain more information about a global symbol
4289 than just its address: they can contain the \I{symbol sizes,
4290 specifying}\I{size, of symbols}size of the symbol and its \I{symbol
4291 types, specifying}\I{type, of symbols}type as well. These are not
4292 merely debugger conveniences, but are actually necessary when the
4293 program being written is a \i{shared library}. NASM therefore
4294 supports some extensions to the \c{GLOBAL} directive, allowing you
4295 to specify these features.
4297 You can specify whether a global variable is a function or a data
4298 object by suffixing the name with a colon and the word
4299 \i\c{function} or \i\c{data}. (\i\c{object} is a synonym for
4300 \c{data}.) For example:
4302 \c global hashlookup:function, hashtable:data
4304 exports the global symbol \c{hashlookup} as a function and
4305 \c{hashtable} as a data object.
4307 You can also specify the size of the data associated with the
4308 symbol, as a numeric expression (which may involve labels, and even
4309 forward references) after the type specifier. Like this:
4311 \c global hashtable:data (hashtable.end - hashtable)
4314 \c db this,that,theother ; some data here
4317 This makes NASM automatically calculate the length of the table and
4318 place that information into the \c{ELF} symbol table.
4320 Declaring the type and size of global symbols is necessary when
4321 writing shared library code. For more information, see
4325 \S{elfcomm} \c{elf} Extensions to the \c{COMMON} Directive
4326 \I{COMMON, elf extensions to}
4328 \c{ELF} also allows you to specify alignment requirements \I{common
4329 variables, alignment in elf}\I{alignment, of elf common variables}on
4330 common variables. This is done by putting a number (which must be a
4331 power of two) after the name and size of the common variable,
4332 separated (as usual) by a colon. For example, an array of
4333 doublewords would benefit from 4-byte alignment:
4335 \c common dwordarray 128:4
4337 This declares the total size of the array to be 128 bytes, and
4338 requires that it be aligned on a 4-byte boundary.
4341 \S{elf16} 16-bit code and ELF
4342 \I{ELF, 16-bit code and}
4344 The \c{ELF32} specification doesn't provide relocations for 8- and
4345 16-bit values, but the GNU \c{ld} linker adds these as an extension.
4346 NASM can generate GNU-compatible relocations, to allow 16-bit code to
4347 be linked as ELF using GNU \c{ld}. If NASM is used with the
4348 \c{-w+gnu-elf-extensions} option, a warning is issued when one of
4349 these relocations is generated.
4351 \H{aoutfmt} \i\c{aout}: Linux \I{a.out, Linux version}\I{linux, a.out}\c{a.out} Object Files
4353 The \c{aout} format generates \c{a.out} object files, in the form used
4354 by early Linux systems (current Linux systems use ELF, see
4355 \k{elffmt}.) These differ from other \c{a.out} object files in that
4356 the magic number in the first four bytes of the file is
4357 different; also, some implementations of \c{a.out}, for example
4358 NetBSD's, support position-independent code, which Linux's
4359 implementation does not.
4361 \c{a.out} provides a default output file-name extension of \c{.o}.
4363 \c{a.out} is a very simple object format. It supports no special
4364 directives, no special symbols, no use of \c{SEG} or \c{WRT}, and no
4365 extensions to any standard directives. It supports only the three
4366 \i{standard section names} \i\c{.text}, \i\c{.data} and \i\c{.bss}.
4369 \H{aoutfmt} \i\c{aoutb}: \i{NetBSD}/\i{FreeBSD}/\i{OpenBSD}
4370 \I{a.out, BSD version}\c{a.out} Object Files
4372 The \c{aoutb} format generates \c{a.out} object files, in the form
4373 used by the various free \c{BSD Unix} clones, \c{NetBSD}, \c{FreeBSD}
4374 and \c{OpenBSD}. For simple object files, this object format is exactly
4375 the same as \c{aout} except for the magic number in the first four bytes
4376 of the file. However, the \c{aoutb} format supports
4377 \I{PIC}\i{position-independent code} in the same way as the \c{elf}
4378 format, so you can use it to write \c{BSD} \i{shared libraries}.
4380 \c{aoutb} provides a default output file-name extension of \c{.o}.
4382 \c{aoutb} supports no special directives, no special symbols, and
4383 only the three \i{standard section names} \i\c{.text}, \i\c{.data}
4384 and \i\c{.bss}. However, it also supports the same use of \i\c{WRT} as
4385 \c{elf} does, to provide position-independent code relocation types.
4386 See \k{elfwrt} for full documentation of this feature.
4388 \c{aoutb} also supports the same extensions to the \c{GLOBAL}
4389 directive as \c{elf} does: see \k{elfglob} for documentation of
4393 \H{as86fmt} \c{as86}: \i{Minix}/Linux\I{linux, as86} \i\c{as86} Object Files
4395 The Minix/Linux 16-bit assembler \c{as86} has its own non-standard
4396 object file format. Although its companion linker \i\c{ld86} produces
4397 something close to ordinary \c{a.out} binaries as output, the object
4398 file format used to communicate between \c{as86} and \c{ld86} is not
4401 NASM supports this format, just in case it is useful, as \c{as86}.
4402 \c{as86} provides a default output file-name extension of \c{.o}.
4404 \c{as86} is a very simple object format (from the NASM user's point
4405 of view). It supports no special directives, no special symbols, no
4406 use of \c{SEG} or \c{WRT}, and no extensions to any standard
4407 directives. It supports only the three \i{standard section names}
4408 \i\c{.text}, \i\c{.data} and \i\c{.bss}.
4411 \H{rdffmt} \I{RDOFF}\i\c{rdf}: \i{Relocatable Dynamic Object File
4414 The \c{rdf} output format produces \c{RDOFF} object files. \c{RDOFF}
4415 (Relocatable Dynamic Object File Format) is a home-grown object-file
4416 format, designed alongside NASM itself and reflecting in its file
4417 format the internal structure of the assembler.
4419 \c{RDOFF} is not used by any well-known operating systems. Those
4420 writing their own systems, however, may well wish to use \c{RDOFF}
4421 as their object format, on the grounds that it is designed primarily
4422 for simplicity and contains very little file-header bureaucracy.
4424 The Unix NASM archive, and the DOS archive which includes sources,
4425 both contain an \I{rdoff subdirectory}\c{rdoff} subdirectory holding
4426 a set of RDOFF utilities: an RDF linker, an \c{RDF} static-library
4427 manager, an RDF file dump utility, and a program which will load and
4428 execute an RDF executable under Linux.
4430 \c{rdf} supports only the \i{standard section names} \i\c{.text},
4431 \i\c{.data} and \i\c{.bss}.
4434 \S{rdflib} Requiring a Library: The \i\c{LIBRARY} Directive
4436 \c{RDOFF} contains a mechanism for an object file to demand a given
4437 library to be linked to the module, either at load time or run time.
4438 This is done by the \c{LIBRARY} directive, which takes one argument
4439 which is the name of the module:
4441 \c library mylib.rdl
4444 \S{rdfmod} Specifying a Module Name: The \i\c{MODULE} Directive
4446 Special \c{RDOFF} header record is used to store the name of the module.
4447 It can be used, for example, by run-time loader to perform dynamic
4448 linking. \c{MODULE} directive takes one argument which is the name
4453 Note that when you statically link modules and tell linker to strip
4454 the symbols from output file, all module names will be stripped too.
4455 To avoid it, you should start module names with \I{$, prefix}\c{$}, like:
4457 \c module $kernel.core
4460 \S{rdfglob} \c{rdf} Extensions to the \c{GLOBAL} directive\I{GLOBAL,
4463 \c{RDOFF} global symbols can contain additional information needed by
4464 the static linker. You can mark a global symbol as exported, thus
4465 telling the linker do not strip it from target executable or library
4466 file. Like in \c{ELF}, you can also specify whether an exported symbol
4467 is a procedure (function) or data object.
4469 Suffixing the name with a colon and the word \i\c{export} you make the
4472 \c global sys_open:export
4474 To specify that exported symbol is a procedure (function), you add the
4475 word \i\c{proc} or \i\c{function} after declaration:
4477 \c global sys_open:export proc
4479 Similarly, to specify exported data object, add the word \i\c{data}
4480 or \i\c{object} to the directive:
4482 \c global kernel_ticks:export data
4485 \H{dbgfmt} \i\c{dbg}: Debugging Format
4487 The \c{dbg} output format is not built into NASM in the default
4488 configuration. If you are building your own NASM executable from the
4489 sources, you can define \i\c{OF_DBG} in \c{outform.h} or on the
4490 compiler command line, and obtain the \c{dbg} output format.
4492 The \c{dbg} format does not output an object file as such; instead,
4493 it outputs a text file which contains a complete list of all the
4494 transactions between the main body of NASM and the output-format
4495 back end module. It is primarily intended to aid people who want to
4496 write their own output drivers, so that they can get a clearer idea
4497 of the various requests the main program makes of the output driver,
4498 and in what order they happen.
4500 For simple files, one can easily use the \c{dbg} format like this:
4502 \c nasm -f dbg filename.asm
4504 which will generate a diagnostic file called \c{filename.dbg}.
4505 However, this will not work well on files which were designed for a
4506 different object format, because each object format defines its own
4507 macros (usually user-level forms of directives), and those macros
4508 will not be defined in the \c{dbg} format. Therefore it can be
4509 useful to run NASM twice, in order to do the preprocessing with the
4510 native object format selected:
4512 \c nasm -e -f rdf -o rdfprog.i rdfprog.asm
4513 \c nasm -a -f dbg rdfprog.i
4515 This preprocesses \c{rdfprog.asm} into \c{rdfprog.i}, keeping the
4516 \c{rdf} object format selected in order to make sure RDF special
4517 directives are converted into primitive form correctly. Then the
4518 preprocessed source is fed through the \c{dbg} format to generate
4519 the final diagnostic output.
4521 This workaround will still typically not work for programs intended
4522 for \c{obj} format, because the \c{obj} \c{SEGMENT} and \c{GROUP}
4523 directives have side effects of defining the segment and group names
4524 as symbols; \c{dbg} will not do this, so the program will not
4525 assemble. You will have to work around that by defining the symbols
4526 yourself (using \c{EXTERN}, for example) if you really need to get a
4527 \c{dbg} trace of an \c{obj}-specific source file.
4529 \c{dbg} accepts any section name and any directives at all, and logs
4530 them all to its output file.
4533 \C{16bit} Writing 16-bit Code (DOS, Windows 3/3.1)
4535 This chapter attempts to cover some of the common issues encountered
4536 when writing 16-bit code to run under \c{MS-DOS} or \c{Windows 3.x}. It
4537 covers how to link programs to produce \c{.EXE} or \c{.COM} files,
4538 how to write \c{.SYS} device drivers, and how to interface assembly
4539 language code with 16-bit C compilers and with Borland Pascal.
4542 \H{exefiles} Producing \i\c{.EXE} Files
4544 Any large program written under DOS needs to be built as a \c{.EXE}
4545 file: only \c{.EXE} files have the necessary internal structure
4546 required to span more than one 64K segment. \i{Windows} programs,
4547 also, have to be built as \c{.EXE} files, since Windows does not
4548 support the \c{.COM} format.
4550 In general, you generate \c{.EXE} files by using the \c{obj} output
4551 format to produce one or more \i\c{.OBJ} files, and then linking
4552 them together using a linker. However, NASM also supports the direct
4553 generation of simple DOS \c{.EXE} files using the \c{bin} output
4554 format (by using \c{DB} and \c{DW} to construct the \c{.EXE} file
4555 header), and a macro package is supplied to do this. Thanks to
4556 Yann Guidon for contributing the code for this.
4558 NASM may also support \c{.EXE} natively as another output format in
4562 \S{objexe} Using the \c{obj} Format To Generate \c{.EXE} Files
4564 This section describes the usual method of generating \c{.EXE} files
4565 by linking \c{.OBJ} files together.
4567 Most 16-bit programming language packages come with a suitable
4568 linker; if you have none of these, there is a free linker called
4569 \i{VAL}\I{linker, free}, available in \c{LZH} archive format from
4570 \W{ftp://x2ftp.oulu.fi/pub/msdos/programming/lang/}\i\c{x2ftp.oulu.fi}.
4571 An LZH archiver can be found at
4572 \W{ftp://ftp.simtel.net/pub/simtelnet/msdos/arcers}\i\c{ftp.simtel.net}.
4573 There is another `free' linker (though this one doesn't come with
4574 sources) called \i{FREELINK}, available from
4575 \W{http://www.pcorner.com/tpc/old/3-101.html}\i\c{www.pcorner.com}.
4576 A third, \i\c{djlink}, written by DJ Delorie, is available at
4577 \W{http://www.delorie.com/djgpp/16bit/djlink/}\i\c{www.delorie.com}.
4578 A fourth linker, \i\c{ALINK}, written by Anthony A.J. Williams, is
4579 available at \W{http://alink.sourceforge.net}\i\c{alink.sourceforge.net}.
4581 When linking several \c{.OBJ} files into a \c{.EXE} file, you should
4582 ensure that exactly one of them has a start point defined (using the
4583 \I{program entry point}\i\c{..start} special symbol defined by the
4584 \c{obj} format: see \k{dotdotstart}). If no module defines a start
4585 point, the linker will not know what value to give the entry-point
4586 field in the output file header; if more than one defines a start
4587 point, the linker will not know \e{which} value to use.
4589 An example of a NASM source file which can be assembled to a
4590 \c{.OBJ} file and linked on its own to a \c{.EXE} is given here. It
4591 demonstrates the basic principles of defining a stack, initialising
4592 the segment registers, and declaring a start point. This file is
4593 also provided in the \I{test subdirectory}\c{test} subdirectory of
4594 the NASM archives, under the name \c{objexe.asm}.
4605 This initial piece of code sets up \c{DS} to point to the data
4606 segment, and initialises \c{SS} and \c{SP} to point to the top of
4607 the provided stack. Notice that interrupts are implicitly disabled
4608 for one instruction after a move into \c{SS}, precisely for this
4609 situation, so that there's no chance of an interrupt occurring
4610 between the loads of \c{SS} and \c{SP} and not having a stack to
4613 Note also that the special symbol \c{..start} is defined at the
4614 beginning of this code, which means that will be the entry point
4615 into the resulting executable file.
4621 The above is the main program: load \c{DS:DX} with a pointer to the
4622 greeting message (\c{hello} is implicitly relative to the segment
4623 \c{data}, which was loaded into \c{DS} in the setup code, so the
4624 full pointer is valid), and call the DOS print-string function.
4629 This terminates the program using another DOS system call.
4633 \c hello: db 'hello, world', 13, 10, '$'
4635 The data segment contains the string we want to display.
4637 \c segment stack stack
4641 The above code declares a stack segment containing 64 bytes of
4642 uninitialised stack space, and points \c{stacktop} at the top of it.
4643 The directive \c{segment stack stack} defines a segment \e{called}
4644 \c{stack}, and also of \e{type} \c{STACK}. The latter is not
4645 necessary to the correct running of the program, but linkers are
4646 likely to issue warnings or errors if your program has no segment of
4649 The above file, when assembled into a \c{.OBJ} file, will link on
4650 its own to a valid \c{.EXE} file, which when run will print `hello,
4651 world' and then exit.
4654 \S{binexe} Using the \c{bin} Format To Generate \c{.EXE} Files
4656 The \c{.EXE} file format is simple enough that it's possible to
4657 build a \c{.EXE} file by writing a pure-binary program and sticking
4658 a 32-byte header on the front. This header is simple enough that it
4659 can be generated using \c{DB} and \c{DW} commands by NASM itself, so
4660 that you can use the \c{bin} output format to directly generate
4663 Included in the NASM archives, in the \I{misc subdirectory}\c{misc}
4664 subdirectory, is a file \i\c{exebin.mac} of macros. It defines three
4665 macros: \i\c{EXE_begin}, \i\c{EXE_stack} and \i\c{EXE_end}.
4667 To produce a \c{.EXE} file using this method, you should start by
4668 using \c{%include} to load the \c{exebin.mac} macro package into
4669 your source file. You should then issue the \c{EXE_begin} macro call
4670 (which takes no arguments) to generate the file header data. Then
4671 write code as normal for the \c{bin} format - you can use all three
4672 standard sections \c{.text}, \c{.data} and \c{.bss}. At the end of
4673 the file you should call the \c{EXE_end} macro (again, no arguments),
4674 which defines some symbols to mark section sizes, and these symbols
4675 are referred to in the header code generated by \c{EXE_begin}.
4677 In this model, the code you end up writing starts at \c{0x100}, just
4678 like a \c{.COM} file - in fact, if you strip off the 32-byte header
4679 from the resulting \c{.EXE} file, you will have a valid \c{.COM}
4680 program. All the segment bases are the same, so you are limited to a
4681 64K program, again just like a \c{.COM} file. Note that an \c{ORG}
4682 directive is issued by the \c{EXE_begin} macro, so you should not
4683 explicitly issue one of your own.
4685 You can't directly refer to your segment base value, unfortunately,
4686 since this would require a relocation in the header, and things
4687 would get a lot more complicated. So you should get your segment
4688 base by copying it out of \c{CS} instead.
4690 On entry to your \c{.EXE} file, \c{SS:SP} are already set up to
4691 point to the top of a 2Kb stack. You can adjust the default stack
4692 size of 2Kb by calling the \c{EXE_stack} macro. For example, to
4693 change the stack size of your program to 64 bytes, you would call
4696 A sample program which generates a \c{.EXE} file in this way is
4697 given in the \c{test} subdirectory of the NASM archive, as
4701 \H{comfiles} Producing \i\c{.COM} Files
4703 While large DOS programs must be written as \c{.EXE} files, small
4704 ones are often better written as \c{.COM} files. \c{.COM} files are
4705 pure binary, and therefore most easily produced using the \c{bin}
4709 \S{combinfmt} Using the \c{bin} Format To Generate \c{.COM} Files
4711 \c{.COM} files expect to be loaded at offset \c{100h} into their
4712 segment (though the segment may change). Execution then begins at
4713 \I\c{ORG}\c{100h}, i.e. right at the start of the program. So to
4714 write a \c{.COM} program, you would create a source file looking
4722 \c ; put your code here
4726 \c ; put data items here
4730 \c ; put uninitialised data here
4732 The \c{bin} format puts the \c{.text} section first in the file, so
4733 you can declare data or BSS items before beginning to write code if
4734 you want to and the code will still end up at the front of the file
4737 The BSS (uninitialised data) section does not take up space in the
4738 \c{.COM} file itself: instead, addresses of BSS items are resolved
4739 to point at space beyond the end of the file, on the grounds that
4740 this will be free memory when the program is run. Therefore you
4741 should not rely on your BSS being initialised to all zeros when you
4744 To assemble the above program, you should use a command line like
4746 \c nasm myprog.asm -fbin -o myprog.com
4748 The \c{bin} format would produce a file called \c{myprog} if no
4749 explicit output file name were specified, so you have to override it
4750 and give the desired file name.
4753 \S{comobjfmt} Using the \c{obj} Format To Generate \c{.COM} Files
4755 If you are writing a \c{.COM} program as more than one module, you
4756 may wish to assemble several \c{.OBJ} files and link them together
4757 into a \c{.COM} program. You can do this, provided you have a linker
4758 capable of outputting \c{.COM} files directly (\i{TLINK} does this),
4759 or alternatively a converter program such as \i\c{EXE2BIN} to
4760 transform the \c{.EXE} file output from the linker into a \c{.COM}
4763 If you do this, you need to take care of several things:
4765 \b The first object file containing code should start its code
4766 segment with a line like \c{RESB 100h}. This is to ensure that the
4767 code begins at offset \c{100h} relative to the beginning of the code
4768 segment, so that the linker or converter program does not have to
4769 adjust address references within the file when generating the
4770 \c{.COM} file. Other assemblers use an \i\c{ORG} directive for this
4771 purpose, but \c{ORG} in NASM is a format-specific directive to the
4772 \c{bin} output format, and does not mean the same thing as it does
4773 in MASM-compatible assemblers.
4775 \b You don't need to define a stack segment.
4777 \b All your segments should be in the same group, so that every time
4778 your code or data references a symbol offset, all offsets are
4779 relative to the same segment base. This is because, when a \c{.COM}
4780 file is loaded, all the segment registers contain the same value.
4783 \H{sysfiles} Producing \i\c{.SYS} Files
4785 \i{MS-DOS device drivers} - \c{.SYS} files - are pure binary files,
4786 similar to \c{.COM} files, except that they start at origin zero
4787 rather than \c{100h}. Therefore, if you are writing a device driver
4788 using the \c{bin} format, you do not need the \c{ORG} directive,
4789 since the default origin for \c{bin} is zero. Similarly, if you are
4790 using \c{obj}, you do not need the \c{RESB 100h} at the start of
4793 \c{.SYS} files start with a header structure, containing pointers to
4794 the various routines inside the driver which do the work. This
4795 structure should be defined at the start of the code segment, even
4796 though it is not actually code.
4798 For more information on the format of \c{.SYS} files, and the data
4799 which has to go in the header structure, a list of books is given in
4800 the Frequently Asked Questions list for the newsgroup
4801 \W{news:comp.os.msdos.programmer}\i\c{comp.os.msdos.programmer}.
4804 \H{16c} Interfacing to 16-bit C Programs
4806 This section covers the basics of writing assembly routines that
4807 call, or are called from, C programs. To do this, you would
4808 typically write an assembly module as a \c{.OBJ} file, and link it
4809 with your C modules to produce a \i{mixed-language program}.
4812 \S{16cunder} External Symbol Names
4814 \I{C symbol names}\I{underscore, in C symbols}C compilers have the
4815 convention that the names of all global symbols (functions or data)
4816 they define are formed by prefixing an underscore to the name as it
4817 appears in the C program. So, for example, the function a C
4818 programmer thinks of as \c{printf} appears to an assembly language
4819 programmer as \c{_printf}. This means that in your assembly
4820 programs, you can define symbols without a leading underscore, and
4821 not have to worry about name clashes with C symbols.
4823 If you find the underscores inconvenient, you can define macros to
4824 replace the \c{GLOBAL} and \c{EXTERN} directives as follows:
4840 (These forms of the macros only take one argument at a time; a
4841 \c{%rep} construct could solve this.)
4843 If you then declare an external like this:
4847 then the macro will expand it as
4850 \c %define printf _printf
4852 Thereafter, you can reference \c{printf} as if it was a symbol, and
4853 the preprocessor will put the leading underscore on where necessary.
4855 The \c{cglobal} macro works similarly. You must use \c{cglobal}
4856 before defining the symbol in question, but you would have had to do
4857 that anyway if you used \c{GLOBAL}.
4860 \S{16cmodels} \i{Memory Models}
4862 NASM contains no mechanism to support the various C memory models
4863 directly; you have to keep track yourself of which one you are
4864 writing for. This means you have to keep track of the following
4867 \b In models using a single code segment (tiny, small and compact),
4868 functions are near. This means that function pointers, when stored
4869 in data segments or pushed on the stack as function arguments, are
4870 16 bits long and contain only an offset field (the \c{CS} register
4871 never changes its value, and always gives the segment part of the
4872 full function address), and that functions are called using ordinary
4873 near \c{CALL} instructions and return using \c{RETN} (which, in
4874 NASM, is synonymous with \c{RET} anyway). This means both that you
4875 should write your own routines to return with \c{RETN}, and that you
4876 should call external C routines with near \c{CALL} instructions.
4878 \b In models using more than one code segment (medium, large and
4879 huge), functions are far. This means that function pointers are 32
4880 bits long (consisting of a 16-bit offset followed by a 16-bit
4881 segment), and that functions are called using \c{CALL FAR} (or
4882 \c{CALL seg:offset}) and return using \c{RETF}. Again, you should
4883 therefore write your own routines to return with \c{RETF} and use
4884 \c{CALL FAR} to call external routines.
4886 \b In models using a single data segment (tiny, small and medium),
4887 data pointers are 16 bits long, containing only an offset field (the
4888 \c{DS} register doesn't change its value, and always gives the
4889 segment part of the full data item address).
4891 \b In models using more than one data segment (compact, large and
4892 huge), data pointers are 32 bits long, consisting of a 16-bit offset
4893 followed by a 16-bit segment. You should still be careful not to
4894 modify \c{DS} in your routines without restoring it afterwards, but
4895 \c{ES} is free for you to use to access the contents of 32-bit data
4896 pointers you are passed.
4898 \b The huge memory model allows single data items to exceed 64K in
4899 size. In all other memory models, you can access the whole of a data
4900 item just by doing arithmetic on the offset field of the pointer you
4901 are given, whether a segment field is present or not; in huge model,
4902 you have to be more careful of your pointer arithmetic.
4904 \b In most memory models, there is a \e{default} data segment, whose
4905 segment address is kept in \c{DS} throughout the program. This data
4906 segment is typically the same segment as the stack, kept in \c{SS},
4907 so that functions' local variables (which are stored on the stack)
4908 and global data items can both be accessed easily without changing
4909 \c{DS}. Particularly large data items are typically stored in other
4910 segments. However, some memory models (though not the standard
4911 ones, usually) allow the assumption that \c{SS} and \c{DS} hold the
4912 same value to be removed. Be careful about functions' local
4913 variables in this latter case.
4915 In models with a single code segment, the segment is called
4916 \i\c{_TEXT}, so your code segment must also go by this name in order
4917 to be linked into the same place as the main code segment. In models
4918 with a single data segment, or with a default data segment, it is
4922 \S{16cfunc} Function Definitions and Function Calls
4924 \I{functions, C calling convention}The \i{C calling convention} in
4925 16-bit programs is as follows. In the following description, the
4926 words \e{caller} and \e{callee} are used to denote the function
4927 doing the calling and the function which gets called.
4929 \b The caller pushes the function's parameters on the stack, one
4930 after another, in reverse order (right to left, so that the first
4931 argument specified to the function is pushed last).
4933 \b The caller then executes a \c{CALL} instruction to pass control
4934 to the callee. This \c{CALL} is either near or far depending on the
4937 \b The callee receives control, and typically (although this is not
4938 actually necessary, in functions which do not need to access their
4939 parameters) starts by saving the value of \c{SP} in \c{BP} so as to
4940 be able to use \c{BP} as a base pointer to find its parameters on
4941 the stack. However, the caller was probably doing this too, so part
4942 of the calling convention states that \c{BP} must be preserved by
4943 any C function. Hence the callee, if it is going to set up \c{BP} as
4944 a \i\e{frame pointer}, must push the previous value first.
4946 \b The callee may then access its parameters relative to \c{BP}.
4947 The word at \c{[BP]} holds the previous value of \c{BP} as it was
4948 pushed; the next word, at \c{[BP+2]}, holds the offset part of the
4949 return address, pushed implicitly by \c{CALL}. In a small-model
4950 (near) function, the parameters start after that, at \c{[BP+4]}; in
4951 a large-model (far) function, the segment part of the return address
4952 lives at \c{[BP+4]}, and the parameters begin at \c{[BP+6]}. The
4953 leftmost parameter of the function, since it was pushed last, is
4954 accessible at this offset from \c{BP}; the others follow, at
4955 successively greater offsets. Thus, in a function such as \c{printf}
4956 which takes a variable number of parameters, the pushing of the
4957 parameters in reverse order means that the function knows where to
4958 find its first parameter, which tells it the number and type of the
4961 \b The callee may also wish to decrease \c{SP} further, so as to
4962 allocate space on the stack for local variables, which will then be
4963 accessible at negative offsets from \c{BP}.
4965 \b The callee, if it wishes to return a value to the caller, should
4966 leave the value in \c{AL}, \c{AX} or \c{DX:AX} depending on the size
4967 of the value. Floating-point results are sometimes (depending on the
4968 compiler) returned in \c{ST0}.
4970 \b Once the callee has finished processing, it restores \c{SP} from
4971 \c{BP} if it had allocated local stack space, then pops the previous
4972 value of \c{BP}, and returns via \c{RETN} or \c{RETF} depending on
4975 \b When the caller regains control from the callee, the function
4976 parameters are still on the stack, so it typically adds an immediate
4977 constant to \c{SP} to remove them (instead of executing a number of
4978 slow \c{POP} instructions). Thus, if a function is accidentally
4979 called with the wrong number of parameters due to a prototype
4980 mismatch, the stack will still be returned to a sensible state since
4981 the caller, which \e{knows} how many parameters it pushed, does the
4984 It is instructive to compare this calling convention with that for
4985 Pascal programs (described in \k{16bpfunc}). Pascal has a simpler
4986 convention, since no functions have variable numbers of parameters.
4987 Therefore the callee knows how many parameters it should have been
4988 passed, and is able to deallocate them from the stack itself by
4989 passing an immediate argument to the \c{RET} or \c{RETF}
4990 instruction, so the caller does not have to do it. Also, the
4991 parameters are pushed in left-to-right order, not right-to-left,
4992 which means that a compiler can give better guarantees about
4993 sequence points without performance suffering.
4995 Thus, you would define a function in C style in the following way.
4996 The following example is for small model:
5003 \c sub sp,0x40 ; 64 bytes of local stack space
5004 \c mov bx,[bp+4] ; first parameter to function
5008 \c mov sp,bp ; undo "sub sp,0x40" above
5012 For a large-model function, you would replace \c{RET} by \c{RETF},
5013 and look for the first parameter at \c{[BP+6]} instead of
5014 \c{[BP+4]}. Of course, if one of the parameters is a pointer, then
5015 the offsets of \e{subsequent} parameters will change depending on
5016 the memory model as well: far pointers take up four bytes on the
5017 stack when passed as a parameter, whereas near pointers take up two.
5019 At the other end of the process, to call a C function from your
5020 assembly code, you would do something like this:
5024 \c ; and then, further down...
5026 \c push word [myint] ; one of my integer variables
5027 \c push word mystring ; pointer into my data segment
5029 \c add sp,byte 4 ; `byte' saves space
5031 \c ; then those data items...
5036 \c mystring db 'This number -> %d <- should be 1234',10,0
5038 This piece of code is the small-model assembly equivalent of the C
5041 \c int myint = 1234;
5042 \c printf("This number -> %d <- should be 1234\n", myint);
5044 In large model, the function-call code might look more like this. In
5045 this example, it is assumed that \c{DS} already holds the segment
5046 base of the segment \c{_DATA}. If not, you would have to initialise
5049 \c push word [myint]
5050 \c push word seg mystring ; Now push the segment, and...
5051 \c push word mystring ; ... offset of "mystring"
5055 The integer value still takes up one word on the stack, since large
5056 model does not affect the size of the \c{int} data type. The first
5057 argument (pushed last) to \c{printf}, however, is a data pointer,
5058 and therefore has to contain a segment and offset part. The segment
5059 should be stored second in memory, and therefore must be pushed
5060 first. (Of course, \c{PUSH DS} would have been a shorter instruction
5061 than \c{PUSH WORD SEG mystring}, if \c{DS} was set up as the above
5062 example assumed.) Then the actual call becomes a far call, since
5063 functions expect far calls in large model; and \c{SP} has to be
5064 increased by 6 rather than 4 afterwards to make up for the extra
5068 \S{16cdata} Accessing Data Items
5070 To get at the contents of C variables, or to declare variables which
5071 C can access, you need only declare the names as \c{GLOBAL} or
5072 \c{EXTERN}. (Again, the names require leading underscores, as stated
5073 in \k{16cunder}.) Thus, a C variable declared as \c{int i} can be
5074 accessed from assembler as
5080 And to declare your own integer variable which C programs can access
5081 as \c{extern int j}, you do this (making sure you are assembling in
5082 the \c{_DATA} segment, if necessary):
5088 To access a C array, you need to know the size of the components of
5089 the array. For example, \c{int} variables are two bytes long, so if
5090 a C program declares an array as \c{int a[10]}, you can access
5091 \c{a[3]} by coding \c{mov ax,[_a+6]}. (The byte offset 6 is obtained
5092 by multiplying the desired array index, 3, by the size of the array
5093 element, 2.) The sizes of the C base types in 16-bit compilers are:
5094 1 for \c{char}, 2 for \c{short} and \c{int}, 4 for \c{long} and
5095 \c{float}, and 8 for \c{double}.
5097 To access a C \i{data structure}, you need to know the offset from
5098 the base of the structure to the field you are interested in. You
5099 can either do this by converting the C structure definition into a
5100 NASM structure definition (using \i\c{STRUC}), or by calculating the
5101 one offset and using just that.
5103 To do either of these, you should read your C compiler's manual to
5104 find out how it organises data structures. NASM gives no special
5105 alignment to structure members in its own \c{STRUC} macro, so you
5106 have to specify alignment yourself if the C compiler generates it.
5107 Typically, you might find that a structure like
5114 might be four bytes long rather than three, since the \c{int} field
5115 would be aligned to a two-byte boundary. However, this sort of
5116 feature tends to be a configurable option in the C compiler, either
5117 using command-line options or \c{#pragma} lines, so you have to find
5118 out how your own compiler does it.
5121 \S{16cmacro} \i\c{c16.mac}: Helper Macros for the 16-bit C Interface
5123 Included in the NASM archives, in the \I{misc subdirectory}\c{misc}
5124 directory, is a file \c{c16.mac} of macros. It defines three macros:
5125 \i\c{proc}, \i\c{arg} and \i\c{endproc}. These are intended to be
5126 used for C-style procedure definitions, and they automate a lot of
5127 the work involved in keeping track of the calling convention.
5129 (An alternative, TASM compatible form of \c{arg} is also now built
5130 into NASM's preprocessor. See \k{tasmcompat} for details.)
5132 An example of an assembly function using the macro set is given
5139 \c mov ax,[bp + %$i]
5140 \c mov bx,[bp + %$j]
5145 This defines \c{_nearproc} to be a procedure taking two arguments,
5146 the first (\c{i}) an integer and the second (\c{j}) a pointer to an
5147 integer. It returns \c{i + *j}.
5149 Note that the \c{arg} macro has an \c{EQU} as the first line of its
5150 expansion, and since the label before the macro call gets prepended
5151 to the first line of the expanded macro, the \c{EQU} works, defining
5152 \c{%$i} to be an offset from \c{BP}. A context-local variable is
5153 used, local to the context pushed by the \c{proc} macro and popped
5154 by the \c{endproc} macro, so that the same argument name can be used
5155 in later procedures. Of course, you don't \e{have} to do that.
5157 The macro set produces code for near functions (tiny, small and
5158 compact-model code) by default. You can have it generate far
5159 functions (medium, large and huge-model code) by means of coding
5160 \I\c{FARCODE}\c{%define FARCODE}. This changes the kind of return
5161 instruction generated by \c{endproc}, and also changes the starting
5162 point for the argument offsets. The macro set contains no intrinsic
5163 dependency on whether data pointers are far or not.
5165 \c{arg} can take an optional parameter, giving the size of the
5166 argument. If no size is given, 2 is assumed, since it is likely that
5167 many function parameters will be of type \c{int}.
5169 The large-model equivalent of the above function would look like this:
5177 \c mov ax,[bp + %$i]
5178 \c mov bx,[bp + %$j]
5179 \c mov es,[bp + %$j + 2]
5184 This makes use of the argument to the \c{arg} macro to define a
5185 parameter of size 4, because \c{j} is now a far pointer. When we
5186 load from \c{j}, we must load a segment and an offset.
5189 \H{16bp} Interfacing to \i{Borland Pascal} Programs
5191 Interfacing to Borland Pascal programs is similar in concept to
5192 interfacing to 16-bit C programs. The differences are:
5194 \b The leading underscore required for interfacing to C programs is
5195 not required for Pascal.
5197 \b The memory model is always large: functions are far, data
5198 pointers are far, and no data item can be more than 64K long.
5199 (Actually, some functions are near, but only those functions that
5200 are local to a Pascal unit and never called from outside it. All
5201 assembly functions that Pascal calls, and all Pascal functions that
5202 assembly routines are able to call, are far.) However, all static
5203 data declared in a Pascal program goes into the default data
5204 segment, which is the one whose segment address will be in \c{DS}
5205 when control is passed to your assembly code. The only things that
5206 do not live in the default data segment are local variables (they
5207 live in the stack segment) and dynamically allocated variables. All
5208 data \e{pointers}, however, are far.
5210 \b The function calling convention is different - described below.
5212 \b Some data types, such as strings, are stored differently.
5214 \b There are restrictions on the segment names you are allowed to
5215 use - Borland Pascal will ignore code or data declared in a segment
5216 it doesn't like the name of. The restrictions are described below.
5219 \S{16bpfunc} The Pascal Calling Convention
5221 \I{functions, Pascal calling convention}\I{Pascal calling
5222 convention}The 16-bit Pascal calling convention is as follows. In
5223 the following description, the words \e{caller} and \e{callee} are
5224 used to denote the function doing the calling and the function which
5227 \b The caller pushes the function's parameters on the stack, one
5228 after another, in normal order (left to right, so that the first
5229 argument specified to the function is pushed first).
5231 \b The caller then executes a far \c{CALL} instruction to pass
5232 control to the callee.
5234 \b The callee receives control, and typically (although this is not
5235 actually necessary, in functions which do not need to access their
5236 parameters) starts by saving the value of \c{SP} in \c{BP} so as to
5237 be able to use \c{BP} as a base pointer to find its parameters on
5238 the stack. However, the caller was probably doing this too, so part
5239 of the calling convention states that \c{BP} must be preserved by
5240 any function. Hence the callee, if it is going to set up \c{BP} as a
5241 \i{frame pointer}, must push the previous value first.
5243 \b The callee may then access its parameters relative to \c{BP}.
5244 The word at \c{[BP]} holds the previous value of \c{BP} as it was
5245 pushed. The next word, at \c{[BP+2]}, holds the offset part of the
5246 return address, and the next one at \c{[BP+4]} the segment part. The
5247 parameters begin at \c{[BP+6]}. The rightmost parameter of the
5248 function, since it was pushed last, is accessible at this offset
5249 from \c{BP}; the others follow, at successively greater offsets.
5251 \b The callee may also wish to decrease \c{SP} further, so as to
5252 allocate space on the stack for local variables, which will then be
5253 accessible at negative offsets from \c{BP}.
5255 \b The callee, if it wishes to return a value to the caller, should
5256 leave the value in \c{AL}, \c{AX} or \c{DX:AX} depending on the size
5257 of the value. Floating-point results are returned in \c{ST0}.
5258 Results of type \c{Real} (Borland's own custom floating-point data
5259 type, not handled directly by the FPU) are returned in \c{DX:BX:AX}.
5260 To return a result of type \c{String}, the caller pushes a pointer
5261 to a temporary string before pushing the parameters, and the callee
5262 places the returned string value at that location. The pointer is
5263 not a parameter, and should not be removed from the stack by the
5264 \c{RETF} instruction.
5266 \b Once the callee has finished processing, it restores \c{SP} from
5267 \c{BP} if it had allocated local stack space, then pops the previous
5268 value of \c{BP}, and returns via \c{RETF}. It uses the form of
5269 \c{RETF} with an immediate parameter, giving the number of bytes
5270 taken up by the parameters on the stack. This causes the parameters
5271 to be removed from the stack as a side effect of the return
5274 \b When the caller regains control from the callee, the function
5275 parameters have already been removed from the stack, so it needs to
5278 Thus, you would define a function in Pascal style, taking two
5279 \c{Integer}-type parameters, in the following way:
5285 \c sub sp,0x40 ; 64 bytes of local stack space
5286 \c mov bx,[bp+8] ; first parameter to function
5287 \c mov bx,[bp+6] ; second parameter to function
5291 \c mov sp,bp ; undo "sub sp,0x40" above
5293 \c retf 4 ; total size of params is 4
5295 At the other end of the process, to call a Pascal function from your
5296 assembly code, you would do something like this:
5300 \c ; and then, further down...
5302 \c push word seg mystring ; Now push the segment, and...
5303 \c push word mystring ; ... offset of "mystring"
5304 \c push word [myint] ; one of my variables
5305 \c call far SomeFunc
5307 This is equivalent to the Pascal code
5309 \c procedure SomeFunc(String: PChar; Int: Integer);
5310 \c SomeFunc(@mystring, myint);
5313 \S{16bpseg} Borland Pascal \I{segment names, Borland Pascal}Segment
5316 Since Borland Pascal's internal unit file format is completely
5317 different from \c{OBJ}, it only makes a very sketchy job of actually
5318 reading and understanding the various information contained in a
5319 real \c{OBJ} file when it links that in. Therefore an object file
5320 intended to be linked to a Pascal program must obey a number of
5323 \b Procedures and functions must be in a segment whose name is
5324 either \c{CODE}, \c{CSEG}, or something ending in \c{_TEXT}.
5326 \b Initialised data must be in a segment whose name is either
5327 \c{CONST} or something ending in \c{_DATA}.
5329 \b Uninitialised data must be in a segment whose name is either
5330 \c{DATA}, \c{DSEG}, or something ending in \c{_BSS}.
5332 \b Any other segments in the object file are completely ignored.
5333 \c{GROUP} directives and segment attributes are also ignored.
5336 \S{16bpmacro} Using \i\c{c16.mac} With Pascal Programs
5338 The \c{c16.mac} macro package, described in \k{16cmacro}, can also
5339 be used to simplify writing functions to be called from Pascal
5340 programs, if you code \I\c{PASCAL}\c{%define PASCAL}. This
5341 definition ensures that functions are far (it implies
5342 \i\c{FARCODE}), and also causes procedure return instructions to be
5343 generated with an operand.
5345 Defining \c{PASCAL} does not change the code which calculates the
5346 argument offsets; you must declare your function's arguments in
5347 reverse order. For example:
5355 \c mov ax,[bp + %$i]
5356 \c mov bx,[bp + %$j]
5357 \c mov es,[bp + %$j + 2]
5362 This defines the same routine, conceptually, as the example in
5363 \k{16cmacro}: it defines a function taking two arguments, an integer
5364 and a pointer to an integer, which returns the sum of the integer
5365 and the contents of the pointer. The only difference between this
5366 code and the large-model C version is that \c{PASCAL} is defined
5367 instead of \c{FARCODE}, and that the arguments are declared in
5371 \C{32bit} Writing 32-bit Code (Unix, Win32, DJGPP)
5373 This chapter attempts to cover some of the common issues involved
5374 when writing 32-bit code, to run under \i{Win32} or Unix, or to be
5375 linked with C code generated by a Unix-style C compiler such as
5376 \i{DJGPP}. It covers how to write assembly code to interface with
5377 32-bit C routines, and how to write position-independent code for
5380 Almost all 32-bit code, and in particular all code running under
5381 \c{Win32}, \c{DJGPP} or any of the PC Unix variants, runs in \I{flat
5382 memory model}\e{flat} memory model. This means that the segment registers
5383 and paging have already been set up to give you the same 32-bit 4Gb
5384 address space no matter what segment you work relative to, and that
5385 you should ignore all segment registers completely. When writing
5386 flat-model application code, you never need to use a segment
5387 override or modify any segment register, and the code-section
5388 addresses you pass to \c{CALL} and \c{JMP} live in the same address
5389 space as the data-section addresses you access your variables by and
5390 the stack-section addresses you access local variables and procedure
5391 parameters by. Every address is 32 bits long and contains only an
5395 \H{32c} Interfacing to 32-bit C Programs
5397 A lot of the discussion in \k{16c}, about interfacing to 16-bit C
5398 programs, still applies when working in 32 bits. The absence of
5399 memory models or segmentation worries simplifies things a lot.
5402 \S{32cunder} External Symbol Names
5404 Most 32-bit C compilers share the convention used by 16-bit
5405 compilers, that the names of all global symbols (functions or data)
5406 they define are formed by prefixing an underscore to the name as it
5407 appears in the C program. However, not all of them do: the \c{ELF}
5408 specification states that C symbols do \e{not} have a leading
5409 underscore on their assembly-language names.
5411 The older Linux \c{a.out} C compiler, all \c{Win32} compilers,
5412 \c{DJGPP}, and \c{NetBSD} and \c{FreeBSD}, all use the leading
5413 underscore; for these compilers, the macros \c{cextern} and
5414 \c{cglobal}, as given in \k{16cunder}, will still work. For \c{ELF},
5415 though, the leading underscore should not be used.
5418 \S{32cfunc} Function Definitions and Function Calls
5420 \I{functions, C calling convention}The \i{C calling convention}The C
5421 calling convention in 32-bit programs is as follows. In the
5422 following description, the words \e{caller} and \e{callee} are used
5423 to denote the function doing the calling and the function which gets
5426 \b The caller pushes the function's parameters on the stack, one
5427 after another, in reverse order (right to left, so that the first
5428 argument specified to the function is pushed last).
5430 \b The caller then executes a near \c{CALL} instruction to pass
5431 control to the callee.
5433 \b The callee receives control, and typically (although this is not
5434 actually necessary, in functions which do not need to access their
5435 parameters) starts by saving the value of \c{ESP} in \c{EBP} so as
5436 to be able to use \c{EBP} as a base pointer to find its parameters
5437 on the stack. However, the caller was probably doing this too, so
5438 part of the calling convention states that \c{EBP} must be preserved
5439 by any C function. Hence the callee, if it is going to set up
5440 \c{EBP} as a \i{frame pointer}, must push the previous value first.
5442 \b The callee may then access its parameters relative to \c{EBP}.
5443 The doubleword at \c{[EBP]} holds the previous value of \c{EBP} as
5444 it was pushed; the next doubleword, at \c{[EBP+4]}, holds the return
5445 address, pushed implicitly by \c{CALL}. The parameters start after
5446 that, at \c{[EBP+8]}. The leftmost parameter of the function, since
5447 it was pushed last, is accessible at this offset from \c{EBP}; the
5448 others follow, at successively greater offsets. Thus, in a function
5449 such as \c{printf} which takes a variable number of parameters, the
5450 pushing of the parameters in reverse order means that the function
5451 knows where to find its first parameter, which tells it the number
5452 and type of the remaining ones.
5454 \b The callee may also wish to decrease \c{ESP} further, so as to
5455 allocate space on the stack for local variables, which will then be
5456 accessible at negative offsets from \c{EBP}.
5458 \b The callee, if it wishes to return a value to the caller, should
5459 leave the value in \c{AL}, \c{AX} or \c{EAX} depending on the size
5460 of the value. Floating-point results are typically returned in
5463 \b Once the callee has finished processing, it restores \c{ESP} from
5464 \c{EBP} if it had allocated local stack space, then pops the previous
5465 value of \c{EBP}, and returns via \c{RET} (equivalently, \c{RETN}).
5467 \b When the caller regains control from the callee, the function
5468 parameters are still on the stack, so it typically adds an immediate
5469 constant to \c{ESP} to remove them (instead of executing a number of
5470 slow \c{POP} instructions). Thus, if a function is accidentally
5471 called with the wrong number of parameters due to a prototype
5472 mismatch, the stack will still be returned to a sensible state since
5473 the caller, which \e{knows} how many parameters it pushed, does the
5476 There is an alternative calling convention used by Win32 programs
5477 for Windows API calls, and also for functions called \e{by} the
5478 Windows API such as window procedures: they follow what Microsoft
5479 calls the \c{__stdcall} convention. This is slightly closer to the
5480 Pascal convention, in that the callee clears the stack by passing a
5481 parameter to the \c{RET} instruction. However, the parameters are
5482 still pushed in right-to-left order.
5484 Thus, you would define a function in C style in the following way:
5491 \c sub esp,0x40 ; 64 bytes of local stack space
5492 \c mov ebx,[ebp+8] ; first parameter to function
5496 \c leave ; mov esp,ebp / pop ebp
5499 At the other end of the process, to call a C function from your
5500 assembly code, you would do something like this:
5504 \c ; and then, further down...
5506 \c push dword [myint] ; one of my integer variables
5507 \c push dword mystring ; pointer into my data segment
5509 \c add esp,byte 8 ; `byte' saves space
5511 \c ; then those data items...
5516 \c mystring db 'This number -> %d <- should be 1234',10,0
5518 This piece of code is the assembly equivalent of the C code
5520 \c int myint = 1234;
5521 \c printf("This number -> %d <- should be 1234\n", myint);
5524 \S{32cdata} Accessing Data Items
5526 To get at the contents of C variables, or to declare variables which
5527 C can access, you need only declare the names as \c{GLOBAL} or
5528 \c{EXTERN}. (Again, the names require leading underscores, as stated
5529 in \k{32cunder}.) Thus, a C variable declared as \c{int i} can be
5530 accessed from assembler as
5535 And to declare your own integer variable which C programs can access
5536 as \c{extern int j}, you do this (making sure you are assembling in
5537 the \c{_DATA} segment, if necessary):
5542 To access a C array, you need to know the size of the components of
5543 the array. For example, \c{int} variables are four bytes long, so if
5544 a C program declares an array as \c{int a[10]}, you can access
5545 \c{a[3]} by coding \c{mov ax,[_a+12]}. (The byte offset 12 is obtained
5546 by multiplying the desired array index, 3, by the size of the array
5547 element, 4.) The sizes of the C base types in 32-bit compilers are:
5548 1 for \c{char}, 2 for \c{short}, 4 for \c{int}, \c{long} and
5549 \c{float}, and 8 for \c{double}. Pointers, being 32-bit addresses,
5550 are also 4 bytes long.
5552 To access a C \i{data structure}, you need to know the offset from
5553 the base of the structure to the field you are interested in. You
5554 can either do this by converting the C structure definition into a
5555 NASM structure definition (using \c{STRUC}), or by calculating the
5556 one offset and using just that.
5558 To do either of these, you should read your C compiler's manual to
5559 find out how it organises data structures. NASM gives no special
5560 alignment to structure members in its own \i\c{STRUC} macro, so you
5561 have to specify alignment yourself if the C compiler generates it.
5562 Typically, you might find that a structure like
5569 might be eight bytes long rather than five, since the \c{int} field
5570 would be aligned to a four-byte boundary. However, this sort of
5571 feature is sometimes a configurable option in the C compiler, either
5572 using command-line options or \c{#pragma} lines, so you have to find
5573 out how your own compiler does it.
5576 \S{32cmacro} \i\c{c32.mac}: Helper Macros for the 32-bit C Interface
5578 Included in the NASM archives, in the \I{misc directory}\c{misc}
5579 directory, is a file \c{c32.mac} of macros. It defines three macros:
5580 \i\c{proc}, \i\c{arg} and \i\c{endproc}. These are intended to be
5581 used for C-style procedure definitions, and they automate a lot of
5582 the work involved in keeping track of the calling convention.
5584 An example of an assembly function using the macro set is given
5591 \c mov eax,[ebp + %$i]
5592 \c mov ebx,[ebp + %$j]
5597 This defines \c{_proc32} to be a procedure taking two arguments, the
5598 first (\c{i}) an integer and the second (\c{j}) a pointer to an
5599 integer. It returns \c{i + *j}.
5601 Note that the \c{arg} macro has an \c{EQU} as the first line of its
5602 expansion, and since the label before the macro call gets prepended
5603 to the first line of the expanded macro, the \c{EQU} works, defining
5604 \c{%$i} to be an offset from \c{BP}. A context-local variable is
5605 used, local to the context pushed by the \c{proc} macro and popped
5606 by the \c{endproc} macro, so that the same argument name can be used
5607 in later procedures. Of course, you don't \e{have} to do that.
5609 \c{arg} can take an optional parameter, giving the size of the
5610 argument. If no size is given, 4 is assumed, since it is likely that
5611 many function parameters will be of type \c{int} or pointers.
5614 \H{picdll} Writing NetBSD/FreeBSD/OpenBSD and Linux/ELF \i{Shared
5617 \c{ELF} replaced the older \c{a.out} object file format under Linux
5618 because it contains support for \i{position-independent code}
5619 (\i{PIC}), which makes writing shared libraries much easier. NASM
5620 supports the \c{ELF} position-independent code features, so you can
5621 write Linux \c{ELF} shared libraries in NASM.
5623 \i{NetBSD}, and its close cousins \i{FreeBSD} and \i{OpenBSD}, take
5624 a different approach by hacking PIC support into the \c{a.out}
5625 format. NASM supports this as the \i\c{aoutb} output format, so you
5626 can write \i{BSD} shared libraries in NASM too.
5628 The operating system loads a PIC shared library by memory-mapping
5629 the library file at an arbitrarily chosen point in the address space
5630 of the running process. The contents of the library's code section
5631 must therefore not depend on where it is loaded in memory.
5633 Therefore, you cannot get at your variables by writing code like
5636 \c mov eax,[myvar] ; WRONG
5638 Instead, the linker provides an area of memory called the
5639 \i\e{global offset table}, or \i{GOT}; the GOT is situated at a
5640 constant distance from your library's code, so if you can find out
5641 where your library is loaded (which is typically done using a
5642 \c{CALL} and \c{POP} combination), you can obtain the address of the
5643 GOT, and you can then load the addresses of your variables out of
5644 linker-generated entries in the GOT.
5646 The \e{data} section of a PIC shared library does not have these
5647 restrictions: since the data section is writable, it has to be
5648 copied into memory anyway rather than just paged in from the library
5649 file, so as long as it's being copied it can be relocated too. So
5650 you can put ordinary types of relocation in the data section without
5651 too much worry (but see \k{picglobal} for a caveat).
5654 \S{picgot} Obtaining the Address of the GOT
5656 Each code module in your shared library should define the GOT as an
5659 \c extern _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ ; in ELF
5660 \c extern __GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ ; in BSD a.out
5662 At the beginning of any function in your shared library which plans
5663 to access your data or BSS sections, you must first calculate the
5664 address of the GOT. This is typically done by writing the function
5673 \c add ebx,_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_+$$-.get_GOT wrt ..gotpc
5675 \c ; the function body comes here
5682 (For BSD, again, the symbol \c{_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE} requires a
5683 second leading underscore.)
5685 The first two lines of this function are simply the standard C
5686 prologue to set up a stack frame, and the last three lines are
5687 standard C function epilogue. The third line, and the fourth to last
5688 line, save and restore the \c{EBX} register, because PIC shared
5689 libraries use this register to store the address of the GOT.
5691 The interesting bit is the \c{CALL} instruction and the following
5692 two lines. The \c{CALL} and \c{POP} combination obtains the address
5693 of the label \c{.get_GOT}, without having to know in advance where
5694 the program was loaded (since the \c{CALL} instruction is encoded
5695 relative to the current position). The \c{ADD} instruction makes use
5696 of one of the special PIC relocation types: \i{GOTPC relocation}.
5697 With the \i\c{WRT ..gotpc} qualifier specified, the symbol
5698 referenced (here \c{_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_}, the special symbol
5699 assigned to the GOT) is given as an offset from the beginning of the
5700 section. (Actually, \c{ELF} encodes it as the offset from the operand
5701 field of the \c{ADD} instruction, but NASM simplifies this
5702 deliberately, so you do things the same way for both \c{ELF} and
5703 \c{BSD}.) So the instruction then \e{adds} the beginning of the section,
5704 to get the real address of the GOT, and subtracts the value of
5705 \c{.get_GOT} which it knows is in \c{EBX}. Therefore, by the time
5706 that instruction has finished, \c{EBX} contains the address of the GOT.
5708 If you didn't follow that, don't worry: it's never necessary to
5709 obtain the address of the GOT by any other means, so you can put
5710 those three instructions into a macro and safely ignore them:
5717 \c add ebx,_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_+$$-%%getgot wrt ..gotpc
5721 \S{piclocal} Finding Your Local Data Items
5723 Having got the GOT, you can then use it to obtain the addresses of
5724 your data items. Most variables will reside in the sections you have
5725 declared; they can be accessed using the \I{GOTOFF
5726 relocation}\c{..gotoff} special \I\c{WRT ..gotoff}\c{WRT} type. The
5727 way this works is like this:
5729 \c lea eax,[ebx+myvar wrt ..gotoff]
5731 The expression \c{myvar wrt ..gotoff} is calculated, when the shared
5732 library is linked, to be the offset to the local variable \c{myvar}
5733 from the beginning of the GOT. Therefore, adding it to \c{EBX} as
5734 above will place the real address of \c{myvar} in \c{EAX}.
5736 If you declare variables as \c{GLOBAL} without specifying a size for
5737 them, they are shared between code modules in the library, but do
5738 not get exported from the library to the program that loaded it.
5739 They will still be in your ordinary data and BSS sections, so you
5740 can access them in the same way as local variables, using the above
5741 \c{..gotoff} mechanism.
5743 Note that due to a peculiarity of the way BSD \c{a.out} format
5744 handles this relocation type, there must be at least one non-local
5745 symbol in the same section as the address you're trying to access.
5748 \S{picextern} Finding External and Common Data Items
5750 If your library needs to get at an external variable (external to
5751 the \e{library}, not just to one of the modules within it), you must
5752 use the \I{GOT relocations}\I\c{WRT ..got}\c{..got} type to get at
5753 it. The \c{..got} type, instead of giving you the offset from the
5754 GOT base to the variable, gives you the offset from the GOT base to
5755 a GOT \e{entry} containing the address of the variable. The linker
5756 will set up this GOT entry when it builds the library, and the
5757 dynamic linker will place the correct address in it at load time. So
5758 to obtain the address of an external variable \c{extvar} in \c{EAX},
5761 \c mov eax,[ebx+extvar wrt ..got]
5763 This loads the address of \c{extvar} out of an entry in the GOT. The
5764 linker, when it builds the shared library, collects together every
5765 relocation of type \c{..got}, and builds the GOT so as to ensure it
5766 has every necessary entry present.
5768 Common variables must also be accessed in this way.
5771 \S{picglobal} Exporting Symbols to the Library User
5773 If you want to export symbols to the user of the library, you have
5774 to declare whether they are functions or data, and if they are data,
5775 you have to give the size of the data item. This is because the
5776 dynamic linker has to build \I{PLT}\i{procedure linkage table}
5777 entries for any exported functions, and also moves exported data
5778 items away from the library's data section in which they were
5781 So to export a function to users of the library, you must use
5783 \c global func:function ; declare it as a function
5789 And to export a data item such as an array, you would have to code
5791 \c global array:data array.end-array ; give the size too
5796 Be careful: If you export a variable to the library user, by
5797 declaring it as \c{GLOBAL} and supplying a size, the variable will
5798 end up living in the data section of the main program, rather than
5799 in your library's data section, where you declared it. So you will
5800 have to access your own global variable with the \c{..got} mechanism
5801 rather than \c{..gotoff}, as if it were external (which,
5802 effectively, it has become).
5804 Equally, if you need to store the address of an exported global in
5805 one of your data sections, you can't do it by means of the standard
5808 \c dataptr: dd global_data_item ; WRONG
5810 NASM will interpret this code as an ordinary relocation, in which
5811 \c{global_data_item} is merely an offset from the beginning of the
5812 \c{.data} section (or whatever); so this reference will end up
5813 pointing at your data section instead of at the exported global
5814 which resides elsewhere.
5816 Instead of the above code, then, you must write
5818 \c dataptr: dd global_data_item wrt ..sym
5820 which makes use of the special \c{WRT} type \I\c{WRT ..sym}\c{..sym}
5821 to instruct NASM to search the symbol table for a particular symbol
5822 at that address, rather than just relocating by section base.
5824 Either method will work for functions: referring to one of your
5825 functions by means of
5827 \c funcptr: dd my_function
5829 will give the user the address of the code you wrote, whereas
5831 \c funcptr: dd my_function wrt .sym
5833 will give the address of the procedure linkage table for the
5834 function, which is where the calling program will \e{believe} the
5835 function lives. Either address is a valid way to call the function.
5838 \S{picproc} Calling Procedures Outside the Library
5840 Calling procedures outside your shared library has to be done by
5841 means of a \i\e{procedure linkage table}, or \i{PLT}. The PLT is
5842 placed at a known offset from where the library is loaded, so the
5843 library code can make calls to the PLT in a position-independent
5844 way. Within the PLT there is code to jump to offsets contained in
5845 the GOT, so function calls to other shared libraries or to routines
5846 in the main program can be transparently passed off to their real
5849 To call an external routine, you must use another special PIC
5850 relocation type, \I{PLT relocations}\i\c{WRT ..plt}. This is much
5851 easier than the GOT-based ones: you simply replace calls such as
5852 \c{CALL printf} with the PLT-relative version \c{CALL printf WRT
5856 \S{link} Generating the Library File
5858 Having written some code modules and assembled them to \c{.o} files,
5859 you then generate your shared library with a command such as
5861 \c ld -shared -o library.so module1.o module2.o # for ELF
5862 \c ld -Bshareable -o library.so module1.o module2.o # for BSD
5864 For ELF, if your shared library is going to reside in system
5865 directories such as \c{/usr/lib} or \c{/lib}, it is usually worth
5866 using the \i\c{-soname} flag to the linker, to store the final
5867 library file name, with a version number, into the library:
5869 \c ld -shared -soname library.so.1 -o library.so.1.2 *.o
5871 You would then copy \c{library.so.1.2} into the library directory,
5872 and create \c{library.so.1} as a symbolic link to it.
5875 \C{mixsize} Mixing 16 and 32 Bit Code
5877 This chapter tries to cover some of the issues, largely related to
5878 unusual forms of addressing and jump instructions, encountered when
5879 writing operating system code such as protected-mode initialisation
5880 routines, which require code that operates in mixed segment sizes,
5881 such as code in a 16-bit segment trying to modify data in a 32-bit
5882 one, or jumps between different-size segments.
5885 \H{mixjump} Mixed-Size Jumps\I{jumps, mixed-size}
5887 \I{operating system, writing}\I{writing operating systems}The most
5888 common form of \i{mixed-size instruction} is the one used when
5889 writing a 32-bit OS: having done your setup in 16-bit mode, such as
5890 loading the kernel, you then have to boot it by switching into
5891 protected mode and jumping to the 32-bit kernel start address. In a
5892 fully 32-bit OS, this tends to be the \e{only} mixed-size
5893 instruction you need, since everything before it can be done in pure
5894 16-bit code, and everything after it can be pure 32-bit.
5896 This jump must specify a 48-bit far address, since the target
5897 segment is a 32-bit one. However, it must be assembled in a 16-bit
5898 segment, so just coding, for example,
5900 \c jmp 0x1234:0x56789ABC ; wrong!
5902 will not work, since the offset part of the address will be
5903 truncated to \c{0x9ABC} and the jump will be an ordinary 16-bit far
5906 The Linux kernel setup code gets round the inability of \c{as86} to
5907 generate the required instruction by coding it manually, using
5908 \c{DB} instructions. NASM can go one better than that, by actually
5909 generating the right instruction itself. Here's how to do it right:
5911 \c jmp dword 0x1234:0x56789ABC ; right
5913 \I\c{JMP DWORD}The \c{DWORD} prefix (strictly speaking, it should
5914 come \e{after} the colon, since it is declaring the \e{offset} field
5915 to be a doubleword; but NASM will accept either form, since both are
5916 unambiguous) forces the offset part to be treated as far, in the
5917 assumption that you are deliberately writing a jump from a 16-bit
5918 segment to a 32-bit one.
5920 You can do the reverse operation, jumping from a 32-bit segment to a
5921 16-bit one, by means of the \c{WORD} prefix:
5923 \c jmp word 0x8765:0x4321 ; 32 to 16 bit
5925 If the \c{WORD} prefix is specified in 16-bit mode, or the \c{DWORD}
5926 prefix in 32-bit mode, they will be ignored, since each is
5927 explicitly forcing NASM into a mode it was in anyway.
5930 \H{mixaddr} Addressing Between Different-Size Segments\I{addressing,
5931 mixed-size}\I{mixed-size addressing}
5933 If your OS is mixed 16 and 32-bit, or if you are writing a DOS
5934 extender, you are likely to have to deal with some 16-bit segments
5935 and some 32-bit ones. At some point, you will probably end up
5936 writing code in a 16-bit segment which has to access data in a
5937 32-bit segment, or vice versa.
5939 If the data you are trying to access in a 32-bit segment lies within
5940 the first 64K of the segment, you may be able to get away with using
5941 an ordinary 16-bit addressing operation for the purpose; but sooner
5942 or later, you will want to do 32-bit addressing from 16-bit mode.
5944 The easiest way to do this is to make sure you use a register for
5945 the address, since any effective address containing a 32-bit
5946 register is forced to be a 32-bit address. So you can do
5948 \c mov eax,offset_into_32_bit_segment_specified_by_fs
5949 \c mov dword [fs:eax],0x11223344
5951 This is fine, but slightly cumbersome (since it wastes an
5952 instruction and a register) if you already know the precise offset
5953 you are aiming at. The x86 architecture does allow 32-bit effective
5954 addresses to specify nothing but a 4-byte offset, so why shouldn't
5955 NASM be able to generate the best instruction for the purpose?
5957 It can. As in \k{mixjump}, you need only prefix the address with the
5958 \c{DWORD} keyword, and it will be forced to be a 32-bit address:
5960 \c mov dword [fs:dword my_offset],0x11223344
5962 Also as in \k{mixjump}, NASM is not fussy about whether the
5963 \c{DWORD} prefix comes before or after the segment override, so
5964 arguably a nicer-looking way to code the above instruction is
5966 \c mov dword [dword fs:my_offset],0x11223344
5968 Don't confuse the \c{DWORD} prefix \e{outside} the square brackets,
5969 which controls the size of the data stored at the address, with the
5970 one \c{inside} the square brackets which controls the length of the
5971 address itself. The two can quite easily be different:
5973 \c mov word [dword 0x12345678],0x9ABC
5975 This moves 16 bits of data to an address specified by a 32-bit
5978 You can also specify \c{WORD} or \c{DWORD} prefixes along with the
5979 \c{FAR} prefix to indirect far jumps or calls. For example:
5981 \c call dword far [fs:word 0x4321]
5983 This instruction contains an address specified by a 16-bit offset;
5984 it loads a 48-bit far pointer from that (16-bit segment and 32-bit
5985 offset), and calls that address.
5988 \H{mixother} Other Mixed-Size Instructions
5990 The other way you might want to access data might be using the
5991 string instructions (\c{LODSx}, \c{STOSx} and so on) or the
5992 \c{XLATB} instruction. These instructions, since they take no
5993 parameters, might seem to have no easy way to make them perform
5994 32-bit addressing when assembled in a 16-bit segment.
5996 This is the purpose of NASM's \i\c{a16} and \i\c{a32} prefixes. If
5997 you are coding \c{LODSB} in a 16-bit segment but it is supposed to
5998 be accessing a string in a 32-bit segment, you should load the
5999 desired address into \c{ESI} and then code
6003 The prefix forces the addressing size to 32 bits, meaning that
6004 \c{LODSB} loads from \c{[DS:ESI]} instead of \c{[DS:SI]}. To access
6005 a string in a 16-bit segment when coding in a 32-bit one, the
6006 corresponding \c{a16} prefix can be used.
6008 The \c{a16} and \c{a32} prefixes can be applied to any instruction
6009 in NASM's instruction table, but most of them can generate all the
6010 useful forms without them. The prefixes are necessary only for
6011 instructions with implicit addressing: \c{CMPSx} (\k{insCMPSB}),
6012 \c{SCASx} (\k{insSCASB}), \c{LODSx} (\k{insLODSB}), \c{STOSx}
6013 (\k{insSTOSB}), \c{MOVSx} (\k{insMOVSB}), \c{INSx} (\k{insINSB}),
6014 \c{OUTSx} (\k{insOUTSB}), and \c{XLATB} (\k{insXLATB}). Also, the
6015 various push and pop instructions (\c{PUSHA} and \c{POPF} as well as
6016 the more usual \c{PUSH} and \c{POP}) can accept \c{a16} or \c{a32}
6017 prefixes to force a particular one of \c{SP} or \c{ESP} to be used
6018 as a stack pointer, in case the stack segment in use is a different
6019 size from the code segment.
6021 \c{PUSH} and \c{POP}, when applied to segment registers in 32-bit
6022 mode, also have the slightly odd behaviour that they push and pop 4
6023 bytes at a time, of which the top two are ignored and the bottom two
6024 give the value of the segment register being manipulated. To force
6025 the 16-bit behaviour of segment-register push and pop instructions,
6026 you can use the operand-size prefix \i\c{o16}:
6031 This code saves a doubleword of stack space by fitting two segment
6032 registers into the space which would normally be consumed by pushing
6035 (You can also use the \i\c{o32} prefix to force the 32-bit behaviour
6036 when in 16-bit mode, but this seems less useful.)
6039 \C{trouble} Troubleshooting
6041 This chapter describes some of the common problems that users have
6042 been known to encounter with NASM, and answers them. It also gives
6043 instructions for reporting bugs in NASM if you find a difficulty
6044 that isn't listed here.
6047 \H{problems} Common Problems
6049 \S{inefficient} NASM Generates \i{Inefficient Code}
6051 I get a lot of `bug' reports about NASM generating inefficient, or
6052 even `wrong', code on instructions such as \c{ADD ESP,8}. This is a
6053 deliberate design feature, connected to predictability of output:
6054 NASM, on seeing \c{ADD ESP,8}, will generate the form of the
6055 instruction which leaves room for a 32-bit offset. You need to code
6056 \I\c{BYTE}\c{ADD ESP,BYTE 8} if you want the space-efficient
6057 form of the instruction. This isn't a bug: at worst it's a
6058 misfeature, and that's a matter of opinion only.
6061 \S{jmprange} My Jumps are Out of Range\I{out of range, jumps}
6063 Similarly, people complain that when they issue \i{conditional
6064 jumps} (which are \c{SHORT} by default) that try to jump too far,
6065 NASM reports `short jump out of range' instead of making the jumps
6068 This, again, is partly a predictability issue, but in fact has a
6069 more practical reason as well. NASM has no means of being told what
6070 type of processor the code it is generating will be run on; so it
6071 cannot decide for itself that it should generate \i\c{Jcc NEAR} type
6072 instructions, because it doesn't know that it's working for a 386 or
6073 above. Alternatively, it could replace the out-of-range short
6074 \c{JNE} instruction with a very short \c{JE} instruction that jumps
6075 over a \c{JMP NEAR}; this is a sensible solution for processors
6076 below a 386, but hardly efficient on processors which have good
6077 branch prediction \e{and} could have used \c{JNE NEAR} instead. So,
6078 once again, it's up to the user, not the assembler, to decide what
6079 instructions should be generated.
6082 \S{proborg} \i\c{ORG} Doesn't Work
6084 People writing \i{boot sector} programs in the \c{bin} format often
6085 complain that \c{ORG} doesn't work the way they'd like: in order to
6086 place the \c{0xAA55} signature word at the end of a 512-byte boot
6087 sector, people who are used to MASM tend to code
6091 \c ; some boot sector code
6096 This is not the intended use of the \c{ORG} directive in NASM, and
6097 will not work. The correct way to solve this problem in NASM is to
6098 use the \i\c{TIMES} directive, like this:
6102 \c ; some boot sector code
6104 \c TIMES 510-($-$$) DB 0
6107 The \c{TIMES} directive will insert exactly enough zero bytes into
6108 the output to move the assembly point up to 510. This method also
6109 has the advantage that if you accidentally fill your boot sector too
6110 full, NASM will catch the problem at assembly time and report it, so
6111 you won't end up with a boot sector that you have to disassemble to
6112 find out what's wrong with it.
6115 \S{probtimes} \i\c{TIMES} Doesn't Work
6117 The other common problem with the above code is people who write the
6122 by reasoning that \c{$} should be a pure number, just like 510, so
6123 the difference between them is also a pure number and can happily be
6126 NASM is a \e{modular} assembler: the various component parts are
6127 designed to be easily separable for re-use, so they don't exchange
6128 information unnecessarily. In consequence, the \c{bin} output
6129 format, even though it has been told by the \c{ORG} directive that
6130 the \c{.text} section should start at 0, does not pass that
6131 information back to the expression evaluator. So from the
6132 evaluator's point of view, \c{$} isn't a pure number: it's an offset
6133 from a section base. Therefore the difference between \c{$} and 510
6134 is also not a pure number, but involves a section base. Values
6135 involving section bases cannot be passed as arguments to \c{TIMES}.
6137 The solution, as in the previous section, is to code the \c{TIMES}
6140 \c TIMES 510-($-$$) DB 0
6142 in which \c{$} and \c{$$} are offsets from the same section base,
6143 and so their difference is a pure number. This will solve the
6144 problem and generate sensible code.
6147 \H{bugs} \i{Bugs}\I{reporting bugs}
6149 We have never yet released a version of NASM with any \e{known}
6150 bugs. That doesn't usually stop there being plenty we didn't know
6151 about, though. Any that you find should be reported firstly via the
6153 \W{https://sourceforge.net/projects/nasm/}\c{https://sourceforge.net/projects/nasm/}
6154 (click on "Bugs"), or if that fails then through one of the
6155 contacts in \k{contact}.
6157 Please read \k{qstart} first, and don't report the bug if it's
6158 listed in there as a deliberate feature. (If you think the feature
6159 is badly thought out, feel free to send us reasons why you think it
6160 should be changed, but don't just send us mail saying `This is a
6161 bug' if the documentation says we did it on purpose.) Then read
6162 \k{problems}, and don't bother reporting the bug if it's listed
6165 If you do report a bug, \e{please} give us all of the following
6168 \b What operating system you're running NASM under. DOS, Linux,
6169 NetBSD, Win16, Win32, VMS (I'd be impressed), whatever.
6171 \b If you're running NASM under DOS or Win32, tell us whether you've
6172 compiled your own executable from the DOS source archive, or whether
6173 you were using the standard distribution binaries out of the
6174 archive. If you were using a locally built executable, try to
6175 reproduce the problem using one of the standard binaries, as this
6176 will make it easier for us to reproduce your problem prior to fixing
6179 \b Which version of NASM you're using, and exactly how you invoked
6180 it. Give us the precise command line, and the contents of the
6181 \c{NASMENV} environment variable if any.
6183 \b Which versions of any supplementary programs you're using, and
6184 how you invoked them. If the problem only becomes visible at link
6185 time, tell us what linker you're using, what version of it you've
6186 got, and the exact linker command line. If the problem involves
6187 linking against object files generated by a compiler, tell us what
6188 compiler, what version, and what command line or options you used.
6189 (If you're compiling in an IDE, please try to reproduce the problem
6190 with the command-line version of the compiler.)
6192 \b If at all possible, send us a NASM source file which exhibits the
6193 problem. If this causes copyright problems (e.g. you can only
6194 reproduce the bug in restricted-distribution code) then bear in mind
6195 the following two points: firstly, we guarantee that any source code
6196 sent to us for the purposes of debugging NASM will be used \e{only}
6197 for the purposes of debugging NASM, and that we will delete all our
6198 copies of it as soon as we have found and fixed the bug or bugs in
6199 question; and secondly, we would prefer \e{not} to be mailed large
6200 chunks of code anyway. The smaller the file, the better. A
6201 three-line sample file that does nothing useful \e{except}
6202 demonstrate the problem is much easier to work with than a
6203 fully fledged ten-thousand-line program. (Of course, some errors
6204 \e{do} only crop up in large files, so this may not be possible.)
6206 \b A description of what the problem actually \e{is}. `It doesn't
6207 work' is \e{not} a helpful description! Please describe exactly what
6208 is happening that shouldn't be, or what isn't happening that should.
6209 Examples might be: `NASM generates an error message saying Line 3
6210 for an error that's actually on Line 5'; `NASM generates an error
6211 message that I believe it shouldn't be generating at all'; `NASM
6212 fails to generate an error message that I believe it \e{should} be
6213 generating'; `the object file produced from this source code crashes
6214 my linker'; `the ninth byte of the output file is 66 and I think it
6215 should be 77 instead'.
6217 \b If you believe the output file from NASM to be faulty, send it to
6218 us. That allows us to determine whether our own copy of NASM
6219 generates the same file, or whether the problem is related to
6220 portability issues between our development platforms and yours. We
6221 can handle binary files mailed to us as MIME attachments, uuencoded,
6222 and even BinHex. Alternatively, we may be able to provide an FTP
6223 site you can upload the suspect files to; but mailing them is easier
6226 \b Any other information or data files that might be helpful. If,
6227 for example, the problem involves NASM failing to generate an object
6228 file while TASM can generate an equivalent file without trouble,
6229 then send us \e{both} object files, so we can see what TASM is doing
6230 differently from us.
6233 \A{ndisasm} \i{Ndisasm}
6235 The Netwide Disassembler, NDISASM
6237 \H{ndisintro} Introduction
6240 The Netwide Disassembler is a small companion program to the Netwide
6241 Assembler, NASM. It seemed a shame to have an x86 assembler,
6242 complete with a full instruction table, and not make as much use of
6243 it as possible, so here's a disassembler which shares the
6244 instruction table (and some other bits of code) with NASM.
6246 The Netwide Disassembler does nothing except to produce
6247 disassemblies of \e{binary} source files. NDISASM does not have any
6248 understanding of object file formats, like \c{objdump}, and it will
6249 not understand \c{DOS .EXE} files like \c{debug} will. It just
6253 \H{ndisstart} Getting Started: Installation
6255 See \k{install} for installation instructions. NDISASM, like NASM,
6256 has a \c{man page} which you may want to put somewhere useful, if you
6257 are on a Unix system.
6260 \H{ndisrun} Running NDISASM
6262 To disassemble a file, you will typically use a command of the form
6264 \c ndisasm [-b16 | -b32] filename
6266 NDISASM can disassemble 16-bit code or 32-bit code equally easily,
6267 provided of course that you remember to specify which it is to work
6268 with. If no \i\c{-b} switch is present, NDISASM works in 16-bit mode by
6269 default. The \i\c{-u} switch (for USE32) also invokes 32-bit mode.
6271 Two more command line options are \i\c{-r} which reports the version
6272 number of NDISASM you are running, and \i\c{-h} which gives a short
6273 summary of command line options.
6276 \S{ndiscom} COM Files: Specifying an Origin
6278 To disassemble a \c{DOS .COM} file correctly, a disassembler must assume
6279 that the first instruction in the file is loaded at address \c{0x100},
6280 rather than at zero. NDISASM, which assumes by default that any file
6281 you give it is loaded at zero, will therefore need to be informed of
6284 The \i\c{-o} option allows you to declare a different origin for the
6285 file you are disassembling. Its argument may be expressed in any of
6286 the NASM numeric formats: decimal by default, if it begins with `\c{$}'
6287 or `\c{0x}' or ends in `\c{H}' it's \c{hex}, if it ends in `\c{Q}' it's
6288 \c{octal}, and if it ends in `\c{B}' it's \c{binary}.
6290 Hence, to disassemble a \c{.COM} file:
6292 \c ndisasm -o100h filename.com
6297 \S{ndissync} Code Following Data: Synchronisation
6299 Suppose you are disassembling a file which contains some data which
6300 isn't machine code, and \e{then} contains some machine code. NDISASM
6301 will faithfully plough through the data section, producing machine
6302 instructions wherever it can (although most of them will look
6303 bizarre, and some may have unusual prefixes, e.g. `\c{FS OR AX,0x240A}'),
6304 and generating `DB' instructions ever so often if it's totally stumped.
6305 Then it will reach the code section.
6307 Supposing NDISASM has just finished generating a strange machine
6308 instruction from part of the data section, and its file position is
6309 now one byte \e{before} the beginning of the code section. It's
6310 entirely possible that another spurious instruction will get
6311 generated, starting with the final byte of the data section, and
6312 then the correct first instruction in the code section will not be
6313 seen because the starting point skipped over it. This isn't really
6316 To avoid this, you can specify a `\i\c{synchronisation}' point, or indeed
6317 as many synchronisation points as you like (although NDISASM can
6318 only handle 8192 sync points internally). The definition of a sync
6319 point is this: NDISASM guarantees to hit sync points exactly during
6320 disassembly. If it is thinking about generating an instruction which
6321 would cause it to jump over a sync point, it will discard that
6322 instruction and output a `\c{db}' instead. So it \e{will} start
6323 disassembly exactly from the sync point, and so you \e{will} see all
6324 the instructions in your code section.
6326 Sync points are specified using the \i\c{-s} option: they are measured
6327 in terms of the program origin, not the file position. So if you
6328 want to synchronise after 32 bytes of a \c{.COM} file, you would have to
6331 \c ndisasm -o100h -s120h file.com
6335 \c ndisasm -o100h -s20h file.com
6337 As stated above, you can specify multiple sync markers if you need
6338 to, just by repeating the \c{-s} option.
6341 \S{ndisisync} Mixed Code and Data: Automatic (Intelligent) Synchronisation
6344 Suppose you are disassembling the boot sector of a \c{DOS} floppy (maybe
6345 it has a virus, and you need to understand the virus so that you
6346 know what kinds of damage it might have done you). Typically, this
6347 will contain a \c{JMP} instruction, then some data, then the rest of the
6348 code. So there is a very good chance of NDISASM being \e{misaligned}
6349 when the data ends and the code begins. Hence a sync point is
6352 On the other hand, why should you have to specify the sync point
6353 manually? What you'd do in order to find where the sync point would
6354 be, surely, would be to read the \c{JMP} instruction, and then to use
6355 its target address as a sync point. So can NDISASM do that for you?
6357 The answer, of course, is yes: using either of the synonymous
6358 switches \i\c{-a} (for automatic sync) or \i\c{-i} (for intelligent
6359 sync) will enable \c{auto-sync} mode. Auto-sync mode automatically
6360 generates a sync point for any forward-referring PC-relative jump or
6361 call instruction that NDISASM encounters. (Since NDISASM is one-pass,
6362 if it encounters a PC-relative jump whose target has already been
6363 processed, there isn't much it can do about it...)
6365 Only PC-relative jumps are processed, since an absolute jump is
6366 either through a register (in which case NDISASM doesn't know what
6367 the register contains) or involves a segment address (in which case
6368 the target code isn't in the same segment that NDISASM is working
6369 in, and so the sync point can't be placed anywhere useful).
6371 For some kinds of file, this mechanism will automatically put sync
6372 points in all the right places, and save you from having to place
6373 any sync points manually. However, it should be stressed that
6374 auto-sync mode is \e{not} guaranteed to catch all the sync points, and
6375 you may still have to place some manually.
6377 Auto-sync mode doesn't prevent you from declaring manual sync
6378 points: it just adds automatically generated ones to the ones you
6379 provide. It's perfectly feasible to specify \c{-i} \e{and} some \c{-s}
6382 Another caveat with auto-sync mode is that if, by some unpleasant
6383 fluke, something in your data section should disassemble to a
6384 PC-relative call or jump instruction, NDISASM may obediently place a
6385 sync point in a totally random place, for example in the middle of
6386 one of the instructions in your code section. So you may end up with
6387 a wrong disassembly even if you use auto-sync. Again, there isn't
6388 much I can do about this. If you have problems, you'll have to use
6389 manual sync points, or use the \c{-k} option (documented below) to
6390 suppress disassembly of the data area.
6393 \S{ndisother} Other Options
6395 The \i\c{-e} option skips a header on the file, by ignoring the first N
6396 bytes. This means that the header is \e{not} counted towards the
6397 disassembly offset: if you give \c{-e10 -o10}, disassembly will start
6398 at byte 10 in the file, and this will be given offset 10, not 20.
6400 The \i\c{-k} option is provided with two comma-separated numeric
6401 arguments, the first of which is an assembly offset and the second
6402 is a number of bytes to skip. This \e{will} count the skipped bytes
6403 towards the assembly offset: its use is to suppress disassembly of a
6404 data section which wouldn't contain anything you wanted to see
6408 \H{ndisbugs} Bugs and Improvements
6410 There are no known bugs. However, any you find, with patches if
6411 possible, should be sent to \W{mailto:jules@dsf.org.uk}\c{jules@dsf.org.uk}
6412 or \W{mailto:anakin@pobox.com}\c{anakin@pobox.com}, or to the
6414 \W{https://sourceforge.net/projects/nasm/}\c{https://sourceforge.net/projects/nasm/}
6415 and we'll try to fix them. Feel free to send contributions and
6416 new features as well.
6418 Future plans include awareness of which processors certain
6419 instructions will run on, and marking of instructions that are too
6420 advanced for some processor (or are \c{FPU} instructions, or are
6421 undocumented opcodes, or are privileged protected-mode instructions,
6426 I hope NDISASM is of some use to somebody. Including me. :-)
6428 I don't recommend taking NDISASM apart to see how an efficient
6429 disassembler works, because as far as I know, it isn't an efficient
6430 one anyway. You have been warned.
6433 \A{iref} x86 Instruction Reference
6435 This appendix provides a complete list of the machine instructions
6436 which NASM will assemble, and a short description of the function of
6439 It is not intended to be exhaustive documentation on the fine
6440 details of the instructions' function, such as which exceptions they
6441 can trigger: for such documentation, you should go to Intel's Web
6442 site, \W{http://developer.intel.com/design/Pentium4/manuals/}\c{http://developer.intel.com/design/Pentium4/manuals/}.
6444 Instead, this appendix is intended primarily to provide
6445 documentation on the way the instructions may be used within NASM.
6446 For example, looking up \c{LOOP} will tell you that NASM allows
6447 \c{CX} or \c{ECX} to be specified as an optional second argument to
6448 the \c{LOOP} instruction, to enforce which of the two possible
6449 counter registers should be used if the default is not the one
6452 The instructions are not quite listed in alphabetical order, since
6453 groups of instructions with similar functions are lumped together in
6454 the same entry. Most of them don't move very far from their
6455 alphabetic position because of this.
6458 \H{iref-opr} Key to Operand Specifications
6460 The instruction descriptions in this appendix specify their operands
6461 using the following notation:
6463 \b Registers: \c{reg8} denotes an 8-bit \i{general purpose
6464 register}, \c{reg16} denotes a 16-bit general purpose register, and
6465 \c{reg32} a 32-bit one. \c{fpureg} denotes one of the eight FPU
6466 stack registers, \c{mmxreg} denotes one of the eight 64-bit MMX
6467 registers, and \c{segreg} denotes a segment register. In addition,
6468 some registers (such as \c{AL}, \c{DX} or
6469 \c{ECX}) may be specified explicitly.
6471 \b Immediate operands: \c{imm} denotes a generic \i{immediate operand}.
6472 \c{imm8}, \c{imm16} and \c{imm32} are used when the operand is
6473 intended to be a specific size. For some of these instructions, NASM
6474 needs an explicit specifier: for example, \c{ADD ESP,16} could be
6475 interpreted as either \c{ADD r/m32,imm32} or \c{ADD r/m32,imm8}.
6476 NASM chooses the former by default, and so you must specify \c{ADD
6477 ESP,BYTE 16} for the latter.
6479 \b Memory references: \c{mem} denotes a generic \i{memory reference};
6480 \c{mem8}, \c{mem16}, \c{mem32}, \c{mem64} and \c{mem80} are used
6481 when the operand needs to be a specific size. Again, a specifier is
6482 needed in some cases: \c{DEC [address]} is ambiguous and will be
6483 rejected by NASM. You must specify \c{DEC BYTE [address]}, \c{DEC
6484 WORD [address]} or \c{DEC DWORD [address]} instead.
6486 \b \i{Restricted memory references}: one form of the \c{MOV}
6487 instruction allows a memory address to be specified \e{without}
6488 allowing the normal range of register combinations and effective
6489 address processing. This is denoted by \c{memoffs8}, \c{memoffs16}
6492 \b Register or memory choices: many instructions can accept either a
6493 register \e{or} a memory reference as an operand. \c{r/m8} is a
6494 shorthand for \c{reg8/mem8}; similarly \c{r/m16} and \c{r/m32}.
6495 \c{r/m64} is MMX-related, and is a shorthand for \c{mmxreg/mem64}.
6498 \H{iref-opc} Key to Opcode Descriptions
6500 This appendix also provides the opcodes which NASM will generate for
6501 each form of each instruction. The opcodes are listed in the
6504 \b A hex number, such as \c{3F}, indicates a fixed byte containing
6507 \b A hex number followed by \c{+r}, such as \c{C8+r}, indicates that
6508 one of the operands to the instruction is a register, and the
6509 `register value' of that register should be added to the hex number
6510 to produce the generated byte. For example, EDX has register value
6511 2, so the code \c{C8+r}, when the register operand is EDX, generates
6512 the hex byte \c{CA}. Register values for specific registers are
6513 given in \k{iref-rv}.
6515 \b A hex number followed by \c{+cc}, such as \c{40+cc}, indicates
6516 that the instruction name has a condition code suffix, and the
6517 numeric representation of the condition code should be added to the
6518 hex number to produce the generated byte. For example, the code
6519 \c{40+cc}, when the instruction contains the \c{NE} condition,
6520 generates the hex byte \c{45}. Condition codes and their numeric
6521 representations are given in \k{iref-cc}.
6523 \b A slash followed by a digit, such as \c{/2}, indicates that one
6524 of the operands to the instruction is a memory address or register
6525 (denoted \c{mem} or \c{r/m}, with an optional size). This is to be
6526 encoded as an effective address, with a \i{ModR/M byte}, an optional
6527 \i{SIB byte}, and an optional displacement, and the spare (register)
6528 field of the ModR/M byte should be the digit given (which will be
6529 from 0 to 7, so it fits in three bits). The encoding of effective
6530 addresses is given in \k{iref-ea}.
6532 \b The code \c{/r} combines the above two: it indicates that one of
6533 the operands is a memory address or \c{r/m}, and another is a
6534 register, and that an effective address should be generated with the
6535 spare (register) field in the ModR/M byte being equal to the
6536 `register value' of the register operand. The encoding of effective
6537 addresses is given in \k{iref-ea}; register values are given in
6540 \b The codes \c{ib}, \c{iw} and \c{id} indicate that one of the
6541 operands to the instruction is an immediate value, and that this is
6542 to be encoded as a byte, little-endian word or little-endian
6543 doubleword respectively.
6545 \b The codes \c{rb}, \c{rw} and \c{rd} indicate that one of the
6546 operands to the instruction is an immediate value, and that the
6547 \e{difference} between this value and the address of the end of the
6548 instruction is to be encoded as a byte, word or doubleword
6549 respectively. Where the form \c{rw/rd} appears, it indicates that
6550 either \c{rw} or \c{rd} should be used according to whether assembly
6551 is being performed in \c{BITS 16} or \c{BITS 32} state respectively.
6553 \b The codes \c{ow} and \c{od} indicate that one of the operands to
6554 the instruction is a reference to the contents of a memory address
6555 specified as an immediate value: this encoding is used in some forms
6556 of the \c{MOV} instruction in place of the standard
6557 effective-address mechanism. The displacement is encoded as a word
6558 or doubleword. Again, \c{ow/od} denotes that \c{ow} or \c{od} should
6559 be chosen according to the \c{BITS} setting.
6561 \b The codes \c{o16} and \c{o32} indicate that the given form of the
6562 instruction should be assembled with operand size 16 or 32 bits. In
6563 other words, \c{o16} indicates a \c{66} prefix in \c{BITS 32} state,
6564 but generates no code in \c{BITS 16} state; and \c{o32} indicates a
6565 \c{66} prefix in \c{BITS 16} state but generates nothing in \c{BITS
6568 \b The codes \c{a16} and \c{a32}, similarly to \c{o16} and \c{o32},
6569 indicate the address size of the given form of the instruction.
6570 Where this does not match the \c{BITS} setting, a \c{67} prefix is
6574 \S{iref-rv} Register Values
6576 Where an instruction requires a register value, it is already
6577 implicit in the encoding of the rest of the instruction what type of
6578 register is intended: an 8-bit general-purpose register, a segment
6579 register, a debug register, an MMX register, or whatever. Therefore
6580 there is no problem with registers of different types sharing an
6583 The encodings for the various classes of register are:
6585 \b 8-bit general registers: \c{AL} is 0, \c{CL} is 1, \c{DL} is 2,
6586 \c{BL} is 3, \c{AH} is 4, \c{CH} is 5, \c{DH} is 6, and \c{BH} is
6589 \b 16-bit general registers: \c{AX} is 0, \c{CX} is 1, \c{DX} is 2,
6590 \c{BX} is 3, \c{SP} is 4, \c{BP} is 5, \c{SI} is 6, and \c{DI} is 7.
6592 \b 32-bit general registers: \c{EAX} is 0, \c{ECX} is 1, \c{EDX} is
6593 2, \c{EBX} is 3, \c{ESP} is 4, \c{EBP} is 5, \c{ESI} is 6, and
6596 \b \i{Segment registers}: \c{ES} is 0, \c{CS} is 1, \c{SS} is 2, \c{DS}
6597 is 3, \c{FS} is 4, and \c{GS} is 5.
6599 \b \I{floating-point, registers}Floating-point registers: \c{ST0}
6600 is 0, \c{ST1} is 1, \c{ST2} is 2, \c{ST3} is 3, \c{ST4} is 4,
6601 \c{ST5} is 5, \c{ST6} is 6, and \c{ST7} is 7.
6603 \b 64-bit \i{MMX registers}: \c{MM0} is 0, \c{MM1} is 1, \c{MM2} is 2,
6604 \c{MM3} is 3, \c{MM4} is 4, \c{MM5} is 5, \c{MM6} is 6, and \c{MM7}
6607 \b \i{Control registers}: \c{CR0} is 0, \c{CR2} is 2, \c{CR3} is 3,
6610 \b \i{Debug registers}: \c{DR0} is 0, \c{DR1} is 1, \c{DR2} is 2,
6611 \c{DR3} is 3, \c{DR6} is 6, and \c{DR7} is 7.
6613 \b \i{Test registers}: \c{TR3} is 3, \c{TR4} is 4, \c{TR5} is 5,
6614 \c{TR6} is 6, and \c{TR7} is 7.
6616 (Note that wherever a register name contains a number, that number
6617 is also the register value for that register.)
6620 \S{iref-cc} \i{Condition Codes}
6622 The available condition codes are given here, along with their
6623 numeric representations as part of opcodes. Many of these condition
6624 codes have synonyms, so several will be listed at a time.
6626 In the following descriptions, the word `either', when applied to two
6627 possible trigger conditions, is used to mean `either or both'. If
6628 `either but not both' is meant, the phrase `exactly one of' is used.
6630 \b \c{O} is 0 (trigger if the overflow flag is set); \c{NO} is 1.
6632 \b \c{B}, \c{C} and \c{NAE} are 2 (trigger if the carry flag is
6633 set); \c{AE}, \c{NB} and \c{NC} are 3.
6635 \b \c{E} and \c{Z} are 4 (trigger if the zero flag is set); \c{NE}
6638 \b \c{BE} and \c{NA} are 6 (trigger if either of the carry or zero
6639 flags is set); \c{A} and \c{NBE} are 7.
6641 \b \c{S} is 8 (trigger if the sign flag is set); \c{NS} is 9.
6643 \b \c{P} and \c{PE} are 10 (trigger if the parity flag is set);
6644 \c{NP} and \c{PO} are 11.
6646 \b \c{L} and \c{NGE} are 12 (trigger if exactly one of the sign and
6647 overflow flags is set); \c{GE} and \c{NL} are 13.
6649 \b \c{LE} and \c{NG} are 14 (trigger if either the zero flag is set,
6650 or exactly one of the sign and overflow flags is set); \c{G} and
6653 Note that in all cases, the sense of a condition code may be
6654 reversed by changing the low bit of the numeric representation.
6656 For details of when an instruction sets each of the status flags,
6657 see the individual instruction, plus the Status Flags reference
6661 \S{iref-SSE-cc} \i{SSE Condition Predicates}
6663 The condition predicates for SSE comparison instructions are the
6664 codes used as part of the opcode, to determine what form of
6665 comparison is being carried out. In each case, the imm8 value is
6666 the final byte of the opcode encoding, and the predicate is the
6667 code used as part of the mnemonic for the instruction (equivalent
6668 to the "cc" in an integer instruction that used a condition code).
6669 The instructions that use this will give details of what the various
6670 mnemonics are, this table is used to help you work out details of what
6673 \c Predi- imm8 Description Relation where: Emula- Result QNaN
6674 \c cate Encod- A Is 1st Operand tion if NaN Signal
6675 \c ing B Is 2nd Operand Operand Invalid
6677 \c EQ 000B equal A = B False No
6679 \c LT 001B less-than A < B False Yes
6681 \c LE 010B less-than- A <= B False Yes
6684 \c --- ---- greater A > B Swap False Yes
6688 \c --- ---- greater- A >= B Swap False Yes
6689 \c than-or-equal Operands,
6692 \c UNORD 011B unordered A, B = Unordered True No
6694 \c NEQ 100B not-equal A != B True No
6696 \c NLT 101B not-less- NOT(A < B) True Yes
6699 \c NLE 110B not-less- NOT(A <= B) True Yes
6703 \c --- ---- not-greater NOT(A > B) Swap True Yes
6707 \c --- ---- not-greater NOT(A >= B) Swap True Yes
6711 \c ORD 111B ordered A , B = Ordered False No
6713 The unordered relationship is true when at least one of the two
6714 values being compared is a NaN or in an unsupported format.
6716 Note that the comparisons which are listed as not having a predicate
6717 or encoding can only be achieved through software emulation, as
6718 described in the "emulation" column. Note in particular that an
6719 instruction such as \c{greater-than} is not the same as \c{NLE}, as,
6720 unlike with the \c{CMP} instruction, it has to take into account the
6721 possibility of one operand containing a NaN or an unsupported numeric
6725 \S{iref-Flags} \i{Status Flags}
6727 The status flags provide some information about the result of the
6728 arithmetic instructions. This information can be used by conditional
6729 instructions (such a \c{Jcc} and \c{CMOVcc}) as well as by some of
6730 the other instructions (such as \c{ADC} and \c{INTO}).
6732 There are 6 status flags:
6736 Set if an arithmetic operation generates a
6737 carry or a borrow out of the most-significant bit of the result;
6738 cleared otherwise. This flag indicates an overflow condition for
6739 unsigned-integer arithmetic. It is also used in multiple-precision
6742 \c PF - Parity flag.
6744 Set if the least-significant byte of the result contains an even
6745 number of 1 bits; cleared otherwise.
6747 \c AF - Adjust flag.
6749 Set if an arithmetic operation generates a carry or a borrow
6750 out of bit 3 of the result; cleared otherwise. This flag is used
6751 in binary-coded decimal (BCD) arithmetic.
6755 Set if the result is zero; cleared otherwise.
6759 Set equal to the most-significant bit of the result, which is the
6760 sign bit of a signed integer. (0 indicates a positive value and 1
6761 indicates a negative value.)
6763 \c OF - Overflow flag.
6765 Set if the integer result is too large a positive number or too
6766 small a negative number (excluding the sign-bit) to fit in the
6767 destination operand; cleared otherwise. This flag indicates an
6768 overflow condition for signed-integer (two's complement) arithmetic.
6771 \S{iref-ea} Effective Address Encoding: \i{ModR/M} and \i{SIB}
6773 An \i{effective address} is encoded in up to three parts: a ModR/M
6774 byte, an optional SIB byte, and an optional byte, word or doubleword
6777 The ModR/M byte consists of three fields: the \c{mod} field, ranging
6778 from 0 to 3, in the upper two bits of the byte, the \c{r/m} field,
6779 ranging from 0 to 7, in the lower three bits, and the spare
6780 (register) field in the middle (bit 3 to bit 5). The spare field is
6781 not relevant to the effective address being encoded, and either
6782 contains an extension to the instruction opcode or the register
6783 value of another operand.
6785 The ModR/M system can be used to encode a direct register reference
6786 rather than a memory access. This is always done by setting the
6787 \c{mod} field to 3 and the \c{r/m} field to the register value of
6788 the register in question (it must be a general-purpose register, and
6789 the size of the register must already be implicit in the encoding of
6790 the rest of the instruction). In this case, the SIB byte and
6791 displacement field are both absent.
6793 In 16-bit addressing mode (either \c{BITS 16} with no \c{67} prefix,
6794 or \c{BITS 32} with a \c{67} prefix), the SIB byte is never used.
6795 The general rules for \c{mod} and \c{r/m} (there is an exception,
6798 \b The \c{mod} field gives the length of the displacement field: 0
6799 means no displacement, 1 means one byte, and 2 means two bytes.
6801 \b The \c{r/m} field encodes the combination of registers to be
6802 added to the displacement to give the accessed address: 0 means
6803 \c{BX+SI}, 1 means \c{BX+DI}, 2 means \c{BP+SI}, 3 means \c{BP+DI},
6804 4 means \c{SI} only, 5 means \c{DI} only, 6 means \c{BP} only, and 7
6807 However, there is a special case:
6809 \b If \c{mod} is 0 and \c{r/m} is 6, the effective address encoded
6810 is not \c{[BP]} as the above rules would suggest, but instead
6811 \c{[disp16]}: the displacement field is present and is two bytes
6812 long, and no registers are added to the displacement.
6814 Therefore the effective address \c{[BP]} cannot be encoded as
6815 efficiently as \c{[BX]}; so if you code \c{[BP]} in a program, NASM
6816 adds a notional 8-bit zero displacement, and sets \c{mod} to 1,
6817 \c{r/m} to 6, and the one-byte displacement field to 0.
6819 In 32-bit addressing mode (either \c{BITS 16} with a \c{67} prefix,
6820 or \c{BITS 32} with no \c{67} prefix) the general rules (again,
6821 there are exceptions) for \c{mod} and \c{r/m} are:
6823 \b The \c{mod} field gives the length of the displacement field: 0
6824 means no displacement, 1 means one byte, and 2 means four bytes.
6826 \b If only one register is to be added to the displacement, and it
6827 is not \c{ESP}, the \c{r/m} field gives its register value, and the
6828 SIB byte is absent. If the \c{r/m} field is 4 (which would encode
6829 \c{ESP}), the SIB byte is present and gives the combination and
6830 scaling of registers to be added to the displacement.
6832 If the SIB byte is present, it describes the combination of
6833 registers (an optional base register, and an optional index register
6834 scaled by multiplication by 1, 2, 4 or 8) to be added to the
6835 displacement. The SIB byte is divided into the \c{scale} field, in
6836 the top two bits, the \c{index} field in the next three, and the
6837 \c{base} field in the bottom three. The general rules are:
6839 \b The \c{base} field encodes the register value of the base
6842 \b The \c{index} field encodes the register value of the index
6843 register, unless it is 4, in which case no index register is used
6844 (so \c{ESP} cannot be used as an index register).
6846 \b The \c{scale} field encodes the multiplier by which the index
6847 register is scaled before adding it to the base and displacement: 0
6848 encodes a multiplier of 1, 1 encodes 2, 2 encodes 4 and 3 encodes 8.
6850 The exceptions to the 32-bit encoding rules are:
6852 \b If \c{mod} is 0 and \c{r/m} is 5, the effective address encoded
6853 is not \c{[EBP]} as the above rules would suggest, but instead
6854 \c{[disp32]}: the displacement field is present and is four bytes
6855 long, and no registers are added to the displacement.
6857 \b If \c{mod} is 0, \c{r/m} is 4 (meaning the SIB byte is present)
6858 and \c{base} is 4, the effective address encoded is not
6859 \c{[EBP+index]} as the above rules would suggest, but instead
6860 \c{[disp32+index]}: the displacement field is present and is four
6861 bytes long, and there is no base register (but the index register is
6862 still processed in the normal way).
6865 \H{iref-flg} Key to Instruction Flags
6867 Given along with each instruction in this appendix is a set of
6868 flags, denoting the type of the instruction. The types are as follows:
6870 \b \c{8086}, \c{186}, \c{286}, \c{386}, \c{486}, \c{PENT} and \c{P6}
6871 denote the lowest processor type that supports the instruction. Most
6872 instructions run on all processors above the given type; those that
6873 do not are documented. The Pentium II contains no additional
6874 instructions beyond the P6 (Pentium Pro); from the point of view of
6875 its instruction set, it can be thought of as a P6 with MMX
6878 \b \c{3DNOW} indicates that the instruction is a 3DNow! one, and will
6879 run on the AMD K6-2 and later processors. ATHLON extensions to the
6880 3DNow! instruction set are documented as such.
6882 \b \c{CYRIX} indicates that the instruction is specific to Cyrix
6883 processors, for example the extra MMX instructions in the Cyrix
6884 extended MMX instruction set.
6886 \b \c{FPU} indicates that the instruction is a floating-point one,
6887 and will only run on machines with a coprocessor (automatically
6888 including 486DX, Pentium and above).
6890 \b \c{KATMAI} indicates that the instruction was introduced as part
6891 of the Katmai New Instruction set. These instructions are available
6892 on the Pentium III and later processors. Those which are not
6893 specifically SSE instructions are also available on the AMD Athlon.
6895 \b \c{MMX} indicates that the instruction is an MMX one, and will
6896 run on MMX-capable Pentium processors and the Pentium II.
6898 \b \c{PRIV} indicates that the instruction is a protected-mode
6899 management instruction. Many of these may only be used in protected
6900 mode, or only at privilege level zero.
6902 \b \c{SSE} and \c{SSE2} indicate that the instruction is a Streaming
6903 SIMD Extension instruction. These instructions operate on multiple
6904 values in a single operation. SSE was introduced with the Pentium III
6905 and SSE2 was introduced with the Pentium 4.
6907 \b \c{UNDOC} indicates that the instruction is an undocumented one,
6908 and not part of the official Intel Architecture; it may or may not
6909 be supported on any given machine.
6911 \b \c{WILLAMETTE} indicates that the instruction was introduced as
6912 part of the new instruction set in the Pentium 4 and Intel Xeon
6913 processors. These instructions are also known as SSE2 instructions.
6916 \H{iref-inst} x86 Instruction Set
6919 \S{insAAA} \i\c{AAA}, \i\c{AAS}, \i\c{AAM}, \i\c{AAD}: ASCII
6926 \c AAD ; D5 0A [8086]
6927 \c AAD imm ; D5 ib [8086]
6929 \c AAM ; D4 0A [8086]
6930 \c AAM imm ; D4 ib [8086]
6932 These instructions are used in conjunction with the add, subtract,
6933 multiply and divide instructions to perform binary-coded decimal
6934 arithmetic in \e{unpacked} (one BCD digit per byte - easy to
6935 translate to and from \c{ASCII}, hence the instruction names) form.
6936 There are also packed BCD instructions \c{DAA} and \c{DAS}: see
6939 \b \c{AAA} (ASCII Adjust After Addition) should be used after a
6940 one-byte \c{ADD} instruction whose destination was the \c{AL}
6941 register: by means of examining the value in the low nibble of
6942 \c{AL} and also the auxiliary carry flag \c{AF}, it determines
6943 whether the addition has overflowed, and adjusts it (and sets
6944 the carry flag) if so. You can add long BCD strings together
6945 by doing \c{ADD}/\c{AAA} on the low digits, then doing
6946 \c{ADC}/\c{AAA} on each subsequent digit.
6948 \b \c{AAS} (ASCII Adjust AL After Subtraction) works similarly to
6949 \c{AAA}, but is for use after \c{SUB} instructions rather than
6952 \b \c{AAM} (ASCII Adjust AX After Multiply) is for use after you
6953 have multiplied two decimal digits together and left the result
6954 in \c{AL}: it divides \c{AL} by ten and stores the quotient in
6955 \c{AH}, leaving the remainder in \c{AL}. The divisor 10 can be
6956 changed by specifying an operand to the instruction: a particularly
6957 handy use of this is \c{AAM 16}, causing the two nibbles in \c{AL}
6958 to be separated into \c{AH} and \c{AL}.
6960 \b \c{AAD} (ASCII Adjust AX Before Division) performs the inverse
6961 operation to \c{AAM}: it multiplies \c{AH} by ten, adds it to
6962 \c{AL}, and sets \c{AH} to zero. Again, the multiplier 10 can
6966 \S{insADC} \i\c{ADC}: Add with Carry
6968 \c ADC r/m8,reg8 ; 10 /r [8086]
6969 \c ADC r/m16,reg16 ; o16 11 /r [8086]
6970 \c ADC r/m32,reg32 ; o32 11 /r [386]
6972 \c ADC reg8,r/m8 ; 12 /r [8086]
6973 \c ADC reg16,r/m16 ; o16 13 /r [8086]
6974 \c ADC reg32,r/m32 ; o32 13 /r [386]
6976 \c ADC r/m8,imm8 ; 80 /2 ib [8086]
6977 \c ADC r/m16,imm16 ; o16 81 /2 iw [8086]
6978 \c ADC r/m32,imm32 ; o32 81 /2 id [386]
6980 \c ADC r/m16,imm8 ; o16 83 /2 ib [8086]
6981 \c ADC r/m32,imm8 ; o32 83 /2 ib [386]
6983 \c ADC AL,imm8 ; 14 ib [8086]
6984 \c ADC AX,imm16 ; o16 15 iw [8086]
6985 \c ADC EAX,imm32 ; o32 15 id [386]
6987 \c{ADC} performs integer addition: it adds its two operands
6988 together, plus the value of the carry flag, and leaves the result in
6989 its destination (first) operand. The destination operand can be a
6990 register or a memory location. The source operand can be a register,
6991 a memory location or an immediate value.
6993 The flags are set according to the result of the operation: in
6994 particular, the carry flag is affected and can be used by a
6995 subsequent \c{ADC} instruction.
6997 In the forms with an 8-bit immediate second operand and a longer
6998 first operand, the second operand is considered to be signed, and is
6999 sign-extended to the length of the first operand. In these cases,
7000 the \c{BYTE} qualifier is necessary to force NASM to generate this
7001 form of the instruction.
7003 To add two numbers without also adding the contents of the carry
7004 flag, use \c{ADD} (\k{insADD}).
7007 \S{insADD} \i\c{ADD}: Add Integers
7009 \c ADD r/m8,reg8 ; 00 /r [8086]
7010 \c ADD r/m16,reg16 ; o16 01 /r [8086]
7011 \c ADD r/m32,reg32 ; o32 01 /r [386]
7013 \c ADD reg8,r/m8 ; 02 /r [8086]
7014 \c ADD reg16,r/m16 ; o16 03 /r [8086]
7015 \c ADD reg32,r/m32 ; o32 03 /r [386]
7017 \c ADD r/m8,imm8 ; 80 /0 ib [8086]
7018 \c ADD r/m16,imm16 ; o16 81 /0 iw [8086]
7019 \c ADD r/m32,imm32 ; o32 81 /0 id [386]
7021 \c ADD r/m16,imm8 ; o16 83 /0 ib [8086]
7022 \c ADD r/m32,imm8 ; o32 83 /0 ib [386]
7024 \c ADD AL,imm8 ; 04 ib [8086]
7025 \c ADD AX,imm16 ; o16 05 iw [8086]
7026 \c ADD EAX,imm32 ; o32 05 id [386]
7028 \c{ADD} performs integer addition: it adds its two operands
7029 together, and leaves the result in its destination (first) operand.
7030 The destination operand can be a register or a memory location.
7031 The source operand can be a register, a memory location or an
7034 The flags are set according to the result of the operation: in
7035 particular, the carry flag is affected and can be used by a
7036 subsequent \c{ADC} instruction.
7038 In the forms with an 8-bit immediate second operand and a longer
7039 first operand, the second operand is considered to be signed, and is
7040 sign-extended to the length of the first operand. In these cases,
7041 the \c{BYTE} qualifier is necessary to force NASM to generate this
7042 form of the instruction.
7045 \S{insADDPD} \i\c{ADDPD}: ADD Packed Double-Precision FP Values
7047 \c ADDPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 66 0F 58 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7049 \c{ADDPD} performs addition on each of two packed double-precision
7052 \c dst[0-63] := dst[0-63] + src[0-63],
7053 \c dst[64-127] := dst[64-127] + src[64-127].
7055 The destination is an \c{XMM} register. The source operand can be
7056 either an \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
7059 \S{insADDPS} \i\c{ADDPS}: ADD Packed Single-Precision FP Values
7061 \c ADDPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 0F 58 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
7063 \c{ADDPS} performs addition on each of four packed single-precision
7066 \c dst[0-31] := dst[0-31] + src[0-31],
7067 \c dst[32-63] := dst[32-63] + src[32-63],
7068 \c dst[64-95] := dst[64-95] + src[64-95],
7069 \c dst[96-127] := dst[96-127] + src[96-127].
7071 The destination is an \c{XMM} register. The source operand can be
7072 either an \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
7075 \S{insADDSD} \i\c{ADDSD}: ADD Scalar Double-Precision FP Values
7077 \c ADDSD xmm1,xmm2/mem64 ; F2 0F 58 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
7079 \c{ADDSD} adds the low double-precision FP values from the source
7080 and destination operands and stores the double-precision FP result
7081 in the destination operand.
7083 \c dst[0-63] := dst[0-63] + src[0-63],
7084 \c dst[64-127) remains unchanged.
7086 The destination is an \c{XMM} register. The source operand can be
7087 either an \c{XMM} register or a 64-bit memory location.
7090 \S{insADDSS} \i\c{ADDSS}: ADD Scalar Single-Precision FP Values
7092 \c ADDSS xmm1,xmm2/mem32 ; F3 0F 58 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7094 \c{ADDSS} adds the low single-precision FP values from the source
7095 and destination operands and stores the single-precision FP result
7096 in the destination operand.
7098 \c dst[0-31] := dst[0-31] + src[0-31],
7099 \c dst[32-127] remains unchanged.
7101 The destination is an \c{XMM} register. The source operand can be
7102 either an \c{XMM} register or a 32-bit memory location.
7105 \S{insAND} \i\c{AND}: Bitwise AND
7107 \c AND r/m8,reg8 ; 20 /r [8086]
7108 \c AND r/m16,reg16 ; o16 21 /r [8086]
7109 \c AND r/m32,reg32 ; o32 21 /r [386]
7111 \c AND reg8,r/m8 ; 22 /r [8086]
7112 \c AND reg16,r/m16 ; o16 23 /r [8086]
7113 \c AND reg32,r/m32 ; o32 23 /r [386]
7115 \c AND r/m8,imm8 ; 80 /4 ib [8086]
7116 \c AND r/m16,imm16 ; o16 81 /4 iw [8086]
7117 \c AND r/m32,imm32 ; o32 81 /4 id [386]
7119 \c AND r/m16,imm8 ; o16 83 /4 ib [8086]
7120 \c AND r/m32,imm8 ; o32 83 /4 ib [386]
7122 \c AND AL,imm8 ; 24 ib [8086]
7123 \c AND AX,imm16 ; o16 25 iw [8086]
7124 \c AND EAX,imm32 ; o32 25 id [386]
7126 \c{AND} performs a bitwise AND operation between its two operands
7127 (i.e. each bit of the result is 1 if and only if the corresponding
7128 bits of the two inputs were both 1), and stores the result in the
7129 destination (first) operand. The destination operand can be a
7130 register or a memory location. The source operand can be a register,
7131 a memory location or an immediate value.
7133 In the forms with an 8-bit immediate second operand and a longer
7134 first operand, the second operand is considered to be signed, and is
7135 sign-extended to the length of the first operand. In these cases,
7136 the \c{BYTE} qualifier is necessary to force NASM to generate this
7137 form of the instruction.
7139 The \c{MMX} instruction \c{PAND} (see \k{insPAND}) performs the same
7140 operation on the 64-bit \c{MMX} registers.
7143 \S{insANDNPD} \i\c{ANDNPD}: Bitwise Logical AND NOT of
7144 Packed Double-Precision FP Values
7146 \c ANDNPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 66 0F 55 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7148 \c{ANDNPD} inverts the bits of the two double-precision
7149 floating-point values in the destination register, and then
7150 performs a logical AND between the two double-precision
7151 floating-point values in the source operand and the temporary
7152 inverted result, storing the result in the destination register.
7154 \c dst[0-63] := src[0-63] AND NOT dst[0-63],
7155 \c dst[64-127] := src[64-127] AND NOT dst[64-127].
7157 The destination is an \c{XMM} register. The source operand can be
7158 either an \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
7161 \S{insANDNPS} \i\c{ANDNPS}: Bitwise Logical AND NOT of
7162 Packed Single-Precision FP Values
7164 \c ANDNPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 0F 55 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
7166 \c{ANDNPS} inverts the bits of the four single-precision
7167 floating-point values in the destination register, and then
7168 performs a logical AND between the four single-precision
7169 floating-point values in the source operand and the temporary
7170 inverted result, storing the result in the destination register.
7172 \c dst[0-31] := src[0-31] AND NOT dst[0-31],
7173 \c dst[32-63] := src[32-63] AND NOT dst[32-63],
7174 \c dst[64-95] := src[64-95] AND NOT dst[64-95],
7175 \c dst[96-127] := src[96-127] AND NOT dst[96-127].
7177 The destination is an \c{XMM} register. The source operand can be
7178 either an \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
7181 \S{insANDPD} \i\c{ANDPD}: Bitwise Logical AND For Single FP
7183 \c ANDPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 66 0F 54 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7185 \c{ANDPD} performs a bitwise logical AND of the two double-precision
7186 floating point values in the source and destination operand, and
7187 stores the result in the destination register.
7189 \c dst[0-63] := src[0-63] AND dst[0-63],
7190 \c dst[64-127] := src[64-127] AND dst[64-127].
7192 The destination is an \c{XMM} register. The source operand can be
7193 either an \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
7196 \S{insANDPS} \i\c{ANDPS}: Bitwise Logical AND For Single FP
7198 \c ANDPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 0F 54 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
7200 \c{ANDPS} performs a bitwise logical AND of the four single-precision
7201 floating point values in the source and destination operand, and
7202 stores the result in the destination register.
7204 \c dst[0-31] := src[0-31] AND dst[0-31],
7205 \c dst[32-63] := src[32-63] AND dst[32-63],
7206 \c dst[64-95] := src[64-95] AND dst[64-95],
7207 \c dst[96-127] := src[96-127] AND dst[96-127].
7209 The destination is an \c{XMM} register. The source operand can be
7210 either an \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
7213 \S{insARPL} \i\c{ARPL}: Adjust RPL Field of Selector
7215 \c ARPL r/m16,reg16 ; 63 /r [286,PRIV]
7217 \c{ARPL} expects its two word operands to be segment selectors. It
7218 adjusts the \i\c{RPL} (requested privilege level - stored in the bottom
7219 two bits of the selector) field of the destination (first) operand
7220 to ensure that it is no less (i.e. no more privileged than) the \c{RPL}
7221 field of the source operand. The zero flag is set if and only if a
7222 change had to be made.
7225 \S{insBOUND} \i\c{BOUND}: Check Array Index against Bounds
7227 \c BOUND reg16,mem ; o16 62 /r [186]
7228 \c BOUND reg32,mem ; o32 62 /r [386]
7230 \c{BOUND} expects its second operand to point to an area of memory
7231 containing two signed values of the same size as its first operand
7232 (i.e. two words for the 16-bit form; two doublewords for the 32-bit
7233 form). It performs two signed comparisons: if the value in the
7234 register passed as its first operand is less than the first of the
7235 in-memory values, or is greater than or equal to the second, it
7236 throws a \c{BR} exception. Otherwise, it does nothing.
7239 \S{insBSF} \i\c{BSF}, \i\c{BSR}: Bit Scan
7241 \c BSF reg16,r/m16 ; o16 0F BC /r [386]
7242 \c BSF reg32,r/m32 ; o32 0F BC /r [386]
7244 \c BSR reg16,r/m16 ; o16 0F BD /r [386]
7245 \c BSR reg32,r/m32 ; o32 0F BD /r [386]
7247 \b \c{BSF} searches for the least significant set bit in its source
7248 (second) operand, and if it finds one, stores the index in
7249 its destination (first) operand. If no set bit is found, the
7250 contents of the destination operand are undefined. If the source
7251 operand is zero, the zero flag is set.
7253 \b \c{BSR} performs the same function, but searches from the top
7254 instead, so it finds the most significant set bit.
7256 Bit indices are from 0 (least significant) to 15 or 31 (most
7257 significant). The destination operand can only be a register.
7258 The source operand can be a register or a memory location.
7261 \S{insBSWAP} \i\c{BSWAP}: Byte Swap
7263 \c BSWAP reg32 ; o32 0F C8+r [486]
7265 \c{BSWAP} swaps the order of the four bytes of a 32-bit register:
7266 bits 0-7 exchange places with bits 24-31, and bits 8-15 swap with
7267 bits 16-23. There is no explicit 16-bit equivalent: to byte-swap
7268 \c{AX}, \c{BX}, \c{CX} or \c{DX}, \c{XCHG} can be used. When \c{BSWAP}
7269 is used with a 16-bit register, the result is undefined.
7272 \S{insBT} \i\c{BT}, \i\c{BTC}, \i\c{BTR}, \i\c{BTS}: Bit Test
7274 \c BT r/m16,reg16 ; o16 0F A3 /r [386]
7275 \c BT r/m32,reg32 ; o32 0F A3 /r [386]
7276 \c BT r/m16,imm8 ; o16 0F BA /4 ib [386]
7277 \c BT r/m32,imm8 ; o32 0F BA /4 ib [386]
7279 \c BTC r/m16,reg16 ; o16 0F BB /r [386]
7280 \c BTC r/m32,reg32 ; o32 0F BB /r [386]
7281 \c BTC r/m16,imm8 ; o16 0F BA /7 ib [386]
7282 \c BTC r/m32,imm8 ; o32 0F BA /7 ib [386]
7284 \c BTR r/m16,reg16 ; o16 0F B3 /r [386]
7285 \c BTR r/m32,reg32 ; o32 0F B3 /r [386]
7286 \c BTR r/m16,imm8 ; o16 0F BA /6 ib [386]
7287 \c BTR r/m32,imm8 ; o32 0F BA /6 ib [386]
7289 \c BTS r/m16,reg16 ; o16 0F AB /r [386]
7290 \c BTS r/m32,reg32 ; o32 0F AB /r [386]
7291 \c BTS r/m16,imm ; o16 0F BA /5 ib [386]
7292 \c BTS r/m32,imm ; o32 0F BA /5 ib [386]
7294 These instructions all test one bit of their first operand, whose
7295 index is given by the second operand, and store the value of that
7296 bit into the carry flag. Bit indices are from 0 (least significant)
7297 to 15 or 31 (most significant).
7299 In addition to storing the original value of the bit into the carry
7300 flag, \c{BTR} also resets (clears) the bit in the operand itself.
7301 \c{BTS} sets the bit, and \c{BTC} complements the bit. \c{BT} does
7302 not modify its operands.
7304 The destination can be a register or a memory location. The source can
7305 be a register or an immediate value.
7307 If the destination operand is a register, the bit offset should be
7308 in the range 0-15 (for 16-bit operands) or 0-31 (for 32-bit operands).
7309 An immediate value outside these ranges will be taken modulo 16/32
7312 If the destination operand is a memory location, then an immediate
7313 bit offset follows the same rules as for a register. If the bit offset
7314 is in a register, then it can be anything within the signed range of
7315 the register used (ie, for a 32-bit operand, it can be (-2^31) to (2^31 - 1)
7318 \S{insCALL} \i\c{CALL}: Call Subroutine
7320 \c CALL imm ; E8 rw/rd [8086]
7321 \c CALL imm:imm16 ; o16 9A iw iw [8086]
7322 \c CALL imm:imm32 ; o32 9A id iw [386]
7323 \c CALL FAR mem16 ; o16 FF /3 [8086]
7324 \c CALL FAR mem32 ; o32 FF /3 [386]
7325 \c CALL r/m16 ; o16 FF /2 [8086]
7326 \c CALL r/m32 ; o32 FF /2 [386]
7328 \c{CALL} calls a subroutine, by means of pushing the current
7329 instruction pointer (\c{IP}) and optionally \c{CS} as well on the
7330 stack, and then jumping to a given address.
7332 \c{CS} is pushed as well as \c{IP} if and only if the call is a far
7333 call, i.e. a destination segment address is specified in the
7334 instruction. The forms involving two colon-separated arguments are
7335 far calls; so are the \c{CALL FAR mem} forms.
7337 The immediate \i{near call} takes one of two forms (\c{call imm16/imm32},
7338 determined by the current segment size limit. For 16-bit operands,
7339 you would use \c{CALL 0x1234}, and for 32-bit operands you would use
7340 \c{CALL 0x12345678}. The value passed as an operand is a relative offset.
7342 You can choose between the two immediate \i{far call} forms
7343 (\c{CALL imm:imm}) by the use of the \c{WORD} and \c{DWORD} keywords:
7344 \c{CALL WORD 0x1234:0x5678}) or \c{CALL DWORD 0x1234:0x56789abc}.
7346 The \c{CALL FAR mem} forms execute a far call by loading the
7347 destination address out of memory. The address loaded consists of 16
7348 or 32 bits of offset (depending on the operand size), and 16 bits of
7349 segment. The operand size may be overridden using \c{CALL WORD FAR
7350 mem} or \c{CALL DWORD FAR mem}.
7352 The \c{CALL r/m} forms execute a \i{near call} (within the same
7353 segment), loading the destination address out of memory or out of a
7354 register. The keyword \c{NEAR} may be specified, for clarity, in
7355 these forms, but is not necessary. Again, operand size can be
7356 overridden using \c{CALL WORD mem} or \c{CALL DWORD mem}.
7358 As a convenience, NASM does not require you to call a far procedure
7359 symbol by coding the cumbersome \c{CALL SEG routine:routine}, but
7360 instead allows the easier synonym \c{CALL FAR routine}.
7362 The \c{CALL r/m} forms given above are near calls; NASM will accept
7363 the \c{NEAR} keyword (e.g. \c{CALL NEAR [address]}), even though it
7364 is not strictly necessary.
7367 \S{insCBW} \i\c{CBW}, \i\c{CWD}, \i\c{CDQ}, \i\c{CWDE}: Sign Extensions
7369 \c CBW ; o16 98 [8086]
7370 \c CWDE ; o32 98 [386]
7372 \c CWD ; o16 99 [8086]
7373 \c CDQ ; o32 99 [386]
7375 All these instructions sign-extend a short value into a longer one,
7376 by replicating the top bit of the original value to fill the
7379 \c{CBW} extends \c{AL} into \c{AX} by repeating the top bit of
7380 \c{AL} in every bit of \c{AH}. \c{CWDE} extends \c{AX} into
7381 \c{EAX}. \c{CWD} extends \c{AX} into \c{DX:AX} by repeating
7382 the top bit of \c{AX} throughout \c{DX}, and \c{CDQ} extends
7383 \c{EAX} into \c{EDX:EAX}.
7386 \S{insCLC} \i\c{CLC}, \i\c{CLD}, \i\c{CLI}, \i\c{CLTS}: Clear Flags
7391 \c CLTS ; 0F 06 [286,PRIV]
7393 These instructions clear various flags. \c{CLC} clears the carry
7394 flag; \c{CLD} clears the direction flag; \c{CLI} clears the
7395 interrupt flag (thus disabling interrupts); and \c{CLTS} clears the
7396 task-switched (\c{TS}) flag in \c{CR0}.
7398 To set the carry, direction, or interrupt flags, use the \c{STC},
7399 \c{STD} and \c{STI} instructions (\k{insSTC}). To invert the carry
7400 flag, use \c{CMC} (\k{insCMC}).
7403 \S{insCLFLUSH} \i\c{CLFLUSH}: Flush Cache Line
7405 \c CLFLUSH mem ; 0F AE /7 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7407 \c{CLFLUSH} invalidates the cache line that contains the linear address
7408 specified by the source operand from all levels of the processor cache
7409 hierarchy (data and instruction). If, at any level of the cache
7410 hierarchy, the line is inconsistent with memory (dirty) it is written
7411 to memory before invalidation. The source operand points to a
7412 byte-sized memory location.
7414 Although \c{CLFLUSH} is flagged \c{SSE2} and above, it may not be
7415 present on all processors which have \c{SSE2} support, and it may be
7416 supported on other processors; the \c{CPUID} instruction (\k{insCPUID})
7417 will return a bit which indicates support for the \c{CLFLUSH} instruction.
7420 \S{insCMC} \i\c{CMC}: Complement Carry Flag
7424 \c{CMC} changes the value of the carry flag: if it was 0, it sets it
7425 to 1, and vice versa.
7428 \S{insCMOVcc} \i\c{CMOVcc}: Conditional Move
7430 \c CMOVcc reg16,r/m16 ; o16 0F 40+cc /r [P6]
7431 \c CMOVcc reg32,r/m32 ; o32 0F 40+cc /r [P6]
7433 \c{CMOV} moves its source (second) operand into its destination
7434 (first) operand if the given condition code is satisfied; otherwise
7437 For a list of condition codes, see \k{iref-cc}.
7439 Although the \c{CMOV} instructions are flagged \c{P6} and above, they
7440 may not be supported by all Pentium Pro processors; the \c{CPUID}
7441 instruction (\k{insCPUID}) will return a bit which indicates whether
7442 conditional moves are supported.
7445 \S{insCMP} \i\c{CMP}: Compare Integers
7447 \c CMP r/m8,reg8 ; 38 /r [8086]
7448 \c CMP r/m16,reg16 ; o16 39 /r [8086]
7449 \c CMP r/m32,reg32 ; o32 39 /r [386]
7451 \c CMP reg8,r/m8 ; 3A /r [8086]
7452 \c CMP reg16,r/m16 ; o16 3B /r [8086]
7453 \c CMP reg32,r/m32 ; o32 3B /r [386]
7455 \c CMP r/m8,imm8 ; 80 /0 ib [8086]
7456 \c CMP r/m16,imm16 ; o16 81 /0 iw [8086]
7457 \c CMP r/m32,imm32 ; o32 81 /0 id [386]
7459 \c CMP r/m16,imm8 ; o16 83 /0 ib [8086]
7460 \c CMP r/m32,imm8 ; o32 83 /0 ib [386]
7462 \c CMP AL,imm8 ; 3C ib [8086]
7463 \c CMP AX,imm16 ; o16 3D iw [8086]
7464 \c CMP EAX,imm32 ; o32 3D id [386]
7466 \c{CMP} performs a `mental' subtraction of its second operand from
7467 its first operand, and affects the flags as if the subtraction had
7468 taken place, but does not store the result of the subtraction
7471 In the forms with an 8-bit immediate second operand and a longer
7472 first operand, the second operand is considered to be signed, and is
7473 sign-extended to the length of the first operand. In these cases,
7474 the \c{BYTE} qualifier is necessary to force NASM to generate this
7475 form of the instruction.
7477 The destination operand can be a register or a memory location. The
7478 source can be a register, memory location or an immediate value of
7479 the same size as the destination.
7482 \S{insCMPccPD} \i\c{CMPccPD}: Packed Double-Precision FP Compare
7483 \I\c{CMPEQPD} \I\c{CMPLTPD} \I\c{CMPLEPD} \I\c{CMPUNORDPD}
7484 \I\c{CMPNEQPD} \I\c{CMPNLTPD} \I\c{CMPNLEPD} \I\c{CMPORDPD}
7486 \c CMPPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128,imm8 ; 66 0F C2 /r ib [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7488 \c CMPEQPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 66 0F C2 /r 00 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7489 \c CMPLTPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 66 0F C2 /r 01 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7490 \c CMPLEPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 66 0F C2 /r 02 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7491 \c CMPUNORDPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 66 0F C2 /r 03 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7492 \c CMPNEQPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 66 0F C2 /r 04 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7493 \c CMPNLTPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 66 0F C2 /r 05 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7494 \c CMPNLEPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 66 0F C2 /r 06 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7495 \c CMPORDPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 66 0F C2 /r 07 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7497 The \c{CMPccPD} instructions compare the two packed double-precision
7498 FP values in the source and destination operands, and returns the
7499 result of the comparison in the destination register. The result of
7500 each comparison is a quadword mask of all 1s (comparison true) or
7501 all 0s (comparison false).
7503 The destination is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be either an
7504 \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
7506 The third operand is an 8-bit immediate value, of which the low 3
7507 bits define the type of comparison. For ease of programming, the
7508 8 two-operand pseudo-instructions are provided, with the third
7509 operand already filled in. The \I{Condition Predicates}
7510 \c{Condition Predicates} are:
7514 \c LE 2 Less-than-or-equal
7515 \c UNORD 3 Unordered
7517 \c NLT 5 Not-less-than
7518 \c NLE 6 Not-less-than-or-equal
7521 For more details of the comparison predicates, and details of how
7522 to emulate the "greater-than" equivalents, see \k{iref-SSE-cc}
7525 \S{insCMPccPS} \i\c{CMPccPS}: Packed Single-Precision FP Compare
7526 \I\c{CMPEQPS} \I\c{CMPLTPS} \I\c{CMPLEPS} \I\c{CMPUNORDPS}
7527 \I\c{CMPNEQPS} \I\c{CMPNLTPS} \I\c{CMPNLEPS} \I\c{CMPORDPS}
7529 \c CMPPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128,imm8 ; 0F C2 /r ib [KATMAI,SSE]
7531 \c CMPEQPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 0F C2 /r 00 [KATMAI,SSE]
7532 \c CMPLTPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 0F C2 /r 01 [KATMAI,SSE]
7533 \c CMPLEPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 0F C2 /r 02 [KATMAI,SSE]
7534 \c CMPUNORDPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 0F C2 /r 03 [KATMAI,SSE]
7535 \c CMPNEQPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 0F C2 /r 04 [KATMAI,SSE]
7536 \c CMPNLTPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 0F C2 /r 05 [KATMAI,SSE]
7537 \c CMPNLEPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 0F C2 /r 06 [KATMAI,SSE]
7538 \c CMPORDPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 0F C2 /r 07 [KATMAI,SSE]
7540 The \c{CMPccPS} instructions compare the two packed single-precision
7541 FP values in the source and destination operands, and returns the
7542 result of the comparison in the destination register. The result of
7543 each comparison is a doubleword mask of all 1s (comparison true) or
7544 all 0s (comparison false).
7546 The destination is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be either an
7547 \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
7549 The third operand is an 8-bit immediate value, of which the low 3
7550 bits define the type of comparison. For ease of programming, the
7551 8 two-operand pseudo-instructions are provided, with the third
7552 operand already filled in. The \I{Condition Predicates}
7553 \c{Condition Predicates} are:
7557 \c LE 2 Less-than-or-equal
7558 \c UNORD 3 Unordered
7560 \c NLT 5 Not-less-than
7561 \c NLE 6 Not-less-than-or-equal
7564 For more details of the comparison predicates, and details of how
7565 to emulate the "greater-than" equivalents, see \k{iref-SSE-cc}
7568 \S{insCMPSB} \i\c{CMPSB}, \i\c{CMPSW}, \i\c{CMPSD}: Compare Strings
7570 \c CMPSB ; A6 [8086]
7571 \c CMPSW ; o16 A7 [8086]
7572 \c CMPSD ; o32 A7 [386]
7574 \c{CMPSB} compares the byte at \c{[DS:SI]} or \c{[DS:ESI]} with the
7575 byte at \c{[ES:DI]} or \c{[ES:EDI]}, and sets the flags accordingly.
7576 It then increments or decrements (depending on the direction flag:
7577 increments if the flag is clear, decrements if it is set) \c{SI} and
7578 \c{DI} (or \c{ESI} and \c{EDI}).
7580 The registers used are \c{SI} and \c{DI} if the address size is 16
7581 bits, and \c{ESI} and \c{EDI} if it is 32 bits. If you need to use
7582 an address size not equal to the current \c{BITS} setting, you can
7583 use an explicit \i\c{a16} or \i\c{a32} prefix.
7585 The segment register used to load from \c{[SI]} or \c{[ESI]} can be
7586 overridden by using a segment register name as a prefix (for
7587 example, \c{ES CMPSB}). The use of \c{ES} for the load from \c{[DI]}
7588 or \c{[EDI]} cannot be overridden.
7590 \c{CMPSW} and \c{CMPSD} work in the same way, but they compare a
7591 word or a doubleword instead of a byte, and increment or decrement
7592 the addressing registers by 2 or 4 instead of 1.
7594 The \c{REPE} and \c{REPNE} prefixes (equivalently, \c{REPZ} and
7595 \c{REPNZ}) may be used to repeat the instruction up to \c{CX} (or
7596 \c{ECX} - again, the address size chooses which) times until the
7597 first unequal or equal byte is found.
7600 \S{insCMPccSD} \i\c{CMPccSD}: Scalar Double-Precision FP Compare
7601 \I\c{CMPEQSD} \I\c{CMPLTSD} \I\c{CMPLESD} \I\c{CMPUNORDSD}
7602 \I\c{CMPNEQSD} \I\c{CMPNLTSD} \I\c{CMPNLESD} \I\c{CMPORDSD}
7604 \c CMPSD xmm1,xmm2/mem64,imm8 ; F2 0F C2 /r ib [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7606 \c CMPEQSD xmm1,xmm2/mem64 ; F2 0F C2 /r 00 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7607 \c CMPLTSD xmm1,xmm2/mem64 ; F2 0F C2 /r 01 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7608 \c CMPLESD xmm1,xmm2/mem64 ; F2 0F C2 /r 02 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7609 \c CMPUNORDSD xmm1,xmm2/mem64 ; F2 0F C2 /r 03 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7610 \c CMPNEQSD xmm1,xmm2/mem64 ; F2 0F C2 /r 04 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7611 \c CMPNLTSD xmm1,xmm2/mem64 ; F2 0F C2 /r 05 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7612 \c CMPNLESD xmm1,xmm2/mem64 ; F2 0F C2 /r 06 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7613 \c CMPORDSD xmm1,xmm2/mem64 ; F2 0F C2 /r 07 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7615 The \c{CMPccSD} instructions compare the low-order double-precision
7616 FP values in the source and destination operands, and returns the
7617 result of the comparison in the destination register. The result of
7618 each comparison is a quadword mask of all 1s (comparison true) or
7619 all 0s (comparison false).
7621 The destination is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be either an
7622 \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
7624 The third operand is an 8-bit immediate value, of which the low 3
7625 bits define the type of comparison. For ease of programming, the
7626 8 two-operand pseudo-instructions are provided, with the third
7627 operand already filled in. The \I{Condition Predicates}
7628 \c{Condition Predicates} are:
7632 \c LE 2 Less-than-or-equal
7633 \c UNORD 3 Unordered
7635 \c NLT 5 Not-less-than
7636 \c NLE 6 Not-less-than-or-equal
7639 For more details of the comparison predicates, and details of how
7640 to emulate the "greater-than" equivalents, see \k{iref-SSE-cc}
7643 \S{insCMPccSS} \i\c{CMPccSS}: Scalar Single-Precision FP Compare
7644 \I\c{CMPEQSS} \I\c{CMPLTSS} \I\c{CMPLESS} \I\c{CMPUNORDSS}
7645 \I\c{CMPNEQSS} \I\c{CMPNLTSS} \I\c{CMPNLESS} \I\c{CMPORDSS}
7647 \c CMPSS xmm1,xmm2/mem32,imm8 ; F3 0F C2 /r ib [KATMAI,SSE]
7649 \c CMPEQSS xmm1,xmm2/mem32 ; F3 0F C2 /r 00 [KATMAI,SSE]
7650 \c CMPLTSS xmm1,xmm2/mem32 ; F3 0F C2 /r 01 [KATMAI,SSE]
7651 \c CMPLESS xmm1,xmm2/mem32 ; F3 0F C2 /r 02 [KATMAI,SSE]
7652 \c CMPUNORDSS xmm1,xmm2/mem32 ; F3 0F C2 /r 03 [KATMAI,SSE]
7653 \c CMPNEQSS xmm1,xmm2/mem32 ; F3 0F C2 /r 04 [KATMAI,SSE]
7654 \c CMPNLTSS xmm1,xmm2/mem32 ; F3 0F C2 /r 05 [KATMAI,SSE]
7655 \c CMPNLESS xmm1,xmm2/mem32 ; F3 0F C2 /r 06 [KATMAI,SSE]
7656 \c CMPORDSS xmm1,xmm2/mem32 ; F3 0F C2 /r 07 [KATMAI,SSE]
7658 The \c{CMPccSS} instructions compare the low-order single-precision
7659 FP values in the source and destination operands, and returns the
7660 result of the comparison in the destination register. The result of
7661 each comparison is a doubleword mask of all 1s (comparison true) or
7662 all 0s (comparison false).
7664 The destination is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be either an
7665 \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
7667 The third operand is an 8-bit immediate value, of which the low 3
7668 bits define the type of comparison. For ease of programming, the
7669 8 two-operand pseudo-instructions are provided, with the third
7670 operand already filled in. The \I{Condition Predicates}
7671 \c{Condition Predicates} are:
7675 \c LE 2 Less-than-or-equal
7676 \c UNORD 3 Unordered
7678 \c NLT 5 Not-less-than
7679 \c NLE 6 Not-less-than-or-equal
7682 For more details of the comparison predicates, and details of how
7683 to emulate the "greater-than" equivalents, see \k{iref-SSE-cc}
7686 \S{insCMPXCHG} \i\c{CMPXCHG}, \i\c{CMPXCHG486}: Compare and Exchange
7688 \c CMPXCHG r/m8,reg8 ; 0F B0 /r [PENT]
7689 \c CMPXCHG r/m16,reg16 ; o16 0F B1 /r [PENT]
7690 \c CMPXCHG r/m32,reg32 ; o32 0F B1 /r [PENT]
7692 \c CMPXCHG486 r/m8,reg8 ; 0F A6 /r [486,UNDOC]
7693 \c CMPXCHG486 r/m16,reg16 ; o16 0F A7 /r [486,UNDOC]
7694 \c CMPXCHG486 r/m32,reg32 ; o32 0F A7 /r [486,UNDOC]
7696 These two instructions perform exactly the same operation; however,
7697 apparently some (not all) 486 processors support it under a
7698 non-standard opcode, so NASM provides the undocumented
7699 \c{CMPXCHG486} form to generate the non-standard opcode.
7701 \c{CMPXCHG} compares its destination (first) operand to the value in
7702 \c{AL}, \c{AX} or \c{EAX} (depending on the operand size of the
7703 instruction). If they are equal, it copies its source (second)
7704 operand into the destination and sets the zero flag. Otherwise, it
7705 clears the zero flag and copies the destination register to AL, AX or EAX.
7707 The destination can be either a register or a memory location. The
7708 source is a register.
7710 \c{CMPXCHG} is intended to be used for atomic operations in
7711 multitasking or multiprocessor environments. To safely update a
7712 value in shared memory, for example, you might load the value into
7713 \c{EAX}, load the updated value into \c{EBX}, and then execute the
7714 instruction \c{LOCK CMPXCHG [value],EBX}. If \c{value} has not
7715 changed since being loaded, it is updated with your desired new
7716 value, and the zero flag is set to let you know it has worked. (The
7717 \c{LOCK} prefix prevents another processor doing anything in the
7718 middle of this operation: it guarantees atomicity.) However, if
7719 another processor has modified the value in between your load and
7720 your attempted store, the store does not happen, and you are
7721 notified of the failure by a cleared zero flag, so you can go round
7725 \S{insCMPXCHG8B} \i\c{CMPXCHG8B}: Compare and Exchange Eight Bytes
7727 \c CMPXCHG8B mem ; 0F C7 /1 [PENT]
7729 This is a larger and more unwieldy version of \c{CMPXCHG}: it
7730 compares the 64-bit (eight-byte) value stored at \c{[mem]} with the
7731 value in \c{EDX:EAX}. If they are equal, it sets the zero flag and
7732 stores \c{ECX:EBX} into the memory area. If they are unequal, it
7733 clears the zero flag and stores the memory contents into \c{EDX:EAX}.
7735 \c{CMPXCHG8B} can be used with the \c{LOCK} prefix, to allow atomic
7736 execution. This is useful in multi-processor and multi-tasking
7740 \S{insCOMISD} \i\c{COMISD}: Scalar Ordered Double-Precision FP Compare and Set EFLAGS
7742 \c COMISD xmm1,xmm2/mem64 ; 66 0F 2F /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7744 \c{COMISD} compares the low-order double-precision FP value in the
7745 two source operands. ZF, PF and CF are set according to the result.
7746 OF, AF and AF are cleared. The unordered result is returned if either
7747 source is a NaN (QNaN or SNaN).
7749 The destination operand is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be either
7750 an \c{XMM} register or a memory location.
7752 The flags are set according to the following rules:
7754 \c Result Flags Values
7756 \c UNORDERED: ZF,PF,CF <-- 111;
7757 \c GREATER_THAN: ZF,PF,CF <-- 000;
7758 \c LESS_THAN: ZF,PF,CF <-- 001;
7759 \c EQUAL: ZF,PF,CF <-- 100;
7762 \S{insCOMISS} \i\c{COMISS}: Scalar Ordered Single-Precision FP Compare and Set EFLAGS
7764 \c COMISS xmm1,xmm2/mem32 ; 66 0F 2F /r [KATMAI,SSE]
7766 \c{COMISS} compares the low-order single-precision FP value in the
7767 two source operands. ZF, PF and CF are set according to the result.
7768 OF, AF and AF are cleared. The unordered result is returned if either
7769 source is a NaN (QNaN or SNaN).
7771 The destination operand is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be either
7772 an \c{XMM} register or a memory location.
7774 The flags are set according to the following rules:
7776 \c Result Flags Values
7778 \c UNORDERED: ZF,PF,CF <-- 111;
7779 \c GREATER_THAN: ZF,PF,CF <-- 000;
7780 \c LESS_THAN: ZF,PF,CF <-- 001;
7781 \c EQUAL: ZF,PF,CF <-- 100;
7784 \S{insCPUID} \i\c{CPUID}: Get CPU Identification Code
7786 \c CPUID ; 0F A2 [PENT]
7788 \c{CPUID} returns various information about the processor it is
7789 being executed on. It fills the four registers \c{EAX}, \c{EBX},
7790 \c{ECX} and \c{EDX} with information, which varies depending on the
7791 input contents of \c{EAX}.
7793 \c{CPUID} also acts as a barrier to serialise instruction execution:
7794 executing the \c{CPUID} instruction guarantees that all the effects
7795 (memory modification, flag modification, register modification) of
7796 previous instructions have been completed before the next
7797 instruction gets fetched.
7799 The information returned is as follows:
7801 \b If \c{EAX} is zero on input, \c{EAX} on output holds the maximum
7802 acceptable input value of \c{EAX}, and \c{EBX:EDX:ECX} contain the
7803 string \c{"GenuineIntel"} (or not, if you have a clone processor).
7804 That is to say, \c{EBX} contains \c{"Genu"} (in NASM's own sense of
7805 character constants, described in \k{chrconst}), \c{EDX} contains
7806 \c{"ineI"} and \c{ECX} contains \c{"ntel"}.
7808 \b If \c{EAX} is one on input, \c{EAX} on output contains version
7809 information about the processor, and \c{EDX} contains a set of
7810 feature flags, showing the presence and absence of various features.
7811 For example, bit 8 is set if the \c{CMPXCHG8B} instruction
7812 (\k{insCMPXCHG8B}) is supported, bit 15 is set if the conditional
7813 move instructions (\k{insCMOVcc} and \k{insFCMOVB}) are supported,
7814 and bit 23 is set if \c{MMX} instructions are supported.
7816 \b If \c{EAX} is two on input, \c{EAX}, \c{EBX}, \c{ECX} and \c{EDX}
7817 all contain information about caches and TLBs (Translation Lookahead
7820 For more information on the data returned from \c{CPUID}, see the
7821 documentation from Intel and other processor manufacturers.
7824 \S{insCVTDQ2PD} \i\c{CVTDQ2PD}:
7825 Packed Signed INT32 to Packed Double-Precision FP Conversion
7827 \c CVTDQ2PD xmm1,xmm2/mem64 ; F3 0F E6 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7829 \c{CVTDQ2PD} converts two packed signed doublewords from the source
7830 operand to two packed double-precision FP values in the destination
7833 The destination operand is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be
7834 either an \c{XMM} register or a 64-bit memory location. If the
7835 source is a register, the packed integers are in the low quadword.
7838 \S{insCVTDQ2PS} \i\c{CVTDQ2PS}:
7839 Packed Signed INT32 to Packed Single-Precision FP Conversion
7841 \c CVTDQ2PS xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 0F 5B /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7843 \c{CVTDQ2PS} converts four packed signed doublewords from the source
7844 operand to four packed single-precision FP values in the destination
7847 The destination operand is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be
7848 either an \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
7850 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
7853 \S{insCVTPD2DQ} \i\c{CVTPD2DQ}:
7854 Packed Double-Precision FP to Packed Signed INT32 Conversion
7856 \c CVTPD2DQ xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; F2 0F E6 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7858 \c{CVTPD2DQ} converts two packed double-precision FP values from the
7859 source operand to two packed signed doublewords in the low quadword
7860 of the destination operand. The high quadword of the destination is
7863 The destination operand is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be
7864 either an \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
7866 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
7869 \S{insCVTPD2PI} \i\c{CVTPD2PI}:
7870 Packed Double-Precision FP to Packed Signed INT32 Conversion
7872 \c CVTPD2PI mm,xmm/mem128 ; 66 0F 2D /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7874 \c{CVTPD2PI} converts two packed double-precision FP values from the
7875 source operand to two packed signed doublewords in the destination
7878 The destination operand is an \c{MMX} register. The source can be
7879 either an \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
7881 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
7884 \S{insCVTPD2PS} \i\c{CVTPD2PS}:
7885 Packed Double-Precision FP to Packed Single-Precision FP Conversion
7887 \c CVTPD2PS xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 66 0F 5A /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7889 \c{CVTPD2PS} converts two packed double-precision FP values from the
7890 source operand to two packed single-precision FP values in the low
7891 quadword of the destination operand. The high quadword of the
7892 destination is set to all 0s.
7894 The destination operand is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be
7895 either an \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
7897 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
7900 \S{insCVTPI2PD} \i\c{CVTPI2PD}:
7901 Packed Signed INT32 to Packed Double-Precision FP Conversion
7903 \c CVTPI2PD xmm,mm/mem64 ; 66 0F 2A /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7905 \c{CVTPI2PD} converts two packed signed doublewords from the source
7906 operand to two packed double-precision FP values in the destination
7909 The destination operand is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be
7910 either an \c{MMX} register or a 64-bit memory location.
7912 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
7915 \S{insCVTPI2PS} \i\c{CVTPI2PS}:
7916 Packed Signed INT32 to Packed Single-FP Conversion
7918 \c CVTPI2PS xmm,mm/mem64 ; 0F 2A /r [KATMAI,SSE]
7920 \c{CVTPI2PS} converts two packed signed doublewords from the source
7921 operand to two packed single-precision FP values in the low quadword
7922 of the destination operand. The high quadword of the destination
7925 The destination operand is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be
7926 either an \c{MMX} register or a 64-bit memory location.
7928 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
7931 \S{insCVTPS2DQ} \i\c{CVTPS2DQ}:
7932 Packed Single-Precision FP to Packed Signed INT32 Conversion
7934 \c CVTPS2DQ xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 66 0F 5B /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7936 \c{CVTPS2DQ} converts four packed single-precision FP values from the
7937 source operand to four packed signed doublewords in the destination operand.
7939 The destination operand is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be
7940 either an \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
7942 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
7945 \S{insCVTPS2PD} \i\c{CVTPS2PD}:
7946 Packed Single-Precision FP to Packed Double-Precision FP Conversion
7948 \c CVTPS2PD xmm1,xmm2/mem64 ; 0F 5A /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7950 \c{CVTPS2PD} converts two packed single-precision FP values from the
7951 source operand to two packed double-precision FP values in the destination
7954 The destination operand is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be
7955 either an \c{XMM} register or a 64-bit memory location. If the source
7956 is a register, the input values are in the low quadword.
7958 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
7961 \S{insCVTPS2PI} \i\c{CVTPS2PI}:
7962 Packed Single-Precision FP to Packed Signed INT32 Conversion
7964 \c CVTPS2PI mm,xmm/mem64 ; 0F 2D /r [KATMAI,SSE]
7966 \c{CVTPS2PI} converts two packed single-precision FP values from
7967 the source operand to two packed signed doublewords in the destination
7970 The destination operand is an \c{MMX} register. The source can be
7971 either an \c{XMM} register or a 64-bit memory location. If the
7972 source is a register, the input values are in the low quadword.
7974 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
7977 \S{insCVTSD2SI} \i\c{CVTSD2SI}:
7978 Scalar Double-Precision FP to Signed INT32 Conversion
7980 \c CVTSD2SI reg32,xmm/mem64 ; F2 0F 2D /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7982 \c{CVTSD2SI} converts a double-precision FP value from the source
7983 operand to a signed doubleword in the destination operand.
7985 The destination operand is a general purpose register. The source can be
7986 either an \c{XMM} register or a 64-bit memory location. If the
7987 source is a register, the input value is in the low quadword.
7989 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
7992 \S{insCVTSD2SS} \i\c{CVTSD2SS}:
7993 Scalar Double-Precision FP to Scalar Single-Precision FP Conversion
7995 \c CVTSD2SS xmm1,xmm2/mem64 ; F2 0F 5A /r [KATMAI,SSE]
7997 \c{CVTSD2SS} converts a double-precision FP value from the source
7998 operand to a single-precision FP value in the low doubleword of the
7999 destination operand. The upper 3 doublewords are left unchanged.
8001 The destination operand is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be
8002 either an \c{XMM} register or a 64-bit memory location. If the
8003 source is a register, the input value is in the low quadword.
8005 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
8008 \S{insCVTSI2SD} \i\c{CVTSI2SD}:
8009 Signed INT32 to Scalar Double-Precision FP Conversion
8011 \c CVTSI2SD xmm,r/m32 ; F2 0F 2A /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
8013 \c{CVTSI2SD} converts a signed doubleword from the source operand to
8014 a double-precision FP value in the low quadword of the destination
8015 operand. The high quadword is left unchanged.
8017 The destination operand is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be either
8018 a general purpose register or a 32-bit memory location.
8020 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
8023 \S{insCVTSI2SS} \i\c{CVTSI2SS}:
8024 Signed INT32 to Scalar Single-Precision FP Conversion
8026 \c CVTSI2SS xmm,r/m32 ; F3 0F 2A /r [KATMAI,SSE]
8028 \c{CVTSI2SS} converts a signed doubleword from the source operand to a
8029 single-precision FP value in the low doubleword of the destination operand.
8030 The upper 3 doublewords are left unchanged.
8032 The destination operand is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be either
8033 a general purpose register or a 32-bit memory location.
8035 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
8038 \S{insCVTSS2SD} \i\c{CVTSS2SD}:
8039 Scalar Single-Precision FP to Scalar Double-Precision FP Conversion
8041 \c CVTSS2SD xmm1,xmm2/mem32 ; F3 0F 5A /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
8043 \c{CVTSS2SD} converts a single-precision FP value from the source operand
8044 to a double-precision FP value in the low quadword of the destination
8045 operand. The upper quadword is left unchanged.
8047 The destination operand is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be either
8048 an \c{XMM} register or a 32-bit memory location. If the source is a
8049 register, the input value is contained in the low doubleword.
8051 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
8054 \S{insCVTSS2SI} \i\c{CVTSS2SI}:
8055 Scalar Single-Precision FP to Signed INT32 Conversion
8057 \c CVTSS2SI reg32,xmm/mem32 ; F3 0F 2D /r [KATMAI,SSE]
8059 \c{CVTSS2SI} converts a single-precision FP value from the source
8060 operand to a signed doubleword in the destination operand.
8062 The destination operand is a general purpose register. The source can be
8063 either an \c{XMM} register or a 32-bit memory location. If the
8064 source is a register, the input value is in the low doubleword.
8066 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
8069 \S{insCVTTPD2DQ} \i\c{CVTTPD2DQ}:
8070 Packed Double-Precision FP to Packed Signed INT32 Conversion with Truncation
8072 \c CVTTPD2DQ xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 66 0F E6 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
8074 \c{CVTTPD2DQ} converts two packed double-precision FP values in the source
8075 operand to two packed single-precision FP values in the destination operand.
8076 If the result is inexact, it is truncated (rounded toward zero). The high
8077 quadword is set to all 0s.
8079 The destination operand is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be
8080 either an \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
8082 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
8085 \S{insCVTTPD2PI} \i\c{CVTTPD2PI}:
8086 Packed Double-Precision FP to Packed Signed INT32 Conversion with Truncation
8088 \c CVTTPD2PI mm,xmm/mem128 ; 66 0F 2C /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
8090 \c{CVTTPD2PI} converts two packed double-precision FP values in the source
8091 operand to two packed single-precision FP values in the destination operand.
8092 If the result is inexact, it is truncated (rounded toward zero).
8094 The destination operand is an \c{MMX} register. The source can be
8095 either an \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
8097 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
8100 \S{insCVTTPS2DQ} \i\c{CVTTPS2DQ}:
8101 Packed Single-Precision FP to Packed Signed INT32 Conversion with Truncation
8103 \c CVTTPS2DQ xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; F3 0F 5B /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
8105 \c{CVTTPS2DQ} converts four packed single-precision FP values in the source
8106 operand to four packed signed doublewords in the destination operand.
8107 If the result is inexact, it is truncated (rounded toward zero).
8109 The destination operand is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be
8110 either an \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
8112 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
8115 \S{insCVTTPS2PI} \i\c{CVTTPS2PI}:
8116 Packed Single-Precision FP to Packed Signed INT32 Conversion with Truncation
8118 \c CVTTPS2PI mm,xmm/mem64 ; 0F 2C /r [KATMAI,SSE]
8120 \c{CVTTPS2PI} converts two packed single-precision FP values in the source
8121 operand to two packed signed doublewords in the destination operand.
8122 If the result is inexact, it is truncated (rounded toward zero). If
8123 the source is a register, the input values are in the low quadword.
8125 The destination operand is an \c{MMX} register. The source can be
8126 either an \c{XMM} register or a 64-bit memory location. If the source
8127 is a register, the input value is in the low quadword.
8129 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
8132 \S{insCVTTSD2SI} \i\c{CVTTSD2SI}:
8133 Scalar Double-Precision FP to Signed INT32 Conversion with Truncation
8135 \c CVTTSD2SI reg32,xmm/mem64 ; F2 0F 2C /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
8137 \c{CVTTSD2SI} converts a double-precision FP value in the source operand
8138 to a signed doubleword in the destination operand. If the result is
8139 inexact, it is truncated (rounded toward zero).
8141 The destination operand is a general purpose register. The source can be
8142 either an \c{XMM} register or a 64-bit memory location. If the source is a
8143 register, the input value is in the low quadword.
8145 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
8148 \S{insCVTTSS2SI} \i\c{CVTTSS2SI}:
8149 Scalar Single-Precision FP to Signed INT32 Conversion with Truncation
8151 \c CVTTSD2SI reg32,xmm/mem32 ; F3 0F 2C /r [KATMAI,SSE]
8153 \c{CVTTSS2SI} converts a single-precision FP value in the source operand
8154 to a signed doubleword in the destination operand. If the result is
8155 inexact, it is truncated (rounded toward zero).
8157 The destination operand is a general purpose register. The source can be
8158 either an \c{XMM} register or a 32-bit memory location. If the source is a
8159 register, the input value is in the low doubleword.
8161 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
8164 \S{insDAA} \i\c{DAA}, \i\c{DAS}: Decimal Adjustments
8169 These instructions are used in conjunction with the add and subtract
8170 instructions to perform binary-coded decimal arithmetic in
8171 \e{packed} (one BCD digit per nibble) form. For the unpacked
8172 equivalents, see \k{insAAA}.
8174 \c{DAA} should be used after a one-byte \c{ADD} instruction whose
8175 destination was the \c{AL} register: by means of examining the value
8176 in the \c{AL} and also the auxiliary carry flag \c{AF}, it
8177 determines whether either digit of the addition has overflowed, and
8178 adjusts it (and sets the carry and auxiliary-carry flags) if so. You
8179 can add long BCD strings together by doing \c{ADD}/\c{DAA} on the
8180 low two digits, then doing \c{ADC}/\c{DAA} on each subsequent pair
8183 \c{DAS} works similarly to \c{DAA}, but is for use after \c{SUB}
8184 instructions rather than \c{ADD}.
8187 \S{insDEC} \i\c{DEC}: Decrement Integer
8189 \c DEC reg16 ; o16 48+r [8086]
8190 \c DEC reg32 ; o32 48+r [386]
8191 \c DEC r/m8 ; FE /1 [8086]
8192 \c DEC r/m16 ; o16 FF /1 [8086]
8193 \c DEC r/m32 ; o32 FF /1 [386]
8195 \c{DEC} subtracts 1 from its operand. It does \e{not} affect the
8196 carry flag: to affect the carry flag, use \c{SUB something,1} (see
8197 \k{insSUB}). \c{DEC} affects all the other flags according to the result.
8199 This instruction can be used with a \c{LOCK} prefix to allow atomic
8202 See also \c{INC} (\k{insINC}).
8205 \S{insDIV} \i\c{DIV}: Unsigned Integer Divide
8207 \c DIV r/m8 ; F6 /6 [8086]
8208 \c DIV r/m16 ; o16 F7 /6 [8086]
8209 \c DIV r/m32 ; o32 F7 /6 [386]
8211 \c{DIV} performs unsigned integer division. The explicit operand
8212 provided is the divisor; the dividend and destination operands are
8213 implicit, in the following way:
8215 \b For \c{DIV r/m8}, \c{AX} is divided by the given operand; the
8216 quotient is stored in \c{AL} and the remainder in \c{AH}.
8218 \b For \c{DIV r/m16}, \c{DX:AX} is divided by the given operand; the
8219 quotient is stored in \c{AX} and the remainder in \c{DX}.
8221 \b For \c{DIV r/m32}, \c{EDX:EAX} is divided by the given operand;
8222 the quotient is stored in \c{EAX} and the remainder in \c{EDX}.
8224 Signed integer division is performed by the \c{IDIV} instruction:
8228 \S{insDIVPD} \i\c{DIVPD}: Packed Double-Precision FP Divide
8230 \c DIVPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 66 0F 5E /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
8232 \c{DIVPD} divides the two packed double-precision FP values in
8233 the destination operand by the two packed double-precision FP
8234 values in the source operand, and stores the packed double-precision
8235 results in the destination register.
8237 The destination is an \c{XMM} register. The source operand can be
8238 either an \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
8240 \c dst[0-63] := dst[0-63] / src[0-63],
8241 \c dst[64-127] := dst[64-127] / src[64-127].
8244 \S{insDIVPS} \i\c{DIVPS}: Packed Single-Precision FP Divide
8246 \c DIVPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 0F 5E /r [KATMAI,SSE]
8248 \c{DIVPS} divides the four packed single-precision FP values in
8249 the destination operand by the four packed single-precision FP
8250 values in the source operand, and stores the packed single-precision
8251 results in the destination register.
8253 The destination is an \c{XMM} register. The source operand can be
8254 either an \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
8256 \c dst[0-31] := dst[0-31] / src[0-31],
8257 \c dst[32-63] := dst[32-63] / src[32-63],
8258 \c dst[64-95] := dst[64-95] / src[64-95],
8259 \c dst[96-127] := dst[96-127] / src[96-127].
8262 \S{insDIVSD} \i\c{DIVSD}: Scalar Double-Precision FP Divide
8264 \c DIVSD xmm1,xmm2/mem64 ; F2 0F 5E /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
8266 \c{DIVSD} divides the low-order double-precision FP value in the
8267 destination operand by the low-order double-precision FP value in
8268 the source operand, and stores the double-precision result in the
8269 destination register.
8271 The destination is an \c{XMM} register. The source operand can be
8272 either an \c{XMM} register or a 64-bit memory location.
8274 \c dst[0-63] := dst[0-63] / src[0-63],
8275 \c dst[64-127] remains unchanged.
8278 \S{insDIVSS} \i\c{DIVSS}: Scalar Single-Precision FP Divide
8280 \c DIVSS xmm1,xmm2/mem32 ; F3 0F 5E /r [KATMAI,SSE]
8282 \c{DIVSS} divides the low-order single-precision FP value in the
8283 destination operand by the low-order single-precision FP value in
8284 the source operand, and stores the single-precision result in the
8285 destination register.
8287 The destination is an \c{XMM} register. The source operand can be
8288 either an \c{XMM} register or a 32-bit memory location.
8290 \c dst[0-31] := dst[0-31] / src[0-31],
8291 \c dst[32-127] remains unchanged.
8294 \S{insEMMS} \i\c{EMMS}: Empty MMX State
8296 \c EMMS ; 0F 77 [PENT,MMX]
8298 \c{EMMS} sets the FPU tag word (marking which floating-point registers
8299 are available) to all ones, meaning all registers are available for
8300 the FPU to use. It should be used after executing \c{MMX} instructions
8301 and before executing any subsequent floating-point operations.
8304 \S{insENTER} \i\c{ENTER}: Create Stack Frame
8306 \c ENTER imm,imm ; C8 iw ib [186]
8308 \c{ENTER} constructs a \i\c{stack frame} for a high-level language
8309 procedure call. The first operand (the \c{iw} in the opcode
8310 definition above refers to the first operand) gives the amount of
8311 stack space to allocate for local variables; the second (the \c{ib}
8312 above) gives the nesting level of the procedure (for languages like
8313 Pascal, with nested procedures).
8315 The function of \c{ENTER}, with a nesting level of zero, is
8318 \c PUSH EBP ; or PUSH BP in 16 bits
8319 \c MOV EBP,ESP ; or MOV BP,SP in 16 bits
8320 \c SUB ESP,operand1 ; or SUB SP,operand1 in 16 bits
8322 This creates a stack frame with the procedure parameters accessible
8323 upwards from \c{EBP}, and local variables accessible downwards from
8326 With a nesting level of one, the stack frame created is 4 (or 2)
8327 bytes bigger, and the value of the final frame pointer \c{EBP} is
8328 accessible in memory at \c{[EBP-4]}.
8330 This allows \c{ENTER}, when called with a nesting level of two, to
8331 look at the stack frame described by the \e{previous} value of
8332 \c{EBP}, find the frame pointer at offset -4 from that, and push it
8333 along with its new frame pointer, so that when a level-two procedure
8334 is called from within a level-one procedure, \c{[EBP-4]} holds the
8335 frame pointer of the most recent level-one procedure call and
8336 \c{[EBP-8]} holds that of the most recent level-two call. And so on,
8337 for nesting levels up to 31.
8339 Stack frames created by \c{ENTER} can be destroyed by the \c{LEAVE}
8340 instruction: see \k{insLEAVE}.
8343 \S{insF2XM1} \i\c{F2XM1}: Calculate 2**X-1
8345 \c F2XM1 ; D9 F0 [8086,FPU]
8347 \c{F2XM1} raises 2 to the power of \c{ST0}, subtracts one, and
8348 stores the result back into \c{ST0}. The initial contents of \c{ST0}
8349 must be a number in the range -1.0 to +1.0.
8352 \S{insFABS} \i\c{FABS}: Floating-Point Absolute Value
8354 \c FABS ; D9 E1 [8086,FPU]
8356 \c{FABS} computes the absolute value of \c{ST0},by clearing the sign
8357 bit, and stores the result back in \c{ST0}.
8360 \S{insFADD} \i\c{FADD}, \i\c{FADDP}: Floating-Point Addition
8362 \c FADD mem32 ; D8 /0 [8086,FPU]
8363 \c FADD mem64 ; DC /0 [8086,FPU]
8365 \c FADD fpureg ; D8 C0+r [8086,FPU]
8366 \c FADD ST0,fpureg ; D8 C0+r [8086,FPU]
8368 \c FADD TO fpureg ; DC C0+r [8086,FPU]
8369 \c FADD fpureg,ST0 ; DC C0+r [8086,FPU]
8371 \c FADDP fpureg ; DE C0+r [8086,FPU]
8372 \c FADDP fpureg,ST0 ; DE C0+r [8086,FPU]
8374 \b \c{FADD}, given one operand, adds the operand to \c{ST0} and stores
8375 the result back in \c{ST0}. If the operand has the \c{TO} modifier,
8376 the result is stored in the register given rather than in \c{ST0}.
8378 \b \c{FADDP} performs the same function as \c{FADD TO}, but pops the
8379 register stack after storing the result.
8381 The given two-operand forms are synonyms for the one-operand forms.
8383 To add an integer value to \c{ST0}, use the c{FIADD} instruction
8387 \S{insFBLD} \i\c{FBLD}, \i\c{FBSTP}: BCD Floating-Point Load and Store
8389 \c FBLD mem80 ; DF /4 [8086,FPU]
8390 \c FBSTP mem80 ; DF /6 [8086,FPU]
8392 \c{FBLD} loads an 80-bit (ten-byte) packed binary-coded decimal
8393 number from the given memory address, converts it to a real, and
8394 pushes it on the register stack. \c{FBSTP} stores the value of
8395 \c{ST0}, in packed BCD, at the given address and then pops the
8399 \S{insFCHS} \i\c{FCHS}: Floating-Point Change Sign
8401 \c FCHS ; D9 E0 [8086,FPU]
8403 \c{FCHS} negates the number in \c{ST0}, by inverting the sign bit:
8404 negative numbers become positive, and vice versa.
8407 \S{insFCLEX} \i\c{FCLEX}, \c{FNCLEX}: Clear Floating-Point Exceptions
8409 \c FCLEX ; 9B DB E2 [8086,FPU]
8410 \c FNCLEX ; DB E2 [8086,FPU]
8412 \c{FCLEX} clears any floating-point exceptions which may be pending.
8413 \c{FNCLEX} does the same thing but doesn't wait for previous
8414 floating-point operations (including the \e{handling} of pending
8415 exceptions) to finish first.
8418 \S{insFCMOVB} \i\c{FCMOVcc}: Floating-Point Conditional Move
8420 \c FCMOVB fpureg ; DA C0+r [P6,FPU]
8421 \c FCMOVB ST0,fpureg ; DA C0+r [P6,FPU]
8423 \c FCMOVE fpureg ; DA C8+r [P6,FPU]
8424 \c FCMOVE ST0,fpureg ; DA C8+r [P6,FPU]
8426 \c FCMOVBE fpureg ; DA D0+r [P6,FPU]
8427 \c FCMOVBE ST0,fpureg ; DA D0+r [P6,FPU]
8429 \c FCMOVU fpureg ; DA D8+r [P6,FPU]
8430 \c FCMOVU ST0,fpureg ; DA D8+r [P6,FPU]
8432 \c FCMOVNB fpureg ; DB C0+r [P6,FPU]
8433 \c FCMOVNB ST0,fpureg ; DB C0+r [P6,FPU]
8435 \c FCMOVNE fpureg ; DB C8+r [P6,FPU]
8436 \c FCMOVNE ST0,fpureg ; DB C8+r [P6,FPU]
8438 \c FCMOVNBE fpureg ; DB D0+r [P6,FPU]
8439 \c FCMOVNBE ST0,fpureg ; DB D0+r [P6,FPU]
8441 \c FCMOVNU fpureg ; DB D8+r [P6,FPU]
8442 \c FCMOVNU ST0,fpureg ; DB D8+r [P6,FPU]
8444 The \c{FCMOV} instructions perform conditional move operations: each
8445 of them moves the contents of the given register into \c{ST0} if its
8446 condition is satisfied, and does nothing if not.
8448 The conditions are not the same as the standard condition codes used
8449 with conditional jump instructions. The conditions \c{B}, \c{BE},
8450 \c{NB}, \c{NBE}, \c{E} and \c{NE} are exactly as normal, but none of
8451 the other standard ones are supported. Instead, the condition \c{U}
8452 and its counterpart \c{NU} are provided; the \c{U} condition is
8453 satisfied if the last two floating-point numbers compared were
8454 \e{unordered}, i.e. they were not equal but neither one could be
8455 said to be greater than the other, for example if they were NaNs.
8456 (The flag state which signals this is the setting of the parity
8457 flag: so the \c{U} condition is notionally equivalent to \c{PE}, and
8458 \c{NU} is equivalent to \c{PO}.)
8460 The \c{FCMOV} conditions test the main processor's status flags, not
8461 the FPU status flags, so using \c{FCMOV} directly after \c{FCOM}
8462 will not work. Instead, you should either use \c{FCOMI} which writes
8463 directly to the main CPU flags word, or use \c{FSTSW} to extract the
8466 Although the \c{FCMOV} instructions are flagged \c{P6} above, they
8467 may not be supported by all Pentium Pro processors; the \c{CPUID}
8468 instruction (\k{insCPUID}) will return a bit which indicates whether
8469 conditional moves are supported.
8472 \S{insFCOM} \i\c{FCOM}, \i\c{FCOMP}, \i\c{FCOMPP}, \i\c{FCOMI},
8473 \i\c{FCOMIP}: Floating-Point Compare
8475 \c FCOM mem32 ; D8 /2 [8086,FPU]
8476 \c FCOM mem64 ; DC /2 [8086,FPU]
8477 \c FCOM fpureg ; D8 D0+r [8086,FPU]
8478 \c FCOM ST0,fpureg ; D8 D0+r [8086,FPU]
8480 \c FCOMP mem32 ; D8 /3 [8086,FPU]
8481 \c FCOMP mem64 ; DC /3 [8086,FPU]
8482 \c FCOMP fpureg ; D8 D8+r [8086,FPU]
8483 \c FCOMP ST0,fpureg ; D8 D8+r [8086,FPU]
8485 \c FCOMPP ; DE D9 [8086,FPU]
8487 \c FCOMI fpureg ; DB F0+r [P6,FPU]
8488 \c FCOMI ST0,fpureg ; DB F0+r [P6,FPU]
8490 \c FCOMIP fpureg ; DF F0+r [P6,FPU]
8491 \c FCOMIP ST0,fpureg ; DF F0+r [P6,FPU]
8493 \c{FCOM} compares \c{ST0} with the given operand, and sets the FPU
8494 flags accordingly. \c{ST0} is treated as the left-hand side of the
8495 comparison, so that the carry flag is set (for a `less-than' result)
8496 if \c{ST0} is less than the given operand.
8498 \c{FCOMP} does the same as \c{FCOM}, but pops the register stack
8499 afterwards. \c{FCOMPP} compares \c{ST0} with \c{ST1} and then pops
8500 the register stack twice.
8502 \c{FCOMI} and \c{FCOMIP} work like the corresponding forms of
8503 \c{FCOM} and \c{FCOMP}, but write their results directly to the CPU
8504 flags register rather than the FPU status word, so they can be
8505 immediately followed by conditional jump or conditional move
8508 The \c{FCOM} instructions differ from the \c{FUCOM} instructions
8509 (\k{insFUCOM}) only in the way they handle quiet NaNs: \c{FUCOM}
8510 will handle them silently and set the condition code flags to an
8511 `unordered' result, whereas \c{FCOM} will generate an exception.
8514 \S{insFCOS} \i\c{FCOS}: Cosine
8516 \c FCOS ; D9 FF [386,FPU]
8518 \c{FCOS} computes the cosine of \c{ST0} (in radians), and stores the
8519 result in \c{ST0}. The absolute value of \c{ST0} must be less than 2**63.
8521 See also \c{FSINCOS} (\k{insFSIN}).
8524 \S{insFDECSTP} \i\c{FDECSTP}: Decrement Floating-Point Stack Pointer
8526 \c FDECSTP ; D9 F6 [8086,FPU]
8528 \c{FDECSTP} decrements the `top' field in the floating-point status
8529 word. This has the effect of rotating the FPU register stack by one,
8530 as if the contents of \c{ST7} had been pushed on the stack. See also
8531 \c{FINCSTP} (\k{insFINCSTP}).
8534 \S{insFDISI} \i\c{FxDISI}, \i\c{FxENI}: Disable and Enable Floating-Point Interrupts
8536 \c FDISI ; 9B DB E1 [8086,FPU]
8537 \c FNDISI ; DB E1 [8086,FPU]
8539 \c FENI ; 9B DB E0 [8086,FPU]
8540 \c FNENI ; DB E0 [8086,FPU]
8542 \c{FDISI} and \c{FENI} disable and enable floating-point interrupts.
8543 These instructions are only meaningful on original 8087 processors:
8544 the 287 and above treat them as no-operation instructions.
8546 \c{FNDISI} and \c{FNENI} do the same thing as \c{FDISI} and \c{FENI}
8547 respectively, but without waiting for the floating-point processor
8548 to finish what it was doing first.
8551 \S{insFDIV} \i\c{FDIV}, \i\c{FDIVP}, \i\c{FDIVR}, \i\c{FDIVRP}: Floating-Point Division
8553 \c FDIV mem32 ; D8 /6 [8086,FPU]
8554 \c FDIV mem64 ; DC /6 [8086,FPU]
8556 \c FDIV fpureg ; D8 F0+r [8086,FPU]
8557 \c FDIV ST0,fpureg ; D8 F0+r [8086,FPU]
8559 \c FDIV TO fpureg ; DC F8+r [8086,FPU]
8560 \c FDIV fpureg,ST0 ; DC F8+r [8086,FPU]
8562 \c FDIVR mem32 ; D8 /0 [8086,FPU]
8563 \c FDIVR mem64 ; DC /0 [8086,FPU]
8565 \c FDIVR fpureg ; D8 F8+r [8086,FPU]
8566 \c FDIVR ST0,fpureg ; D8 F8+r [8086,FPU]
8568 \c FDIVR TO fpureg ; DC F0+r [8086,FPU]
8569 \c FDIVR fpureg,ST0 ; DC F0+r [8086,FPU]
8571 \c FDIVP fpureg ; DE F8+r [8086,FPU]
8572 \c FDIVP fpureg,ST0 ; DE F8+r [8086,FPU]
8574 \c FDIVRP fpureg ; DE F0+r [8086,FPU]
8575 \c FDIVRP fpureg,ST0 ; DE F0+r [8086,FPU]
8577 \b \c{FDIV} divides \c{ST0} by the given operand and stores the result
8578 back in \c{ST0}, unless the \c{TO} qualifier is given, in which case
8579 it divides the given operand by \c{ST0} and stores the result in the
8582 \b \c{FDIVR} does the same thing, but does the division the other way
8583 up: so if \c{TO} is not given, it divides the given operand by
8584 \c{ST0} and stores the result in \c{ST0}, whereas if \c{TO} is given
8585 it divides \c{ST0} by its operand and stores the result in the
8588 \b \c{FDIVP} operates like \c{FDIV TO}, but pops the register stack
8589 once it has finished.
8591 \b \c{FDIVRP} operates like \c{FDIVR TO}, but pops the register stack
8592 once it has finished.
8594 For FP/Integer divisions, see \c{FIDIV} (\k{insFIDIV}).
8597 \S{insFEMMS} \i\c{FEMMS}: Faster Enter/Exit of the MMX or floating-point state
8599 \c FEMMS ; 0F 0E [PENT,3DNOW]
8601 \c{FEMMS} can be used in place of the \c{EMMS} instruction on
8602 processors which support the 3DNow! instruction set. Following
8603 execution of \c{FEMMS}, the state of the \c{MMX/FP} registers
8604 is undefined, and this allows a faster context switch between
8605 \c{FP} and \c{MMX} instructions. The \c{FEMMS} instruction can
8606 also be used \e{before} executing \c{MMX} instructions
8609 \S{insFFREE} \i\c{FFREE}: Flag Floating-Point Register as Unused
8611 \c FFREE fpureg ; DD C0+r [8086,FPU]
8612 \c FFREEP fpureg ; DF C0+r [286,FPU,UNDOC]
8614 \c{FFREE} marks the given register as being empty.
8616 \c{FFREEP} marks the given register as being empty, and then
8617 pops the register stack.
8620 \S{insFIADD} \i\c{FIADD}: Floating-Point/Integer Addition
8622 \c FIADD mem16 ; DE /0 [8086,FPU]
8623 \c FIADD mem32 ; DA /0 [8086,FPU]
8625 \c{FIADD} adds the 16-bit or 32-bit integer stored in the given
8626 memory location to \c{ST0}, storing the result in \c{ST0}.
8629 \S{insFICOM} \i\c{FICOM}, \i\c{FICOMP}: Floating-Point/Integer Compare
8631 \c FICOM mem16 ; DE /2 [8086,FPU]
8632 \c FICOM mem32 ; DA /2 [8086,FPU]
8634 \c FICOMP mem16 ; DE /3 [8086,FPU]
8635 \c FICOMP mem32 ; DA /3 [8086,FPU]
8637 \c{FICOM} compares \c{ST0} with the 16-bit or 32-bit integer stored
8638 in the given memory location, and sets the FPU flags accordingly.
8639 \c{FICOMP} does the same, but pops the register stack afterwards.
8642 \S{insFIDIV} \i\c{FIDIV}, \i\c{FIDIVR}: Floating-Point/Integer Division
8644 \c FIDIV mem16 ; DE /6 [8086,FPU]
8645 \c FIDIV mem32 ; DA /6 [8086,FPU]
8647 \c FIDIVR mem16 ; DE /7 [8086,FPU]
8648 \c FIDIVR mem32 ; DA /7 [8086,FPU]
8650 \c{FIDIV} divides \c{ST0} by the 16-bit or 32-bit integer stored in
8651 the given memory location, and stores the result in \c{ST0}.
8652 \c{FIDIVR} does the division the other way up: it divides the
8653 integer by \c{ST0}, but still stores the result in \c{ST0}.
8656 \S{insFILD} \i\c{FILD}, \i\c{FIST}, \i\c{FISTP}: Floating-Point/Integer Conversion
8658 \c FILD mem16 ; DF /0 [8086,FPU]
8659 \c FILD mem32 ; DB /0 [8086,FPU]
8660 \c FILD mem64 ; DF /5 [8086,FPU]
8662 \c FIST mem16 ; DF /2 [8086,FPU]
8663 \c FIST mem32 ; DB /2 [8086,FPU]
8665 \c FISTP mem16 ; DF /3 [8086,FPU]
8666 \c FISTP mem32 ; DB /3 [8086,FPU]
8667 \c FISTP mem64 ; DF /7 [8086,FPU]
8669 \c{FILD} loads an integer out of a memory location, converts it to a
8670 real, and pushes it on the FPU register stack. \c{FIST} converts
8671 \c{ST0} to an integer and stores that in memory; \c{FISTP} does the
8672 same as \c{FIST}, but pops the register stack afterwards.
8675 \S{insFIMUL} \i\c{FIMUL}: Floating-Point/Integer Multiplication
8677 \c FIMUL mem16 ; DE /1 [8086,FPU]
8678 \c FIMUL mem32 ; DA /1 [8086,FPU]
8680 \c{FIMUL} multiplies \c{ST0} by the 16-bit or 32-bit integer stored
8681 in the given memory location, and stores the result in \c{ST0}.
8684 \S{insFINCSTP} \i\c{FINCSTP}: Increment Floating-Point Stack Pointer
8686 \c FINCSTP ; D9 F7 [8086,FPU]
8688 \c{FINCSTP} increments the `top' field in the floating-point status
8689 word. This has the effect of rotating the FPU register stack by one,
8690 as if the register stack had been popped; however, unlike the
8691 popping of the stack performed by many FPU instructions, it does not
8692 flag the new \c{ST7} (previously \c{ST0}) as empty. See also
8693 \c{FDECSTP} (\k{insFDECSTP}).
8696 \S{insFINIT} \i\c{FINIT}, \i\c{FNINIT}: Initialise Floating-Point Unit
8698 \c FINIT ; 9B DB E3 [8086,FPU]
8699 \c FNINIT ; DB E3 [8086,FPU]
8701 \c{FINIT} initialises the FPU to its default state. It flags all
8702 registers as empty, without actually change their values, clears
8703 the top of stack pointer. \c{FNINIT} does the same, without first
8704 waiting for pending exceptions to clear.
8707 \S{insFISUB} \i\c{FISUB}: Floating-Point/Integer Subtraction
8709 \c FISUB mem16 ; DE /4 [8086,FPU]
8710 \c FISUB mem32 ; DA /4 [8086,FPU]
8712 \c FISUBR mem16 ; DE /5 [8086,FPU]
8713 \c FISUBR mem32 ; DA /5 [8086,FPU]
8715 \c{FISUB} subtracts the 16-bit or 32-bit integer stored in the given
8716 memory location from \c{ST0}, and stores the result in \c{ST0}.
8717 \c{FISUBR} does the subtraction the other way round, i.e. it
8718 subtracts \c{ST0} from the given integer, but still stores the
8722 \S{insFLD} \i\c{FLD}: Floating-Point Load
8724 \c FLD mem32 ; D9 /0 [8086,FPU]
8725 \c FLD mem64 ; DD /0 [8086,FPU]
8726 \c FLD mem80 ; DB /5 [8086,FPU]
8727 \c FLD fpureg ; D9 C0+r [8086,FPU]
8729 \c{FLD} loads a floating-point value out of the given register or
8730 memory location, and pushes it on the FPU register stack.
8733 \S{insFLD1} \i\c{FLDxx}: Floating-Point Load Constants
8735 \c FLD1 ; D9 E8 [8086,FPU]
8736 \c FLDL2E ; D9 EA [8086,FPU]
8737 \c FLDL2T ; D9 E9 [8086,FPU]
8738 \c FLDLG2 ; D9 EC [8086,FPU]
8739 \c FLDLN2 ; D9 ED [8086,FPU]
8740 \c FLDPI ; D9 EB [8086,FPU]
8741 \c FLDZ ; D9 EE [8086,FPU]
8743 These instructions push specific standard constants on the FPU
8746 \c Instruction Constant pushed
8749 \c FLDL2E base-2 logarithm of e
8750 \c FLDL2T base-2 log of 10
8751 \c FLDLG2 base-10 log of 2
8752 \c FLDLN2 base-e log of 2
8757 \S{insFLDCW} \i\c{FLDCW}: Load Floating-Point Control Word
8759 \c FLDCW mem16 ; D9 /5 [8086,FPU]
8761 \c{FLDCW} loads a 16-bit value out of memory and stores it into the
8762 FPU control word (governing things like the rounding mode, the
8763 precision, and the exception masks). See also \c{FSTCW}
8764 (\k{insFSTCW}). If exceptions are enabled and you don't want to
8765 generate one, use \c{FCLEX} or \c{FNCLEX} (\k{insFCLEX}) before
8766 loading the new control word.
8769 \S{insFLDENV} \i\c{FLDENV}: Load Floating-Point Environment
8771 \c FLDENV mem ; D9 /4 [8086,FPU]
8773 \c{FLDENV} loads the FPU operating environment (control word, status
8774 word, tag word, instruction pointer, data pointer and last opcode)
8775 from memory. The memory area is 14 or 28 bytes long, depending on
8776 the CPU mode at the time. See also \c{FSTENV} (\k{insFSTENV}).
8779 \S{insFMUL} \i\c{FMUL}, \i\c{FMULP}: Floating-Point Multiply
8781 \c FMUL mem32 ; D8 /1 [8086,FPU]
8782 \c FMUL mem64 ; DC /1 [8086,FPU]
8784 \c FMUL fpureg ; D8 C8+r [8086,FPU]
8785 \c FMUL ST0,fpureg ; D8 C8+r [8086,FPU]
8787 \c FMUL TO fpureg ; DC C8+r [8086,FPU]
8788 \c FMUL fpureg,ST0 ; DC C8+r [8086,FPU]
8790 \c FMULP fpureg ; DE C8+r [8086,FPU]
8791 \c FMULP fpureg,ST0 ; DE C8+r [8086,FPU]
8793 \c{FMUL} multiplies \c{ST0} by the given operand, and stores the
8794 result in \c{ST0}, unless the \c{TO} qualifier is used in which case
8795 it stores the result in the operand. \c{FMULP} performs the same
8796 operation as \c{FMUL TO}, and then pops the register stack.
8799 \S{insFNOP} \i\c{FNOP}: Floating-Point No Operation
8801 \c FNOP ; D9 D0 [8086,FPU]
8803 \c{FNOP} does nothing.
8806 \S{insFPATAN} \i\c{FPATAN}, \i\c{FPTAN}: Arctangent and Tangent
8808 \c FPATAN ; D9 F3 [8086,FPU]
8809 \c FPTAN ; D9 F2 [8086,FPU]
8811 \c{FPATAN} computes the arctangent, in radians, of the result of
8812 dividing \c{ST1} by \c{ST0}, stores the result in \c{ST1}, and pops
8813 the register stack. It works like the C \c{atan2} function, in that
8814 changing the sign of both \c{ST0} and \c{ST1} changes the output
8815 value by pi (so it performs true rectangular-to-polar coordinate
8816 conversion, with \c{ST1} being the Y coordinate and \c{ST0} being
8817 the X coordinate, not merely an arctangent).
8819 \c{FPTAN} computes the tangent of the value in \c{ST0} (in radians),
8820 and stores the result back into \c{ST0}.
8822 The absolute value of \c{ST0} must be less than 2**63.
8825 \S{insFPREM} \i\c{FPREM}, \i\c{FPREM1}: Floating-Point Partial Remainder
8827 \c FPREM ; D9 F8 [8086,FPU]
8828 \c FPREM1 ; D9 F5 [386,FPU]
8830 These instructions both produce the remainder obtained by dividing
8831 \c{ST0} by \c{ST1}. This is calculated, notionally, by dividing
8832 \c{ST0} by \c{ST1}, rounding the result to an integer, multiplying
8833 by \c{ST1} again, and computing the value which would need to be
8834 added back on to the result to get back to the original value in
8837 The two instructions differ in the way the notional round-to-integer
8838 operation is performed. \c{FPREM} does it by rounding towards zero,
8839 so that the remainder it returns always has the same sign as the
8840 original value in \c{ST0}; \c{FPREM1} does it by rounding to the
8841 nearest integer, so that the remainder always has at most half the
8842 magnitude of \c{ST1}.
8844 Both instructions calculate \e{partial} remainders, meaning that
8845 they may not manage to provide the final result, but might leave
8846 intermediate results in \c{ST0} instead. If this happens, they will
8847 set the C2 flag in the FPU status word; therefore, to calculate a
8848 remainder, you should repeatedly execute \c{FPREM} or \c{FPREM1}
8849 until C2 becomes clear.
8852 \S{insFRNDINT} \i\c{FRNDINT}: Floating-Point Round to Integer
8854 \c FRNDINT ; D9 FC [8086,FPU]
8856 \c{FRNDINT} rounds the contents of \c{ST0} to an integer, according
8857 to the current rounding mode set in the FPU control word, and stores
8858 the result back in \c{ST0}.
8861 \S{insFRSTOR} \i\c{FSAVE}, \i\c{FRSTOR}: Save/Restore Floating-Point State
8863 \c FSAVE mem ; 9B DD /6 [8086,FPU]
8864 \c FNSAVE mem ; DD /6 [8086,FPU]
8866 \c FRSTOR mem ; DD /4 [8086,FPU]
8868 \c{FSAVE} saves the entire floating-point unit state, including all
8869 the information saved by \c{FSTENV} (\k{insFSTENV}) plus the
8870 contents of all the registers, to a 94 or 108 byte area of memory
8871 (depending on the CPU mode). \c{FRSTOR} restores the floating-point
8872 state from the same area of memory.
8874 \c{FNSAVE} does the same as \c{FSAVE}, without first waiting for
8875 pending floating-point exceptions to clear.
8878 \S{insFSCALE} \i\c{FSCALE}: Scale Floating-Point Value by Power of Two
8880 \c FSCALE ; D9 FD [8086,FPU]
8882 \c{FSCALE} scales a number by a power of two: it rounds \c{ST1}
8883 towards zero to obtain an integer, then multiplies \c{ST0} by two to
8884 the power of that integer, and stores the result in \c{ST0}.
8887 \S{insFSETPM} \i\c{FSETPM}: Set Protected Mode
8889 \c FSETPM ; DB E4 [286,FPU]
8891 This instruction initialises protected mode on the 287 floating-point
8892 coprocessor. It is only meaningful on that processor: the 387 and
8893 above treat the instruction as a no-operation.
8896 \S{insFSIN} \i\c{FSIN}, \i\c{FSINCOS}: Sine and Cosine
8898 \c FSIN ; D9 FE [386,FPU]
8899 \c FSINCOS ; D9 FB [386,FPU]
8901 \c{FSIN} calculates the sine of \c{ST0} (in radians) and stores the
8902 result in \c{ST0}. \c{FSINCOS} does the same, but then pushes the
8903 cosine of the same value on the register stack, so that the sine
8904 ends up in \c{ST1} and the cosine in \c{ST0}. \c{FSINCOS} is faster
8905 than executing \c{FSIN} and \c{FCOS} (see \k{insFCOS}) in succession.
8907 The absolute value of \c{ST0} must be less than 2**63.
8910 \S{insFSQRT} \i\c{FSQRT}: Floating-Point Square Root
8912 \c FSQRT ; D9 FA [8086,FPU]
8914 \c{FSQRT} calculates the square root of \c{ST0} and stores the
8918 \S{insFST} \i\c{FST}, \i\c{FSTP}: Floating-Point Store
8920 \c FST mem32 ; D9 /2 [8086,FPU]
8921 \c FST mem64 ; DD /2 [8086,FPU]
8922 \c FST fpureg ; DD D0+r [8086,FPU]
8924 \c FSTP mem32 ; D9 /3 [8086,FPU]
8925 \c FSTP mem64 ; DD /3 [8086,FPU]
8926 \c FSTP mem80 ; DB /7 [8086,FPU]
8927 \c FSTP fpureg ; DD D8+r [8086,FPU]
8929 \c{FST} stores the value in \c{ST0} into the given memory location
8930 or other FPU register. \c{FSTP} does the same, but then pops the
8934 \S{insFSTCW} \i\c{FSTCW}: Store Floating-Point Control Word
8936 \c FSTCW mem16 ; 9B D9 /7 [8086,FPU]
8937 \c FNSTCW mem16 ; D9 /7 [8086,FPU]
8939 \c{FSTCW} stores the \c{FPU} control word (governing things like the
8940 rounding mode, the precision, and the exception masks) into a 2-byte
8941 memory area. See also \c{FLDCW} (\k{insFLDCW}).
8943 \c{FNSTCW} does the same thing as \c{FSTCW}, without first waiting
8944 for pending floating-point exceptions to clear.
8947 \S{insFSTENV} \i\c{FSTENV}: Store Floating-Point Environment
8949 \c FSTENV mem ; 9B D9 /6 [8086,FPU]
8950 \c FNSTENV mem ; D9 /6 [8086,FPU]
8952 \c{FSTENV} stores the \c{FPU} operating environment (control word,
8953 status word, tag word, instruction pointer, data pointer and last
8954 opcode) into memory. The memory area is 14 or 28 bytes long,
8955 depending on the CPU mode at the time. See also \c{FLDENV}
8958 \c{FNSTENV} does the same thing as \c{FSTENV}, without first waiting
8959 for pending floating-point exceptions to clear.
8962 \S{insFSTSW} \i\c{FSTSW}: Store Floating-Point Status Word
8964 \c FSTSW mem16 ; 9B DD /7 [8086,FPU]
8965 \c FSTSW AX ; 9B DF E0 [286,FPU]
8967 \c FNSTSW mem16 ; DD /7 [8086,FPU]
8968 \c FNSTSW AX ; DF E0 [286,FPU]
8970 \c{FSTSW} stores the \c{FPU} status word into \c{AX} or into a 2-byte
8973 \c{FNSTSW} does the same thing as \c{FSTSW}, without first waiting
8974 for pending floating-point exceptions to clear.
8977 \S{insFSUB} \i\c{FSUB}, \i\c{FSUBP}, \i\c{FSUBR}, \i\c{FSUBRP}: Floating-Point Subtract
8979 \c FSUB mem32 ; D8 /4 [8086,FPU]
8980 \c FSUB mem64 ; DC /4 [8086,FPU]
8982 \c FSUB fpureg ; D8 E0+r [8086,FPU]
8983 \c FSUB ST0,fpureg ; D8 E0+r [8086,FPU]
8985 \c FSUB TO fpureg ; DC E8+r [8086,FPU]
8986 \c FSUB fpureg,ST0 ; DC E8+r [8086,FPU]
8988 \c FSUBR mem32 ; D8 /5 [8086,FPU]
8989 \c FSUBR mem64 ; DC /5 [8086,FPU]
8991 \c FSUBR fpureg ; D8 E8+r [8086,FPU]
8992 \c FSUBR ST0,fpureg ; D8 E8+r [8086,FPU]
8994 \c FSUBR TO fpureg ; DC E0+r [8086,FPU]
8995 \c FSUBR fpureg,ST0 ; DC E0+r [8086,FPU]
8997 \c FSUBP fpureg ; DE E8+r [8086,FPU]
8998 \c FSUBP fpureg,ST0 ; DE E8+r [8086,FPU]
9000 \c FSUBRP fpureg ; DE E0+r [8086,FPU]
9001 \c FSUBRP fpureg,ST0 ; DE E0+r [8086,FPU]
9003 \b \c{FSUB} subtracts the given operand from \c{ST0} and stores the
9004 result back in \c{ST0}, unless the \c{TO} qualifier is given, in
9005 which case it subtracts \c{ST0} from the given operand and stores
9006 the result in the operand.
9008 \b \c{FSUBR} does the same thing, but does the subtraction the other
9009 way up: so if \c{TO} is not given, it subtracts \c{ST0} from the given
9010 operand and stores the result in \c{ST0}, whereas if \c{TO} is given
9011 it subtracts its operand from \c{ST0} and stores the result in the
9014 \b \c{FSUBP} operates like \c{FSUB TO}, but pops the register stack
9015 once it has finished.
9017 \b \c{FSUBRP} operates like \c{FSUBR TO}, but pops the register stack
9018 once it has finished.
9021 \S{insFTST} \i\c{FTST}: Test \c{ST0} Against Zero
9023 \c FTST ; D9 E4 [8086,FPU]
9025 \c{FTST} compares \c{ST0} with zero and sets the FPU flags
9026 accordingly. \c{ST0} is treated as the left-hand side of the
9027 comparison, so that a `less-than' result is generated if \c{ST0} is
9031 \S{insFUCOM} \i\c{FUCOMxx}: Floating-Point Unordered Compare
9033 \c FUCOM fpureg ; DD E0+r [386,FPU]
9034 \c FUCOM ST0,fpureg ; DD E0+r [386,FPU]
9036 \c FUCOMP fpureg ; DD E8+r [386,FPU]
9037 \c FUCOMP ST0,fpureg ; DD E8+r [386,FPU]
9039 \c FUCOMPP ; DA E9 [386,FPU]
9041 \c FUCOMI fpureg ; DB E8+r [P6,FPU]
9042 \c FUCOMI ST0,fpureg ; DB E8+r [P6,FPU]
9044 \c FUCOMIP fpureg ; DF E8+r [P6,FPU]
9045 \c FUCOMIP ST0,fpureg ; DF E8+r [P6,FPU]
9047 \b \c{FUCOM} compares \c{ST0} with the given operand, and sets the
9048 FPU flags accordingly. \c{ST0} is treated as the left-hand side of
9049 the comparison, so that the carry flag is set (for a `less-than'
9050 result) if \c{ST0} is less than the given operand.
9052 \b \c{FUCOMP} does the same as \c{FUCOM}, but pops the register stack
9053 afterwards. \c{FUCOMPP} compares \c{ST0} with \c{ST1} and then pops
9054 the register stack twice.
9056 \b \c{FUCOMI} and \c{FUCOMIP} work like the corresponding forms of
9057 \c{FUCOM} and \c{FUCOMP}, but write their results directly to the CPU
9058 flags register rather than the FPU status word, so they can be
9059 immediately followed by conditional jump or conditional move
9062 The \c{FUCOM} instructions differ from the \c{FCOM} instructions
9063 (\k{insFCOM}) only in the way they handle quiet NaNs: \c{FUCOM} will
9064 handle them silently and set the condition code flags to an
9065 `unordered' result, whereas \c{FCOM} will generate an exception.
9068 \S{insFXAM} \i\c{FXAM}: Examine Class of Value in \c{ST0}
9070 \c FXAM ; D9 E5 [8086,FPU]
9072 \c{FXAM} sets the FPU flags \c{C3}, \c{C2} and \c{C0} depending on
9073 the type of value stored in \c{ST0}:
9075 \c Register contents Flags
9077 \c Unsupported format 000
9079 \c Finite number 010
9082 \c Empty register 101
9085 Additionally, the \c{C1} flag is set to the sign of the number.
9088 \S{insFXCH} \i\c{FXCH}: Floating-Point Exchange
9090 \c FXCH ; D9 C9 [8086,FPU]
9091 \c FXCH fpureg ; D9 C8+r [8086,FPU]
9092 \c FXCH fpureg,ST0 ; D9 C8+r [8086,FPU]
9093 \c FXCH ST0,fpureg ; D9 C8+r [8086,FPU]
9095 \c{FXCH} exchanges \c{ST0} with a given FPU register. The no-operand
9096 form exchanges \c{ST0} with \c{ST1}.
9099 \S{insFXRSTOR} \i\c{FXRSTOR}: Restore \c{FP}, \c{MMX} and \c{SSE} State
9101 \c FXRSTOR memory ; 0F AE /1 [P6,SSE,FPU]
9103 The \c{FXRSTOR} instruction reloads the \c{FPU}, \c{MMX} and \c{SSE}
9104 state (environment and registers), from the 512 byte memory area defined
9105 by the source operand. This data should have been written by a previous
9109 \S{insFXSAVE} \i\c{FXSAVE}: Store \c{FP}, \c{MMX} and \c{SSE} State
9111 \c FXSAVE memory ; 0F AE /0 [P6,SSE,FPU]
9113 \c{FXSAVE}The FXSAVE instruction writes the current \c{FPU}, \c{MMX}
9114 and \c{SSE} technology states (environment and registers), to the
9115 512 byte memory area defined by the destination operand. It does this
9116 without checking for pending unmasked floating-point exceptions
9117 (similar to the operation of \c{FNSAVE}).
9119 Unlike the \c{FSAVE/FNSAVE} instructions, the processor retains the
9120 contents of the \c{FPU}, \c{MMX} and \c{SSE} state in the processor
9121 after the state has been saved. This instruction has been optimised
9122 to maximize floating-point save performance.
9125 \S{insFXTRACT} \i\c{FXTRACT}: Extract Exponent and Significand
9127 \c FXTRACT ; D9 F4 [8086,FPU]
9129 \c{FXTRACT} separates the number in \c{ST0} into its exponent and
9130 significand (mantissa), stores the exponent back into \c{ST0}, and
9131 then pushes the significand on the register stack (so that the
9132 significand ends up in \c{ST0}, and the exponent in \c{ST1}).
9135 \S{insFYL2X} \i\c{FYL2X}, \i\c{FYL2XP1}: Compute Y times Log2(X) or Log2(X+1)
9137 \c FYL2X ; D9 F1 [8086,FPU]
9138 \c FYL2XP1 ; D9 F9 [8086,FPU]
9140 \c{FYL2X} multiplies \c{ST1} by the base-2 logarithm of \c{ST0},
9141 stores the result in \c{ST1}, and pops the register stack (so that
9142 the result ends up in \c{ST0}). \c{ST0} must be non-zero and
9145 \c{FYL2XP1} works the same way, but replacing the base-2 log of
9146 \c{ST0} with that of \c{ST0} plus one. This time, \c{ST0} must have
9147 magnitude no greater than 1 minus half the square root of two.
9150 \S{insHLT} \i\c{HLT}: Halt Processor
9152 \c HLT ; F4 [8086,PRIV]
9154 \c{HLT} puts the processor into a halted state, where it will
9155 perform no more operations until restarted by an interrupt or a
9158 On the 286 and later processors, this is a privileged instruction.
9161 \S{insIBTS} \i\c{IBTS}: Insert Bit String
9163 \c IBTS r/m16,reg16 ; o16 0F A7 /r [386,UNDOC]
9164 \c IBTS r/m32,reg32 ; o32 0F A7 /r [386,UNDOC]
9166 The implied operation of this instruction is:
9168 \c IBTS r/m16,AX,CL,reg16
9169 \c IBTS r/m32,EAX,CL,reg32
9171 Writes a bit string from the source operand to the destination.
9172 \c{CL} indicates the number of bits to be copied, from the low bits
9173 of the source. \c{(E)AX} indicates the low order bit offset in the
9174 destination that is written to. For example, if \c{CL} is set to 4
9175 and \c{AX} (for 16-bit code) is set to 5, bits 0-3 of \c{src} will
9176 be copied to bits 5-8 of \c{dst}. This instruction is very poorly
9177 documented, and I have been unable to find any official source of
9178 documentation on it.
9180 \c{IBTS} is supported only on the early Intel 386s, and conflicts
9181 with the opcodes for \c{CMPXCHG486} (on early Intel 486s). NASM
9182 supports it only for completeness. Its counterpart is \c{XBTS}
9186 \S{insIDIV} \i\c{IDIV}: Signed Integer Divide
9188 \c IDIV r/m8 ; F6 /7 [8086]
9189 \c IDIV r/m16 ; o16 F7 /7 [8086]
9190 \c IDIV r/m32 ; o32 F7 /7 [386]
9192 \c{IDIV} performs signed integer division. The explicit operand
9193 provided is the divisor; the dividend and destination operands
9194 are implicit, in the following way:
9196 \b For \c{IDIV r/m8}, \c{AX} is divided by the given operand;
9197 the quotient is stored in \c{AL} and the remainder in \c{AH}.
9199 \b For \c{IDIV r/m16}, \c{DX:AX} is divided by the given operand;
9200 the quotient is stored in \c{AX} and the remainder in \c{DX}.
9202 \b For \c{IDIV r/m32}, \c{EDX:EAX} is divided by the given operand;
9203 the quotient is stored in \c{EAX} and the remainder in \c{EDX}.
9205 Unsigned integer division is performed by the \c{DIV} instruction:
9209 \S{insIMUL} \i\c{IMUL}: Signed Integer Multiply
9211 \c IMUL r/m8 ; F6 /5 [8086]
9212 \c IMUL r/m16 ; o16 F7 /5 [8086]
9213 \c IMUL r/m32 ; o32 F7 /5 [386]
9215 \c IMUL reg16,r/m16 ; o16 0F AF /r [386]
9216 \c IMUL reg32,r/m32 ; o32 0F AF /r [386]
9218 \c IMUL reg16,imm8 ; o16 6B /r ib [186]
9219 \c IMUL reg16,imm16 ; o16 69 /r iw [186]
9220 \c IMUL reg32,imm8 ; o32 6B /r ib [386]
9221 \c IMUL reg32,imm32 ; o32 69 /r id [386]
9223 \c IMUL reg16,r/m16,imm8 ; o16 6B /r ib [186]
9224 \c IMUL reg16,r/m16,imm16 ; o16 69 /r iw [186]
9225 \c IMUL reg32,r/m32,imm8 ; o32 6B /r ib [386]
9226 \c IMUL reg32,r/m32,imm32 ; o32 69 /r id [386]
9228 \c{IMUL} performs signed integer multiplication. For the
9229 single-operand form, the other operand and destination are
9230 implicit, in the following way:
9232 \b For \c{IMUL r/m8}, \c{AL} is multiplied by the given operand;
9233 the product is stored in \c{AX}.
9235 \b For \c{IMUL r/m16}, \c{AX} is multiplied by the given operand;
9236 the product is stored in \c{DX:AX}.
9238 \b For \c{IMUL r/m32}, \c{EAX} is multiplied by the given operand;
9239 the product is stored in \c{EDX:EAX}.
9241 The two-operand form multiplies its two operands and stores the
9242 result in the destination (first) operand. The three-operand
9243 form multiplies its last two operands and stores the result in
9246 The two-operand form with an immediate second operand is in
9247 fact a shorthand for the three-operand form, as can be seen by
9248 examining the opcode descriptions: in the two-operand form, the
9249 code \c{/r} takes both its register and \c{r/m} parts from the
9250 same operand (the first one).
9252 In the forms with an 8-bit immediate operand and another longer
9253 source operand, the immediate operand is considered to be signed,
9254 and is sign-extended to the length of the other source operand.
9255 In these cases, the \c{BYTE} qualifier is necessary to force
9256 NASM to generate this form of the instruction.
9258 Unsigned integer multiplication is performed by the \c{MUL}
9259 instruction: see \k{insMUL}.
9262 \S{insIN} \i\c{IN}: Input from I/O Port
9264 \c IN AL,imm8 ; E4 ib [8086]
9265 \c IN AX,imm8 ; o16 E5 ib [8086]
9266 \c IN EAX,imm8 ; o32 E5 ib [386]
9267 \c IN AL,DX ; EC [8086]
9268 \c IN AX,DX ; o16 ED [8086]
9269 \c IN EAX,DX ; o32 ED [386]
9271 \c{IN} reads a byte, word or doubleword from the specified I/O port,
9272 and stores it in the given destination register. The port number may
9273 be specified as an immediate value if it is between 0 and 255, and
9274 otherwise must be stored in \c{DX}. See also \c{OUT} (\k{insOUT}).
9277 \S{insINC} \i\c{INC}: Increment Integer
9279 \c INC reg16 ; o16 40+r [8086]
9280 \c INC reg32 ; o32 40+r [386]
9281 \c INC r/m8 ; FE /0 [8086]
9282 \c INC r/m16 ; o16 FF /0 [8086]
9283 \c INC r/m32 ; o32 FF /0 [386]
9285 \c{INC} adds 1 to its operand. It does \e{not} affect the carry
9286 flag: to affect the carry flag, use \c{ADD something,1} (see
9287 \k{insADD}). \c{INC} affects all the other flags according to the result.
9289 This instruction can be used with a \c{LOCK} prefix to allow atomic execution.
9291 See also \c{DEC} (\k{insDEC}).
9294 \S{insINSB} \i\c{INSB}, \i\c{INSW}, \i\c{INSD}: Input String from I/O Port
9297 \c INSW ; o16 6D [186]
9298 \c INSD ; o32 6D [386]
9300 \c{INSB} inputs a byte from the I/O port specified in \c{DX} and
9301 stores it at \c{[ES:DI]} or \c{[ES:EDI]}. It then increments or
9302 decrements (depending on the direction flag: increments if the flag
9303 is clear, decrements if it is set) \c{DI} or \c{EDI}.
9305 The register used is \c{DI} if the address size is 16 bits, and
9306 \c{EDI} if it is 32 bits. If you need to use an address size not
9307 equal to the current \c{BITS} setting, you can use an explicit
9308 \i\c{a16} or \i\c{a32} prefix.
9310 Segment override prefixes have no effect for this instruction: the
9311 use of \c{ES} for the load from \c{[DI]} or \c{[EDI]} cannot be
9314 \c{INSW} and \c{INSD} work in the same way, but they input a word or
9315 a doubleword instead of a byte, and increment or decrement the
9316 addressing register by 2 or 4 instead of 1.
9318 The \c{REP} prefix may be used to repeat the instruction \c{CX} (or
9319 \c{ECX} - again, the address size chooses which) times.
9321 See also \c{OUTSB}, \c{OUTSW} and \c{OUTSD} (\k{insOUTSB}).
9324 \S{insINT} \i\c{INT}: Software Interrupt
9326 \c INT imm8 ; CD ib [8086]
9328 \c{INT} causes a software interrupt through a specified vector
9329 number from 0 to 255.
9331 The code generated by the \c{INT} instruction is always two bytes
9332 long: although there are short forms for some \c{INT} instructions,
9333 NASM does not generate them when it sees the \c{INT} mnemonic. In
9334 order to generate single-byte breakpoint instructions, use the
9335 \c{INT3} or \c{INT1} instructions (see \k{insINT1}) instead.
9338 \S{insINT1} \i\c{INT3}, \i\c{INT1}, \i\c{ICEBP}, \i\c{INT01}: Breakpoints
9345 \c INT03 ; CC [8086]
9347 \c{INT1} and \c{INT3} are short one-byte forms of the instructions
9348 \c{INT 1} and \c{INT 3} (see \k{insINT}). They perform a similar
9349 function to their longer counterparts, but take up less code space.
9350 They are used as breakpoints by debuggers.
9352 \b \c{INT1}, and its alternative synonyms \c{INT01} and \c{ICEBP}, is
9353 an instruction used by in-circuit emulators (ICEs). It is present,
9354 though not documented, on some processors down to the 286, but is
9355 only documented for the Pentium Pro. \c{INT3} is the instruction
9356 normally used as a breakpoint by debuggers.
9358 \b \c{INT3}, and its synonym \c{INT03}, is not precisely equivalent to
9359 \c{INT 3}: the short form, since it is designed to be used as a
9360 breakpoint, bypasses the normal \c{IOPL} checks in virtual-8086 mode,
9361 and also does not go through interrupt redirection.
9364 \S{insINTO} \i\c{INTO}: Interrupt if Overflow
9368 \c{INTO} performs an \c{INT 4} software interrupt (see \k{insINT})
9369 if and only if the overflow flag is set.
9372 \S{insINVD} \i\c{INVD}: Invalidate Internal Caches
9374 \c INVD ; 0F 08 [486]
9376 \c{INVD} invalidates and empties the processor's internal caches,
9377 and causes the processor to instruct external caches to do the same.
9378 It does not write the contents of the caches back to memory first:
9379 any modified data held in the caches will be lost. To write the data
9380 back first, use \c{WBINVD} (\k{insWBINVD}).
9383 \S{insINVLPG} \i\c{INVLPG}: Invalidate TLB Entry
9385 \c INVLPG mem ; 0F 01 /7 [486]
9387 \c{INVLPG} invalidates the translation lookahead buffer (TLB) entry
9388 associated with the supplied memory address.
9391 \S{insIRET} \i\c{IRET}, \i\c{IRETW}, \i\c{IRETD}: Return from Interrupt
9394 \c IRETW ; o16 CF [8086]
9395 \c IRETD ; o32 CF [386]
9397 \c{IRET} returns from an interrupt (hardware or software) by means
9398 of popping \c{IP} (or \c{EIP}), \c{CS} and the flags off the stack
9399 and then continuing execution from the new \c{CS:IP}.
9401 \c{IRETW} pops \c{IP}, \c{CS} and the flags as 2 bytes each, taking
9402 6 bytes off the stack in total. \c{IRETD} pops \c{EIP} as 4 bytes,
9403 pops a further 4 bytes of which the top two are discarded and the
9404 bottom two go into \c{CS}, and pops the flags as 4 bytes as well,
9405 taking 12 bytes off the stack.
9407 \c{IRET} is a shorthand for either \c{IRETW} or \c{IRETD}, depending
9408 on the default \c{BITS} setting at the time.
9411 \S{insJcc} \i\c{Jcc}: Conditional Branch
9413 \c Jcc imm ; 70+cc rb [8086]
9414 \c Jcc NEAR imm ; 0F 80+cc rw/rd [386]
9416 The \i{conditional jump} instructions execute a near (same segment)
9417 jump if and only if their conditions are satisfied. For example,
9418 \c{JNZ} jumps only if the zero flag is not set.
9420 The ordinary form of the instructions has only a 128-byte range; the
9421 \c{NEAR} form is a 386 extension to the instruction set, and can
9422 span the full size of a segment. NASM will not override your choice
9423 of jump instruction: if you want \c{Jcc NEAR}, you have to use the
9426 The \c{SHORT} keyword is allowed on the first form of the
9427 instruction, for clarity, but is not necessary.
9429 For details of the condition codes, see \k{iref-cc}.
9432 \S{insJCXZ} \i\c{JCXZ}, \i\c{JECXZ}: Jump if CX/ECX Zero
9434 \c JCXZ imm ; a16 E3 rb [8086]
9435 \c JECXZ imm ; a32 E3 rb [386]
9437 \c{JCXZ} performs a short jump (with maximum range 128 bytes) if and
9438 only if the contents of the \c{CX} register is 0. \c{JECXZ} does the
9439 same thing, but with \c{ECX}.
9442 \S{insJMP} \i\c{JMP}: Jump
9444 \c JMP imm ; E9 rw/rd [8086]
9445 \c JMP SHORT imm ; EB rb [8086]
9446 \c JMP imm:imm16 ; o16 EA iw iw [8086]
9447 \c JMP imm:imm32 ; o32 EA id iw [386]
9448 \c JMP FAR mem ; o16 FF /5 [8086]
9449 \c JMP FAR mem32 ; o32 FF /5 [386]
9450 \c JMP r/m16 ; o16 FF /4 [8086]
9451 \c JMP r/m32 ; o32 FF /4 [386]
9453 \c{JMP} jumps to a given address. The address may be specified as an
9454 absolute segment and offset, or as a relative jump within the
9457 \c{JMP SHORT imm} has a maximum range of 128 bytes, since the
9458 displacement is specified as only 8 bits, but takes up less code
9459 space. NASM does not choose when to generate \c{JMP SHORT} for you:
9460 you must explicitly code \c{SHORT} every time you want a short jump.
9462 You can choose between the two immediate \i{far jump} forms (\c{JMP
9463 imm:imm}) by the use of the \c{WORD} and \c{DWORD} keywords: \c{JMP
9464 WORD 0x1234:0x5678}) or \c{JMP DWORD 0x1234:0x56789abc}.
9466 The \c{JMP FAR mem} forms execute a far jump by loading the
9467 destination address out of memory. The address loaded consists of 16
9468 or 32 bits of offset (depending on the operand size), and 16 bits of
9469 segment. The operand size may be overridden using \c{JMP WORD FAR
9470 mem} or \c{JMP DWORD FAR mem}.
9472 The \c{JMP r/m} forms execute a \i{near jump} (within the same
9473 segment), loading the destination address out of memory or out of a
9474 register. The keyword \c{NEAR} may be specified, for clarity, in
9475 these forms, but is not necessary. Again, operand size can be
9476 overridden using \c{JMP WORD mem} or \c{JMP DWORD mem}.
9478 As a convenience, NASM does not require you to jump to a far symbol
9479 by coding the cumbersome \c{JMP SEG routine:routine}, but instead
9480 allows the easier synonym \c{JMP FAR routine}.
9482 The \c{CALL r/m} forms given above are near calls; NASM will accept
9483 the \c{NEAR} keyword (e.g. \c{CALL NEAR [address]}), even though it
9484 is not strictly necessary.
9487 \S{insLAHF} \i\c{LAHF}: Load AH from Flags
9491 \c{LAHF} sets the \c{AH} register according to the contents of the
9492 low byte of the flags word.
9494 The operation of \c{LAHF} is:
9496 \c AH <-- SF:ZF:0:AF:0:PF:1:CF
9498 See also \c{SAHF} (\k{insSAHF}).
9501 \S{insLAR} \i\c{LAR}: Load Access Rights
9503 \c LAR reg16,r/m16 ; o16 0F 02 /r [286,PRIV]
9504 \c LAR reg32,r/m32 ; o32 0F 02 /r [286,PRIV]
9506 \c{LAR} takes the segment selector specified by its source (second)
9507 operand, finds the corresponding segment descriptor in the GDT or
9508 LDT, and loads the access-rights byte of the descriptor into its
9509 destination (first) operand.
9512 \S{insLDMXCSR} \i\c{LDMXCSR}: Load Streaming SIMD Extension
9515 \c LDMXCSR mem32 ; 0F AE /2 [KATMAI,SSE]
9517 \c{LDMXCSR} loads 32-bits of data from the specified memory location
9518 into the \c{MXCSR} control/status register. \c{MXCSR} is used to
9519 enable masked/unmasked exception handling, to set rounding modes,
9520 to set flush-to-zero mode, and to view exception status flags.
9522 For details of the \c{MXCSR} register, see the Intel processor docs.
9524 See also \c{STMXCSR} (\k{insSTMXCSR}
9527 \S{insLDS} \i\c{LDS}, \i\c{LES}, \i\c{LFS}, \i\c{LGS}, \i\c{LSS}: Load Far Pointer
9529 \c LDS reg16,mem ; o16 C5 /r [8086]
9530 \c LDS reg32,mem ; o32 C5 /r [386]
9532 \c LES reg16,mem ; o16 C4 /r [8086]
9533 \c LES reg32,mem ; o32 C4 /r [386]
9535 \c LFS reg16,mem ; o16 0F B4 /r [386]
9536 \c LFS reg32,mem ; o32 0F B4 /r [386]
9538 \c LGS reg16,mem ; o16 0F B5 /r [386]
9539 \c LGS reg32,mem ; o32 0F B5 /r [386]
9541 \c LSS reg16,mem ; o16 0F B2 /r [386]
9542 \c LSS reg32,mem ; o32 0F B2 /r [386]
9544 These instructions load an entire far pointer (16 or 32 bits of
9545 offset, plus 16 bits of segment) out of memory in one go. \c{LDS},
9546 for example, loads 16 or 32 bits from the given memory address into
9547 the given register (depending on the size of the register), then
9548 loads the \e{next} 16 bits from memory into \c{DS}. \c{LES},
9549 \c{LFS}, \c{LGS} and \c{LSS} work in the same way but use the other
9553 \S{insLEA} \i\c{LEA}: Load Effective Address
9555 \c LEA reg16,mem ; o16 8D /r [8086]
9556 \c LEA reg32,mem ; o32 8D /r [386]
9558 \c{LEA}, despite its syntax, does not access memory. It calculates
9559 the effective address specified by its second operand as if it were
9560 going to load or store data from it, but instead it stores the
9561 calculated address into the register specified by its first operand.
9562 This can be used to perform quite complex calculations (e.g. \c{LEA
9563 EAX,[EBX+ECX*4+100]}) in one instruction.
9565 \c{LEA}, despite being a purely arithmetic instruction which
9566 accesses no memory, still requires square brackets around its second
9567 operand, as if it were a memory reference.
9569 The size of the calculation is the current \e{address} size, and the
9570 size that the result is stored as is the current \e{operand} size.
9571 If the address and operand size are not the same, then if the
9572 addressing mode was 32-bits, the low 16-bits are stored, and if the
9573 address was 16-bits, it is zero-extended to 32-bits before storing.
9576 \S{insLEAVE} \i\c{LEAVE}: Destroy Stack Frame
9580 \c{LEAVE} destroys a stack frame of the form created by the
9581 \c{ENTER} instruction (see \k{insENTER}). It is functionally
9582 equivalent to \c{MOV ESP,EBP} followed by \c{POP EBP} (or \c{MOV
9583 SP,BP} followed by \c{POP BP} in 16-bit mode).
9586 \S{insLFENCE} \i\c{LFENCE}: Load Fence
9588 \c LFENCE ; 0F AE /5 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
9590 \c{LFENCE} performs a serialising operation on all loads from memory
9591 that were issued before the \c{LFENCE} instruction. This guarantees that
9592 all memory reads before the \c{LFENCE} instruction are visible before any
9593 reads after the \c{LFENCE} instruction.
9595 \c{LFENCE} is ordered respective to other \c{LFENCE} instruction, \c{MFENCE},
9596 any memory read and any other serialising instruction (such as \c{CPUID}).
9598 Weakly ordered memory types can be used to achieve higher processor
9599 performance through such techniques as out-of-order issue and
9600 speculative reads. The degree to which a consumer of data recognizes
9601 or knows that the data is weakly ordered varies among applications
9602 and may be unknown to the producer of this data. The \c{LFENCE}
9603 instruction provides a performance-efficient way of ensuring load
9604 ordering between routines that produce weakly-ordered results and
9605 routines that consume that data.
9607 \c{LFENCE} uses the following ModRM encoding:
9610 \c Reg/Opcode (5:3) = 101B
9613 All other ModRM encodings are defined to be reserved, and use
9614 of these encodings risks incompatibility with future processors.
9616 See also \c{SFENCE} (\k{insSFENCE}) and \c{MFENCE} (\k{insMFENCE}).
9619 \S{insLGDT} \i\c{LGDT}, \i\c{LIDT}, \i\c{LLDT}: Load Descriptor Tables
9621 \c LGDT mem ; 0F 01 /2 [286,PRIV]
9622 \c LIDT mem ; 0F 01 /3 [286,PRIV]
9623 \c LLDT r/m16 ; 0F 00 /2 [286,PRIV]
9625 \c{LGDT} and \c{LIDT} both take a 6-byte memory area as an operand:
9626 they load a 32-bit linear address and a 16-bit size limit from that
9627 area (in the opposite order) into the \c{GDTR} (global descriptor table
9628 register) or \c{IDTR} (interrupt descriptor table register). These are
9629 the only instructions which directly use \e{linear} addresses, rather
9630 than segment/offset pairs.
9632 \c{LLDT} takes a segment selector as an operand. The processor looks
9633 up that selector in the GDT and stores the limit and base address
9634 given there into the \c{LDTR} (local descriptor table register).
9636 See also \c{SGDT}, \c{SIDT} and \c{SLDT} (\k{insSGDT}).
9639 \S{insLMSW} \i\c{LMSW}: Load/Store Machine Status Word
9641 \c LMSW r/m16 ; 0F 01 /6 [286,PRIV]
9643 \c{LMSW} loads the bottom four bits of the source operand into the
9644 bottom four bits of the \c{CR0} control register (or the Machine
9645 Status Word, on 286 processors). See also \c{SMSW} (\k{insSMSW}).
9648 \S{insLOADALL} \i\c{LOADALL}, \i\c{LOADALL286}: Load Processor State
9650 \c LOADALL ; 0F 07 [386,UNDOC]
9651 \c LOADALL286 ; 0F 05 [286,UNDOC]
9653 This instruction, in its two different-opcode forms, is apparently
9654 supported on most 286 processors, some 386 and possibly some 486.
9655 The opcode differs between the 286 and the 386.
9657 The function of the instruction is to load all information relating
9658 to the state of the processor out of a block of memory: on the 286,
9659 this block is located implicitly at absolute address \c{0x800}, and
9660 on the 386 and 486 it is at \c{[ES:EDI]}.
9663 \S{insLODSB} \i\c{LODSB}, \i\c{LODSW}, \i\c{LODSD}: Load from String
9665 \c LODSB ; AC [8086]
9666 \c LODSW ; o16 AD [8086]
9667 \c LODSD ; o32 AD [386]
9669 \c{LODSB} loads a byte from \c{[DS:SI]} or \c{[DS:ESI]} into \c{AL}.
9670 It then increments or decrements (depending on the direction flag:
9671 increments if the flag is clear, decrements if it is set) \c{SI} or
9674 The register used is \c{SI} if the address size is 16 bits, and
9675 \c{ESI} if it is 32 bits. If you need to use an address size not
9676 equal to the current \c{BITS} setting, you can use an explicit
9677 \i\c{a16} or \i\c{a32} prefix.
9679 The segment register used to load from \c{[SI]} or \c{[ESI]} can be
9680 overridden by using a segment register name as a prefix (for
9681 example, \c{ES LODSB}).
9683 \c{LODSW} and \c{LODSD} work in the same way, but they load a
9684 word or a doubleword instead of a byte, and increment or decrement
9685 the addressing registers by 2 or 4 instead of 1.
9688 \S{insLOOP} \i\c{LOOP}, \i\c{LOOPE}, \i\c{LOOPZ}, \i\c{LOOPNE}, \i\c{LOOPNZ}: Loop with Counter
9690 \c LOOP imm ; E2 rb [8086]
9691 \c LOOP imm,CX ; a16 E2 rb [8086]
9692 \c LOOP imm,ECX ; a32 E2 rb [386]
9694 \c LOOPE imm ; E1 rb [8086]
9695 \c LOOPE imm,CX ; a16 E1 rb [8086]
9696 \c LOOPE imm,ECX ; a32 E1 rb [386]
9697 \c LOOPZ imm ; E1 rb [8086]
9698 \c LOOPZ imm,CX ; a16 E1 rb [8086]
9699 \c LOOPZ imm,ECX ; a32 E1 rb [386]
9701 \c LOOPNE imm ; E0 rb [8086]
9702 \c LOOPNE imm,CX ; a16 E0 rb [8086]
9703 \c LOOPNE imm,ECX ; a32 E0 rb [386]
9704 \c LOOPNZ imm ; E0 rb [8086]
9705 \c LOOPNZ imm,CX ; a16 E0 rb [8086]
9706 \c LOOPNZ imm,ECX ; a32 E0 rb [386]
9708 \c{LOOP} decrements its counter register (either \c{CX} or \c{ECX} -
9709 if one is not specified explicitly, the \c{BITS} setting dictates
9710 which is used) by one, and if the counter does not become zero as a
9711 result of this operation, it jumps to the given label. The jump has
9712 a range of 128 bytes.
9714 \c{LOOPE} (or its synonym \c{LOOPZ}) adds the additional condition
9715 that it only jumps if the counter is nonzero \e{and} the zero flag
9716 is set. Similarly, \c{LOOPNE} (and \c{LOOPNZ}) jumps only if the
9717 counter is nonzero and the zero flag is clear.
9720 \S{insLSL} \i\c{LSL}: Load Segment Limit
9722 \c LSL reg16,r/m16 ; o16 0F 03 /r [286,PRIV]
9723 \c LSL reg32,r/m32 ; o32 0F 03 /r [286,PRIV]
9725 \c{LSL} is given a segment selector in its source (second) operand;
9726 it computes the segment limit value by loading the segment limit
9727 field from the associated segment descriptor in the \c{GDT} or \c{LDT}.
9728 (This involves shifting left by 12 bits if the segment limit is
9729 page-granular, and not if it is byte-granular; so you end up with a
9730 byte limit in either case.) The segment limit obtained is then
9731 loaded into the destination (first) operand.
9734 \S{insLTR} \i\c{LTR}: Load Task Register
9736 \c LTR r/m16 ; 0F 00 /3 [286,PRIV]
9738 \c{LTR} looks up the segment base and limit in the GDT or LDT
9739 descriptor specified by the segment selector given as its operand,
9740 and loads them into the Task Register.
9743 \S{insMASKMOVDQU} \i\c{MASKMOVDQU}: Byte Mask Write
9745 \c MASKMOVDQU xmm1,xmm2 ; 66 0F F7 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
9747 \c{MASKMOVDQU} stores data from xmm1 to the location specified by
9748 \c{ES:(E)DI}. The size of the store depends on the address-size
9749 attribute. The most significant bit in each byte of the mask
9750 register xmm2 is used to selectively write the data (0 = no write,
9751 1 = write) on a per-byte basis.
9754 \S{insMASKMOVQ} \i\c{MASKMOVQ}: Byte Mask Write
9756 \c MASKMOVQ mm1,mm2 ; 0F F7 /r [KATMAI,MMX]
9758 \c{MASKMOVQ} stores data from mm1 to the location specified by
9759 \c{ES:(E)DI}. The size of the store depends on the address-size
9760 attribute. The most significant bit in each byte of the mask
9761 register mm2 is used to selectively write the data (0 = no write,
9762 1 = write) on a per-byte basis.
9765 \S{insMAXPD} \i\c{MAXPD}: Return Packed Double-Precision FP Maximum
9767 \c MAXPD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 5F /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
9769 \c{MAXPD} performs a SIMD compare of the packed double-precision
9770 FP numbers from xmm1 and xmm2/mem, and stores the maximum values
9771 of each pair of values in xmm1. If the values being compared are
9772 both zeroes, source2 (xmm2/m128) would be returned. If source2
9773 (xmm2/m128) is an SNaN, this SNaN is forwarded unchanged to the
9774 destination (i.e., a QNaN version of the SNaN is not returned).
9777 \S{insMAXPS} \i\c{MAXPS}: Return Packed Single-Precision FP Maximum
9779 \c MAXPS xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 0F 5F /r [KATMAI,SSE]
9781 \c{MAXPS} performs a SIMD compare of the packed single-precision
9782 FP numbers from xmm1 and xmm2/mem, and stores the maximum values
9783 of each pair of values in xmm1. If the values being compared are
9784 both zeroes, source2 (xmm2/m128) would be returned. If source2
9785 (xmm2/m128) is an SNaN, this SNaN is forwarded unchanged to the
9786 destination (i.e., a QNaN version of the SNaN is not returned).
9789 \S{insMAXSD} \i\c{MAXSD}: Return Scalar Double-Precision FP Maximum
9791 \c MAXSD xmm1,xmm2/m64 ; F2 0F 5F /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
9793 \c{MAXSD} compares the low-order double-precision FP numbers from
9794 xmm1 and xmm2/mem, and stores the maximum value in xmm1. If the
9795 values being compared are both zeroes, source2 (xmm2/m64) would
9796 be returned. If source2 (xmm2/m64) is an SNaN, this SNaN is
9797 forwarded unchanged to the destination (i.e., a QNaN version of
9798 the SNaN is not returned). The high quadword of the destination
9802 \S{insMAXSS} \i\c{MAXSS}: Return Scalar Single-Precision FP Maximum
9804 \c MAXSS xmm1,xmm2/m32 ; F3 0F 5F /r [KATMAI,SSE]
9806 \c{MAXSS} compares the low-order single-precision FP numbers from
9807 xmm1 and xmm2/mem, and stores the maximum value in xmm1. If the
9808 values being compared are both zeroes, source2 (xmm2/m32) would
9809 be returned. If source2 (xmm2/m32) is an SNaN, this SNaN is
9810 forwarded unchanged to the destination (i.e., a QNaN version of
9811 the SNaN is not returned). The high three doublewords of the
9812 destination are left unchanged.
9815 \S{insMFENCE} \i\c{MFENCE}: Memory Fence
9817 \c MFENCE ; 0F AE /6 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
9819 \c{MFENCE} performs a serialising operation on all loads from memory
9820 and writes to memory that were issued before the \c{MFENCE} instruction.
9821 This guarantees that all memory reads and writes before the \c{MFENCE}
9822 instruction are completed before any reads and writes after the
9823 \c{MFENCE} instruction.
9825 \c{MFENCE} is ordered respective to other \c{MFENCE} instructions,
9826 \c{LFENCE}, \c{SFENCE}, any memory read and any other serialising
9827 instruction (such as \c{CPUID}).
9829 Weakly ordered memory types can be used to achieve higher processor
9830 performance through such techniques as out-of-order issue, speculative
9831 reads, write-combining, and write-collapsing. The degree to which a
9832 consumer of data recognizes or knows that the data is weakly ordered
9833 varies among applications and may be unknown to the producer of this
9834 data. The \c{MFENCE} instruction provides a performance-efficient way
9835 of ensuring load and store ordering between routines that produce
9836 weakly-ordered results and routines that consume that data.
9838 \c{MFENCE} uses the following ModRM encoding:
9841 \c Reg/Opcode (5:3) = 110B
9844 All other ModRM encodings are defined to be reserved, and use
9845 of these encodings risks incompatibility with future processors.
9847 See also \c{LFENCE} (\k{insLFENCE}) and \c{SFENCE} (\k{insSFENCE}).
9850 \S{insMINPD} \i\c{MINPD}: Return Packed Double-Precision FP Minimum
9852 \c MINPD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 5D /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
9854 \c{MINPD} performs a SIMD compare of the packed double-precision
9855 FP numbers from xmm1 and xmm2/mem, and stores the minimum values
9856 of each pair of values in xmm1. If the values being compared are
9857 both zeroes, source2 (xmm2/m128) would be returned. If source2
9858 (xmm2/m128) is an SNaN, this SNaN is forwarded unchanged to the
9859 destination (i.e., a QNaN version of the SNaN is not returned).
9862 \S{insMINPS} \i\c{MINPS}: Return Packed Single-Precision FP Minimum
9864 \c MINPS xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 0F 5D /r [KATMAI,SSE]
9866 \c{MINPS} performs a SIMD compare of the packed single-precision
9867 FP numbers from xmm1 and xmm2/mem, and stores the minimum values
9868 of each pair of values in xmm1. If the values being compared are
9869 both zeroes, source2 (xmm2/m128) would be returned. If source2
9870 (xmm2/m128) is an SNaN, this SNaN is forwarded unchanged to the
9871 destination (i.e., a QNaN version of the SNaN is not returned).
9874 \S{insMINSD} \i\c{MINSD}: Return Scalar Double-Precision FP Minimum
9876 \c MINSD xmm1,xmm2/m64 ; F2 0F 5D /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
9878 \c{MINSD} compares the low-order double-precision FP numbers from
9879 xmm1 and xmm2/mem, and stores the minimum value in xmm1. If the
9880 values being compared are both zeroes, source2 (xmm2/m64) would
9881 be returned. If source2 (xmm2/m64) is an SNaN, this SNaN is
9882 forwarded unchanged to the destination (i.e., a QNaN version of
9883 the SNaN is not returned). The high quadword of the destination
9887 \S{insMINSS} \i\c{MINSS}: Return Scalar Single-Precision FP Minimum
9889 \c MINSS xmm1,xmm2/m32 ; F3 0F 5D /r [KATMAI,SSE]
9891 \c{MINSS} compares the low-order single-precision FP numbers from
9892 xmm1 and xmm2/mem, and stores the minimum value in xmm1. If the
9893 values being compared are both zeroes, source2 (xmm2/m32) would
9894 be returned. If source2 (xmm2/m32) is an SNaN, this SNaN is
9895 forwarded unchanged to the destination (i.e., a QNaN version of
9896 the SNaN is not returned). The high three doublewords of the
9897 destination are left unchanged.
9900 \S{insMOV} \i\c{MOV}: Move Data
9902 \c MOV r/m8,reg8 ; 88 /r [8086]
9903 \c MOV r/m16,reg16 ; o16 89 /r [8086]
9904 \c MOV r/m32,reg32 ; o32 89 /r [386]
9905 \c MOV reg8,r/m8 ; 8A /r [8086]
9906 \c MOV reg16,r/m16 ; o16 8B /r [8086]
9907 \c MOV reg32,r/m32 ; o32 8B /r [386]
9909 \c MOV reg8,imm8 ; B0+r ib [8086]
9910 \c MOV reg16,imm16 ; o16 B8+r iw [8086]
9911 \c MOV reg32,imm32 ; o32 B8+r id [386]
9912 \c MOV r/m8,imm8 ; C6 /0 ib [8086]
9913 \c MOV r/m16,imm16 ; o16 C7 /0 iw [8086]
9914 \c MOV r/m32,imm32 ; o32 C7 /0 id [386]
9916 \c MOV AL,memoffs8 ; A0 ow/od [8086]
9917 \c MOV AX,memoffs16 ; o16 A1 ow/od [8086]
9918 \c MOV EAX,memoffs32 ; o32 A1 ow/od [386]
9919 \c MOV memoffs8,AL ; A2 ow/od [8086]
9920 \c MOV memoffs16,AX ; o16 A3 ow/od [8086]
9921 \c MOV memoffs32,EAX ; o32 A3 ow/od [386]
9923 \c MOV r/m16,segreg ; o16 8C /r [8086]
9924 \c MOV r/m32,segreg ; o32 8C /r [386]
9925 \c MOV segreg,r/m16 ; o16 8E /r [8086]
9926 \c MOV segreg,r/m32 ; o32 8E /r [386]
9928 \c MOV reg32,CR0/2/3/4 ; 0F 20 /r [386]
9929 \c MOV reg32,DR0/1/2/3/6/7 ; 0F 21 /r [386]
9930 \c MOV reg32,TR3/4/5/6/7 ; 0F 24 /r [386]
9931 \c MOV CR0/2/3/4,reg32 ; 0F 22 /r [386]
9932 \c MOV DR0/1/2/3/6/7,reg32 ; 0F 23 /r [386]
9933 \c MOV TR3/4/5/6/7,reg32 ; 0F 26 /r [386]
9935 \c{MOV} copies the contents of its source (second) operand into its
9936 destination (first) operand.
9938 In all forms of the \c{MOV} instruction, the two operands are the
9939 same size, except for moving between a segment register and an
9940 \c{r/m32} operand. These instructions are treated exactly like the
9941 corresponding 16-bit equivalent (so that, for example, \c{MOV
9942 DS,EAX} functions identically to \c{MOV DS,AX} but saves a prefix
9943 when in 32-bit mode), except that when a segment register is moved
9944 into a 32-bit destination, the top two bytes of the result are
9947 \c{MOV} may not use \c{CS} as a destination.
9949 \c{CR4} is only a supported register on the Pentium and above.
9951 Test registers are supported on 386/486 processors and on some
9952 non-Intel Pentium class processors.
9955 \S{insMOVAPD} \i\c{MOVAPD}: Move Aligned Packed Double-Precision FP Values
9957 \c MOVAPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 66 0F 28 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
9958 \c MOVAPD xmm1/mem128,xmm2 ; 66 0F 29 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
9960 \c{MOVAPD} moves a double quadword containing 2 packed double-precision
9961 FP values from the source operand to the destination. When the source
9962 or destination operand is a memory location, it must be aligned on a
9965 To move data in and out of memory locations that are not known to be on
9966 16-byte boundaries, use the \c{MOVUPD} instruction (\k{insMOVUPD}).
9969 \S{insMOVAPS} \i\c{MOVAPS}: Move Aligned Packed Single-Precision FP Values
9971 \c MOVAPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 0F 28 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
9972 \c MOVAPS xmm1/mem128,xmm2 ; 0F 29 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
9974 \c{MOVAPS} moves a double quadword containing 4 packed single-precision
9975 FP values from the source operand to the destination. When the source
9976 or destination operand is a memory location, it must be aligned on a
9979 To move data in and out of memory locations that are not known to be on
9980 16-byte boundaries, use the \c{MOVUPS} instruction (\k{insMOVUPS}).
9983 \S{insMOVD} \i\c{MOVD}: Move Doubleword to/from MMX Register
9985 \c MOVD mm,r/m32 ; 0F 6E /r [PENT,MMX]
9986 \c MOVD r/m32,mm ; 0F 7E /r [PENT,MMX]
9987 \c MOVD xmm,r/m32 ; 66 0F 6E /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
9988 \c MOVD r/m32,xmm ; 66 0F 7E /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
9990 \c{MOVD} copies 32 bits from its source (second) operand into its
9991 destination (first) operand. When the destination is a 64-bit \c{MMX}
9992 register or a 128-bit \c{XMM} register, the input value is zero-extended
9993 to fill the destination register.
9996 \S{insMOVDQ2Q} \i\c{MOVDQ2Q}: Move Quadword from XMM to MMX register.
9998 \c MOVDQ2Q mm,xmm ; F2 OF D6 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10000 \c{MOVDQ2Q} moves the low quadword from the source operand to the
10001 destination operand.
10004 \S{insMOVDQA} \i\c{MOVDQA}: Move Aligned Double Quadword
10006 \c MOVDQA xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 OF 6F /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10007 \c MOVDQA xmm1/m128,xmm2 ; 66 OF 7F /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10009 \c{MOVDQA} moves a double quadword from the source operand to the
10010 destination operand. When the source or destination operand is a
10011 memory location, it must be aligned to a 16-byte boundary.
10013 To move a double quadword to or from unaligned memory locations,
10014 use the \c{MOVDQU} instruction (\k{insMOVDQU}).
10017 \S{insMOVDQU} \i\c{MOVDQU}: Move Unaligned Double Quadword
10019 \c MOVDQU xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; F3 OF 6F /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10020 \c MOVDQU xmm1/m128,xmm2 ; F3 OF 7F /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10022 \c{MOVDQU} moves a double quadword from the source operand to the
10023 destination operand. When the source or destination operand is a
10024 memory location, the memory may be unaligned.
10026 To move a double quadword to or from known aligned memory locations,
10027 use the \c{MOVDQA} instruction (\k{insMOVDQA}).
10030 \S{insMOVHLPS} \i\c{MOVHLPS}: Move Packed Single-Precision FP High to Low
10032 \c MOVHLPS xmm1,xmm2 ; OF 12 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
10034 \c{MOVHLPS} moves the two packed single-precision FP values from the
10035 high quadword of the source register xmm2 to the low quadword of the
10036 destination register, xmm2. The upper quadword of xmm1 is left unchanged.
10038 The operation of this instruction is:
10040 \c dst[0-63] := src[64-127],
10041 \c dst[64-127] remains unchanged.
10044 \S{insMOVHPD} \i\c{MOVHPD}: Move High Packed Double-Precision FP
10046 \c MOVHPD xmm,m64 ; 66 OF 16 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10047 \c MOVHPD m64,xmm ; 66 OF 17 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10049 \c{MOVHPD} moves a double-precision FP value between the source and
10050 destination operands. One of the operands is a 64-bit memory location,
10051 the other is the high quadword of an \c{XMM} register.
10053 The operation of this instruction is:
10055 \c mem[0-63] := xmm[64-127];
10059 \c xmm[0-63] remains unchanged;
10060 \c xmm[64-127] := mem[0-63].
10063 \S{insMOVHPS} \i\c{MOVHPS}: Move High Packed Single-Precision FP
10065 \c MOVHPS xmm,m64 ; 0F 16 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
10066 \c MOVHPS m64,xmm ; 0F 17 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
10068 \c{MOVHPS} moves two packed single-precision FP values between the source
10069 and destination operands. One of the operands is a 64-bit memory location,
10070 the other is the high quadword of an \c{XMM} register.
10072 The operation of this instruction is:
10074 \c mem[0-63] := xmm[64-127];
10078 \c xmm[0-63] remains unchanged;
10079 \c xmm[64-127] := mem[0-63].
10082 \S{insMOVLHPS} \i\c{MOVLHPS}: Move Packed Single-Precision FP Low to High
10084 \c MOVLHPS xmm1,xmm2 ; OF 16 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
10086 \c{MOVLHPS} moves the two packed single-precision FP values from the
10087 low quadword of the source register xmm2 to the high quadword of the
10088 destination register, xmm2. The low quadword of xmm1 is left unchanged.
10090 The operation of this instruction is:
10092 \c dst[0-63] remains unchanged;
10093 \c dst[64-127] := src[0-63].
10095 \S{insMOVLPD} \i\c{MOVLPD}: Move Low Packed Double-Precision FP
10097 \c MOVLPD xmm,m64 ; 66 OF 12 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10098 \c MOVLPD m64,xmm ; 66 OF 13 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10100 \c{MOVLPD} moves a double-precision FP value between the source and
10101 destination operands. One of the operands is a 64-bit memory location,
10102 the other is the low quadword of an \c{XMM} register.
10104 The operation of this instruction is:
10106 \c mem(0-63) := xmm(0-63);
10110 \c xmm(0-63) := mem(0-63);
10111 \c xmm(64-127) remains unchanged.
10113 \S{insMOVLPS} \i\c{MOVLPS}: Move Low Packed Single-Precision FP
10115 \c MOVLPS xmm,m64 ; OF 12 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
10116 \c MOVLPS m64,xmm ; OF 13 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
10118 \c{MOVLPS} moves two packed single-precision FP values between the source
10119 and destination operands. One of the operands is a 64-bit memory location,
10120 the other is the low quadword of an \c{XMM} register.
10122 The operation of this instruction is:
10124 \c mem(0-63) := xmm(0-63);
10128 \c xmm(0-63) := mem(0-63);
10129 \c xmm(64-127) remains unchanged.
10132 \S{insMOVMSKPD} \i\c{MOVMSKPD}: Extract Packed Double-Precision FP Sign Mask
10134 \c MOVMSKPD reg32,xmm ; 66 0F 50 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10136 \c{MOVMSKPD} inserts a 2-bit mask in r32, formed of the most significant
10137 bits of each double-precision FP number of the source operand.
10140 \S{insMOVMSKPS} \i\c{MOVMSKPS}: Extract Packed Single-Precision FP Sign Mask
10142 \c MOVMSKPS reg32,xmm ; 0F 50 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
10144 \c{MOVMSKPS} inserts a 4-bit mask in r32, formed of the most significant
10145 bits of each single-precision FP number of the source operand.
10148 \S{insMOVNTDQ} \i\c{MOVNTDQ}: Move Double Quadword Non Temporal
10150 \c MOVNTDQ m128,xmm ; 66 0F E7 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10152 \c{MOVNTDQ} moves the double quadword from the \c{XMM} source
10153 register to the destination memory location, using a non-temporal
10154 hint. This store instruction minimizes cache pollution.
10157 \S{insMOVNTI} \i\c{MOVNTI}: Move Doubleword Non Temporal
10159 \c MOVNTI m32,reg32 ; 0F C3 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10161 \c{MOVNTI} moves the doubleword in the source register
10162 to the destination memory location, using a non-temporal
10163 hint. This store instruction minimizes cache pollution.
10166 \S{insMOVNTPD} \i\c{MOVNTPD}: Move Aligned Four Packed Single-Precision
10167 FP Values Non Temporal
10169 \c MOVNTPD m128,xmm ; 66 0F 2B /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10171 \c{MOVNTPD} moves the double quadword from the \c{XMM} source
10172 register to the destination memory location, using a non-temporal
10173 hint. This store instruction minimizes cache pollution. The memory
10174 location must be aligned to a 16-byte boundary.
10177 \S{insMOVNTPS} \i\c{MOVNTPS}: Move Aligned Four Packed Single-Precision
10178 FP Values Non Temporal
10180 \c MOVNTPS m128,xmm ; 0F 2B /r [KATMAI,SSE]
10182 \c{MOVNTPS} moves the double quadword from the \c{XMM} source
10183 register to the destination memory location, using a non-temporal
10184 hint. This store instruction minimizes cache pollution. The memory
10185 location must be aligned to a 16-byte boundary.
10188 \S{insMOVNTQ} \i\c{MOVNTQ}: Move Quadword Non Temporal
10190 \c MOVNTQ m64,mm ; 0F E7 /r [KATMAI,MMX]
10192 \c{MOVNTQ} moves the quadword in the \c{MMX} source register
10193 to the destination memory location, using a non-temporal
10194 hint. This store instruction minimizes cache pollution.
10197 \S{insMOVQ} \i\c{MOVQ}: Move Quadword to/from MMX Register
10199 \c MOVQ mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 6F /r [PENT,MMX]
10200 \c MOVQ mm1/m64,mm2 ; 0F 7F /r [PENT,MMX]
10202 \c MOVQ xmm1,xmm2/m64 ; F3 0F 7E /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10203 \c MOVQ xmm1/m64,xmm2 ; 66 0F D6 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10205 \c{MOVQ} copies 64 bits from its source (second) operand into its
10206 destination (first) operand. When the source is an \c{XMM} register,
10207 the low quadword is moved. When the destination is an \c{XMM} register,
10208 the destination is the low quadword, and the high quadword is cleared.
10211 \S{insMOVQ2DQ} \i\c{MOVQ2DQ}: Move Quadword from MMX to XMM register.
10213 \c MOVQ2DQ xmm,mm ; F3 OF D6 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10215 \c{MOVQ2DQ} moves the quadword from the source operand to the low
10216 quadword of the destination operand, and clears the high quadword.
10219 \S{insMOVSB} \i\c{MOVSB}, \i\c{MOVSW}, \i\c{MOVSD}: Move String
10221 \c MOVSB ; A4 [8086]
10222 \c MOVSW ; o16 A5 [8086]
10223 \c MOVSD ; o32 A5 [386]
10225 \c{MOVSB} copies the byte at \c{[DS:SI]} or \c{[DS:ESI]} to
10226 \c{[ES:DI]} or \c{[ES:EDI]}. It then increments or decrements
10227 (depending on the direction flag: increments if the flag is clear,
10228 decrements if it is set) \c{SI} and \c{DI} (or \c{ESI} and \c{EDI}).
10230 The registers used are \c{SI} and \c{DI} if the address size is 16
10231 bits, and \c{ESI} and \c{EDI} if it is 32 bits. If you need to use
10232 an address size not equal to the current \c{BITS} setting, you can
10233 use an explicit \i\c{a16} or \i\c{a32} prefix.
10235 The segment register used to load from \c{[SI]} or \c{[ESI]} can be
10236 overridden by using a segment register name as a prefix (for
10237 example, \c{es movsb}). The use of \c{ES} for the store to \c{[DI]}
10238 or \c{[EDI]} cannot be overridden.
10240 \c{MOVSW} and \c{MOVSD} work in the same way, but they copy a word
10241 or a doubleword instead of a byte, and increment or decrement the
10242 addressing registers by 2 or 4 instead of 1.
10244 The \c{REP} prefix may be used to repeat the instruction \c{CX} (or
10245 \c{ECX} - again, the address size chooses which) times.
10248 \S{insMOVSD} \i\c{MOVSD}: Move Scalar Double-Precision FP Value
10250 \c MOVSD xmm1,xmm2/m64 ; F2 0F 10 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10251 \c MOVSD xmm1/m64,xmm2 ; F2 0F 11 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10253 \c{MOVSD} moves a double-precision FP value from the source operand
10254 to the destination operand. When the source or destination is a
10255 register, the low-order FP value is read or written.
10258 \S{insMOVSS} \i\c{MOVSS}: Move Scalar Single-Precision FP Value
10260 \c MOVSS xmm1,xmm2/m32 ; F3 0F 10 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
10261 \c MOVSS xmm1/m32,xmm2 ; F3 0F 11 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
10263 \c{MOVSS} moves a single-precision FP value from the source operand
10264 to the destination operand. When the source or destination is a
10265 register, the low-order FP value is read or written.
10268 \S{insMOVSX} \i\c{MOVSX}, \i\c{MOVZX}: Move Data with Sign or Zero Extend
10270 \c MOVSX reg16,r/m8 ; o16 0F BE /r [386]
10271 \c MOVSX reg32,r/m8 ; o32 0F BE /r [386]
10272 \c MOVSX reg32,r/m16 ; o32 0F BF /r [386]
10274 \c MOVZX reg16,r/m8 ; o16 0F B6 /r [386]
10275 \c MOVZX reg32,r/m8 ; o32 0F B6 /r [386]
10276 \c MOVZX reg32,r/m16 ; o32 0F B7 /r [386]
10278 \c{MOVSX} sign-extends its source (second) operand to the length of
10279 its destination (first) operand, and copies the result into the
10280 destination operand. \c{MOVZX} does the same, but zero-extends
10281 rather than sign-extending.
10284 \S{insMOVUPD} \i\c{MOVUPD}: Move Unaligned Packed Double-Precision FP Values
10286 \c MOVUPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 66 0F 10 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10287 \c MOVUPD xmm1/mem128,xmm2 ; 66 0F 11 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10289 \c{MOVUPD} moves a double quadword containing 2 packed double-precision
10290 FP values from the source operand to the destination. This instruction
10291 makes no assumptions about alignment of memory operands.
10293 To move data in and out of memory locations that are known to be on 16-byte
10294 boundaries, use the \c{MOVAPD} instruction (\k{insMOVAPD}).
10297 \S{insMOVUPS} \i\c{MOVUPS}: Move Unaligned Packed Single-Precision FP Values
10299 \c MOVUPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 0F 10 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
10300 \c MOVUPS xmm1/mem128,xmm2 ; 0F 11 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
10302 \c{MOVUPS} moves a double quadword containing 4 packed single-precision
10303 FP values from the source operand to the destination. This instruction
10304 makes no assumptions about alignment of memory operands.
10306 To move data in and out of memory locations that are known to be on 16-byte
10307 boundaries, use the \c{MOVAPS} instruction (\k{insMOVAPS}).
10310 \S{insMUL} \i\c{MUL}: Unsigned Integer Multiply
10312 \c MUL r/m8 ; F6 /4 [8086]
10313 \c MUL r/m16 ; o16 F7 /4 [8086]
10314 \c MUL r/m32 ; o32 F7 /4 [386]
10316 \c{MUL} performs unsigned integer multiplication. The other operand
10317 to the multiplication, and the destination operand, are implicit, in
10320 \b For \c{MUL r/m8}, \c{AL} is multiplied by the given operand; the
10321 product is stored in \c{AX}.
10323 \b For \c{MUL r/m16}, \c{AX} is multiplied by the given operand;
10324 the product is stored in \c{DX:AX}.
10326 \b For \c{MUL r/m32}, \c{EAX} is multiplied by the given operand;
10327 the product is stored in \c{EDX:EAX}.
10329 Signed integer multiplication is performed by the \c{IMUL}
10330 instruction: see \k{insIMUL}.
10333 \S{insMULPD} \i\c{MULPD}: Packed Single-FP Multiply
10335 \c MULPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 66 0F 59 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10337 \c{MULPD} performs a SIMD multiply of the packed double-precision FP
10338 values in both operands, and stores the results in the destination register.
10341 \S{insMULPS} \i\c{MULPS}: Packed Single-FP Multiply
10343 \c MULPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 0F 59 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
10345 \c{MULPS} performs a SIMD multiply of the packed single-precision FP
10346 values in both operands, and stores the results in the destination register.
10349 \S{insMULSD} \i\c{MULSD}: Scalar Single-FP Multiply
10351 \c MULSD xmm1,xmm2/mem32 ; F2 0F 59 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10353 \c{MULSD} multiplies the lowest double-precision FP values of both
10354 operands, and stores the result in the low quadword of xmm1.
10357 \S{insMULSS} \i\c{MULSS}: Scalar Single-FP Multiply
10359 \c MULSS xmm1,xmm2/mem32 ; F3 0F 59 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
10361 \c{MULSS} multiplies the lowest single-precision FP values of both
10362 operands, and stores the result in the low doubleword of xmm1.
10365 \S{insNEG} \i\c{NEG}, \i\c{NOT}: Two's and One's Complement
10367 \c NEG r/m8 ; F6 /3 [8086]
10368 \c NEG r/m16 ; o16 F7 /3 [8086]
10369 \c NEG r/m32 ; o32 F7 /3 [386]
10371 \c NOT r/m8 ; F6 /2 [8086]
10372 \c NOT r/m16 ; o16 F7 /2 [8086]
10373 \c NOT r/m32 ; o32 F7 /2 [386]
10375 \c{NEG} replaces the contents of its operand by the two's complement
10376 negation (invert all the bits and then add one) of the original
10377 value. \c{NOT}, similarly, performs one's complement (inverts all
10381 \S{insNOP} \i\c{NOP}: No Operation
10385 \c{NOP} performs no operation. Its opcode is the same as that
10386 generated by \c{XCHG AX,AX} or \c{XCHG EAX,EAX} (depending on the
10387 processor mode; see \k{insXCHG}).
10390 \S{insOR} \i\c{OR}: Bitwise OR
10392 \c OR r/m8,reg8 ; 08 /r [8086]
10393 \c OR r/m16,reg16 ; o16 09 /r [8086]
10394 \c OR r/m32,reg32 ; o32 09 /r [386]
10396 \c OR reg8,r/m8 ; 0A /r [8086]
10397 \c OR reg16,r/m16 ; o16 0B /r [8086]
10398 \c OR reg32,r/m32 ; o32 0B /r [386]
10400 \c OR r/m8,imm8 ; 80 /1 ib [8086]
10401 \c OR r/m16,imm16 ; o16 81 /1 iw [8086]
10402 \c OR r/m32,imm32 ; o32 81 /1 id [386]
10404 \c OR r/m16,imm8 ; o16 83 /1 ib [8086]
10405 \c OR r/m32,imm8 ; o32 83 /1 ib [386]
10407 \c OR AL,imm8 ; 0C ib [8086]
10408 \c OR AX,imm16 ; o16 0D iw [8086]
10409 \c OR EAX,imm32 ; o32 0D id [386]
10411 \c{OR} performs a bitwise OR operation between its two operands
10412 (i.e. each bit of the result is 1 if and only if at least one of the
10413 corresponding bits of the two inputs was 1), and stores the result
10414 in the destination (first) operand.
10416 In the forms with an 8-bit immediate second operand and a longer
10417 first operand, the second operand is considered to be signed, and is
10418 sign-extended to the length of the first operand. In these cases,
10419 the \c{BYTE} qualifier is necessary to force NASM to generate this
10420 form of the instruction.
10422 The MMX instruction \c{POR} (see \k{insPOR}) performs the same
10423 operation on the 64-bit MMX registers.
10426 \S{insORPD} \i\c{ORPD}: Bit-wise Logical OR of Double-Precision FP Data
10428 \c ORPD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 56 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10430 \c{ORPD} return a bit-wise logical OR between xmm1 and xmm2/mem,
10431 and stores the result in xmm1. If the source operand is a memory
10432 location, it must be aligned to a 16-byte boundary.
10435 \S{insORPS} \i\c{ORPS}: Bit-wise Logical OR of Single-Precision FP Data
10437 \c ORPS xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 0F 56 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
10439 \c{ORPS} return a bit-wise logical OR between xmm1 and xmm2/mem,
10440 and stores the result in xmm1. If the source operand is a memory
10441 location, it must be aligned to a 16-byte boundary.
10444 \S{insOUT} \i\c{OUT}: Output Data to I/O Port
10446 \c OUT imm8,AL ; E6 ib [8086]
10447 \c OUT imm8,AX ; o16 E7 ib [8086]
10448 \c OUT imm8,EAX ; o32 E7 ib [386]
10449 \c OUT DX,AL ; EE [8086]
10450 \c OUT DX,AX ; o16 EF [8086]
10451 \c OUT DX,EAX ; o32 EF [386]
10453 \c{OUT} writes the contents of the given source register to the
10454 specified I/O port. The port number may be specified as an immediate
10455 value if it is between 0 and 255, and otherwise must be stored in
10456 \c{DX}. See also \c{IN} (\k{insIN}).
10459 \S{insOUTSB} \i\c{OUTSB}, \i\c{OUTSW}, \i\c{OUTSD}: Output String to I/O Port
10461 \c OUTSB ; 6E [186]
10462 \c OUTSW ; o16 6F [186]
10463 \c OUTSD ; o32 6F [386]
10465 \c{OUTSB} loads a byte from \c{[DS:SI]} or \c{[DS:ESI]} and writes
10466 it to the I/O port specified in \c{DX}. It then increments or
10467 decrements (depending on the direction flag: increments if the flag
10468 is clear, decrements if it is set) \c{SI} or \c{ESI}.
10470 The register used is \c{SI} if the address size is 16 bits, and
10471 \c{ESI} if it is 32 bits. If you need to use an address size not
10472 equal to the current \c{BITS} setting, you can use an explicit
10473 \i\c{a16} or \i\c{a32} prefix.
10475 The segment register used to load from \c{[SI]} or \c{[ESI]} can be
10476 overridden by using a segment register name as a prefix (for
10477 example, \c{es outsb}).
10479 \c{OUTSW} and \c{OUTSD} work in the same way, but they output a
10480 word or a doubleword instead of a byte, and increment or decrement
10481 the addressing registers by 2 or 4 instead of 1.
10483 The \c{REP} prefix may be used to repeat the instruction \c{CX} (or
10484 \c{ECX} - again, the address size chooses which) times.
10487 \S{insPACKSSDW} \i\c{PACKSSDW}, \i\c{PACKSSWB}, \i\c{PACKUSWB}: Pack Data
10489 \c PACKSSDW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 6B /r [PENT,MMX]
10490 \c PACKSSWB mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 63 /r [PENT,MMX]
10491 \c PACKUSWB mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 67 /r [PENT,MMX]
10493 \c PACKSSDW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 6B /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10494 \c PACKSSWB xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 63 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10495 \c PACKUSWB xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 67 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10497 All these instructions start by combining the source and destination
10498 operands, and then splitting the result in smaller sections which it
10499 then packs into the destination register. The \c{MMX} versions pack
10500 two 64-bit operands into one 64-bit register, while the \c{SSE}
10501 versions pack two 128-bit operands into one 128-bit register.
10503 \b \c{PACKSSWB} splits the combined value into words, and then reduces
10504 the words to bytes, using signed saturation. It then packs the bytes
10505 into the destination register in the same order the words were in.
10507 \b \c{PACKSSDW} performs the same operation as \c{PACKSSWB}, except that
10508 it reduces doublewords to words, then packs them into the destination
10511 \b \c{PACKUSWB} performs the same operation as \c{PACKSSWB}, except that
10512 it uses unsigned saturation when reducing the size of the elements.
10514 To perform signed saturation on a number, it is replaced by the largest
10515 signed number (\c{7FFFh} or \c{7Fh}) that \e{will} fit, and if it is too
10516 small it is replaced by the smallest signed number (\c{8000h} or
10517 \c{80h}) that will fit. To perform unsigned saturation, the input is
10518 treated as unsigned, and the input is replaced by the largest unsigned
10519 number that will fit.
10522 \S{insPADDB} \i\c{PADDB}, \i\c{PADDW}, \i\c{PADDD}: Add Packed Integers
10524 \c PADDB mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F FC /r [PENT,MMX]
10525 \c PADDW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F FD /r [PENT,MMX]
10526 \c PADDD mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F FE /r [PENT,MMX]
10528 \c PADDB xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F FC /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10529 \c PADDW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F FD /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10530 \c PADDD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F FE /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10532 \c{PADDx} performs packed addition of the two operands, storing the
10533 result in the destination (first) operand.
10535 \b \c{PADDB} treats the operands as packed bytes, and adds each byte
10538 \b \c{PADDW} treats the operands as packed words;
10540 \b \c{PADDD} treats its operands as packed doublewords.
10542 When an individual result is too large to fit in its destination, it
10543 is wrapped around and the low bits are stored, with the carry bit
10547 \S{insPADDQ} \i\c{PADDQ}: Add Packed Quadword Integers
10549 \c PADDQ mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F D4 /r [PENT,MMX]
10551 \c PADDQ xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F D4 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10553 \c{PADDQ} adds the quadwords in the source and destination operands, and
10554 stores the result in the destination register.
10556 When an individual result is too large to fit in its destination, it
10557 is wrapped around and the low bits are stored, with the carry bit
10561 \S{insPADDSB} \i\c{PADDSB}, \i\c{PADDSW}: Add Packed Signed Integers With Saturation
10563 \c PADDSB mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F EC /r [PENT,MMX]
10564 \c PADDSW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F ED /r [PENT,MMX]
10566 \c PADDSB xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F EC /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10567 \c PADDSW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F ED /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10569 \c{PADDSx} performs packed addition of the two operands, storing the
10570 result in the destination (first) operand.
10571 \c{PADDSB} treats the operands as packed bytes, and adds each byte
10572 individually; and \c{PADDSW} treats the operands as packed words.
10574 When an individual result is too large to fit in its destination, a
10575 saturated value is stored. The resulting value is the value with the
10576 largest magnitude of the same sign as the result which will fit in
10577 the available space.
10580 \S{insPADDSIW} \i\c{PADDSIW}: MMX Packed Addition to Implicit Destination
10582 \c PADDSIW mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F 51 /r [CYRIX,MMX]
10584 \c{PADDSIW}, specific to the Cyrix extensions to the MMX instruction
10585 set, performs the same function as \c{PADDSW}, except that the result
10586 is placed in an implied register.
10588 To work out the implied register, invert the lowest bit in the register
10589 number. So \c{PADDSIW MM0,MM2} would put the result in \c{MM1}, but
10590 \c{PADDSIW MM1,MM2} would put the result in \c{MM0}.
10593 \S{insPADDUSB} \i\c{PADDUSB}, \i\c{PADDUSW}: Add Packed Unsigned Integers With Saturation
10595 \c PADDUSB mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F DC /r [PENT,MMX]
10596 \c PADDUSW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F DD /r [PENT,MMX]
10598 \c PADDUSB xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F DC /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10599 \c PADDUSW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F DD /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10601 \c{PADDUSx} performs packed addition of the two operands, storing the
10602 result in the destination (first) operand.
10603 \c{PADDUSB} treats the operands as packed bytes, and adds each byte
10604 individually; and \c{PADDUSW} treats the operands as packed words.
10606 When an individual result is too large to fit in its destination, a
10607 saturated value is stored. The resulting value is the maximum value
10608 that will fit in the available space.
10611 \S{insPAND} \i\c{PAND}, \i\c{PANDN}: MMX Bitwise AND and AND-NOT
10613 \c PAND mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F DB /r [PENT,MMX]
10614 \c PANDN mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F DF /r [PENT,MMX]
10616 \c PAND xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F DB /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10617 \c PANDN xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F DF /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10620 \c{PAND} performs a bitwise AND operation between its two operands
10621 (i.e. each bit of the result is 1 if and only if the corresponding
10622 bits of the two inputs were both 1), and stores the result in the
10623 destination (first) operand.
10625 \c{PANDN} performs the same operation, but performs a one's
10626 complement operation on the destination (first) operand first.
10629 \S{insPAUSE} \i\c{PAUSE}: Spin Loop Hint
10631 \c PAUSE ; F3 90 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10633 \c{PAUSE} provides a hint to the processor that the following code
10634 is a spin loop. This improves processor performance by bypassing
10635 possible memory order violations. On older processors, this instruction
10636 operates as a \c{NOP}.
10639 \S{insPAVEB} \i\c{PAVEB}: MMX Packed Average
10641 \c PAVEB mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F 50 /r [CYRIX,MMX]
10643 \c{PAVEB}, specific to the Cyrix MMX extensions, treats its two
10644 operands as vectors of eight unsigned bytes, and calculates the
10645 average of the corresponding bytes in the operands. The resulting
10646 vector of eight averages is stored in the first operand.
10648 This opcode maps to \c{MOVMSKPS r32, xmm} on processors that support
10649 the SSE instruction set.
10652 \S{insPAVGB} \i\c{PAVGB} \i\c{PAVGW}: Average Packed Integers
10654 \c PAVGB mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F E0 /r [KATMAI,MMX]
10655 \c PAVGW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F E3 /r [KATMAI,MMX,SM]
10657 \c PAVGB xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F E0 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10658 \c PAVGW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F E3 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10660 \c{PAVGB} and \c{PAVGW} add the unsigned data elements of the source
10661 operand to the unsigned data elements of the destination register,
10662 then adds 1 to the temporary results. The results of the add are then
10663 each independently right-shifted by one bit position. The high order
10664 bits of each element are filled with the carry bits of the corresponding
10667 \b \c{PAVGB} operates on packed unsigned bytes, and
10669 \b \c{PAVGW} operates on packed unsigned words.
10672 \S{insPAVGUSB} \i\c{PAVGUSB}: Average of unsigned packed 8-bit values
10674 \c PAVGUSB mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r BF [PENT,3DNOW]
10676 \c{PAVGUSB} adds the unsigned data elements of the source operand to
10677 the unsigned data elements of the destination register, then adds 1
10678 to the temporary results. The results of the add are then each
10679 independently right-shifted by one bit position. The high order bits
10680 of each element are filled with the carry bits of the corresponding
10683 This instruction performs exactly the same operations as the \c{PAVGB}
10684 \c{MMX} instruction (\k{insPAVGB}).
10687 \S{insPCMPEQB} \i\c{PCMPxx}: Compare Packed Integers.
10689 \c PCMPEQB mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 74 /r [PENT,MMX]
10690 \c PCMPEQW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 75 /r [PENT,MMX]
10691 \c PCMPEQD mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 76 /r [PENT,MMX]
10693 \c PCMPGTB mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 64 /r [PENT,MMX]
10694 \c PCMPGTW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 65 /r [PENT,MMX]
10695 \c PCMPGTD mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 66 /r [PENT,MMX]
10697 \c PCMPEQB xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 74 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10698 \c PCMPEQW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 75 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10699 \c PCMPEQD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 76 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10701 \c PCMPGTB xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 64 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10702 \c PCMPGTW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 65 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10703 \c PCMPGTD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 66 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10705 The \c{PCMPxx} instructions all treat their operands as vectors of
10706 bytes, words, or doublewords; corresponding elements of the source
10707 and destination are compared, and the corresponding element of the
10708 destination (first) operand is set to all zeros or all ones
10709 depending on the result of the comparison.
10711 \b \c{PCMPxxB} treats the operands as vectors of bytes;
10713 \b \c{PCMPxxW} treats the operands as vectors of words;
10715 \b \c{PCMPxxD} treats the operands as vectors of doublewords;
10717 \b \c{PCMPEQx} sets the corresponding element of the destination
10718 operand to all ones if the two elements compared are equal;
10720 \b \c{PCMPGTx} sets the destination element to all ones if the element
10721 of the first (destination) operand is greater (treated as a signed
10722 integer) than that of the second (source) operand.
10725 \S{insPDISTIB} \i\c{PDISTIB}: MMX Packed Distance and Accumulate
10726 with Implied Register
10728 \c PDISTIB mm,m64 ; 0F 54 /r [CYRIX,MMX]
10730 \c{PDISTIB}, specific to the Cyrix MMX extensions, treats its two
10731 input operands as vectors of eight unsigned bytes. For each byte
10732 position, it finds the absolute difference between the bytes in that
10733 position in the two input operands, and adds that value to the byte
10734 in the same position in the implied output register. The addition is
10735 saturated to an unsigned byte in the same way as \c{PADDUSB}.
10737 To work out the implied register, invert the lowest bit in the register
10738 number. So \c{PDISTIB MM0,M64} would put the result in \c{MM1}, but
10739 \c{PDISTIB MM1,M64} would put the result in \c{MM0}.
10741 Note that \c{PDISTIB} cannot take a register as its second source
10746 \c dstI[0-7] := dstI[0-7] + ABS(src0[0-7] - src1[0-7]),
10747 \c dstI[8-15] := dstI[8-15] + ABS(src0[8-15] - src1[8-15]),
10750 \c dstI[56-63] := dstI[56-63] + ABS(src0[56-63] - src1[56-63]).
10753 \S{insPEXTRW} \i\c{PEXTRW}: Extract Word
10755 \c PEXTRW reg32,mm,imm8 ; 0F C5 /r ib [KATMAI,MMX]
10756 \c PEXTRW reg32,xmm,imm8 ; 66 0F C5 /r ib [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10758 \c{PEXTRW} moves the word in the source register (second operand)
10759 that is pointed to by the count operand (third operand), into the
10760 lower half of a 32-bit general purpose register. The upper half of
10761 the register is cleared to all 0s.
10763 When the source operand is an \c{MMX} register, the two least
10764 significant bits of the count specify the source word. When it is
10765 an \c{SSE} register, the three least significant bits specify the
10769 \S{insPF2ID} \i\c{PF2ID}: Packed Single-Precision FP to Integer Convert
10771 \c PF2ID mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r 1D [PENT,3DNOW]
10773 \c{PF2ID} converts two single-precision FP values in the source operand
10774 to signed 32-bit integers, using truncation, and stores them in the
10775 destination operand. Source values that are outside the range supported
10776 by the destination are saturated to the largest absolute value of the
10780 \S{insPF2IW} \i\c{PF2IW}: Packed Single-Precision FP to Integer Word Convert
10782 \c PF2IW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r 1C [PENT,3DNOW]
10784 \c{PF2IW} converts two single-precision FP values in the source operand
10785 to signed 16-bit integers, using truncation, and stores them in the
10786 destination operand. Source values that are outside the range supported
10787 by the destination are saturated to the largest absolute value of the
10790 \b In the K6-2 and K6-III, the 16-bit value is zero-extended to 32-bits
10793 \b In the K6-2+, K6-III+ and Athlon processors, the value is sign-extended
10794 to 32-bits before storing.
10797 \S{insPFACC} \i\c{PFACC}: Packed Single-Precision FP Accumulate
10799 \c PFACC mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r AE [PENT,3DNOW]
10801 \c{PFACC} adds the two single-precision FP values from the destination
10802 operand together, then adds the two single-precision FP values from the
10803 source operand, and places the results in the low and high doublewords
10804 of the destination operand.
10808 \c dst[0-31] := dst[0-31] + dst[32-63],
10809 \c dst[32-63] := src[0-31] + src[32-63].
10812 \S{insPFADD} \i\c{PFADD}: Packed Single-Precision FP Addition
10814 \c PFADD mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r 9E [PENT,3DNOW]
10816 \c{PFADD} performs addition on each of two packed single-precision
10819 \c dst[0-31] := dst[0-31] + src[0-31],
10820 \c dst[32-63] := dst[32-63] + src[32-63].
10823 \S{insPFCMP} \i\c{PFCMPxx}: Packed Single-Precision FP Compare
10824 \I\c{PFCMPEQ} \I\c{PFCMPGE} \I\c{PFCMPGT}
10826 \c PFCMPEQ mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r B0 [PENT,3DNOW]
10827 \c PFCMPGE mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r 90 [PENT,3DNOW]
10828 \c PFCMPGT mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r A0 [PENT,3DNOW]
10830 The \c{PFCMPxx} instructions compare the packed single-point FP values
10831 in the source and destination operands, and set the destination
10832 according to the result. If the condition is true, the destination is
10833 set to all 1s, otherwise it's set to all 0s.
10835 \b \c{PFCMPEQ} tests whether dst == src;
10837 \b \c{PFCMPGE} tests whether dst >= src;
10839 \b \c{PFCMPGT} tests whether dst > src.
10842 \S{insPFMAX} \i\c{PFMAX}: Packed Single-Precision FP Maximum
10844 \c PFMAX mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r A4 [PENT,3DNOW]
10846 \c{PFMAX} returns the higher of each pair of single-precision FP values.
10847 If the higher value is zero, it is returned as positive zero.
10850 \S{insPFMIN} \i\c{PFMIN}: Packed Single-Precision FP Minimum
10852 \c PFMIN mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r 94 [PENT,3DNOW]
10854 \c{PFMIN} returns the lower of each pair of single-precision FP values.
10855 If the lower value is zero, it is returned as positive zero.
10858 \S{insPFMUL} \i\c{PFMUL}: Packed Single-Precision FP Multiply
10860 \c PFMUL mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r B4 [PENT,3DNOW]
10862 \c{PFMUL} returns the product of each pair of single-precision FP values.
10864 \c dst[0-31] := dst[0-31] * src[0-31],
10865 \c dst[32-63] := dst[32-63] * src[32-63].
10868 \S{insPFNACC} \i\c{PFNACC}: Packed Single-Precision FP Negative Accumulate
10870 \c PFNACC mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r 8A [PENT,3DNOW]
10872 \c{PFNACC} performs a negative accumulate of the two single-precision
10873 FP values in the source and destination registers. The result of the
10874 accumulate from the destination register is stored in the low doubleword
10875 of the destination, and the result of the source accumulate is stored in
10876 the high doubleword of the destination register.
10880 \c dst[0-31] := dst[0-31] - dst[32-63],
10881 \c dst[32-63] := src[0-31] - src[32-63].
10884 \S{insPFPNACC} \i\c{PFPNACC}: Packed Single-Precision FP Mixed Accumulate
10886 \c PFPNACC mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r 8E [PENT,3DNOW]
10888 \c{PFPNACC} performs a positive accumulate of the two single-precision
10889 FP values in the source register and a negative accumulate of the
10890 destination register. The result of the accumulate from the destination
10891 register is stored in the low doubleword of the destination, and the
10892 result of the source accumulate is stored in the high doubleword of the
10893 destination register.
10897 \c dst[0-31] := dst[0-31] - dst[32-63],
10898 \c dst[32-63] := src[0-31] + src[32-63].
10901 \S{insPFRCP} \i\c{PFRCP}: Packed Single-Precision FP Reciprocal Approximation
10903 \c PFRCP mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r 96 [PENT,3DNOW]
10905 \c{PFRCP} performs a low precision estimate of the reciprocal of the
10906 low-order single-precision FP value in the source operand, storing the
10907 result in both halves of the destination register. The result is accurate
10910 For higher precision reciprocals, this instruction should be followed by
10911 two more instructions: \c{PFRCPIT1} (\k{insPFRCPIT1}) and \c{PFRCPIT2}
10912 (\k{insPFRCPIT1}). This will result in a 24-bit accuracy. For more details,
10913 see the AMD 3DNow! technology manual.
10916 \S{insPFRCPIT1} \i\c{PFRCPIT1}: Packed Single-Precision FP Reciprocal,
10917 First Iteration Step
10919 \c PFRCPIT1 mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r A6 [PENT,3DNOW]
10921 \c{PFRCPIT1} performs the first intermediate step in the calculation of
10922 the reciprocal of a single-precision FP value. The first source value
10923 (\c{mm1} is the original value, and the second source value (\c{mm2/m64}
10924 is the result of a \c{PFRCP} instruction.
10926 For the final step in a reciprocal, returning the full 24-bit accuracy
10927 of a single-precision FP value, see \c{PFRCPIT2} (\k{insPFRCPIT2}). For
10928 more details, see the AMD 3DNow! technology manual.
10931 \S{insPFRCPIT2} \i\c{PFRCPIT2}: Packed Single-Precision FP
10932 Reciprocal/ Reciprocal Square Root, Second Iteration Step
10934 \c PFRCPIT2 mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r B6 [PENT,3DNOW]
10936 \c{PFRCPIT2} performs the second and final intermediate step in the
10937 calculation of a reciprocal or reciprocal square root, refining the
10938 values returned by the \c{PFRCP} and \c{PFRSQRT} instructions,
10941 The first source value (\c{mm1}) is the output of either a \c{PFRCPIT1}
10942 or a \c{PFRSQIT1} instruction, and the second source is the output of
10943 either the \c{PFRCP} or the \c{PFRSQRT} instruction. For more details,
10944 see the AMD 3DNow! technology manual.
10947 \S{insPFRSQIT1} \i\c{PFRSQIT1}: Packed Single-Precision FP Reciprocal
10948 Square Root, First Iteration Step
10950 \c PFRSQIT1 mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r A7 [PENT,3DNOW]
10952 \c{PFRSQIT1} performs the first intermediate step in the calculation of
10953 the reciprocal square root of a single-precision FP value. The first
10954 source value (\c{mm1} is the square of the result of a \c{PFRSQRT}
10955 instruction, and the second source value (\c{mm2/m64} is the original
10958 For the final step in a calculation, returning the full 24-bit accuracy
10959 of a single-precision FP value, see \c{PFRCPIT2} (\k{insPFRCPIT2}). For
10960 more details, see the AMD 3DNow! technology manual.
10963 \S{insPFRSQRT} \i\c{PFRSQRT}: Packed Single-Precision FP Reciprocal
10964 Square Root Approximation
10966 \c PFRSQRT mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r 97 [PENT,3DNOW]
10968 \c{PFRSQRT} performs a low precision estimate of the reciprocal square
10969 root of the low-order single-precision FP value in the source operand,
10970 storing the result in both halves of the destination register. The result
10971 is accurate to 15 bits.
10973 For higher precision reciprocals, this instruction should be followed by
10974 two more instructions: \c{PFRSQIT1} (\k{insPFRSQIT1}) and \c{PFRCPIT2}
10975 (\k{insPFRCPIT1}). This will result in a 24-bit accuracy. For more details,
10976 see the AMD 3DNow! technology manual.
10979 \S{insPFSUB} \i\c{PFSUB}: Packed Single-Precision FP Subtract
10981 \c PFSUB mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r 9A [PENT,3DNOW]
10983 \c{PFSUB} subtracts the single-precision FP values in the source from
10984 those in the destination, and stores the result in the destination
10987 \c dst[0-31] := dst[0-31] - src[0-31],
10988 \c dst[32-63] := dst[32-63] - src[32-63].
10991 \S{insPFSUBR} \i\c{PFSUBR}: Packed Single-Precision FP Reverse Subtract
10993 \c PFSUBR mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r AA [PENT,3DNOW]
10995 \c{PFSUBR} subtracts the single-precision FP values in the destination
10996 from those in the source, and stores the result in the destination
10999 \c dst[0-31] := src[0-31] - dst[0-31],
11000 \c dst[32-63] := src[32-63] - dst[32-63].
11003 \S{insPI2FD} \i\c{PI2FD}: Packed Doubleword Integer to Single-Precision FP Convert
11005 \c PI2FD mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r 0D [PENT,3DNOW]
11007 \c{PF2ID} converts two signed 32-bit integers in the source operand
11008 to single-precision FP values, using truncation of significant digits,
11009 and stores them in the destination operand.
11012 \S{insPF2IW} \i\c{PF2IW}: Packed Word Integer to Single-Precision FP Convert
11014 \c PI2FW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r 0C [PENT,3DNOW]
11016 \c{PF2IW} converts two signed 16-bit integers in the source operand
11017 to single-precision FP values, and stores them in the destination
11018 operand. The input values are in the low word of each doubleword.
11021 \S{insPINSRW} \i\c{PINSRW}: Insert Word
11023 \c PINSRW mm,r16/r32/m16,imm8 ;0F C4 /r ib [KATMAI,MMX]
11024 \c PINSRW xmm,r16/r32/m16,imm8 ;66 0F C4 /r ib [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11026 \c{PINSRW} loads a word from a 16-bit register (or the low half of a
11027 32-bit register), or from memory, and loads it to the word position
11028 in the destination register, pointed at by the count operand (third
11029 operand). If the destination is an \c{MMX} register, the low two bits
11030 of the count byte are used, if it is an \c{XMM} register the low 3
11031 bits are used. The insertion is done in such a way that the other
11032 words from the destination register are left untouched.
11035 \S{insPMACHRIW} \i\c{PMACHRIW}: Packed Multiply and Accumulate with Rounding
11037 \c PMACHRIW mm,m64 ; 0F 5E /r [CYRIX,MMX]
11039 \c{PMACHRIW} takes two packed 16-bit integer inputs, multiplies the
11040 values in the inputs, rounds on bit 15 of each result, then adds bits
11041 15-30 of each result to the corresponding position of the \e{implied}
11042 destination register.
11044 The operation of this instruction is:
11046 \c dstI[0-15] := dstI[0-15] + (mm[0-15] *m64[0-15]
11047 \c + 0x00004000)[15-30],
11048 \c dstI[16-31] := dstI[16-31] + (mm[16-31]*m64[16-31]
11049 \c + 0x00004000)[15-30],
11050 \c dstI[32-47] := dstI[32-47] + (mm[32-47]*m64[32-47]
11051 \c + 0x00004000)[15-30],
11052 \c dstI[48-63] := dstI[48-63] + (mm[48-63]*m64[48-63]
11053 \c + 0x00004000)[15-30].
11055 Note that \c{PMACHRIW} cannot take a register as its second source
11059 \S{insPMADDWD} \i\c{PMADDWD}: MMX Packed Multiply and Add
11061 \c PMADDWD mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F F5 /r [PENT,MMX]
11062 \c PMADDWD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F F5 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11064 \c{PMADDWD} treats its two inputs as vectors of signed words. It
11065 multiplies corresponding elements of the two operands, giving doubleword
11066 results. These are then added together in pairs and stored in the
11067 destination operand.
11069 The operation of this instruction is:
11071 \c dst[0-31] := (dst[0-15] * src[0-15])
11072 \c + (dst[16-31] * src[16-31]);
11073 \c dst[32-63] := (dst[32-47] * src[32-47])
11074 \c + (dst[48-63] * src[48-63]);
11076 The following apply to the \c{SSE} version of the instruction:
11078 \c dst[64-95] := (dst[64-79] * src[64-79])
11079 \c + (dst[80-95] * src[80-95]);
11080 \c dst[96-127] := (dst[96-111] * src[96-111])
11081 \c + (dst[112-127] * src[112-127]).
11084 \S{insPMAGW} \i\c{PMAGW}: MMX Packed Magnitude
11086 \c PMAGW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 52 /r [CYRIX,MMX]
11088 \c{PMAGW}, specific to the Cyrix MMX extensions, treats both its
11089 operands as vectors of four signed words. It compares the absolute
11090 values of the words in corresponding positions, and sets each word
11091 of the destination (first) operand to whichever of the two words in
11092 that position had the larger absolute value.
11095 \S{insPMAXSW} \i\c{PMAXSW}: Packed Signed Integer Word Maximum
11097 \c PMAXSW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F EE /r [KATMAI,MMX]
11098 \c PMAXSW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F EE /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11100 \c{PMAXSW} compares each pair of words in the two source operands, and
11101 for each pair it stores the maximum value in the destination register.
11104 \S{insPMAXUB} \i\c{PMAXUB}: Packed Unsigned Integer Byte Maximum
11106 \c PMAXUB mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F DE /r [KATMAI,MMX]
11107 \c PMAXUB xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F DE /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11109 \c{PMAXUB} compares each pair of bytes in the two source operands, and
11110 for each pair it stores the maximum value in the destination register.
11113 \S{insPMINSW} \i\c{PMINSW}: Packed Signed Integer Word Minimum
11115 \c PMINSW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F EA /r [KATMAI,MMX]
11116 \c PMINSW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F EA /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11118 \c{PMINSW} compares each pair of words in the two source operands, and
11119 for each pair it stores the minimum value in the destination register.
11122 \S{insPMINUB} \i\c{PMINUB}: Packed Unsigned Integer Byte Minimum
11124 \c PMINUB mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F DA /r [KATMAI,MMX]
11125 \c PMINUB xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F DA /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11127 \c{PMINUB} compares each pair of bytes in the two source operands, and
11128 for each pair it stores the minimum value in the destination register.
11131 \S{insPMOVMSKB} \i\c{PMOVMSKB}: Move Byte Mask To Integer
11133 \c PMOVMSKB reg32,mm ; 0F D7 /r [KATMAI,MMX]
11134 \c PMOVMSKB reg32,xmm ; 66 0F D7 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11136 \c{PMOVMSKB} returns an 8-bit or 16-bit mask formed of the most
11137 significant bits of each byte of source operand (8-bits for an
11138 \c{MMX} register, 16-bits for an \c{XMM} register).
11141 \S{insPMULHRW} \i\c{PMULHRWC}, \i\c{PMULHRIW}: Multiply Packed 16-bit Integers
11142 With Rounding, and Store High Word
11144 \c PMULHRWC mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 59 /r [CYRIX,MMX]
11145 \c PMULHRIW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 5D /r [CYRIX,MMX]
11147 These instructions take two packed 16-bit integer inputs, multiply the
11148 values in the inputs, round on bit 15 of each result, then store bits
11149 15-30 of each result to the corresponding position of the destination
11152 \b For \c{PMULHRWC}, the destination is the first source operand.
11154 \b For \c{PMULHRIW}, the destination is an implied register (worked out
11155 as described for \c{PADDSIW} (\k{insPADDSIW})).
11157 The operation of this instruction is:
11159 \c dst[0-15] := (src1[0-15] *src2[0-15] + 0x00004000)[15-30]
11160 \c dst[16-31] := (src1[16-31]*src2[16-31] + 0x00004000)[15-30]
11161 \c dst[32-47] := (src1[32-47]*src2[32-47] + 0x00004000)[15-30]
11162 \c dst[48-63] := (src1[48-63]*src2[48-63] + 0x00004000)[15-30]
11164 See also \c{PMULHRWA} (\k{insPMULHRWA}) for a 3DNow! version of this
11168 \S{insPMULHRWA} \i\c{PMULHRWA}: Multiply Packed 16-bit Integers
11169 With Rounding, and Store High Word
11171 \c PMULHRWA mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r B7 [PENT,3DNOW]
11173 \c{PMULHRWA} takes two packed 16-bit integer inputs, multiplies
11174 the values in the inputs, rounds on bit 16 of each result, then
11175 stores bits 16-31 of each result to the corresponding position
11176 of the destination register.
11178 The operation of this instruction is:
11180 \c dst[0-15] := (src1[0-15] *src2[0-15] + 0x00008000)[16-31];
11181 \c dst[16-31] := (src1[16-31]*src2[16-31] + 0x00008000)[16-31];
11182 \c dst[32-47] := (src1[32-47]*src2[32-47] + 0x00008000)[16-31];
11183 \c dst[48-63] := (src1[48-63]*src2[48-63] + 0x00008000)[16-31].
11185 See also \c{PMULHRWC} (\k{insPMULHRW}) for a Cyrix version of this
11189 \S{insPMULHUW} \i\c{PMULHUW}: Multiply Packed 16-bit Integers,
11190 and Store High Word
11192 \c PMULHUW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F E4 /r [KATMAI,MMX]
11193 \c PMULHUW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F E4 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11195 \c{PMULHUW} takes two packed unsigned 16-bit integer inputs, multiplies
11196 the values in the inputs, then stores bits 16-31 of each result to the
11197 corresponding position of the destination register.
11200 \S{insPMULHW} \i\c{PMULHW}, \i\c{PMULLW}: Multiply Packed 16-bit Integers,
11203 \c PMULHW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F E5 /r [PENT,MMX]
11204 \c PMULLW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F D5 /r [PENT,MMX]
11206 \c PMULHW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F E5 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11207 \c PMULLW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F D5 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11209 \c{PMULxW} takes two packed unsigned 16-bit integer inputs, and
11210 multiplies the values in the inputs, forming doubleword results.
11212 \b \c{PMULHW} then stores the top 16 bits of each doubleword in the
11213 destination (first) operand;
11215 \b \c{PMULLW} stores the bottom 16 bits of each doubleword in the
11216 destination operand.
11219 \S{insPMULUDQ} \i\c{PMULUDQ}: Multiply Packed Unsigned
11220 32-bit Integers, and Store.
11222 \c PMULUDQ mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F F4 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11223 \c PMULUDQ xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F F4 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11225 \c{PMULUDQ} takes two packed unsigned 32-bit integer inputs, and
11226 multiplies the values in the inputs, forming quadword results. The
11227 source is either an unsigned doubleword in the low doubleword of a
11228 64-bit operand, or it's two unsigned doublewords in the first and
11229 third doublewords of a 128-bit operand. This produces either one or
11230 two 64-bit results, which are stored in the respective quadword
11231 locations of the destination register.
11235 \c dst[0-63] := dst[0-31] * src[0-31];
11236 \c dst[64-127] := dst[64-95] * src[64-95].
11239 \S{insPMVccZB} \i\c{PMVccZB}: MMX Packed Conditional Move
11241 \c PMVZB mmxreg,mem64 ; 0F 58 /r [CYRIX,MMX]
11242 \c PMVNZB mmxreg,mem64 ; 0F 5A /r [CYRIX,MMX]
11243 \c PMVLZB mmxreg,mem64 ; 0F 5B /r [CYRIX,MMX]
11244 \c PMVGEZB mmxreg,mem64 ; 0F 5C /r [CYRIX,MMX]
11246 These instructions, specific to the Cyrix MMX extensions, perform
11247 parallel conditional moves. The two input operands are treated as
11248 vectors of eight bytes. Each byte of the destination (first) operand
11249 is either written from the corresponding byte of the source (second)
11250 operand, or left alone, depending on the value of the byte in the
11251 \e{implied} operand (specified in the same way as \c{PADDSIW}, in
11254 \b \c{PMVZB} performs each move if the corresponding byte in the
11255 implied operand is zero;
11257 \b \c{PMVNZB} moves if the byte is non-zero;
11259 \b \c{PMVLZB} moves if the byte is less than zero;
11261 \b \c{PMVGEZB} moves if the byte is greater than or equal to zero.
11263 Note that these instructions cannot take a register as their second
11267 \S{insPOP} \i\c{POP}: Pop Data from Stack
11269 \c POP reg16 ; o16 58+r [8086]
11270 \c POP reg32 ; o32 58+r [386]
11272 \c POP r/m16 ; o16 8F /0 [8086]
11273 \c POP r/m32 ; o32 8F /0 [386]
11275 \c POP CS ; 0F [8086,UNDOC]
11276 \c POP DS ; 1F [8086]
11277 \c POP ES ; 07 [8086]
11278 \c POP SS ; 17 [8086]
11279 \c POP FS ; 0F A1 [386]
11280 \c POP GS ; 0F A9 [386]
11282 \c{POP} loads a value from the stack (from \c{[SS:SP]} or
11283 \c{[SS:ESP]}) and then increments the stack pointer.
11285 The address-size attribute of the instruction determines whether
11286 \c{SP} or \c{ESP} is used as the stack pointer: to deliberately
11287 override the default given by the \c{BITS} setting, you can use an
11288 \i\c{a16} or \i\c{a32} prefix.
11290 The operand-size attribute of the instruction determines whether the
11291 stack pointer is incremented by 2 or 4: this means that segment
11292 register pops in \c{BITS 32} mode will pop 4 bytes off the stack and
11293 discard the upper two of them. If you need to override that, you can
11294 use an \i\c{o16} or \i\c{o32} prefix.
11296 The above opcode listings give two forms for general-purpose
11297 register pop instructions: for example, \c{POP BX} has the two forms
11298 \c{5B} and \c{8F C3}. NASM will always generate the shorter form
11299 when given \c{POP BX}. NDISASM will disassemble both.
11301 \c{POP CS} is not a documented instruction, and is not supported on
11302 any processor above the 8086 (since they use \c{0Fh} as an opcode
11303 prefix for instruction set extensions). However, at least some 8086
11304 processors do support it, and so NASM generates it for completeness.
11307 \S{insPOPA} \i\c{POPAx}: Pop All General-Purpose Registers
11310 \c POPAW ; o16 61 [186]
11311 \c POPAD ; o32 61 [386]
11313 \b \c{POPAW} pops a word from the stack into each of, successively,
11314 \c{DI}, \c{SI}, \c{BP}, nothing (it discards a word from the stack
11315 which was a placeholder for \c{SP}), \c{BX}, \c{DX}, \c{CX} and
11316 \c{AX}. It is intended to reverse the operation of \c{PUSHAW} (see
11317 \k{insPUSHA}), but it ignores the value for \c{SP} that was pushed
11318 on the stack by \c{PUSHAW}.
11320 \b \c{POPAD} pops twice as much data, and places the results in
11321 \c{EDI}, \c{ESI}, \c{EBP}, nothing (placeholder for \c{ESP}),
11322 \c{EBX}, \c{EDX}, \c{ECX} and \c{EAX}. It reverses the operation of
11325 \c{POPA} is an alias mnemonic for either \c{POPAW} or \c{POPAD},
11326 depending on the current \c{BITS} setting.
11328 Note that the registers are popped in reverse order of their numeric
11329 values in opcodes (see \k{iref-rv}).
11332 \S{insPOPF} \i\c{POPFx}: Pop Flags Register
11334 \c POPF ; 9D [8086]
11335 \c POPFW ; o16 9D [8086]
11336 \c POPFD ; o32 9D [386]
11338 \b \c{POPFW} pops a word from the stack and stores it in the bottom 16
11339 bits of the flags register (or the whole flags register, on
11340 processors below a 386).
11342 \b \c{POPFD} pops a doubleword and stores it in the entire flags register.
11344 \c{POPF} is an alias mnemonic for either \c{POPFW} or \c{POPFD},
11345 depending on the current \c{BITS} setting.
11347 See also \c{PUSHF} (\k{insPUSHF}).
11350 \S{insPOR} \i\c{POR}: MMX Bitwise OR
11352 \c POR mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F EB /r [PENT,MMX]
11353 \c POR xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F EB /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11355 \c{POR} performs a bitwise OR operation between its two operands
11356 (i.e. each bit of the result is 1 if and only if at least one of the
11357 corresponding bits of the two inputs was 1), and stores the result
11358 in the destination (first) operand.
11361 \S{insPREFETCH} \i\c{PREFETCH}: Prefetch Data Into Caches
11363 \c PREFETCH mem8 ; 0F 0D /0 [PENT,3DNOW]
11364 \c PREFETCHW mem8 ; 0F 0D /1 [PENT,3DNOW]
11366 \c{PREFETCH} and \c{PREFETCHW} fetch the line of data from memory that
11367 contains the specified byte. \c{PREFETCHW} performs differently on the
11368 Athlon to earlier processors.
11370 For more details, see the 3DNow! Technology Manual.
11373 \S{insPREFETCHh} \i\c{PREFETCHh}: Prefetch Data Into Caches
11374 \I\c{PREFETCHNTA} \I\c{PREFETCHT0} \I\c{PREFETCHT1} \I\c{PREFETCHT2}
11376 \c PREFETCHNTA m8 ; 0F 18 /0 [KATMAI]
11377 \c PREFETCHT0 m8 ; 0F 18 /1 [KATMAI]
11378 \c PREFETCHT1 m8 ; 0F 18 /2 [KATMAI]
11379 \c PREFETCHT2 m8 ; 0F 18 /3 [KATMAI]
11381 The \c{PREFETCHh} instructions fetch the line of data from memory
11382 that contains the specified byte. It is placed in the cache
11383 according to rules specified by locality hints \c{h}:
11387 \b \c{T0} (temporal data) - prefetch data into all levels of the
11390 \b \c{T1} (temporal data with respect to first level cache) -
11391 prefetch data into level 2 cache and higher.
11393 \b \c{T2} (temporal data with respect to second level cache) -
11394 prefetch data into level 2 cache and higher.
11396 \b \c{NTA} (non-temporal data with respect to all cache levels) -
11397 prefetch data into non-temporal cache structure and into a
11398 location close to the processor, minimizing cache pollution.
11400 Note that this group of instructions doesn't provide a guarantee
11401 that the data will be in the cache when it is needed. For more
11402 details, see the Intel IA32 Software Developer Manual, Volume 2.
11405 \S{insPSADBW} \i\c{PSADBW}: Packed Sum of Absolute Differences
11407 \c PSADBW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F F6 /r [KATMAI,MMX]
11408 \c PSADBW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F F6 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11410 \c{PSADBW} The PSADBW instruction computes the absolute value of the
11411 difference of the packed unsigned bytes in the two source operands.
11412 These differences are then summed to produce a word result in the lower
11413 16-bit field of the destination register; the rest of the register is
11414 cleared. The destination operand is an \c{MMX} or an \c{XMM} register.
11415 The source operand can either be a register or a memory operand.
11418 \S{insPSHUFD} \i\c{PSHUFD}: Shuffle Packed Doublewords
11420 \c PSHUFD xmm1,xmm2/m128,imm8 ; 66 0F 70 /r ib [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11422 \c{PSHUFD} shuffles the doublewords in the source (second) operand
11423 according to the encoding specified by imm8, and stores the result
11424 in the destination (first) operand.
11426 Bits 0 and 1 of imm8 encode the source position of the doubleword to
11427 be copied to position 0 in the destination operand. Bits 2 and 3
11428 encode for position 1, bits 4 and 5 encode for position 2, and bits
11429 6 and 7 encode for position 3. For example, an encoding of 10 in
11430 bits 0 and 1 of imm8 indicates that the doubleword at bits 64-95 of
11431 the source operand will be copied to bits 0-31 of the destination.
11434 \S{insPSHUFHW} \i\c{PSHUFHW}: Shuffle Packed High Words
11436 \c PSHUFHW xmm1,xmm2/m128,imm8 ; F3 0F 70 /r ib [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11438 \c{PSHUFW} shuffles the words in the high quadword of the source
11439 (second) operand according to the encoding specified by imm8, and
11440 stores the result in the high quadword of the destination (first)
11443 The operation of this instruction is similar to the \c{PSHUFW}
11444 instruction, except that the source and destination are the top
11445 quadword of a 128-bit operand, instead of being 64-bit operands.
11446 The low quadword is copied from the source to the destination
11447 without any changes.
11450 \S{insPSHUFLW} \i\c{PSHUFLW}: Shuffle Packed Low Words
11452 \c PSHUFLW xmm1,xmm2/m128,imm8 ; F2 0F 70 /r ib [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11454 \c{PSHUFLW} shuffles the words in the low quadword of the source
11455 (second) operand according to the encoding specified by imm8, and
11456 stores the result in the low quadword of the destination (first)
11459 The operation of this instruction is similar to the \c{PSHUFW}
11460 instruction, except that the source and destination are the low
11461 quadword of a 128-bit operand, instead of being 64-bit operands.
11462 The high quadword is copied from the source to the destination
11463 without any changes.
11466 \S{insPSHUFW} \i\c{PSHUFW}: Shuffle Packed Words
11468 \c PSHUFW mm1,mm2/m64,imm8 ; 0F 70 /r ib [KATMAI,MMX]
11470 \c{PSHUFW} shuffles the words in the source (second) operand
11471 according to the encoding specified by imm8, and stores the result
11472 in the destination (first) operand.
11474 Bits 0 and 1 of imm8 encode the source position of the word to be
11475 copied to position 0 in the destination operand. Bits 2 and 3 encode
11476 for position 1, bits 4 and 5 encode for position 2, and bits 6 and 7
11477 encode for position 3. For example, an encoding of 10 in bits 0 and 1
11478 of imm8 indicates that the word at bits 32-47 of the source operand
11479 will be copied to bits 0-15 of the destination.
11482 \S{insPSLLD} \i\c{PSLLx}: Packed Data Bit Shift Left Logical
11484 \c PSLLW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F F1 /r [PENT,MMX]
11485 \c PSLLW mm,imm8 ; 0F 71 /6 ib [PENT,MMX]
11487 \c PSLLW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F F1 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11488 \c PSLLW xmm,imm8 ; 66 0F 71 /6 ib [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11490 \c PSLLD mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F F2 /r [PENT,MMX]
11491 \c PSLLD mm,imm8 ; 0F 72 /6 ib [PENT,MMX]
11493 \c PSLLD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F F2 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11494 \c PSLLD xmm,imm8 ; 66 0F 72 /6 ib [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11496 \c PSLLQ mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F F3 /r [PENT,MMX]
11497 \c PSLLQ mm,imm8 ; 0F 73 /6 ib [PENT,MMX]
11499 \c PSLLQ xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F F3 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11500 \c PSLLQ xmm,imm8 ; 66 0F 73 /6 ib [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11502 \c PSLLDQ xmm1,imm8 ; 66 0F 73 /7 ib [PENT,MMX]
11504 \c{PSLLx} performs logical left shifts of the data elements in the
11505 destination (first) operand, moving each bit in the separate elements
11506 left by the number of bits specified in the source (second) operand,
11507 clearing the low-order bits as they are vacated.
11509 \b \c{PSLLW} shifts word sized elements.
11511 \b \c{PSLLD} shifts doubleword sized elements.
11513 \b \c{PSLLQ} shifts quadword sized elements.
11515 \b \c{PSLLDQ} shifts double quadword sized elements.
11518 \S{insPSRAD} \i\c{PSRAx}: Packed Data Bit Shift Right Arithmetic
11520 \c PSRAW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F E1 /r [PENT,MMX]
11521 \c PSRAW mm,imm8 ; 0F 71 /4 ib [PENT,MMX]
11523 \c PSRAW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F E1 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11524 \c PSRAW xmm,imm8 ; 66 0F 71 /4 ib [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11526 \c PSRAD mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F E2 /r [PENT,MMX]
11527 \c PSRAD mm,imm8 ; 0F 72 /4 ib [PENT,MMX]
11529 \c PSRAD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F E2 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11530 \c PSRAD xmm,imm8 ; 66 0F 72 /4 ib [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11532 \c{PSRAx} performs arithmetic right shifts of the data elements in the
11533 destination (first) operand, moving each bit in the separate elements
11534 right by the number of bits specified in the source (second) operand,
11535 setting the high-order bits to the value of the original sign bit.
11537 \b \c{PSRAW} shifts word sized elements.
11539 \b \c{PSRAD} shifts doubleword sized elements.
11542 \S{insPSRLD} \i\c{PSRLx}: Packed Data Bit Shift Right Logical
11544 \c PSRLW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F D1 /r [PENT,MMX]
11545 \c PSRLW mm,imm8 ; 0F 71 /2 ib [PENT,MMX]
11547 \c PSRLW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F D1 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11548 \c PSRLW xmm,imm8 ; 66 0F 71 /2 ib [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11550 \c PSRLD mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F D2 /r [PENT,MMX]
11551 \c PSRLD mm,imm8 ; 0F 72 /2 ib [PENT,MMX]
11553 \c PSRLD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F D2 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11554 \c PSRLD xmm,imm8 ; 66 0F 72 /2 ib [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11556 \c PSRLQ mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F D3 /r [PENT,MMX]
11557 \c PSRLQ mm,imm8 ; 0F 73 /2 ib [PENT,MMX]
11559 \c PSRLQ xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F D3 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11560 \c PSRLQ xmm,imm8 ; 66 0F 73 /2 ib [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11562 \c PSRLDQ xmm1,imm8 ; 66 0F 73 /3 ib [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11564 \c{PSRLx} performs logical right shifts of the data elements in the
11565 destination (first) operand, moving each bit in the separate elements
11566 right by the number of bits specified in the source (second) operand,
11567 clearing the high-order bits as they are vacated.
11569 \b \c{PSRLW} shifts word sized elements.
11571 \b \c{PSRLD} shifts doubleword sized elements.
11573 \b \c{PSRLQ} shifts quadword sized elements.
11575 \b \c{PSRLDQ} shifts double quadword sized elements.
11578 \S{insPSUBB} \i\c{PSUBx}: Subtract Packed Integers
11580 \c PSUBB mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F F8 /r [PENT,MMX]
11581 \c PSUBW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F F9 /r [PENT,MMX]
11582 \c PSUBD mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F FA /r [PENT,MMX]
11583 \c PSUBQ mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F FB /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11585 \c PSUBB xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F F8 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11586 \c PSUBW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F F9 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11587 \c PSUBD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F FA /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11588 \c PSUBQ xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F FB /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11590 \c{PSUBx} subtracts packed integers in the source operand from those
11591 in the destination operand. It doesn't differentiate between signed
11592 and unsigned integers, and doesn't set any of the flags.
11594 \b \c{PSUBB} operates on byte sized elements.
11596 \b \c{PSUBW} operates on word sized elements.
11598 \b \c{PSUBD} operates on doubleword sized elements.
11600 \b \c{PSUBQ} operates on quadword sized elements.
11603 \S{insPSUBSB} \i\c{PSUBSxx}, \i\c{PSUBUSx}: Subtract Packed Integers With Saturation
11605 \c PSUBSB mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F E8 /r [PENT,MMX]
11606 \c PSUBSW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F E9 /r [PENT,MMX]
11608 \c PSUBSB xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F E8 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11609 \c PSUBSW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F E9 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11611 \c PSUBUSB mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F D8 /r [PENT,MMX]
11612 \c PSUBUSW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F D9 /r [PENT,MMX]
11614 \c PSUBUSB xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F D8 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11615 \c PSUBUSW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F D9 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11617 \c{PSUBSx} and \c{PSUBUSx} subtracts packed integers in the source
11618 operand from those in the destination operand, and use saturation for
11619 results that are outside the range supported by the destination operand.
11621 \b \c{PSUBSB} operates on signed bytes, and uses signed saturation on the
11624 \b \c{PSUBSW} operates on signed words, and uses signed saturation on the
11627 \b \c{PSUBUSB} operates on unsigned bytes, and uses signed saturation on
11630 \b \c{PSUBUSW} operates on unsigned words, and uses signed saturation on
11634 \S{insPSUBSIW} \i\c{PSUBSIW}: MMX Packed Subtract with Saturation to
11635 Implied Destination
11637 \c PSUBSIW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 55 /r [CYRIX,MMX]
11639 \c{PSUBSIW}, specific to the Cyrix extensions to the MMX instruction
11640 set, performs the same function as \c{PSUBSW}, except that the
11641 result is not placed in the register specified by the first operand,
11642 but instead in the implied destination register, specified as for
11643 \c{PADDSIW} (\k{insPADDSIW}).
11646 \S{insPSWAPD} \i\c{PSWAPD}: Swap Packed Data
11649 \c PSWAPD mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r BB [PENT,3DNOW]
11651 \c{PSWAPD} swaps the packed doublewords in the source operand, and
11652 stores the result in the destination operand.
11654 In the \c{K6-2} and \c{K6-III} processors, this opcode uses the
11655 mnemonic \c{PSWAPW}, and it swaps the order of words when copying
11656 from the source to the destination.
11658 The operation in the \c{K6-2} and \c{K6-III} processors is
11660 \c dst[0-15] = src[48-63];
11661 \c dst[16-31] = src[32-47];
11662 \c dst[32-47] = src[16-31];
11663 \c dst[48-63] = src[0-15].
11665 The operation in the \c{K6-x+}, \c{ATHLON} and later processors is:
11667 \c dst[0-31] = src[32-63];
11668 \c dst[32-63] = src[0-31].
11671 \S{insPUNPCKHBW} \i\c{PUNPCKxxx}: Unpack and Interleave Data
11673 \c PUNPCKHBW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 68 /r [PENT,MMX]
11674 \c PUNPCKHWD mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 69 /r [PENT,MMX]
11675 \c PUNPCKHDQ mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 6A /r [PENT,MMX]
11677 \c PUNPCKHBW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 68 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11678 \c PUNPCKHWD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 69 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11679 \c PUNPCKHDQ xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 6A /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11680 \c PUNPCKHQDQ xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 6D /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11682 \c PUNPCKLBW mm1,mm2/m32 ; 0F 60 /r [PENT,MMX]
11683 \c PUNPCKLWD mm1,mm2/m32 ; 0F 61 /r [PENT,MMX]
11684 \c PUNPCKLDQ mm1,mm2/m32 ; 0F 62 /r [PENT,MMX]
11686 \c PUNPCKLBW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 60 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11687 \c PUNPCKLWD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 61 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11688 \c PUNPCKLDQ xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 62 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11689 \c PUNPCKLQDQ xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 6C /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11691 \c{PUNPCKxx} all treat their operands as vectors, and produce a new
11692 vector generated by interleaving elements from the two inputs. The
11693 \c{PUNPCKHxx} instructions start by throwing away the bottom half of
11694 each input operand, and the \c{PUNPCKLxx} instructions throw away
11697 The remaining elements, are then interleaved into the destination,
11698 alternating elements from the second (source) operand and the first
11699 (destination) operand: so the leftmost part of each element in the
11700 result always comes from the second operand, and the rightmost from
11703 \b \c{PUNPCKxBW} works a byte at a time, producing word sized output
11706 \b \c{PUNPCKxWD} works a word at a time, producing doubleword sized
11709 \b \c{PUNPCKxDQ} works a doubleword at a time, producing quadword sized
11712 \b \c{PUNPCKxQDQ} works a quadword at a time, producing double quadword
11713 sized output elements.
11715 So, for example, for \c{MMX} operands, if the first operand held
11716 \c{0x7A6A5A4A3A2A1A0A} and the second held \c{0x7B6B5B4B3B2B1B0B},
11719 \b \c{PUNPCKHBW} would return \c{0x7B7A6B6A5B5A4B4A}.
11721 \b \c{PUNPCKHWD} would return \c{0x7B6B7A6A5B4B5A4A}.
11723 \b \c{PUNPCKHDQ} would return \c{0x7B6B5B4B7A6A5A4A}.
11725 \b \c{PUNPCKLBW} would return \c{0x3B3A2B2A1B1A0B0A}.
11727 \b \c{PUNPCKLWD} would return \c{0x3B2B3A2A1B0B1A0A}.
11729 \b \c{PUNPCKLDQ} would return \c{0x3B2B1B0B3A2A1A0A}.
11732 \S{insPUSH} \i\c{PUSH}: Push Data on Stack
11734 \c PUSH reg16 ; o16 50+r [8086]
11735 \c PUSH reg32 ; o32 50+r [386]
11737 \c PUSH r/m16 ; o16 FF /6 [8086]
11738 \c PUSH r/m32 ; o32 FF /6 [386]
11740 \c PUSH CS ; 0E [8086]
11741 \c PUSH DS ; 1E [8086]
11742 \c PUSH ES ; 06 [8086]
11743 \c PUSH SS ; 16 [8086]
11744 \c PUSH FS ; 0F A0 [386]
11745 \c PUSH GS ; 0F A8 [386]
11747 \c PUSH imm8 ; 6A ib [186]
11748 \c PUSH imm16 ; o16 68 iw [186]
11749 \c PUSH imm32 ; o32 68 id [386]
11751 \c{PUSH} decrements the stack pointer (\c{SP} or \c{ESP}) by 2 or 4,
11752 and then stores the given value at \c{[SS:SP]} or \c{[SS:ESP]}.
11754 The address-size attribute of the instruction determines whether
11755 \c{SP} or \c{ESP} is used as the stack pointer: to deliberately
11756 override the default given by the \c{BITS} setting, you can use an
11757 \i\c{a16} or \i\c{a32} prefix.
11759 The operand-size attribute of the instruction determines whether the
11760 stack pointer is decremented by 2 or 4: this means that segment
11761 register pushes in \c{BITS 32} mode will push 4 bytes on the stack,
11762 of which the upper two are undefined. If you need to override that,
11763 you can use an \i\c{o16} or \i\c{o32} prefix.
11765 The above opcode listings give two forms for general-purpose
11766 \i{register push} instructions: for example, \c{PUSH BX} has the two
11767 forms \c{53} and \c{FF F3}. NASM will always generate the shorter
11768 form when given \c{PUSH BX}. NDISASM will disassemble both.
11770 Unlike the undocumented and barely supported \c{POP CS}, \c{PUSH CS}
11771 is a perfectly valid and sensible instruction, supported on all
11774 The instruction \c{PUSH SP} may be used to distinguish an 8086 from
11775 later processors: on an 8086, the value of \c{SP} stored is the
11776 value it has \e{after} the push instruction, whereas on later
11777 processors it is the value \e{before} the push instruction.
11780 \S{insPUSHA} \i\c{PUSHAx}: Push All General-Purpose Registers
11782 \c PUSHA ; 60 [186]
11783 \c PUSHAD ; o32 60 [386]
11784 \c PUSHAW ; o16 60 [186]
11786 \c{PUSHAW} pushes, in succession, \c{AX}, \c{CX}, \c{DX}, \c{BX},
11787 \c{SP}, \c{BP}, \c{SI} and \c{DI} on the stack, decrementing the
11788 stack pointer by a total of 16.
11790 \c{PUSHAD} pushes, in succession, \c{EAX}, \c{ECX}, \c{EDX},
11791 \c{EBX}, \c{ESP}, \c{EBP}, \c{ESI} and \c{EDI} on the stack,
11792 decrementing the stack pointer by a total of 32.
11794 In both cases, the value of \c{SP} or \c{ESP} pushed is its
11795 \e{original} value, as it had before the instruction was executed.
11797 \c{PUSHA} is an alias mnemonic for either \c{PUSHAW} or \c{PUSHAD},
11798 depending on the current \c{BITS} setting.
11800 Note that the registers are pushed in order of their numeric values
11801 in opcodes (see \k{iref-rv}).
11803 See also \c{POPA} (\k{insPOPA}).
11806 \S{insPUSHF} \i\c{PUSHFx}: Push Flags Register
11808 \c PUSHF ; 9C [8086]
11809 \c PUSHFD ; o32 9C [386]
11810 \c PUSHFW ; o16 9C [8086]
11812 \b \c{PUSHFW} pops a word from the stack and stores it in the
11813 bottom 16 bits of the flags register (or the whole flags register,
11814 on processors below a 386).
11816 \b \c{PUSHFD} pops a doubleword and stores it in the entire flags
11819 \c{PUSHF} is an alias mnemonic for either \c{PUSHFW} or \c{PUSHFD},
11820 depending on the current \c{BITS} setting.
11822 See also \c{POPF} (\k{insPOPF}).
11825 \S{insPXOR} \i\c{PXOR}: MMX Bitwise XOR
11827 \c PXOR mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F EF /r [PENT,MMX]
11828 \c PXOR xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F EF /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11830 \c{PXOR} performs a bitwise XOR operation between its two operands
11831 (i.e. each bit of the result is 1 if and only if exactly one of the
11832 corresponding bits of the two inputs was 1), and stores the result
11833 in the destination (first) operand.
11836 \S{insRCL} \i\c{RCL}, \i\c{RCR}: Bitwise Rotate through Carry Bit
11838 \c RCL r/m8,1 ; D0 /2 [8086]
11839 \c RCL r/m8,CL ; D2 /2 [8086]
11840 \c RCL r/m8,imm8 ; C0 /2 ib [186]
11841 \c RCL r/m16,1 ; o16 D1 /2 [8086]
11842 \c RCL r/m16,CL ; o16 D3 /2 [8086]
11843 \c RCL r/m16,imm8 ; o16 C1 /2 ib [186]
11844 \c RCL r/m32,1 ; o32 D1 /2 [386]
11845 \c RCL r/m32,CL ; o32 D3 /2 [386]
11846 \c RCL r/m32,imm8 ; o32 C1 /2 ib [386]
11848 \c RCR r/m8,1 ; D0 /3 [8086]
11849 \c RCR r/m8,CL ; D2 /3 [8086]
11850 \c RCR r/m8,imm8 ; C0 /3 ib [186]
11851 \c RCR r/m16,1 ; o16 D1 /3 [8086]
11852 \c RCR r/m16,CL ; o16 D3 /3 [8086]
11853 \c RCR r/m16,imm8 ; o16 C1 /3 ib [186]
11854 \c RCR r/m32,1 ; o32 D1 /3 [386]
11855 \c RCR r/m32,CL ; o32 D3 /3 [386]
11856 \c RCR r/m32,imm8 ; o32 C1 /3 ib [386]
11858 \c{RCL} and \c{RCR} perform a 9-bit, 17-bit or 33-bit bitwise
11859 rotation operation, involving the given source/destination (first)
11860 operand and the carry bit. Thus, for example, in the operation
11861 \c{RCL AL,1}, a 9-bit rotation is performed in which \c{AL} is
11862 shifted left by 1, the top bit of \c{AL} moves into the carry flag,
11863 and the original value of the carry flag is placed in the low bit of
11866 The number of bits to rotate by is given by the second operand. Only
11867 the bottom five bits of the rotation count are considered by
11868 processors above the 8086.
11870 You can force the longer (286 and upwards, beginning with a \c{C1}
11871 byte) form of \c{RCL foo,1} by using a \c{BYTE} prefix: \c{RCL
11872 foo,BYTE 1}. Similarly with \c{RCR}.
11875 \S{insRCPPS} \i\c{RCPPS}: Packed Single-Precision FP Reciprocal
11877 \c RCPPS xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 0F 53 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
11879 \c{RCPPS} returns an approximation of the reciprocal of the packed
11880 single-precision FP values from xmm2/m128. The maximum error for this
11881 approximation is: |Error| <= 1.5 x 2^-12
11884 \S{insRCPSS} \i\c{RCPSS}: Scalar Single-Precision FP Reciprocal
11886 \c RCPSS xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; F3 0F 53 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
11888 \c{RCPSS} returns an approximation of the reciprocal of the lower
11889 single-precision FP value from xmm2/m32; the upper three fields are
11890 passed through from xmm1. The maximum error for this approximation is:
11891 |Error| <= 1.5 x 2^-12
11894 \S{insRDMSR} \i\c{RDMSR}: Read Model-Specific Registers
11896 \c RDMSR ; 0F 32 [PENT,PRIV]
11898 \c{RDMSR} reads the processor Model-Specific Register (MSR) whose
11899 index is stored in \c{ECX}, and stores the result in \c{EDX:EAX}.
11900 See also \c{WRMSR} (\k{insWRMSR}).
11903 \S{insRDPMC} \i\c{RDPMC}: Read Performance-Monitoring Counters
11905 \c RDPMC ; 0F 33 [P6]
11907 \c{RDPMC} reads the processor performance-monitoring counter whose
11908 index is stored in \c{ECX}, and stores the result in \c{EDX:EAX}.
11910 This instruction is available on P6 and later processors and on MMX
11914 \S{insRDSHR} \i\c{RDSHR}: Read SMM Header Pointer Register
11916 \c RDSHR r/m32 ; 0F 36 /0 [386,CYRIX,SMM]
11918 \c{RDSHR} reads the contents of the SMM header pointer register and
11919 saves it to the destination operand, which can be either a 32 bit
11920 memory location or a 32 bit register.
11922 See also \c{WRSHR} (\k{insWRSHR}).
11925 \S{insRDTSC} \i\c{RDTSC}: Read Time-Stamp Counter
11927 \c RDTSC ; 0F 31 [PENT]
11929 \c{RDTSC} reads the processor's time-stamp counter into \c{EDX:EAX}.
11932 \S{insRET} \i\c{RET}, \i\c{RETF}, \i\c{RETN}: Return from Procedure Call
11935 \c RET imm16 ; C2 iw [8086]
11937 \c RETF ; CB [8086]
11938 \c RETF imm16 ; CA iw [8086]
11940 \c RETN ; C3 [8086]
11941 \c RETN imm16 ; C2 iw [8086]
11943 \b \c{RET}, and its exact synonym \c{RETN}, pop \c{IP} or \c{EIP} from
11944 the stack and transfer control to the new address. Optionally, if a
11945 numeric second operand is provided, they increment the stack pointer
11946 by a further \c{imm16} bytes after popping the return address.
11948 \b \c{RETF} executes a far return: after popping \c{IP}/\c{EIP}, it
11949 then pops \c{CS}, and \e{then} increments the stack pointer by the
11950 optional argument if present.
11953 \S{insROL} \i\c{ROL}, \i\c{ROR}: Bitwise Rotate
11955 \c ROL r/m8,1 ; D0 /0 [8086]
11956 \c ROL r/m8,CL ; D2 /0 [8086]
11957 \c ROL r/m8,imm8 ; C0 /0 ib [186]
11958 \c ROL r/m16,1 ; o16 D1 /0 [8086]
11959 \c ROL r/m16,CL ; o16 D3 /0 [8086]
11960 \c ROL r/m16,imm8 ; o16 C1 /0 ib [186]
11961 \c ROL r/m32,1 ; o32 D1 /0 [386]
11962 \c ROL r/m32,CL ; o32 D3 /0 [386]
11963 \c ROL r/m32,imm8 ; o32 C1 /0 ib [386]
11965 \c ROR r/m8,1 ; D0 /1 [8086]
11966 \c ROR r/m8,CL ; D2 /1 [8086]
11967 \c ROR r/m8,imm8 ; C0 /1 ib [186]
11968 \c ROR r/m16,1 ; o16 D1 /1 [8086]
11969 \c ROR r/m16,CL ; o16 D3 /1 [8086]
11970 \c ROR r/m16,imm8 ; o16 C1 /1 ib [186]
11971 \c ROR r/m32,1 ; o32 D1 /1 [386]
11972 \c ROR r/m32,CL ; o32 D3 /1 [386]
11973 \c ROR r/m32,imm8 ; o32 C1 /1 ib [386]
11975 \c{ROL} and \c{ROR} perform a bitwise rotation operation on the given
11976 source/destination (first) operand. Thus, for example, in the
11977 operation \c{ROL AL,1}, an 8-bit rotation is performed in which
11978 \c{AL} is shifted left by 1 and the original top bit of \c{AL} moves
11979 round into the low bit.
11981 The number of bits to rotate by is given by the second operand. Only
11982 the bottom five bits of the rotation count are considered by processors
11985 You can force the longer (286 and upwards, beginning with a \c{C1}
11986 byte) form of \c{ROL foo,1} by using a \c{BYTE} prefix: \c{ROL
11987 foo,BYTE 1}. Similarly with \c{ROR}.
11990 \S{insRSDC} \i\c{RSDC}: Restore Segment Register and Descriptor
11992 \c RSDC segreg,m80 ; 0F 79 /r [486,CYRIX,SMM]
11994 \c{RSDC} restores a segment register (DS, ES, FS, GS, or SS) from mem80,
11995 and sets up its descriptor.
11998 \S{insRSLDT} \i\c{RSLDT}: Restore Segment Register and Descriptor
12000 \c RSLDT m80 ; 0F 7B /0 [486,CYRIX,SMM]
12002 \c{RSLDT} restores the Local Descriptor Table (LDTR) from mem80.
12005 \S{insRSM} \i\c{RSM}: Resume from System-Management Mode
12007 \c RSM ; 0F AA [PENT]
12009 \c{RSM} returns the processor to its normal operating mode when it
12010 was in System-Management Mode.
12013 \S{insRSQRTPS} \i\c{RSQRTPS}: Packed Single-Precision FP Square Root Reciprocal
12015 \c RSQRTPS xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 0F 52 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
12017 \c{RSQRTPS} computes the approximate reciprocals of the square
12018 roots of the packed single-precision floating-point values in the
12019 source and stores the results in xmm1. The maximum error for this
12020 approximation is: |Error| <= 1.5 x 2^-12
12023 \S{insRSQRTSS} \i\c{RSQRTSS}: Scalar Single-Precision FP Square Root Reciprocal
12025 \c RSQRTSS xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; F3 0F 52 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
12027 \c{RSQRTSS} returns an approximation of the reciprocal of the
12028 square root of the lowest order single-precision FP value from
12029 the source, and stores it in the low doubleword of the destination
12030 register. The upper three fields of xmm1 are preserved. The maximum
12031 error for this approximation is: |Error| <= 1.5 x 2^-12
12034 \S{insRSTS} \i\c{RSTS}: Restore TSR and Descriptor
12036 \c RSTS m80 ; 0F 7D /0 [486,CYRIX,SMM]
12038 \c{RSTS} restores Task State Register (TSR) from mem80.
12041 \S{insSAHF} \i\c{SAHF}: Store AH to Flags
12043 \c SAHF ; 9E [8086]
12045 \c{SAHF} sets the low byte of the flags word according to the
12046 contents of the \c{AH} register.
12048 The operation of \c{SAHF} is:
12050 \c AH --> SF:ZF:0:AF:0:PF:1:CF
12052 See also \c{LAHF} (\k{insLAHF}).
12055 \S{insSAL} \i\c{SAL}, \i\c{SAR}: Bitwise Arithmetic Shifts
12057 \c SAL r/m8,1 ; D0 /4 [8086]
12058 \c SAL r/m8,CL ; D2 /4 [8086]
12059 \c SAL r/m8,imm8 ; C0 /4 ib [186]
12060 \c SAL r/m16,1 ; o16 D1 /4 [8086]
12061 \c SAL r/m16,CL ; o16 D3 /4 [8086]
12062 \c SAL r/m16,imm8 ; o16 C1 /4 ib [186]
12063 \c SAL r/m32,1 ; o32 D1 /4 [386]
12064 \c SAL r/m32,CL ; o32 D3 /4 [386]
12065 \c SAL r/m32,imm8 ; o32 C1 /4 ib [386]
12067 \c SAR r/m8,1 ; D0 /7 [8086]
12068 \c SAR r/m8,CL ; D2 /7 [8086]
12069 \c SAR r/m8,imm8 ; C0 /7 ib [186]
12070 \c SAR r/m16,1 ; o16 D1 /7 [8086]
12071 \c SAR r/m16,CL ; o16 D3 /7 [8086]
12072 \c SAR r/m16,imm8 ; o16 C1 /7 ib [186]
12073 \c SAR r/m32,1 ; o32 D1 /7 [386]
12074 \c SAR r/m32,CL ; o32 D3 /7 [386]
12075 \c SAR r/m32,imm8 ; o32 C1 /7 ib [386]
12077 \c{SAL} and \c{SAR} perform an arithmetic shift operation on the given
12078 source/destination (first) operand. The vacated bits are filled with
12079 zero for \c{SAL}, and with copies of the original high bit of the
12080 source operand for \c{SAR}.
12082 \c{SAL} is a synonym for \c{SHL} (see \k{insSHL}). NASM will
12083 assemble either one to the same code, but NDISASM will always
12084 disassemble that code as \c{SHL}.
12086 The number of bits to shift by is given by the second operand. Only
12087 the bottom five bits of the shift count are considered by processors
12090 You can force the longer (286 and upwards, beginning with a \c{C1}
12091 byte) form of \c{SAL foo,1} by using a \c{BYTE} prefix: \c{SAL
12092 foo,BYTE 1}. Similarly with \c{SAR}.
12095 \S{insSALC} \i\c{SALC}: Set AL from Carry Flag
12097 \c SALC ; D6 [8086,UNDOC]
12099 \c{SALC} is an early undocumented instruction similar in concept to
12100 \c{SETcc} (\k{insSETcc}). Its function is to set \c{AL} to zero if
12101 the carry flag is clear, or to \c{0xFF} if it is set.
12104 \S{insSBB} \i\c{SBB}: Subtract with Borrow
12106 \c SBB r/m8,reg8 ; 18 /r [8086]
12107 \c SBB r/m16,reg16 ; o16 19 /r [8086]
12108 \c SBB r/m32,reg32 ; o32 19 /r [386]
12110 \c SBB reg8,r/m8 ; 1A /r [8086]
12111 \c SBB reg16,r/m16 ; o16 1B /r [8086]
12112 \c SBB reg32,r/m32 ; o32 1B /r [386]
12114 \c SBB r/m8,imm8 ; 80 /3 ib [8086]
12115 \c SBB r/m16,imm16 ; o16 81 /3 iw [8086]
12116 \c SBB r/m32,imm32 ; o32 81 /3 id [386]
12118 \c SBB r/m16,imm8 ; o16 83 /3 ib [8086]
12119 \c SBB r/m32,imm8 ; o32 83 /3 ib [386]
12121 \c SBB AL,imm8 ; 1C ib [8086]
12122 \c SBB AX,imm16 ; o16 1D iw [8086]
12123 \c SBB EAX,imm32 ; o32 1D id [386]
12125 \c{SBB} performs integer subtraction: it subtracts its second
12126 operand, plus the value of the carry flag, from its first, and
12127 leaves the result in its destination (first) operand. The flags are
12128 set according to the result of the operation: in particular, the
12129 carry flag is affected and can be used by a subsequent \c{SBB}
12132 In the forms with an 8-bit immediate second operand and a longer
12133 first operand, the second operand is considered to be signed, and is
12134 sign-extended to the length of the first operand. In these cases,
12135 the \c{BYTE} qualifier is necessary to force NASM to generate this
12136 form of the instruction.
12138 To subtract one number from another without also subtracting the
12139 contents of the carry flag, use \c{SUB} (\k{insSUB}).
12142 \S{insSCASB} \i\c{SCASB}, \i\c{SCASW}, \i\c{SCASD}: Scan String
12144 \c SCASB ; AE [8086]
12145 \c SCASW ; o16 AF [8086]
12146 \c SCASD ; o32 AF [386]
12148 \c{SCASB} compares the byte in \c{AL} with the byte at \c{[ES:DI]}
12149 or \c{[ES:EDI]}, and sets the flags accordingly. It then increments
12150 or decrements (depending on the direction flag: increments if the
12151 flag is clear, decrements if it is set) \c{DI} (or \c{EDI}).
12153 The register used is \c{DI} if the address size is 16 bits, and
12154 \c{EDI} if it is 32 bits. If you need to use an address size not
12155 equal to the current \c{BITS} setting, you can use an explicit
12156 \i\c{a16} or \i\c{a32} prefix.
12158 Segment override prefixes have no effect for this instruction: the
12159 use of \c{ES} for the load from \c{[DI]} or \c{[EDI]} cannot be
12162 \c{SCASW} and \c{SCASD} work in the same way, but they compare a
12163 word to \c{AX} or a doubleword to \c{EAX} instead of a byte to
12164 \c{AL}, and increment or decrement the addressing registers by 2 or
12167 The \c{REPE} and \c{REPNE} prefixes (equivalently, \c{REPZ} and
12168 \c{REPNZ}) may be used to repeat the instruction up to \c{CX} (or
12169 \c{ECX} - again, the address size chooses which) times until the
12170 first unequal or equal byte is found.
12173 \S{insSETcc} \i\c{SETcc}: Set Register from Condition
12175 \c SETcc r/m8 ; 0F 90+cc /2 [386]
12177 \c{SETcc} sets the given 8-bit operand to zero if its condition is
12178 not satisfied, and to 1 if it is.
12181 \S{insSFENCE} \i\c{SFENCE}: Store Fence
12183 \c SFENCE ; 0F AE /7 [KATMAI]
12185 \c{SFENCE} performs a serialising operation on all writes to memory
12186 that were issued before the \c{SFENCE} instruction. This guarantees that
12187 all memory writes before the \c{SFENCE} instruction are visible before any
12188 writes after the \c{SFENCE} instruction.
12190 \c{SFENCE} is ordered respective to other \c{SFENCE} instruction, \c{MFENCE},
12191 any memory write and any other serialising instruction (such as \c{CPUID}).
12193 Weakly ordered memory types can be used to achieve higher processor
12194 performance through such techniques as out-of-order issue,
12195 write-combining, and write-collapsing. The degree to which a consumer
12196 of data recognizes or knows that the data is weakly ordered varies
12197 among applications and may be unknown to the producer of this data.
12198 The \c{SFENCE} instruction provides a performance-efficient way of
12199 insuring store ordering between routines that produce weakly-ordered
12200 results and routines that consume this data.
12202 \c{SFENCE} uses the following ModRM encoding:
12205 \c Reg/Opcode (5:3) = 111B
12206 \c R/M (2:0) = 000B
12208 All other ModRM encodings are defined to be reserved, and use
12209 of these encodings risks incompatibility with future processors.
12211 See also \c{LFENCE} (\k{insLFENCE}) and \c{MFENCE} (\k{insMFENCE}).
12214 \S{insSGDT} \i\c{SGDT}, \i\c{SIDT}, \i\c{SLDT}: Store Descriptor Table Pointers
12216 \c SGDT mem ; 0F 01 /0 [286,PRIV]
12217 \c SIDT mem ; 0F 01 /1 [286,PRIV]
12218 \c SLDT r/m16 ; 0F 00 /0 [286,PRIV]
12220 \c{SGDT} and \c{SIDT} both take a 6-byte memory area as an operand:
12221 they store the contents of the GDTR (global descriptor table
12222 register) or IDTR (interrupt descriptor table register) into that
12223 area as a 32-bit linear address and a 16-bit size limit from that
12224 area (in that order). These are the only instructions which directly
12225 use \e{linear} addresses, rather than segment/offset pairs.
12227 \c{SLDT} stores the segment selector corresponding to the LDT (local
12228 descriptor table) into the given operand.
12230 See also \c{LGDT}, \c{LIDT} and \c{LLDT} (\k{insLGDT}).
12233 \S{insSHL} \i\c{SHL}, \i\c{SHR}: Bitwise Logical Shifts
12235 \c SHL r/m8,1 ; D0 /4 [8086]
12236 \c SHL r/m8,CL ; D2 /4 [8086]
12237 \c SHL r/m8,imm8 ; C0 /4 ib [186]
12238 \c SHL r/m16,1 ; o16 D1 /4 [8086]
12239 \c SHL r/m16,CL ; o16 D3 /4 [8086]
12240 \c SHL r/m16,imm8 ; o16 C1 /4 ib [186]
12241 \c SHL r/m32,1 ; o32 D1 /4 [386]
12242 \c SHL r/m32,CL ; o32 D3 /4 [386]
12243 \c SHL r/m32,imm8 ; o32 C1 /4 ib [386]
12245 \c SHR r/m8,1 ; D0 /5 [8086]
12246 \c SHR r/m8,CL ; D2 /5 [8086]
12247 \c SHR r/m8,imm8 ; C0 /5 ib [186]
12248 \c SHR r/m16,1 ; o16 D1 /5 [8086]
12249 \c SHR r/m16,CL ; o16 D3 /5 [8086]
12250 \c SHR r/m16,imm8 ; o16 C1 /5 ib [186]
12251 \c SHR r/m32,1 ; o32 D1 /5 [386]
12252 \c SHR r/m32,CL ; o32 D3 /5 [386]
12253 \c SHR r/m32,imm8 ; o32 C1 /5 ib [386]
12255 \c{SHL} and \c{SHR} perform a logical shift operation on the given
12256 source/destination (first) operand. The vacated bits are filled with
12259 A synonym for \c{SHL} is \c{SAL} (see \k{insSAL}). NASM will
12260 assemble either one to the same code, but NDISASM will always
12261 disassemble that code as \c{SHL}.
12263 The number of bits to shift by is given by the second operand. Only
12264 the bottom five bits of the shift count are considered by processors
12267 You can force the longer (286 and upwards, beginning with a \c{C1}
12268 byte) form of \c{SHL foo,1} by using a \c{BYTE} prefix: \c{SHL
12269 foo,BYTE 1}. Similarly with \c{SHR}.
12272 \S{insSHLD} \i\c{SHLD}, \i\c{SHRD}: Bitwise Double-Precision Shifts
12274 \c SHLD r/m16,reg16,imm8 ; o16 0F A4 /r ib [386]
12275 \c SHLD r/m16,reg32,imm8 ; o32 0F A4 /r ib [386]
12276 \c SHLD r/m16,reg16,CL ; o16 0F A5 /r [386]
12277 \c SHLD r/m16,reg32,CL ; o32 0F A5 /r [386]
12279 \c SHRD r/m16,reg16,imm8 ; o16 0F AC /r ib [386]
12280 \c SHRD r/m32,reg32,imm8 ; o32 0F AC /r ib [386]
12281 \c SHRD r/m16,reg16,CL ; o16 0F AD /r [386]
12282 \c SHRD r/m32,reg32,CL ; o32 0F AD /r [386]
12284 \b \c{SHLD} performs a double-precision left shift. It notionally
12285 places its second operand to the right of its first, then shifts
12286 the entire bit string thus generated to the left by a number of
12287 bits specified in the third operand. It then updates only the
12288 \e{first} operand according to the result of this. The second
12289 operand is not modified.
12291 \b \c{SHRD} performs the corresponding right shift: it notionally
12292 places the second operand to the \e{left} of the first, shifts the
12293 whole bit string right, and updates only the first operand.
12295 For example, if \c{EAX} holds \c{0x01234567} and \c{EBX} holds
12296 \c{0x89ABCDEF}, then the instruction \c{SHLD EAX,EBX,4} would update
12297 \c{EAX} to hold \c{0x12345678}. Under the same conditions, \c{SHRD
12298 EAX,EBX,4} would update \c{EAX} to hold \c{0xF0123456}.
12300 The number of bits to shift by is given by the third operand. Only
12301 the bottom five bits of the shift count are considered.
12304 \S{insSHUFPD} \i\c{SHUFPD}: Shuffle Packed Double-Precision FP Values
12306 \c SHUFPD xmm1,xmm2/m128,imm8 ; 66 0F C6 /r ib [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
12308 \c{SHUFPD} moves one of the packed double-precision FP values from
12309 the destination operand into the low quadword of the destination
12310 operand; the upper quadword is generated by moving one of the
12311 double-precision FP values from the source operand into the
12312 destination. The select (third) operand selects which of the values
12313 are moved to the destination register.
12315 The select operand is an 8-bit immediate: bit 0 selects which value
12316 is moved from the destination operand to the result (where 0 selects
12317 the low quadword and 1 selects the high quadword) and bit 1 selects
12318 which value is moved from the source operand to the result.
12319 Bits 2 through 7 of the shuffle operand are reserved.
12322 \S{insSHUFPS} \i\c{SHUFPS}: Shuffle Packed Single-Precision FP Values
12324 \c SHUFPS xmm1,xmm2/m128,imm8 ; 0F C6 /r ib [KATMAI,SSE]
12326 \c{SHUFPS} moves two of the packed single-precision FP values from
12327 the destination operand into the low quadword of the destination
12328 operand; the upper quadword is generated by moving two of the
12329 single-precision FP values from the source operand into the
12330 destination. The select (third) operand selects which of the
12331 values are moved to the destination register.
12333 The select operand is an 8-bit immediate: bits 0 and 1 select the
12334 value to be moved from the destination operand the low doubleword of
12335 the result, bits 2 and 3 select the value to be moved from the
12336 destination operand the second doubleword of the result, bits 4 and
12337 5 select the value to be moved from the source operand the third
12338 doubleword of the result, and bits 6 and 7 select the value to be
12339 moved from the source operand to the high doubleword of the result.
12342 \S{insSMI} \i\c{SMI}: System Management Interrupt
12344 \c SMI ; F1 [386,UNDOC]
12346 \c{SMI} puts some AMD processors into SMM mode. It is available on some
12347 386 and 486 processors, and is only available when DR7 bit 12 is set,
12348 otherwise it generates an Int 1.
12351 \S{insSMINT} \i\c{SMINT}, \i\c{SMINTOLD}: Software SMM Entry (CYRIX)
12353 \c SMINT ; 0F 38 [PENT,CYRIX]
12354 \c SMINTOLD ; 0F 7E [486,CYRIX]
12356 \c{SMINT} puts the processor into SMM mode. The CPU state information is
12357 saved in the SMM memory header, and then execution begins at the SMM base
12360 \c{SMINTOLD} is the same as \c{SMINT}, but was the opcode used on the 486.
12362 This pair of opcodes are specific to the Cyrix and compatible range of
12363 processors (Cyrix, IBM, Via).
12366 \S{insSMSW} \i\c{SMSW}: Store Machine Status Word
12368 \c SMSW r/m16 ; 0F 01 /4 [286,PRIV]
12370 \c{SMSW} stores the bottom half of the \c{CR0} control register (or
12371 the Machine Status Word, on 286 processors) into the destination
12372 operand. See also \c{LMSW} (\k{insLMSW}).
12374 For 32-bit code, this would use the low 16-bits of the specified
12375 register (or a 16bit memory location), without needing an operand
12376 size override byte.
12379 \S{insSQRTPD} \i\c{SQRTPD}: Packed Double-Precision FP Square Root
12381 \c SQRTPD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 51 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
12383 \c{SQRTPD} calculates the square root of the packed double-precision
12384 FP value from the source operand, and stores the double-precision
12385 results in the destination register.
12388 \S{insSQRTPS} \i\c{SQRTPS}: Packed Single-Precision FP Square Root
12390 \c SQRTPS xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 0F 51 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
12392 \c{SQRTPS} calculates the square root of the packed single-precision
12393 FP value from the source operand, and stores the single-precision
12394 results in the destination register.
12397 \S{insSQRTSD} \i\c{SQRTSD}: Scalar Double-Precision FP Square Root
12399 \c SQRTSD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; F2 0F 51 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
12401 \c{SQRTSD} calculates the square root of the low-order double-precision
12402 FP value from the source operand, and stores the double-precision
12403 result in the destination register. The high-quadword remains unchanged.
12406 \S{insSQRTSS} \i\c{SQRTSS}: Scalar Single-Precision FP Square Root
12408 \c SQRTSS xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; F3 0F 51 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
12410 \c{SQRTSS} calculates the square root of the low-order single-precision
12411 FP value from the source operand, and stores the single-precision
12412 result in the destination register. The three high doublewords remain
12416 \S{insSTC} \i\c{STC}, \i\c{STD}, \i\c{STI}: Set Flags
12422 These instructions set various flags. \c{STC} sets the carry flag;
12423 \c{STD} sets the direction flag; and \c{STI} sets the interrupt flag
12424 (thus enabling interrupts).
12426 To clear the carry, direction, or interrupt flags, use the \c{CLC},
12427 \c{CLD} and \c{CLI} instructions (\k{insCLC}). To invert the carry
12428 flag, use \c{CMC} (\k{insCMC}).
12431 \S{insSTMXCSR} \i\c{STMXCSR}: Store Streaming SIMD Extension
12434 \c STMXCSR m32 ; 0F AE /3 [KATMAI,SSE]
12436 \c{STMXCSR} stores the contents of the \c{MXCSR} control/status
12437 register to the specified memory location. \c{MXCSR} is used to
12438 enable masked/unmasked exception handling, to set rounding modes,
12439 to set flush-to-zero mode, and to view exception status flags.
12440 The reserved bits in the \c{MXCSR} register are stored as 0s.
12442 For details of the \c{MXCSR} register, see the Intel processor docs.
12444 See also \c{LDMXCSR} (\k{insLDMXCSR}).
12447 \S{insSTOSB} \i\c{STOSB}, \i\c{STOSW}, \i\c{STOSD}: Store Byte to String
12449 \c STOSB ; AA [8086]
12450 \c STOSW ; o16 AB [8086]
12451 \c STOSD ; o32 AB [386]
12453 \c{STOSB} stores the byte in \c{AL} at \c{[ES:DI]} or \c{[ES:EDI]},
12454 and sets the flags accordingly. It then increments or decrements
12455 (depending on the direction flag: increments if the flag is clear,
12456 decrements if it is set) \c{DI} (or \c{EDI}).
12458 The register used is \c{DI} if the address size is 16 bits, and
12459 \c{EDI} if it is 32 bits. If you need to use an address size not
12460 equal to the current \c{BITS} setting, you can use an explicit
12461 \i\c{a16} or \i\c{a32} prefix.
12463 Segment override prefixes have no effect for this instruction: the
12464 use of \c{ES} for the store to \c{[DI]} or \c{[EDI]} cannot be
12467 \c{STOSW} and \c{STOSD} work in the same way, but they store the
12468 word in \c{AX} or the doubleword in \c{EAX} instead of the byte in
12469 \c{AL}, and increment or decrement the addressing registers by 2 or
12472 The \c{REP} prefix may be used to repeat the instruction \c{CX} (or
12473 \c{ECX} - again, the address size chooses which) times.
12476 \S{insSTR} \i\c{STR}: Store Task Register
12478 \c STR r/m16 ; 0F 00 /1 [286,PRIV]
12480 \c{STR} stores the segment selector corresponding to the contents of
12481 the Task Register into its operand. When the operand size is a 16-bit
12482 register, the upper 16-bits are cleared to 0s. When the destination
12483 operand is a memory location, 16 bits are written regardless of the
12487 \S{insSUB} \i\c{SUB}: Subtract Integers
12489 \c SUB r/m8,reg8 ; 28 /r [8086]
12490 \c SUB r/m16,reg16 ; o16 29 /r [8086]
12491 \c SUB r/m32,reg32 ; o32 29 /r [386]
12493 \c SUB reg8,r/m8 ; 2A /r [8086]
12494 \c SUB reg16,r/m16 ; o16 2B /r [8086]
12495 \c SUB reg32,r/m32 ; o32 2B /r [386]
12497 \c SUB r/m8,imm8 ; 80 /5 ib [8086]
12498 \c SUB r/m16,imm16 ; o16 81 /5 iw [8086]
12499 \c SUB r/m32,imm32 ; o32 81 /5 id [386]
12501 \c SUB r/m16,imm8 ; o16 83 /5 ib [8086]
12502 \c SUB r/m32,imm8 ; o32 83 /5 ib [386]
12504 \c SUB AL,imm8 ; 2C ib [8086]
12505 \c SUB AX,imm16 ; o16 2D iw [8086]
12506 \c SUB EAX,imm32 ; o32 2D id [386]
12508 \c{SUB} performs integer subtraction: it subtracts its second
12509 operand from its first, and leaves the result in its destination
12510 (first) operand. The flags are set according to the result of the
12511 operation: in particular, the carry flag is affected and can be used
12512 by a subsequent \c{SBB} instruction (\k{insSBB}).
12514 In the forms with an 8-bit immediate second operand and a longer
12515 first operand, the second operand is considered to be signed, and is
12516 sign-extended to the length of the first operand. In these cases,
12517 the \c{BYTE} qualifier is necessary to force NASM to generate this
12518 form of the instruction.
12521 \S{insSUBPD} \i\c{SUBPD}: Packed Double-Precision FP Subtract
12523 \c SUBPD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 5C /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
12525 \c{SUBPD} subtracts the packed double-precision FP values of
12526 the source operand from those of the destination operand, and
12527 stores the result in the destination operation.
12530 \S{insSUBPS} \i\c{SUBPS}: Packed Single-Precision FP Subtract
12532 \c SUBPS xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 0F 5C /r [KATMAI,SSE]
12534 \c{SUBPS} subtracts the packed single-precision FP values of
12535 the source operand from those of the destination operand, and
12536 stores the result in the destination operation.
12539 \S{insSUBSD} \i\c{SUBSD}: Scalar Single-FP Subtract
12541 \c SUBSD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; F2 0F 5C /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
12543 \c{SUBSD} subtracts the low-order double-precision FP value of
12544 the source operand from that of the destination operand, and
12545 stores the result in the destination operation. The high
12546 quadword is unchanged.
12549 \S{insSUBSS} \i\c{SUBSS}: Scalar Single-FP Subtract
12551 \c SUBSS xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; F3 0F 5C /r [KATMAI,SSE]
12553 \c{SUBSS} subtracts the low-order single-precision FP value of
12554 the source operand from that of the destination operand, and
12555 stores the result in the destination operation. The three high
12556 doublewords are unchanged.
12559 \S{insSVDC} \i\c{SVDC}: Save Segment Register and Descriptor
12561 \c SVDC m80,segreg ; 0F 78 /r [486,CYRIX,SMM]
12563 \c{SVDC} saves a segment register (DS, ES, FS, GS, or SS) and its
12564 descriptor to mem80.
12567 \S{insSVLDT} \i\c{SVLDT}: Save LDTR and Descriptor
12569 \c SVLDT m80 ; 0F 7A /0 [486,CYRIX,SMM]
12571 \c{SVLDT} saves the Local Descriptor Table (LDTR) to mem80.
12574 \S{insSVTS} \i\c{SVTS}: Save TSR and Descriptor
12576 \c SVTS m80 ; 0F 7C /0 [486,CYRIX,SMM]
12578 \c{SVTS} saves the Task State Register (TSR) to mem80.
12581 \S{insSYSCALL} \i\c{SYSCALL}: Call Operating System
12583 \c SYSCALL ; 0F 05 [P6,AMD]
12585 \c{SYSCALL} provides a fast method of transferring control to a fixed
12586 entry point in an operating system.
12588 \b The \c{EIP} register is copied into the \c{ECX} register.
12590 \b Bits [31-0] of the 64-bit SYSCALL/SYSRET Target Address Register
12591 (\c{STAR}) are copied into the \c{EIP} register.
12593 \b Bits [47-32] of the \c{STAR} register specify the selector that is
12594 copied into the \c{CS} register.
12596 \b Bits [47-32]+1000b of the \c{STAR} register specify the selector that
12597 is copied into the SS register.
12599 The \c{CS} and \c{SS} registers should not be modified by the operating
12600 system between the execution of the \c{SYSCALL} instruction and its
12601 corresponding \c{SYSRET} instruction.
12603 For more information, see the \c{SYSCALL and SYSRET Instruction Specification}
12604 (AMD document number 21086.pdf).
12607 \S{insSYSENTER} \i\c{SYSENTER}: Fast System Call
12609 \c SYSENTER ; 0F 34 [P6]
12611 \c{SYSENTER} executes a fast call to a level 0 system procedure or
12612 routine. Before using this instruction, various MSRs need to be set
12615 \b \c{SYSENTER_CS_MSR} contains the 32-bit segment selector for the
12616 privilege level 0 code segment. (This value is also used to compute
12617 the segment selector of the privilege level 0 stack segment.)
12619 \b \c{SYSENTER_EIP_MSR} contains the 32-bit offset into the privilege
12620 level 0 code segment to the first instruction of the selected operating
12621 procedure or routine.
12623 \b \c{SYSENTER_ESP_MSR} contains the 32-bit stack pointer for the
12624 privilege level 0 stack.
12626 \c{SYSENTER} performs the following sequence of operations:
12628 \b Loads the segment selector from the \c{SYSENTER_CS_MSR} into the
12631 \b Loads the instruction pointer from the \c{SYSENTER_EIP_MSR} into
12632 the \c{EIP} register.
12634 \b Adds 8 to the value in \c{SYSENTER_CS_MSR} and loads it into the
12637 \b Loads the stack pointer from the \c{SYSENTER_ESP_MSR} into the
12640 \b Switches to privilege level 0.
12642 \b Clears the \c{VM} flag in the \c{EFLAGS} register, if the flag
12645 \b Begins executing the selected system procedure.
12647 In particular, note that this instruction des not save the values of
12648 \c{CS} or \c{(E)IP}. If you need to return to the calling code, you
12649 need to write your code to cater for this.
12651 For more information, see the Intel Architecture Software Developer's
12655 \S{insSYSEXIT} \i\c{SYSEXIT}: Fast Return From System Call
12657 \c SYSEXIT ; 0F 35 [P6,PRIV]
12659 \c{SYSEXIT} executes a fast return to privilege level 3 user code.
12660 This instruction is a companion instruction to the \c{SYSENTER}
12661 instruction, and can only be executed by privilege level 0 code.
12662 Various registers need to be set up before calling this instruction:
12664 \b \c{SYSENTER_CS_MSR} contains the 32-bit segment selector for the
12665 privilege level 0 code segment in which the processor is currently
12666 executing. (This value is used to compute the segment selectors for
12667 the privilege level 3 code and stack segments.)
12669 \b \c{EDX} contains the 32-bit offset into the privilege level 3 code
12670 segment to the first instruction to be executed in the user code.
12672 \b \c{ECX} contains the 32-bit stack pointer for the privilege level 3
12675 \c{SYSEXIT} performs the following sequence of operations:
12677 \b Adds 16 to the value in \c{SYSENTER_CS_MSR} and loads the sum into
12678 the \c{CS} selector register.
12680 \b Loads the instruction pointer from the \c{EDX} register into the
12683 \b Adds 24 to the value in \c{SYSENTER_CS_MSR} and loads the sum
12684 into the \c{SS} selector register.
12686 \b Loads the stack pointer from the \c{ECX} register into the \c{ESP}
12689 \b Switches to privilege level 3.
12691 \b Begins executing the user code at the \c{EIP} address.
12693 For more information on the use of the \c{SYSENTER} and \c{SYSEXIT}
12694 instructions, see the Intel Architecture Software Developer's
12698 \S{insSYSRET} \i\c{SYSRET}: Return From Operating System
12700 \c SYSRET ; 0F 07 [P6,AMD,PRIV]
12702 \c{SYSRET} is the return instruction used in conjunction with the
12703 \c{SYSCALL} instruction to provide fast entry/exit to an operating system.
12705 \b The \c{ECX} register, which points to the next sequential instruction
12706 after the corresponding \c{SYSCALL} instruction, is copied into the \c{EIP}
12709 \b Bits [63-48] of the \c{STAR} register specify the selector that is copied
12710 into the \c{CS} register.
12712 \b Bits [63-48]+1000b of the \c{STAR} register specify the selector that is
12713 copied into the \c{SS} register.
12715 \b Bits [1-0] of the \c{SS} register are set to 11b (RPL of 3) regardless of
12716 the value of bits [49-48] of the \c{STAR} register.
12718 The \c{CS} and \c{SS} registers should not be modified by the operating
12719 system between the execution of the \c{SYSCALL} instruction and its
12720 corresponding \c{SYSRET} instruction.
12722 For more information, see the \c{SYSCALL and SYSRET Instruction Specification}
12723 (AMD document number 21086.pdf).
12726 \S{insTEST} \i\c{TEST}: Test Bits (notional bitwise AND)
12728 \c TEST r/m8,reg8 ; 84 /r [8086]
12729 \c TEST r/m16,reg16 ; o16 85 /r [8086]
12730 \c TEST r/m32,reg32 ; o32 85 /r [386]
12732 \c TEST r/m8,imm8 ; F6 /0 ib [8086]
12733 \c TEST r/m16,imm16 ; o16 F7 /0 iw [8086]
12734 \c TEST r/m32,imm32 ; o32 F7 /0 id [386]
12736 \c TEST AL,imm8 ; A8 ib [8086]
12737 \c TEST AX,imm16 ; o16 A9 iw [8086]
12738 \c TEST EAX,imm32 ; o32 A9 id [386]
12740 \c{TEST} performs a `mental' bitwise AND of its two operands, and
12741 affects the flags as if the operation had taken place, but does not
12742 store the result of the operation anywhere.
12745 \S{insUCOMISD} \i\c{UCOMISD}: Unordered Scalar Double-Precision FP
12746 compare and set EFLAGS
12748 \c UCOMISD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 2E /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
12750 \c{UCOMISD} compares the low-order double-precision FP numbers in the
12751 two operands, and sets the \c{ZF}, \c{PF} and \c{CF} bits in the
12752 \c{EFLAGS} register. In addition, the \c{OF}, \c{SF} and \c{AF} bits
12753 in the \c{EFLAGS} register are zeroed out. The unordered predicate
12754 (\c{ZF}, \c{PF} and \c{CF} all set) is returned if either source
12755 operand is a \c{NaN} (\c{qNaN} or \c{sNaN}).
12758 \S{insUCOMISS} \i\c{UCOMISS}: Unordered Scalar Single-Precision FP
12759 compare and set EFLAGS
12761 \c UCOMISS xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 0F 2E /r [KATMAI,SSE]
12763 \c{UCOMISS} compares the low-order single-precision FP numbers in the
12764 two operands, and sets the \c{ZF}, \c{PF} and \c{CF} bits in the
12765 \c{EFLAGS} register. In addition, the \c{OF}, \c{SF} and \c{AF} bits
12766 in the \c{EFLAGS} register are zeroed out. The unordered predicate
12767 (\c{ZF}, \c{PF} and \c{CF} all set) is returned if either source
12768 operand is a \c{NaN} (\c{qNaN} or \c{sNaN}).
12771 \S{insUD2} \i\c{UD0}, \i\c{UD1}, \i\c{UD2}: Undefined Instruction
12773 \c UD0 ; 0F FF [186,UNDOC]
12774 \c UD1 ; 0F B9 [186,UNDOC]
12775 \c UD2 ; 0F 0B [186]
12777 \c{UDx} can be used to generate an invalid opcode exception, for testing
12780 \c{UD0} is specifically documented by AMD as being reserved for this
12783 \c{UD1} is documented by Intel as being available for this purpose.
12785 \c{UD2} is specifically documented by Intel as being reserved for this
12786 purpose. Intel document this as the preferred method of generating an
12787 invalid opcode exception.
12789 All these opcodes can be used to generate invalid opcode exceptions on
12790 all currently available processors.
12793 \S{insUMOV} \i\c{UMOV}: User Move Data
12795 \c UMOV r/m8,reg8 ; 0F 10 /r [386,UNDOC]
12796 \c UMOV r/m16,reg16 ; o16 0F 11 /r [386,UNDOC]
12797 \c UMOV r/m32,reg32 ; o32 0F 11 /r [386,UNDOC]
12799 \c UMOV reg8,r/m8 ; 0F 12 /r [386,UNDOC]
12800 \c UMOV reg16,r/m16 ; o16 0F 13 /r [386,UNDOC]
12801 \c UMOV reg32,r/m32 ; o32 0F 13 /r [386,UNDOC]
12803 This undocumented instruction is used by in-circuit emulators to
12804 access user memory (as opposed to host memory). It is used just like
12805 an ordinary memory/register or register/register \c{MOV}
12806 instruction, but accesses user space.
12808 This instruction is only available on some AMD and IBM 386 and 486
12812 \S{insUNPCKHPD} \i\c{UNPCKHPD}: Unpack and Interleave High Packed
12813 Double-Precision FP Values
12815 \c UNPCKHPD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 15 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
12817 \c{UNPCKHPD} performs an interleaved unpack of the high-order data
12818 elements of the source and destination operands, saving the result
12819 in \c{xmm1}. It ignores the lower half of the sources.
12821 The operation of this instruction is:
12823 \c dst[63-0] := dst[127-64];
12824 \c dst[127-64] := src[127-64].
12827 \S{insUNPCKHPS} \i\c{UNPCKHPS}: Unpack and Interleave High Packed
12828 Single-Precision FP Values
12830 \c UNPCKHPS xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 0F 15 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
12832 \c{UNPCKHPS} performs an interleaved unpack of the high-order data
12833 elements of the source and destination operands, saving the result
12834 in \c{xmm1}. It ignores the lower half of the sources.
12836 The operation of this instruction is:
12838 \c dst[31-0] := dst[95-64];
12839 \c dst[63-32] := src[95-64];
12840 \c dst[95-64] := dst[127-96];
12841 \c dst[127-96] := src[127-96].
12844 \S{insUNPCKLPD} \i\c{UNPCKLPD}: Unpack and Interleave Low Packed
12845 Double-Precision FP Data
12847 \c UNPCKLPD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 14 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
12849 \c{UNPCKLPD} performs an interleaved unpack of the low-order data
12850 elements of the source and destination operands, saving the result
12851 in \c{xmm1}. It ignores the lower half of the sources.
12853 The operation of this instruction is:
12855 \c dst[63-0] := dst[63-0];
12856 \c dst[127-64] := src[63-0].
12859 \S{insUNPCKLPS} \i\c{UNPCKLPS}: Unpack and Interleave Low Packed
12860 Single-Precision FP Data
12862 \c UNPCKLPS xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 0F 14 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
12864 \c{UNPCKLPS} performs an interleaved unpack of the low-order data
12865 elements of the source and destination operands, saving the result
12866 in \c{xmm1}. It ignores the lower half of the sources.
12868 The operation of this instruction is:
12870 \c dst[31-0] := dst[31-0];
12871 \c dst[63-32] := src[31-0];
12872 \c dst[95-64] := dst[63-32];
12873 \c dst[127-96] := src[63-32].
12876 \S{insVERR} \i\c{VERR}, \i\c{VERW}: Verify Segment Readability/Writability
12878 \c VERR r/m16 ; 0F 00 /4 [286,PRIV]
12880 \c VERW r/m16 ; 0F 00 /5 [286,PRIV]
12882 \b \c{VERR} sets the zero flag if the segment specified by the selector
12883 in its operand can be read from at the current privilege level.
12884 Otherwise it is cleared.
12886 \b \c{VERW} sets the zero flag if the segment can be written.
12889 \S{insWAIT} \i\c{WAIT}: Wait for Floating-Point Processor
12891 \c WAIT ; 9B [8086]
12892 \c FWAIT ; 9B [8086]
12894 \c{WAIT}, on 8086 systems with a separate 8087 FPU, waits for the
12895 FPU to have finished any operation it is engaged in before
12896 continuing main processor operations, so that (for example) an FPU
12897 store to main memory can be guaranteed to have completed before the
12898 CPU tries to read the result back out.
12900 On higher processors, \c{WAIT} is unnecessary for this purpose, and
12901 it has the alternative purpose of ensuring that any pending unmasked
12902 FPU exceptions have happened before execution continues.
12905 \S{insWBINVD} \i\c{WBINVD}: Write Back and Invalidate Cache
12907 \c WBINVD ; 0F 09 [486]
12909 \c{WBINVD} invalidates and empties the processor's internal caches,
12910 and causes the processor to instruct external caches to do the same.
12911 It writes the contents of the caches back to memory first, so no
12912 data is lost. To flush the caches quickly without bothering to write
12913 the data back first, use \c{INVD} (\k{insINVD}).
12916 \S{insWRMSR} \i\c{WRMSR}: Write Model-Specific Registers
12918 \c WRMSR ; 0F 30 [PENT]
12920 \c{WRMSR} writes the value in \c{EDX:EAX} to the processor
12921 Model-Specific Register (MSR) whose index is stored in \c{ECX}.
12922 See also \c{RDMSR} (\k{insRDMSR}).
12925 \S{insWRSHR} \i\c{WRSHR}: Write SMM Header Pointer Register
12927 \c WRSHR r/m32 ; 0F 37 /0 [386,CYRIX,SMM]
12929 \c{WRSHR} loads the contents of either a 32-bit memory location or a
12930 32-bit register into the SMM header pointer register.
12932 See also \c{RDSHR} (\k{insRDSHR}).
12935 \S{insXADD} \i\c{XADD}: Exchange and Add
12937 \c XADD r/m8,reg8 ; 0F C0 /r [486]
12938 \c XADD r/m16,reg16 ; o16 0F C1 /r [486]
12939 \c XADD r/m32,reg32 ; o32 0F C1 /r [486]
12941 \c{XADD} exchanges the values in its two operands, and then adds
12942 them together and writes the result into the destination (first)
12943 operand. This instruction can be used with a \c{LOCK} prefix for
12944 multi-processor synchronisation purposes.
12947 \S{insXBTS} \i\c{XBTS}: Extract Bit String
12949 \c XBTS reg16,r/m16 ; o16 0F A6 /r [386,UNDOC]
12950 \c XBTS reg32,r/m32 ; o32 0F A6 /r [386,UNDOC]
12952 The implied operation of this instruction is:
12954 \c XBTS r/m16,reg16,AX,CL
12955 \c XBTS r/m32,reg32,EAX,CL
12957 Writes a bit string from the source operand to the destination. \c{CL}
12958 indicates the number of bits to be copied, and \c{(E)AX} indicates the
12959 low order bit offset in the source. The bits are written to the low
12960 order bits of the destination register. For example, if \c{CL} is set
12961 to 4 and \c{AX} (for 16-bit code) is set to 5, bits 5-8 of \c{src} will
12962 be copied to bits 0-3 of \c{dst}. This instruction is very poorly
12963 documented, and I have been unable to find any official source of
12964 documentation on it.
12966 \c{XBTS} is supported only on the early Intel 386s, and conflicts with
12967 the opcodes for \c{CMPXCHG486} (on early Intel 486s). NASM supports it
12968 only for completeness. Its counterpart is \c{IBTS} (see \k{insIBTS}).
12971 \S{insXCHG} \i\c{XCHG}: Exchange
12973 \c XCHG reg8,r/m8 ; 86 /r [8086]
12974 \c XCHG reg16,r/m8 ; o16 87 /r [8086]
12975 \c XCHG reg32,r/m32 ; o32 87 /r [386]
12977 \c XCHG r/m8,reg8 ; 86 /r [8086]
12978 \c XCHG r/m16,reg16 ; o16 87 /r [8086]
12979 \c XCHG r/m32,reg32 ; o32 87 /r [386]
12981 \c XCHG AX,reg16 ; o16 90+r [8086]
12982 \c XCHG EAX,reg32 ; o32 90+r [386]
12983 \c XCHG reg16,AX ; o16 90+r [8086]
12984 \c XCHG reg32,EAX ; o32 90+r [386]
12986 \c{XCHG} exchanges the values in its two operands. It can be used
12987 with a \c{LOCK} prefix for purposes of multi-processor
12990 \c{XCHG AX,AX} or \c{XCHG EAX,EAX} (depending on the \c{BITS}
12991 setting) generates the opcode \c{90h}, and so is a synonym for
12992 \c{NOP} (\k{insNOP}).
12995 \S{insXLATB} \i\c{XLATB}: Translate Byte in Lookup Table
12997 \c XLAT ; D7 [8086]
12998 \c XLATB ; D7 [8086]
13000 \c{XLATB} adds the value in \c{AL}, treated as an unsigned byte, to
13001 \c{BX} or \c{EBX}, and loads the byte from the resulting address (in
13002 the segment specified by \c{DS}) back into \c{AL}.
13004 The base register used is \c{BX} if the address size is 16 bits, and
13005 \c{EBX} if it is 32 bits. If you need to use an address size not
13006 equal to the current \c{BITS} setting, you can use an explicit
13007 \i\c{a16} or \i\c{a32} prefix.
13009 The segment register used to load from \c{[BX+AL]} or \c{[EBX+AL]}
13010 can be overridden by using a segment register name as a prefix (for
13011 example, \c{es xlatb}).
13014 \S{insXOR} \i\c{XOR}: Bitwise Exclusive OR
13016 \c XOR r/m8,reg8 ; 30 /r [8086]
13017 \c XOR r/m16,reg16 ; o16 31 /r [8086]
13018 \c XOR r/m32,reg32 ; o32 31 /r [386]
13020 \c XOR reg8,r/m8 ; 32 /r [8086]
13021 \c XOR reg16,r/m16 ; o16 33 /r [8086]
13022 \c XOR reg32,r/m32 ; o32 33 /r [386]
13024 \c XOR r/m8,imm8 ; 80 /6 ib [8086]
13025 \c XOR r/m16,imm16 ; o16 81 /6 iw [8086]
13026 \c XOR r/m32,imm32 ; o32 81 /6 id [386]
13028 \c XOR r/m16,imm8 ; o16 83 /6 ib [8086]
13029 \c XOR r/m32,imm8 ; o32 83 /6 ib [386]
13031 \c XOR AL,imm8 ; 34 ib [8086]
13032 \c XOR AX,imm16 ; o16 35 iw [8086]
13033 \c XOR EAX,imm32 ; o32 35 id [386]
13035 \c{XOR} performs a bitwise XOR operation between its two operands
13036 (i.e. each bit of the result is 1 if and only if exactly one of the
13037 corresponding bits of the two inputs was 1), and stores the result
13038 in the destination (first) operand.
13040 In the forms with an 8-bit immediate second operand and a longer
13041 first operand, the second operand is considered to be signed, and is
13042 sign-extended to the length of the first operand. In these cases,
13043 the \c{BYTE} qualifier is necessary to force NASM to generate this
13044 form of the instruction.
13046 The \c{MMX} instruction \c{PXOR} (see \k{insPXOR}) performs the same
13047 operation on the 64-bit \c{MMX} registers.
13050 \S{insXORPD} \i\c{XORPD}: Bitwise Logical XOR of Double-Precision FP Values
13052 \c XORPD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 57 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
13054 \c{XORPD} returns a bit-wise logical XOR between the source and
13055 destination operands, storing the result in the destination operand.
13058 \S{insXORPS} \i\c{XORPS}: Bitwise Logical XOR of Single-Precision FP Values
13060 \c XORPS xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 0F 57 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
13062 \c{XORPS} returns a bit-wise logical XOR between the source and
13063 destination operands, storing the result in the destination operand.